0100CT1501 PDF
0100CT1501 PDF
Digest 177
digestplus-us.schneider-electric.com
Schneider Electric brands that
deliver the solutions you demand.
Square D power solutions – ready for the future.
Square D by Schneider Electric brand NEMA power and control solutions have been trusted over 100 years for
TM TM
performance, reliability, and energy-saving design. From residential load centers and metering products to commercial
panelboards, energy conserving transformers, and safety switches, Square D brand products provide you with quality
solutions for distributing and monitoring electrical power. It’s more than an electrical system. It’s the backbone of
today’s energy-demanding homes and businesses.
solutions and advanced system controls. Since 1976, we have been serving customers throughout North America,
including electrical distributors, lighting showrooms, contractors, architects, engineers, lighting designers, and
commercial establishments, offering them high-quality, innovative products, designed and engineered in the
United States. The Juno Lighting Group product family includes over 50,000 items for commercial and residential
construction, and includes a rapidly expanding line of eco-friendly LED fixtures for outdoor, recessed, track,
decorative, and under-cabinet applications.
systems ideal for any industry. From megapixel cameras to video management and recording to display, Pelco
solutions deliver the best image quality in video security.
> pelco.com
TM software, and services designed to ensure availability and higher energy efficiency across the residential, business
network, data center, and manufacturing environments. The position of APC on the cutting edge of data center
thought leadership for over two decades has changed the way the world designs, installs, operates, and maintains
data centers. APC has unparalleled commitment to innovation and the world’s leading R&D investment (more than
$90 million annually) dedicated to critical power and cooling issues.
Founded over 90 years ago, Telemecanique Sensors is an independent brand of Schneider Electric, specializing
in sensors and sensor-related technology.
Telemecanique Sensors is a global player, present in more than 20 countries, with products distributed worldwide
through a broad network of partners.
As a global leader in the sensors business, we help our customers select the right technology to get the best
performance and reliability from their machines.
Focused on three core values – Simplicity, Proximity, and Expertise – we have become experts in factory automation
sensors as well as specialists in demanding applications, making our customers’ lives “simply easy!”
© 2015 Schneider Electric. All Rights Reserved. Schneider Electric, Square D, Juno, Pelco, and APC are trademarks owned by Schneider Electric Industries SAS or its affiliated companies. All other trademarks are
the property of their respective owners. • www.schneider-electric.com • 998-19128217_GMA-US
How to Use Digest 177 Table of Contents
Product Section Listing
Welcome to the Schneider Electric Digest! Over a thousand pages of technical product
information to help you specify and select Schneider Electric products. 1 Load Centers
A key element of the Digest 177 is its color-coded Table of Contents, shown at the right, and
matching product section tabs throughout the Digest. This colorful approach aids navigation
and helps you quickly find the major product categories.
2 Metering Equipment
A detailed Table of Contents is provided at the beginning of each product section and two
indexes are available in the back of the book: an alphabetical listing and an alphanumeric 3 Safety Switches
listing. To ensure you have the latest pricing information, list prices are now available online
only. This meets our customer and market driven demand to merge technical information with
functionality. 4 Power Monitoring and Control
Finally, the Supplemental and Obsolescence Digest 177 contains additional product
information for our international product offer, our legacy products in the obsolescence
process, and more.
5 Advanced Products
DigestPLUS
6 Surge Protective Devices
DigestPLUS provides one location to access the technical product information you need to 7 Miniature and Molded Case
Circuit Breakers
specify and select Schneider Electric products, right at your fingers. With links to over 22,000
orderable parts and over 17,000 pages of the most up-to-date product data, including: the
Digest, Supplemental and Obsolescence Digest, related product catalogs, CAD drawings, 8 Operator Mechanisms and
Disconnect Switches
circuit breaker time-current characteristic curves, white papers, product cross reference, and
locator services tools. DigestPLUS is powerful, yet simple.
DigestPLUS offers you the option to install a mobile app (iOS or Android), which ensures you
9 Panelboards
have access to the latest Schneider Electric technical and product selection information.
www.digestplus-us.schneider-electric.com
10 Power Solutions: Integrated
PROficient: is a Suite of Free Digital Tools, designed for electrical contractors, by electrical
13 Wire Management
contractors, to help increase efficiency in everything you do.
• Easy to use, on your desktop, smartphone, and tablet 14 Transformers
• Faster, more accurate
•
•
Quick response to change
Project history visible and accessible
15 Medical Products
• One log-in, one suite of tools
• Your 24/7 pathway to generating more business 16 NEMA Contactors and Starters
www.schneider-electric.us/proficient
17 Motor Control Centers
LayoutFAST: a Revit MEP Plugin that's going to help you select, configure and insert the
most updated Schneider Electric Product Models from the cloud into your design without
leaving your Revit Project. Depending on your project stage, build the most accurate Revit 18 IEC Contactors and Starters
family simply by answering a few questions.
Turn minutes of design work into seconds.
19 Push Buttons and
Operator Interface
Customer Care Center 20 Electronic Sensors and
Machine Cabling
Have questions?
Need technical support or onsite service? 21 Limit Switches
1-888-778-2733
Product Cross Reference: Enter an obsolete or competitive part number to receive the
Schneider Electric equivalent.
28 Enclosures
Frequently Asked Questions: Access our Knowledge Base for answers to thousands of
our most frequently asked questions, updated daily. https://www.schneider-electric.us/en/faqs 29 Uninterruptible Power Supplies
Calculators and Configurators: Simplify your product selection.
Alphabetical Listing
Alpha-Numeric Listing
New and Enhanced Products in Digest 177
schneider-electric.us
Section 1
Load Centers
LOAD CENTERS
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance 1-2
1
QO Minia ture Circuit Bre a ke rs
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers 1-10
11/10/2017
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance Load Center EZ Selector - Selection
Assistance
1
schneider-electric.us
Additional Information
• Search “Load Centers” from our technical FAQs page: www.schneider-electric.us/en/
faqs/home/
• Refer to catalog 1100CT0501.
1-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs QO™ Load Centers
Class 736, 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
QO120L125G QO816L100F or S
without cover
1
Mains Max. 1P Max. Indoor Cover with Door Main Wire Size
Space- Tandem Load Center (Order Separately) AWG/kcmil Equipment Ground Bar Box No.
Rat- Circuits
s Circuit Box and Interior Kit (Order Separately) [2]
ing [1] Flush Surface Al Cu
Breakers
Fixed Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [3]
30 A 2 2 0 QO2L30S [4] [5] Cover Included—Without Door 12–10 14–10 PK3GTA1 1
70 A 2 4 2 QO24L70F/S [6] [7] Cover Included—Without Door 12–3 14–4 PK4GTA 2
6 12 6 QO612L100F/S [6] [8] Cover Included—Without Door PK7GTA 4
6 12 6 QO612L100DF/S [6] [8] Cover Included—With Door PK7GTA 4
8 16 8 QO816L100F/S [6] [8] Cover Included—Without Door
100 A PK7GTA 4
8 16 8 QO816L100DF/S [6] [8] Cover Included—With Door 8–1
6 12 6 QO612L100DFCU/SCU [6] [8] [9] Cover Included—With Door PK7GTA 4
8 16 8 QO816L100DFCU/SCU [6] [8] [9] Cover Included—With Door PK7GTA 4
125 A 4 8 4 QO148L125GF/S [6] [10] Cover Included—Without Door 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA [11] 21
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker—Cu Bus [3] [12]
12 12 0 QO112L125G QOC16UF QOC16US PK9GTA [11] 6
12 24 12 QO11224L125G QOC16UF QOC16US PK15GTA [11] 6
6–2/0
16 16 0 QO116L125G QOC24UF QOC24US PK12GTA [11] 7
16 24 8 QO11624L125G QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTA [11] 7
125 A
20 20 0 QO120L125G QOC20U100F QOC20U100S 6–2/0 6–1 PK15GTA [11] 6
I 20 24 4 QO12024L125G QOC20U100F QOC20U100S 6–2/0 6–1 PK15GTA [11] 6
N
D 24 24 0 QO124L125G QOC24UF QOC24US PK15GTA [11] 7
6–2/0
O 32 32 0 QO132L125G QOC32UF Use Flush PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 8
O Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating —Convertible To Main Circuit Breaker—Cu Bus [3] [12]
R
20 30 10 QO12030L150G QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
150 A 24 24 0 QO124L150G QOC30UF QOC30US 6–250 PK15GTA [11] 9
30 30 0 QO130L150G QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
12 12 0 QO112L200G QOC30UF QOC30US PK15GTA [11] 9
24 36 12 QO12436L200TFT [13] QOC40UF QOC40US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 10
30 30 0 QO130L200G QOC30UF QOC30US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
200 A 30 40 10 QO13040L200G QOC30UF QOC30US 6–250 PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 9
40 40 0 QO140L200G QOC40UF QOC40US PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 10
40 60 20 QO14060L200G QOC40UF QOC40US (2) PK15GTA [11] 10
42 52 10 QO14252L200G QOC42UF QOC42US (2) PK15GTA [11] 11
225 A 42 42 0 QO142L225G QOC42UF QOC42US 6–300 PK23GTA, LK100AN [11] 11
Fixed Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [3] [12]
QONQ30LS400 (Int) [14]
30 30 0 NC50NQVF NC50NQVS PK27GTA [15] 15
MH50 (box) [16] (1) 1/0–750
400 A or (2) 1/0–300 or
QONQ42LS400 (Int) [14] PK15GTA6
42 42 0 NC50NQVF NC50NQVS 15
MH50 (box) [16]
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115C as Type 1, Class 2.
[1] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[2] See Table 1.57 Knockout Information, page 1-24
[3] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[4] Will not accept QO-EPD or Qwik-Gard™ QO-GFI or QO-AFI circuit breakers.
[5] Mains rated 25 A when Al wire is used.
[6] Order F for flush device or S for surface device.
[7] Use 10 AWG maximum size wire for GFI and AFI circuit breakers.
[8] 70 A Max. branch circuit breaker and 100 A max. back fed main circuit breaker.
[9] CU indicates copper bus.
[10] Copper bus.
[11] Factory-included.
[12] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[13] Supplied with feed-thru lugs.
[14] Interior only, order box separately.
[15] PK27GTA includes a 6–2/0 AWG Al/Cu lug.
[16] PE1A Discount Schedule.
1-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Load Centers Indoor, 1Ø, Main Circuit Breaker
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
60 A 100–125 QOM60VH
70 A 100–125 QOM70VH
80 A 100–125 QOM80VH
12–2/0 Al or Cu
90 A 100–125 QOM90VH
QOM1 Frame Size 100 A 100–125 QOM100VH
50–125 Amperes
110 A 125 QOM110VH
125 A 125 QOM125VH
Table 1.3: QOM2 Frame Size—Use with Convertible Main Load Centers Only
Convertible 22 k AIR [18]
Main Circuit Breaker Lug Wire Size [19]
Load Center Mains
Rating [17] Rating Main Circuit Breaker [20] AWG/kcmil
100 A 150–225 QOM2100VH
125 A 150–225 QOM2125VH
150 A 150–225 QOM2150VH
4–300 Al or Cu
175 A 200–225 QOM2175VH
200 A 200–225 QOM2200VH
QOM2 Frame Size 225 A 225 QOM2225VH
100–225 Amperes
LOAD CENTERS
Main Lugs Lug Wire Size [29]
Rating [28] Convertible Load Center Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
with Mains Rating Al or Cu
125 A 100–125 A QOL125 [30] 6–2/0
225 A 150–225 A QOL225 [30] 6–300
QOL125 QOL225
Table 1.6: QO Plug-on Neutral CAFI Load Center (accepts QO Circuit Breakers only)
Indoor Cover with Door Main Wire Equipment
Max. Max. (Order Separately) Size Ground Bar
Mains Load Center Box and Box No.
Spaces 1P Tandem AWG/kcmil Kit [31]
Rating Interior [32]
1
Circuits Breakers (Order
Flush Surface Al/Cu Separately)
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
125 A 24 24 0 QO124L125PG QOC24UF QOC24US 6–2/0 PK15GTA 7
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
200 A 30 30 0 QO130L200PG QOC30UF QOC30US 6–250 PK23GTA, 9
LK100AN
I 42 42 0 QO142L225PG QOC42UF QOC42US (2) PK15GTA 11
N 225 A 6–300 PK23GTA,
D 54 54 0 QO154L225PG QOC54UF — 12
LK100AN
O Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
O QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker
R
100 A 24 24 0 QO124M100P QOC24UF QOC24US 6–2/0 PK15GTA 7
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker
30 30 0 QO130M200P QOC30UF QOC30US PK18GTA 9
42 42 0 QO142M200P QOC42UF QOC42US PK23GTA 11
200 A 4–250
54 54 0 QO154M200P QOC54UF — PK23GTA 12
60 60 0 QO160M200PC [33] — — PK23GTA 24
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Cu Bus
QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker — Equipment Ground Bar Included
125 A 24 24 0 QO124L125PGRB — — 6–2/0 PK15GTA 4R
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Lugs — 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Cu Bus
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker — Equipment Ground Bar Included
QO130L200PGRB PK23GTA,
O 200 A 30 30 0 — — 6–250 6R
LK100AN
U 225 A 42 42 0 QO142L225PGRB — — 6–300 (2) PK15GTA 8R
QO154M200P T
D Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
O Convertible to Main Lugs (see below) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs, page 1-3),
O QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size
R 100 A 24 24 0 QO124M100PRB — — 6–2/0 PK15GTA 4R
Convertible Mains — Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker — 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating — Copper Bus
Convertible to Main Lugs (see below) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs, page 1-3),
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size
150 A 30 30 0 QO130M150PRB — — PK18GTA 6R
30 30 0 QO130M200PRB — — 4–250 PK18GTA 6R
200 A
42 42 0 QO142M200PRB — — PK23GTA 8R
Max. Main
Max. Wire Size Equipment
Mains Tandem Load Center Box No.
Rating Spaces Single Pole AWG/kcmil Ground Bar Kit
Circuit Box and Interior (Order Separately) [35]
Circuits [34]
Breakers Al Cu
Non-Metallic Enclosure
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
60 A 2 4 2 QO24L60NRNM 14–4 14–4 Factory-installed 1NM
Metallic Enclosure
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
40 A 2 2 0 QO2L40RB [36] 12–6 14–6 PK3GTA1 1R
70 A 2 4 2 QO24L70RB [36] 12–3 14–4 PK4GTA 1R
6 12 6 QO612L100RB[37] PK7GTA 2R
6 12 6 QO612L100TRB[37] Factory-installed 2R
100 A 8 16 8 QO816L100RB [37] 8–1 PK7GTA 2R
6 12 6 QO612L100RBCU[37] [38] PK7GTA 2R
R 8 16 8 QO816L100RBCU[37] [38] PK7GTA 2R
A 125 A 4 8 4 QO148L125GRB [38] 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA Factory-included 15R
I Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current[39][40][41]
N QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus
P
R 12 12 0 QO112L125GRB PK9GTA Factory-included 3R
O 12 24 12 QO11224L125GRB PK15GTA Factory-included 3R
O 125 A 6–2/0
F 16 24 8 QO11624L125GRB PK15GTA Factory-included 4R
24 24 0 QO124L125GRB PK15GTA Factory-included 4R
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—65 kA Short Circuit Current[39][40][41]
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus
150 A 30 30 0 QO130L150GRB 4–250 PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 6R
12 12 0 QO112L200GRB PK9GTA Factory-included 5R
30 30 0 QO130L200GRB PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 6R
30 40 10 QO13040L200GRB PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 6R
200 A 4–250
40 40 0 QO140L200GRB PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 7R
40 60 20 QO14060L200GRB (2) PK15GTA Factory-included 7R
42 52 10 QO14252L200GRB (2) PK15GTA Factory-included 8R
225 A 42 42 0 QO142L225GRB 4–300 PK23GTA, LK100AN Factory-included 8R
Table 1.8: Main Circuit Breaker (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers.)
Max. Max. Main Equipment
Mains Tandem Load Center Wire Size Box No.
Rating Spaces Single Pole Ground Bar Kit
Circuit Box and Interior AWG/kcmil (Order Separately) [35]
Circuits [34]
Breakers Al or Cu
Convertible Mains —Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible to Main Lugs (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit Breaker, page 1-4)
or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Lugs, page 1-3)[41][42]
QOM1 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
12 12 0 QO112M100RB PK9GTA 3R
100 A 16 16 0 QO116M100RB 6–2/0 PK12GTA 4R
20 20 0 QO120M100RB PK15GTA 4R
125 A 24 24 0 QO124M125RB 6–2/0 PK15GTA 4R
Convertible Mains —Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to Main Lugs (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit
Breaker, page 1-4) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Lugs, page 1-3) [41][42]
QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
R 20 30 10 QO12030M150RB PK18GTA 5R
A 150 A 4–250
I 30 30 0 QO130M150RB PK18GTA 6R
N 20 40 20 QO12040M200RB PK23GTA 5R
P 30 30 0 QO130M200RB PK18GTA 6R
R 30 40 10 QO13040M200GRB PK23GTA 6R
O
O 200 A 40 40 0 QO140M200RB 4–250 PK23GTA 7R
F 40 60 20 QO14060M200RB PK15GTA 7R
42 42 0 QO142M200RB PK23GTA 8R
42 52 10 QO14252M200RB PK15GTA 8R
225 A 42 42 0 QO142M225RB 4–300 PK23GTA 8R
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible to Main Lugs (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed Main Circuit Breaker, page 1-4) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (see 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed
Main Lugs, page 1-3) [41][42]
QOM1 or QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size—Copper Bus
125 A 6 12 6 QO1612M125FTRB[43] 4–2/0 PK12GTA 3R
150 A 8 16 8 QO1816M150FTRB[43] 4–250 PK15GTA-L 6R
200 A 8 16 8 QO1816M200FTRB [43] 4–250 PK15GTA-L 6R
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.
[34] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[35] See Table 1.59 Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-26Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[36] Use 10 AWG maximum size wire for GFI and AFI circuit breakers.
[37] 70 A Max. branch circuit breaker and 70 A max. back fed main circuit breaker.
[38] Copper bus.
[39] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[40] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[41] Side hinge door device; allow 1-1/4 in. on left side for door to open.
[42] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QOT, QO-GFI, QO-AFI, QO-EPD and QOPL 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems up to 22 kA
available fault current.
[43] QO1612M125FTRB provided with QOM1 frame main circuit breaker. QO1816M150FTRB and QO1816M200FTRB provided with QOM2 frame main circuit breaker.
1-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Breaker QO™ Load Centers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
Table 1.9: Main Lugs and Main Breakers (Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers)
Max. Indoor Cover with Door Main
Number Load Center Wire Size Equipment Box No.
Mains Box and Interior (Order Separately) Ground Bar Kit See
Rating of 1P QO AWG/kcmil Pages 1-17,
circuit (Order Separately)
Cat. No. Flush Surface Al Cu 1–18
breakers
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Copper Bus—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [44]
Cover Included With Load Center (No
60 A 3 QO403L60NF/S Door) — 10–6 PK4GTA 13
12 QO312L125G [45] QOC16UF QOC16US Factory-incl. [46] 6
125 A 20 QO320L125G [45] QOC24UF QOC24US 6–2/0 6–2/0 Factory-incl. [46] 7
24 QO324L125G [45] QOC24UF QOC24US Factory-incl. [46] 7
18 QO318L200G [45] QOC30UF QOC30US Factory-incl. [47] 9
I 200 A 6–250 6–250
N 30 QO330L200G [45] QOC30UF QOC30US Factory-incl. [47] 9
D 225 A 42 QO342L225G [45] QOC42UF QOC42US 6–300 6–300 Factory-incl. [47] 11
1
O
O Convertible Mains—Factory-installed QDL Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus—25 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [48]
R 100 A 27 QO327M100 [49] QOC30UF QOC30US 4–2/0 4–2/0 PK15GTA 9
125 A 30 QO330MQ125[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS 4–300 4–300 PK18GTA 12
30 QO330MQ150[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK18GTA 12
150 A 4–300 4–300
42 QO342MQ150[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK23GTA 12
30 QO330MQ200[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK18GTA 12
200 A 4–300 4–300
42 QO342MQ200[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS PK23GTA 12
225 A 42 QO342MQ225[50] [45] QOC342MQF QOC342MQS 4–300 4–300 PK23GTA 12
Fixed Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Copper Bus—65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [44] [51]
60 A 3 QO403L60NRB — 10–6 PK4GTA 10R
12 QO312L125GRB Factory Incl. [46] 3R
125 A 6–2/0 6–2/0
20 QO320L125GRB Factory Incl. [46] 4R
R Cover Included
18 QO318L200GRB Factory Incl. [47] 6R
A 200 A 6–250 6–250
I 30 QO330L200GRB Factory Incl. [47] 6R
N 225 A 42 QO342L225GRB 6–300 6–300 Factory Incl. [47] 8R
P
R Convertible Mains—Factory-installed QDL Main Circuit Breaker—Copper Bus—25 kA Short Circuit Current Rating [48] [51]
O 100 A 27 QO327M100RB [49] 4–2/0 4–2/0 PK15GTA 6R
O 125 A 30 QO330MQ125RB [50] 4–300 4–300 PK18GTA 14R
F
150 A 30 QO330MQ150RB [50] 4–300 4–300 PK18GTA 14R
Cover Included
30 QO330MQ200RB[50] PK18GTA 14R
200 A 4–300 4–300
42 QO342MQ200RB [50] PK23GTA 14R
225 A 42 QO342MQ225RB [50] 4–300 4–300 PK23GTA 14R
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115C as Type 1, Class 2.
[44] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[45] For Certification to IEC 60439-1 contact the local Square D sales office; otherwise panels are NOT CE marked. (For use on 415Y/240 Vac 3-phase 4-wire, 3,000 Short Circuit Current Rating
when QOXD...branch circuit breakers are used and 10,000 Short Circuit Current Rating when QO...VS branch circuit breakers are used).
[46] PK15GTA.
[47] PK23GTA and LK100AN.
[48] 25 kA short circuit current rating SSCR maximum with Square D Type QDL main circuit breaker, or 22 kA SCCR maximum with back-fed Type QO-VH main circuit breaker, feeding QO 10 k
AIR branch circuit breakers.
[49] Includes factory-installed back fed QO3100VH main circuit breaker.
[50] 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating maximum with field-installed Square D type QGL 65 k AIR minimum main circuit breaker feeding QO and Q1 10 k AIR minimum branch circuit breakers.
[51] Side hinge door device allow 1-1/4 in. on left side for door to open.
[52] When these 3P circuit breakers are used as the main circuit breaker of a 3Ø load center, the maximum AIR rating is 65 kA at 240 Vac and 100 kA at 208 Vac.
1-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Load Centers 1Ø, Backup Power Solutions
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
[53] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[54] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24 orRainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs, page 1-26
[55] One main circuit breaker is included with panel. NEMA 1 indoor device requires cover ordered separately. Alternate source main circuit breaker (QO 125 A max.) ordered separately.
Automatic Transfer Switch and Generator for secondary power source are ordered through a Kohler authorized dealer or contractor.
[56] Universal mains – No factory-installed main circuit breaker or main lugs. QOM2 frame size, field-install 22 k AIR. Main circuit breaker or main lugs (see Table 1.10 3Ø, Main Circuit Breakers,
page 1-7 and Table 1.11 3Ø, Main Lugs Kits, page 1-7.
[57] Supplied with feed-thru lugs.
[58] Device is rated NEMA 3R and can be used for indoor or outdoor applications.
1-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
1Ø, Special Applications QO™ Load Centers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
Short Load Center [60] Equipment Ground Bar Main Wire Size
Mains Max. 1P Max. Tandem AWG/kcmil Box No.
Rating Circuit Current Spaces Box, Interior, and Kit
Rating Circuits [59] Circuit Breakers (Order Separately) [61]
Cover Al Cu
Manufactured Housing: 1Ø2W 120 Vac—Main Lugs Only—CSA Certified
30 A[62] 10 kA 2 2 0 QO2L30TTS[63] 12–10 14–10 1
Factory-installed
50 A 10 kA 2 4 2 QO24L50TTS [64] — 14–6 2
1Ø2W 120 Vac—Main Circuit Breaker—CSA Certified
30 A 10 kA 3 5 2 QO35FM30TTF/S Factory-installed [65] 3
1Ø3W 120/240 Vac—Main Lugs Only—CSA Certified
70 A 10 kA 2 4 2 QO24L70TS [64] 12–3 14–4 2
6 12 6 QO612L100TF/S [66] 4
QO612L100DTF/S [66] Factory
6 12 6 Installed 4
100 A 10 kA 4–1
8 16 8 QO816L100TF/S [66] 4
8 16 8 QO816L100DTF/S [66] 4
1
Load Center with Cover: 1Ø3W 120/240 Vac—UL Listed Complete QO Load Center—Box, Interior and Combination Cover in One Package
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs [67]—QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus
65 kA 12 12 0 QO112L125GC PK12GTA Incl. 6–2/0 6
125 A 65 kA 12 24 12 QO11224L125GC PK15GTA Incl. 6–2/0 6
I
N 65 kA 20 20 0 QO120L125GC PK15GTA Incl. 6–2/0 6–1 6
D Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs [67]—QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus
O PK23GTA, LK100AN
O 150 A 65 kA 30 30 0 QO130L150TC 6–250 9
Installed
R
200 A 65 kA 30 40 10 QO13040L200GC PK23GTA, LK100AN Incl. 6–250 9
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker—
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs (See page 1-5) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus [68]
22 kA 12 12 0 QO112M100C PK9GTA 4–1/0 5
22 kA 12 20 8 QO11220M100C PK15GTA 4–1/0 5
100 A
22 kA 16 16 0 QO116M100C PK12GTA 4–1/0 6
22 kA 20 20 0 QO120M100C PK15GTA 4–1/0 6
125 A 22 kA 32 32 0 QO132M125C PK18GTA 6–2/0 8
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker—
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs (Seepage 1-5) or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-4)—Copper Bus [68]
22 kA 20 30 10 QO12030M150C PK18GTA 4–250 9
150 A
22 kA 30 30 0 QO130M150C PK18GTA 4–250 9
22 kA 20 40 20 QO12040M200C PK23GTA 4–250 9
22 kA 30 30 0 QO130M200C PK18GTA 4–250 9
200 A
22 kA 30 40 10 QO13040M200C PK23GTA 4–250 9
22 kA 40 40 0 QO140M200C PK23GTA 4–250 10
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.
Table 1.15: Service Upgrade Load Centers: 1Ø3W 120/240Vac—UL Listed Load Center with Removable End Walls
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Breaker—22KA
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See page 1-8) [68]
Extra Long Cover with Door Main Wire Size Equipment Ground
I Mains Max. 1P Max. Tandem (Order Separately) Bar
N Load Center AWG / kcmil Box No.
Rating Spaces Circuits Circuit Kit (Order [61]
D [59] Box and Interior
Breakers Flush Surface Al Cu Separately)
O
O 30 60 30 HOM3060M200PCEP [69] HOMC30UFL — PK23GTA 10
R 4-250
200 A 40 40 0 QO140M200EP[70] QOC40UFL — PK23GTA 10
Table 1.17: Tap Kits 120/240 Vac—UL Listed for use with Auxiliary Gutter SDAG26
Use with Auxiliary Riser Wire Tap Off Wire
Cat. N0. Gutter Cat. No. Lug Type Al/Cu Wire Size Lug Type Al/Cu Wire Size
SDGT30020 SDAG26 Mechanical (Included) (2) 6 AWG–300 kcmil Mechanical (Included) (1) 6–2/0 AWG
SDGT300300 SDAG26 Mechanical (Included) (2) 6 AWG–300 kcmil Mechanical (Included) (1) 6 AWG–300 kcmil
SDGT300C10C SDAG26 Anderson VCEL030516H1 (Not included) (2) 4 AWG–300 kcmil Anderson VCEL02114S1 (Not Included) (1) 8–1/0 AWG
Anderson VCEL030516H1 (Not
SDGT300C300C SDAG26 Anderson VCEL030516H1 (Not included) (2) 4 AWG–300 kcmil included) (1) 4 AWG–300 kcmil
QOGL20Grounding Mechanical (Included) (2) 6–2/0 AWG
Terminals SDAG26 — —
[59] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[60] Order F for flush device or S for surface device.
[61] See Table 1.57 Knockout Information, page 1-24
[62] Mains rating 25 A when Al wire is used.
[63] Will not accept Qwik-Gard™ QO-GFI or QO-AFI circuit breaker.
[64] Use 10 AWG maximum size wire for GFI and AFI circuit breakers.
[65] Main circuit breaker is a field-installed standard QO single pole circuit breaker. Order separately from page 1-2, page 1-10.
[66] 70 A max. branch circuit breaker and 70 A max. back fed main circuit breaker.
[67] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[68] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QOT and QO-PL 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems with up to 22 kA available fault current.
[69] Ships with standard length cover.
[70] Copper Bus, order cover separately QOC40UF/S or QOC40UFL.
[71] One tap kit required for each riser wire.
[72] When used with B300 bolt-on hubs.
1-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
1
schneider-electric.us
The Square D exclusive Qwik-Open™ mechanism, with a trip reaction within 1/60th of a
second, is standard on all 1P 15 A and 20 A QO circuit breakers.
QO2200 2P 200 A
4 Spaces Required
[1] See Digest Section 1 for load centers, and Section 9 for panelboards and interiors.
[2] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[3] UL Listed 5 k AIR on corner grounded Delta systems.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[6] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu.) Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[7] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[8] Order only. Contact your local Field Office.
[9] UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QO-GFI, QO-EPD, QOT, QO-AFI, and QO-PL 10 k AIR circuit breakers to permit their application at 22 kA fault level.
[10] 100 A maximum branch mounted opposite.
1-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
Poles Suffix
10–30 A 1, 2, 3 5237
35–60 A 1,2
5238
35–50 A 3
70–110 A 2
5273
60–100 A 3
1
10–30 A (2) 14–10 Cu
QO
2P 35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
80–125 A 4–2/0 Al/Cu
150–200 A 4–300 Al/Cu
10–30 A 14–8 Al/Cu, (2) 14-10 Cu
QO
3P 35–70 A 8–2 Al/Cu
80–125 A 4–2/0 Al/Cu
QOB-VH 110–150 A 4–300 Al/Cu
QOT 15–20 A 12–8 Al 14–8 Cu
15–30 A 12–8 Al 14–8 Cu
QO-AFI, QO-GFI or QO-EPD
40, 50, 60 A 12–4 Al 14–6 Cu
QO-PL 10–60 A 12–2 Al 14–2 Cu
QOT 1P Tandem
Replacement Tandem Circuit Breakers Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030
1 Space Required and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.
[11] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[12] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[13] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[14] Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030 and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.
1-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
1
schneider-electric.us
QO Plug-on Neutral
Load Center with Qwik-Grip
1P QO-DF 1P QO-DF
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail
[15] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[16] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
[17] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
1-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us
QO-GFI
Qwik-Gard™ circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection, combined with
Class A ground fault protection. Class A denotes a ground fault circuit interrupter that will
LOAD CENTERS
trip when a fault current to ground is 6 mA or more, for people protection. Do not connect
to more than 250 feet of load conductor for the total one-way run to prevent nuisance
tripping.
1
50 — — QO250GFI QO350GFI
60 — — QO260GFI [19] —
QO-EPD/EPE
QO-EPD/EPE circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection combined
with Class B ground fault protection. They are designed to provide ground fault
protection of equipment at a 30 mA level (EPD) or 100 mA level (EPE). They are not
designed to protect people from electrical shock.
QO-SWN
Switch Neutral Common Trip 2008 NEC® 514.11
QO-HID
HID circuit breakers are for use on circuits feeding fluorescent and high intensity
discharge (HID) lighting systems such as mercury vapor, metal halide, or high pressure
sodium. These circuit breakers are physically interchangeable with QO circuit breakers.
[18] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[19] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[20] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[21] See note in Instruction Bulletin when using in an enclosure with a QO403 or QON prefix.
[22] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[23] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[24] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
1-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers Accessories
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
QO-K
Key operated QO circuit breakers are available in single-pole construction and can be
mounted in any single-pole space which will accept a standard QO. These circuit
breakers can be turned ON or OFF or to RESET with a special key (catalog number
QOK10) included with the circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are UL Listed and
available as shown in the table.
LOAD CENTERS
QO-HM
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.
[25] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[26] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[27] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
1-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories QO™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
Handle Attachments
Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac 1P QO circuit breakers to independent trip 2P QO1HT DE2E
Handle Tie Converts any two adjacent 120/240 Vac1P side-by-side QOT circuit breakers to independent trip 2P QOTHT DE2E
Clamp for holding QO 1P handle in ON or OFF position QO1LO DE2E
Handle Clamp Clamp for holding QO or Q1 either 1P, 2P or 3P circuit breaker handles in ON or OFF position HLO1 DE2E
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in ON or OFF position
Loose attachment QOHPL DE2E
Fixed attachment QO1PA DE2E
Handle Padlock Attachment for For padlocking 1P side-by-side QOT circuit breaker in ON or OFF position QOTHPA DE2E
Padlocking in ON or OFF
position For padlocking 2P QO-GFI circuit breakers in either ON or OFF position, fixed attachment. GFI2PA DE2A
For 2P and 3P QO and Q1 standard circuit breakers which require padlocking in either ON or OFF position.
Loose attachment QO1HPL DE2E
Fixed attachment QO1PL DE2E
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QO1PAF DE2E
Handle Padlock Attachment for For padlocking 2P and 3P QO circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QO2PAF DE2E
Padlocking in OFF position For padlocking 1P QO-GFI, QO-CAFI, QO-DF and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QOGFI1PAF DE2E
1
For padlocking 2P QO-GFI, QO-CAFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment. QOGFI2PAF DE2E
Ring Terminal Ring terminals are available as a factory-installed option. See page 7–10 DE2A
60 A 2P plug-on – 2 spaces required (6–2 Al/Cu) QO60SL DE2A
125 A 2P plug-on – 2 spaces required (12–2/0 Al/Cu) QO2125SL DE2A
Sub-feed Lugs 225 A 2P plug-on – 4 spaces required (4–300 Al/Cu) QO2225SL [28] DE2A
125 A 3P plug-on – 3 spaces required (12–2/0 Al/Cu) QO3125SL DE3
Mechanical Interlock For interlocking the handles of two 2P or one 2P and one 1P QO and Q1 circuit breakers mounted side-by-side so that
only one circuit breaker can be ON at a time (Not QOU) QO2DTI DE2E
Attachment
QO2DTI mechanical interlock attachment with retaining kits for securing two adjacent back-fed circuit breakers in dual
With Retaining Kit power supply applications. Can be used with (2) 2Ps or (1) 2P and (1) 1P QO circuit breakers in QO816L100 load QO2DTIM DE2E
centers.
[28] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
1-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers and 1Ø, Value Packs and Riser Panels
Circuit Breakers
1
Table 1.35: Value Packs Contains Complete Load Center (Box, Interior and Cover) with Selected Branch Circuit Breakers
Equipment
Max. Load Center Ground Bar Kit Main
Box, Interior, Cover and Branch Circuit Breakers Box
Main Spaces Max. 1P Tandem (Order Separately) Wire Size No.
Ratings Circuits Circuit AWG/kcmil [1]
Breakers Included Load Center/Circuit Al/Cu
Cat. No. Cat. No.
Breakers
QO Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, up to 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit breaker
(1) QO124L125PQGC, (3)
QO124L125PQGCVP QO120, (2) QO230 and (1) PK15GTAL 7Q
125 A 24 24 0 6–2/0
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit Included
QO Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Main Circuit breaker
(1) QO142M200PQC, (3)
PK23GTA
200 A 42 42 0 QO142M200PQCVP QO120, (2) QO230 and (1) 4–250 11Q
I PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit (Order seperately)
N
D Homeline Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit breaker, 22kA Short Circuit Current Rating—Copper Bus, QOM1 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs
O or Main Circuit Breaker
O (1) HOM2040M100PQC, (2)
PK18GTA
R 100 A 20 40 20 HOM2040M100PQCVP HOM120, (1) HOM230 and (1) (Order seperately) 6–2/0 6–1 6
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit
(1) HOM3060M200PQC, (3)
HOM120, (2) HOM230 and (1) PK23GTA
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PQCVP (Order seperately) 4–250 10Q
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit
200 A
(1) HOM2040M100PQC, (2)
PK27GTA
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PQCVP HOM120, (1) HOM230 and (1) 12Q
PKQGA Qwik-Grip assembly kit (Order seperately) 4–250
[1] See Indoor knockout information and Enclosure Dimensions for Qwik Grip Loadcenters, page 1-24
[2] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[3] See Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts, page 1-24 or Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs, page 1-26
1-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories Load Center Accessories
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
QO Riser Panels
Table 1.37: Offset Interior for Wide Gutter—30 A Maximum Branch Circuit Breaker on left side of interior [4] [5]
(Accepts Only QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers)
LOAD CENTERS
Max. Single Equipment Main Wire Size AWG/
Mains Max. Tandem Circuit Load Center Box and Load Center kcmil Box No. [7]
Rating Spaces Pole Circuits Ground Bar Kit
[6] Breakers Interior Cover (Order Separately) Al Cu
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to QOM1 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main
Lugs, page 1-3) when used with QOC cover below—Copper Bus
12 24 12 QO11224L125WG QOC20UFWG PK15GTA 14
I 125 A 6–2/0
N 20 30 10 QO12030L125WG QOC20UFWG PK15GTA 14
D Convertible Mains-Factory—Installed Main Lugs, 65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to QOM2 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main
O Lugs, page 1-3) when used with QOC cover below—Copper Bus
O 200 A 30 40 10 QO13040L200WG QOC30UFWG PK23GTA 4–250 23
R Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Convertible to Main Lugs (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Circuit Breaker, page 1-4)
or Lower Amperage QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker (See Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs, page 1-3) when used with QOC cover below—Copper Bus
200 A 24 24 0 QO124M200WG125 [8] QOC30UFWG PK23GTA 4–250 23
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.
1
Panelboard-style Covers for Riser Panels
Mono-Flat™ Front available for riser panels as an alternative to standard load center
Mains Rating of Load Center Cat. No. cover listed above. Provides a low-profile, aesthetically pleasing solution for high-traffic
125 A NQC20FWG areas in upscale multi-family applications. Deadfront included. Lock kit not provided.
200 A NQC30FWG Cover NQC30FWG CANNOT be used when panel has been converted to a main circuit
breaker panel. [9]
QO Load Center Accessories
Table 1.38: QO Load Center Accessories
Description Cat. No. Schedule
Secures circuit breaker to interior when used as a back-fed main. For QO612L100F/S, RB,
QO612L100DF/S, QO816L100F/S, RB, QO816L100DF/S and QO148L125GF/S, GRB load centers PK2MB DE3A
Secures 3P circuit breaker without accessories to left side of interior when used as a back-fed main. For 3Ø load centers PK3MB DE3A
Retaining Kit for Breakers Secures circuit breaker to interior when used as a back-fed main for 2P QO 150–200 A circuit breakers PK5RK DE3A
Used as Back-fed Mains Secures ONE circuit breaker with or without electrical accessories to right side of interior when used as a back-fed main
For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02 PK4MB2LA DE3A
Secures ONE circuit breaker with or without electrical accessories to right side of interior when used as a back-fed main
For 1Ø 150–225 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02 PK4MB2HA DE3A
Cover Sealing Strap Provides means of sealing trim mounting screws on QO load center covers QO1SE DE3A
Replacement Cover 1 through 42 numbered universal replacement directory label for load center covers
Directory Label LSDL DE5
Circuit Identification Circuit identification stickers for use on cover directory labels to identify branch circuits
Stickers PSDS DE5
Fills opening in covers if twistout is removed in error QOFP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in convertible load center covers 100–125 A QOM1FP DE3A
Filler Plates Fills main circuit breaker opening in convertible load center covers 150–225 A QOM2FP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in 3Ø load center covers (S01 and S02 Series) KFP DE3A
Fills main circuit breaker opening in “Q” style 3Ø load center covers (S03 Series) Q2FP DE3A
Use with QO612L100DF/S, QO612L100DFCU/SCU, QO612L100DTF/S, QO816L100DF/S, QO816L100DFCU/SCU, PK8FL [1]
QO816L100DTF/S, QO48M30DSGP, or QO48M60DSGP DE3A
Door Lock Kits Use with convertible mains, 1Ø and 3Ø 100–225 A, and fixed mains,
3Ø 125–225 A indoor load centers PK6FL DE3A
Use with 300 and 400 ampere indoor load centers PK4FL PE1A
Field-installed for 12– 2 Al or 14–4 Cu AWG wire LK70AN DE3A
Field-installed for 6–2/0 Al/Cu AWG wire LK100AN DE3A
Neutral / Ground Lugs Field-installed for 14–2/0 Al/Cu AWG wire LK125AN DE3A
Field-installed for 2–3/0 Al/Cu AWG wire LK150AN DE3A
Field-installed for 4 AWG to 300 kcmil Al/Cu wire. Use in Series S, LK225AN
150-225A QO load center or S03 and below, 150-225A HOM load center DE3A
LK225ANHOM
Standard PK15GTA with a 1–4/0 Al/Cu Lug PK15GTAL DE3A
Standard PK18GTA with a 1–4/0 Al/Cu Lug PK18GTAL DE3A
Ground Bar Kits
Standard PK23GTA with a 1–4/0 Al/Cu Lug PK23GTAL DE3A
Insulator Kit for PK7GTA through PK27GTA PKGTAB DE3A
50–125 A
QOM1PA DE2E
Handle Padlock For padlocking main circuit breakers in convertible load centers OFF
Attachment 100–225 A
QOM2PA DE2E
QO / Homeline 1Ø 100–125 A QOM1 convertible main load centers PKSB1LA DE3A
QO / Homeline 1Ø 150–225 A QOM2 convertible main load centers PKSB1HA DE3A
Service Entrance Barriers QO 3Ø convertible main load centers PKSB3 DE3A
QO 1Ø back-fed main breaker applications PKSB1QOBF DE3A
QO 3Ø back-fed main breaker applications PKSB3BF DE3A
QO Load Center Manual Power Transfer Accessories
For interlocking the handles of two 2P or one 2P and one 1P QO and Q1 circuit breakers mounted side-by-side so that only one QO2DTI
circuit breaker can be “ON’’ at a time. DE2E
QO2DTI mechanical interlock attachment with retaining kits for securing two adjacent back-fed circuit breakers in dual power
supply applications. Can be used with (2) 2P or (1) 2P and (1) 1P QO circuit breakers in QO816L100 load centers. QO2DTIM DE2E
Manual Transfer
Equipment Kit Secures two 2P circuit breakers to right side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit included for back-up power
supply applications. For 1Ø 100–125 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02. PK4DTIM4LA DE3A
Secures two 2P circuit breakers to right side of interior when used as back-fed mains, a QO2DTI Kit included for back-up power
supply applications. For 1Ø 150–225 ampere convertible main load centers. Series S01 and S02. PK4DTIM4HA DE3A
[4] UL short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of circuit breaker installed.
[5] UL Listed 5000 A short circuit current rating for corner grounded Delta systems. Use QO-H circuit breakers only.
[6] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing QO and/or QOT circuit breakers.
[7] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[8] Comes with 125 A main circuit breaker factory installed.
[9] Order catalog number PK4FL for field-installed lock kit.
[1] QO403L60NF/S does not have provisions for a field-installed lock.
1-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Load Center Accessories QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
PK2MB
PK3MB
QOFP
PKGTAB
PK6FL and PK8FL PK4FL
1-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit Homeline™ Load Centers
Breaker
schneider-electric.us Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
Surge Protective Devices
Table 1.41: Load Center and CSED Surge Protection Devices
Description
LOAD CENTERS
Cat. No. Schedule
For use on 1Ø3W, 150 Vac maximum SDSA1175 DE1B
For use on 3Ø4W, 650 Vac maximum SDSA3650 DE1B
Surge Arresters QO Surgebreaker CULUS Listed Secondary Surge Arrester
150 Vac line-to-ground maximum QO2175SB DE1B
Homeline Surgebreaker CULUS Listed Secondary Surge
Arrester 150 Vac line-to-ground maximum HOM2175SB DE1B
QOSAMK UL Listed for mounting SDSA1175 surge arrester into ground
Surge Arrester
Mounting Kit bar mounting holes on 1Ø convertible main circuit breaker QOSAMK DE3A
load centers
1
Mains Equipment Ground
Single Tandem Load Center AWG/kcmil Bar Kit Box No.
Rating Spaces Pole Box, Interior and Cover [2] [3]
Circuit (Order Separately)
Circuits [1] Breakers Al Cu
Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating Order HOM Circuit Breakers (See Homeline™ Circuit Breakers, page 1-21) Factory-installed Fixed Main Lugs
70 A 2 4 2 HOM24L70F/S [4] [5] 12–3 14–4 PK3GTA1 2
100 A 6 12 6 HOM612L100F/S [4] [6] 8–1 PK7GTA 4
125 A 4 8 4 HOM48L125GC 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA Included 21
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
8 16 8 HOM816L125PC 6–1 PK9GTA 6
12 24 12 HOM1224L125PC 6–1 PK15GTA 6
125 A 16 32 16 HOM1632L125PC 6–2/0 6–1/0 PK15GTA 8
20 40 20 HOM2040L125PC 6–1/0 PK18GTA 8
30 60 30 HOM3060L125PC 6–2/0 PK23GTA 10
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
30 60 30 HOM3060L225PC PK23GTA 10
40 80 40 HOM4080L225PC PK27GTA 12
4–300 4–250
225 A 42 84 42 HOM4284L225PC PK27GTA 12
60 120 60 HOM60120L225PC [7] PK27GTA 25
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Ground Bar Included
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
8 16 8 HOM816L125PGC 6–1 PK15GTAL Included 6
12 24 12 HOM1224L125PGC 6–1 PK15GTAL Included 6
125 A 6–2/0
20 40 20 HOM2040L125PGC 6–1/0 PK15GTAL Included 8
24 80 24 HOM2448L125PGC 6–1/0 PK15GTAL Included 8
I Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Lugs—Ground Bar Included
N QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
D
O 30 60 30 HOM3060L225PGC PK15GTAL & 10
O PK15GTA Included
R 16 32 16 HOM1632L225PGC PK15GTAL Included 9
20 40 20 HOM2040L225PGC PK15GTAL Included 9
225 A 4–300 4–250
40 80 40 HOM4080L225PGC PK15GTAL &
PK15GTA Included 12
PK15GTAL &
42 84 42 HOM4284L225PGC PK15GTA Included 12
Main Circuit Breaker—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker
QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
8 16 8 HOM816M100PC 6–1 PK9GTA 5
12 24 12 HOM1224M100PC 6–2/0 PK15GTA 6
100 A 20 40 20 HOM2040M100PC 6–1 PK18GTA 7
24 48 24 HOM2448M100PC 6–2/0 PK23GTA 8
30 60 30 HOM3060M100PC 6–2/0 PK23GTA 10
24 48 24 HOM2448M125PC 6–1/0 PK23GTA 8
125 A
30 60 30 HOM3060M125PC 6–2/0 6–2/0 PK23GTA 10
Convertible Mains—Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See 1Ø3W—120/240 Vac—UL Listed, page 1-20)
150 A 30 60 30 HOM3060M150PC 4–250 PK23GTA 10
20 40 20 HOM2040M200PC PK18GTA 9
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PC PK23GTA 10
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PC PK27GTA 12
200 A 4–250
42 84 42 HOM4284M200PC PK27GTA 12
60 120 60 HOM60120M200C [7] PK27GTA 25
225 A 42 84 42 HOM4284M225PC 4–300 4–250 PK27GTA 12
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.
[1] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing HOM and/or HOMT circuit breakers.
[2] C at end of catalog number indicates combination flush/surface cover included with device.
[3] See Indoor Knockout Information and Enclosure Dimensions, page 1-24
[4] F/S at end of catalog number indicates to order F for flush device or S for surface device. The cover does not have a door.
[5] HOM-GFI and HOM-AFI branch circuit breakers are limited to number 10 maximum wire.
[6] 70 A maximum branch circuit breaker, 100 A maximum back feed main circuit breaker.
[7] Door kit available separately. Order QOCDK60.
1-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Load Centers Rainproof, 1Ø, Main Lugs and Main Circuit
Breakers
1
Max. Single Max. Tandem Load Center Main Wire Size Bar Kit
Mains Rating Spaces Box, Interior and Cover AWG/kcmil Box No.
Pole Circuit (Order Separately) [9]
Circuits [8] Breakers
Cat. No. (DE3C) Al Cu Cat. No. (DE3A)
Main Lugs—10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Factory-installed Fixed Main Lugs, 10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
70 A 2 4 2 HOM24L70RB [10] 12–3 14–4 PK4GTA 1R
100 A 6 12 6 HOM612L100RB [11] 8–1 PK7GTA 2R
125 A 4 8 4 HOM48L125GRB 12–2/0 14–2/0 PK7GTA Included 15R
R Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Lugs [12], QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See Below)
A 8 16 8 HOM816L125PRB PK9GTA 3R
I 12 24 12 HOM1224L125PRB PK15GTA 3R
N 125 A 6–2/0 6–1
P 20 40 20 HOM2040L125PRB PK18GTA 4R
R 24 48 24 HOM2448L125PRB PK23GTA 6R
O Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Lugs [12], QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker (See Below)
O
12 12 0 HOM12L225PRB PK9GTA 5R
F
16 32 16 HOM1632L225PRB PK15GTA 6R
20 40 20 HOM2040L225PRB PK18GTA 6R
225 A 4–300 4–250
30 60 30 HOM3060L225PRB PK23GTA 7R
40 80 40 HOM4080L225PRB PK27GTA 14R
42 84 42 HOM4284L225PRB PK27GTA 14R
Main Circuit Breaker—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Convertible Mains with Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, QOM1 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Below) [13]
8 16 8 HOM816M100PRB PK9GTA 3R
100 A 12 24 12 HOM1224M100PRB 6–2/0 6–1 PK15GTA 3R
20 40 20 HOM2040M100PRB PK18GTA 4R
8 16 8 HOM816M125PRB PK9GTA 3R
R 125 A 6–2/0 6–1
24 48 24 HOM2448M125PRB PK23GTA 6R
A Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker , QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Below)
I
N 150 A 30 60 30 HOM3060M150PRB 4–250 PK23GTA 7R
P 12 12 0 HOM12M200PRB PK9GTA 5R
R 20 40 20 HOM2040M200PRB PK18GTA 6R
O 200 A 4–250
O 30 60 30 HOM3060M200PRB PK23GTA 7R
F 40 80 40 HOM4080M200PRB PK27GTA 14R
Convertible Mains with Factory-installed Main Circuit Breaker with Feed-thru Lugs,
QOM2 Main Frame Size—Convertible to Main Lugs or Lower Amperage Main Circuit Breaker (See Below) [12]
150 A 8 16 8 HOM816M150PFTRB 4–250 PK15GTA 6R
200 A 8 16 8 HOM816M200PFTRB 4–250 PK15GTA 6R
Above listings through 200 A mains rating meet Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2.
[8] Maximum single pole branch circuits utilizing HOM and/or HOMT circuit breakers.
[9] See Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and Bolt-on Hubs, page 1-26
[10] HOM-GFI and HOM-AFI branch circuit breakers are limited to number 10 maximum wire.
[11] 70 A maximum branch circuit breaker, 100 A maximum back feed main circuit breaker.
[12] Side hinge door device allow 1-1/4 in. on left side for door to open.
[13] 22 k AIR main circuit breaker UL Listed for use ahead of HOM and HOMT 10 k AIR branch circuit breakers to permit their application on systems with up to 22 kA available fault current.
[14] Do not exceed the load center mains rating.
[15] Wire range listed for main device kits is the wire range of that device. To find out maximum wire size permitted in a particular load center per UL, see tables in QO™ Load Centers, page 1-3
and QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers and Circuit Breakers, page 1-16 under Main Wire Size.
[16] If main circuit breaker knockout has been removed from the load center’s trim, order appropriate filler plate from QO and Homeline Load Center Accessories, page 1-17.
[17] Add suffix 1021 for 120, 208, 240 Vac shunt trip.
1-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-On Circuit Breakers Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
Homeline Plug-On Circuit Breakers
The Square D Homeline circuit breakers are in a 1 in. wide format for 1-pole circuit
breakers. They are designed to plug into Homeline load centers.
1
50 A 10 kA HOM150 [2] HOM250 [2]
60 A 10 kA — HOM260 [2]
70 A 10 kA — HOM270 [2]
80 A 10 kA — HOM280 [2]
90 A 10 kA — HOM290 [2]
100 A 10 kA — HOM2100 [2]
110 A 10 kA — HOM2110 [2]
125 A 10 kA — HOM2125 [2]
150 A 10 kA — HOM2150BB [2][3]
175 A 10 kA — HOM2175BB [2][3]
HOM2200BB
Branch Circuit Breaker 200 A 10 kA — HOM2200BB [2][3]
4 Spaces Required
Homeline High Magnetic (HM) Circuit Breakers
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush current may occur.
[1] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[2] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[3] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
1-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
[6] 15– 20 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 25– 50 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC
conductors only.
[7] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
1-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-On Circuit Breakers Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
wire bend guide on the Qwik-Grip insert, the wire easily slides into the slot. Solution is UL
listed.
1
Ratings Cat. No.
Breakers Cat. No. Al Cu
HOM2448L125PQGC 6–2/0 6–1/0 PK15GTAL 8Q
24 48 24 Included
125 A
HOM3060L125PQGC PK23GTAL 10Q
30 60 30 6–2/0 6–2/0 Included
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Lugs, 10 kA Short Circuit Current Rating— QOM2 Main Frame Size, Convertible to Main Circuit Breaker
PK15GTAL
I HOM3060L225PQGC and 10Q
30 60 30 4–250
N PK15GTA
D Included
225 A
O PK15GTAL
O HOM4080L225PQGC and 12Q
40 80 40 4–250
R PK15GTA
Included
Convertible Mains—Factory-Installed Main Circuit Breaker, 22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating— QOM2 Main Circuit Breaker Frame Size, Convertible to Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker
PK23GTA
30 60 30 HOM3060M200PQC 4–250 (Order seperately) 10Q
200 A
PK27GTA
40 80 40 HOM4080M200PQC 4–250 (Order seperately) 12Q
[8] 15–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 40–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[9] 50–125 A QOM1 frame size; 100–225 A QOM2 frame size.
[10] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
1-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts
Class 1130, 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
D,E,F,G
D,E,F,G
B,C,D ,E
B,C,D ,E
B,C,D ,E
D,E,F,G D,E,F,G
D,E,F,G
C,D,E ,F
1-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor, Dimensions and Knockouts QO™ and Homeline™ Load Centers
Class 1130, 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
Table 1.58: Indoor knockout information and Enclosure Dimensions for Qwik Grip
Loadcenters
Dimensions
LOAD CENTERS
W H D
Box No.
in. mm in. mm in. mm
7Q 14.25 362 20.92 531 3.75 95
8Q 14.25 362 26.04 661 3.75 95
9Q 14.25 362 29.86 758 3.75 95
10Q 14.25 362 33.78 858 3.75 95
11Q 14.25 362 37.98 965 3.75 95
12Q 14.25 362 39.37 1000 3.75 95
A,B A,B
1
A,B
A A
B,C
A,B
A,B
A,B
A
A
A
1-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Rainproof, Dimensions, Knockouts and
Bolt-on Hubs
1
Bolt-On Hubs
Square D equipment with “R’’ or “RB’’ suffix, designated NEMA 3R rainproof
construction, utilizes bolt-on hubs listed below. “RB’’ devices will accept 3/4 in. through 2-
1/2 in. bolt-on hubs without the use of reducers. Off-center conduit thread openings and
elongated mounting holes provide quick and easy adjustment to eliminate costly conduit
offsets and bends. Catalog suffix “R’’ devices require 3 in. through 4 in. field cut opening.
Hubs are suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread.
LOAD CENTERS
Q QO Ringless
R HOM Ringless
Socket Type
C QO Ring type
S HOM Ring type
Blank Field Installed
Service Disconnect Install
Q Factory Installed
Blank Combination overhead/underground
C Combination overhead/underground
O Overhead only
Service Feed
U Underground only
RA “A” Hub provision in top endwall
RB “B” Hub provision in top endwall
Spaces (Service Discounts # Maximum # of 1-pole circuits
or Branches) # Maximum # of 1-pole spaces
1
D Dual main service disconnects (feed-thru lugs on meter mains only)
F Single main service disconnect with feed-thru lugs
Interior
L Main lug interior (service disconnects field installed)
M Single main service disconnect
100 100 A
125 125 A
150 150 A
Amperage Rating
200 200 A
225 225 A
400 400 A
C Surface mount or convertible to semi-flush (use appropriate flange kit)
F Semi-flush mount only
R Reverse mount only
Enclosure Mounting Style
S Surface mount only
PF Home PoN semi-flush mount device
PS Home PoN surface mount device
H Horn by-pass
K K-4 bolt-on, no by-pass
L Class 320 with lever by-pass
Meter Socket Bypass Type N Class 320, No by-pass
B Class 320 with test block by-pass
Blank No by-pass
X 2 piece lever by-pass cover
S Solar ready
Application FMG Florida Meter Group
MEG Meter Equipment Group
This table is for interpreting existing part number only. All possible combinations are not
available.
1-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Rainproof, Meter Mains
Class 4119, 4120
1
schneider-electric.us
Current Rating
Service (Order separately [1])
separately [2])
Main Ground Each
Bypass Type
Short Circuit
(Type of Feed)
Rating Max.
Rating Max.
Max. Quantity Lugs Lug (Lbs)
LOAD CENTERS
Ampere
Ampere
Spaces
Circuits (Order kcmil kcmil Pallet
UL and (Al/ (Al/Cu) Qty.
UL EU- (Max.) separately [3]) Circuits Tan-
dems Cu)
SERC
Ring Type, QOTM
Surface Mount Only
125 A None OH/UG — 10 kA C125RB 1 QOM1-VH 125 A — — — — B 4–1/0 8–1/0 15, 54
OH/UG — 22 kA CM200S 1 QOM2-VH 200 A — — — — A 4–250 (2)8–2/0 26, 24
— 1 QOM2-VH 200 A — — — — (2)8–2/0
200 A None OH/UG 22 kA C2M200S A 4–250 27, 20
— 1 QO-VH 50 A — — — —
OH/UG — 10 kA C4L200S 2 QO 100 A — — — — A 4–250 (2)8–2/0 27, 28
Ring Type, HomelineTM
Surface Mount Only
125
125 A None OH/UG OH/UG 10 kA SC8L125S 4 HOM A [4] — — — — A 6–2/0 6–2/0 31, 24
200 A
200 A None OH/UG OH/UG 10 kA SC12L200S 6 HOM [5] — — — — A–L 4–250 8–2/0 40, 10
Semiflush Mount only
A or 37, 20
125 A None OH/UG OH/UG 10 kA SC8L125F 4 HOM 110 A — — — — 6–2/0 6–2/0
B300
OH [6]/ OH [6]/ 200 A
None 10 kA SC12L200F 6 HOM [7] — — — — A–L 4–250 8–2/0 47, 10
UG UG
200 A
OH [6]/ OH [6]/ QOM2200VH 200 A
None 22 kA SC816F200F [8] 1 200 A 8 16 8 A–L 4–250 8–2/0 51, 10
UG UG [4] [7]
Surface Mount—Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
SC816F150S [8] QOM2150VH 150 A
OH/UG 22 kA 1 [9] 150 A 8 16 8 [10] A–L 4–250 8–2/0 40, 10
150 A None OH/UG SC816D150C [8] [11]
— 1 HOM2150 [9] 150 A 100 A
10 kA 8 16 8 [12] A or A–L 6–300 8–1/0 48, 18
UG SU816D150C [8] [11] 1 HOM 50 A
[1] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[2] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[3] To order service disconnects, see Circuit Breakers for CSEDs, page 1-32 except as noted)
[4] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[5] Use only 15–110 A and 150–200 A breakers.
[6] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTK20). Order separately.
[7] Use only 15–100 A and 150–200 A circuit breakers.
[8] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
[9] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[10] Use only 15–110 A and 150 A breakers.
[11] Convertible to semiflush with SC200F flange kit (order separately).
[12] A 100 A circuit breaker can be installed in bottom position only, all other positions are limited to 70 A max.
[13] Use only 15–110 A and 150–200 A breakers.
[14] Device supplied with barrel lock provisions factory-installed.
[15] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[16] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[17] Use only 15–100 A and 150 A circuit breakers.
[18] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
1-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains Combination Service Entrance Devices
Class 4119, 4120
schneider-electric.us
separately [20])
Ampere Rating
Current Rating
Service (Order separately [19])
LOAD CENTERS
Main Ground Each
Bypass Type
Short Circuit
(Type of Feed)
Rating Max.
Rating Max.
Max. Quantity Lugs Lug (Lbs)
Cat. No. Type AWG/ AWG/ and
2P 1P
Ampere
Ampere
(Order
Spaces
Circuits kcmil kcmil Pallet
UL and separately (Al/ (Al/Cu) Qty.
UL EU- (Max.) Circuits Tan-
[21]) dems Cu)
SERC
QC816F200S [22] [23] QOM2200VH 200 A
None OH/UG — 22 kA [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] A 6–350
8–2/0 43, 21
QC816F200SH [22] QOM2200VH 200 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] A 6–350
200 A
QC816F200CH [22] QOM2200VH 200 A
Horn OH/UG — 22 kA [23] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 [27] A 6–350 12-2/0 40, 21
QC816F200SL [22] QOM2200-VH
Lever OH/UG — 22 kA [23] [24] [25] 1 [26] 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A 6–350 8–2/0 74 / 12
Ringless, HomelineTM
Surface Mount Only
125 A
1
125 A None OH/UG — 10 kA RC8L125S [28] 4 HOM — — — — A 6–2/0 6–2/0 27, 32
[29]
RC12L200S [23] [24] 200 A
200 A None OH/UG — 10 kA [25] 6 HOM [27] — — — — A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
[19] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[20] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[21] To order service disconnects, see Circuit Breakers for CSEDs, page 1-32 except as noted)
[22] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
[23] Device supplied with barrel lock provisions factory-installed.
[24] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[25] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[26] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[27] Use only 15–100 A and 150–200 A circuit breakers.
[28] Knockout provided in cover for use with barrel lock kit SCBRLLOCK (see Accessories).
[29] 125 A Homeline™ 2P circuit breaker can be installed in top position only. All other positions are limited to 100 A max.
[30] Use only 15–100 A and 150 A circuit breakers.
[31] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBL, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[32] Convertible to semiflush with SC200F flange kit (order separately).
[33] A 100 A circuit breaker can be installed in bottom position only, all other positions are limited to 70 A max.
1-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Rainproof, All-In-Ones, 100 to 225 A
Maximum
1
(Order separately )
Circuit Breakers Line
Service Weight
Ampere Rating
Current Rating
Service Service Disconnect(s) (Order separately [34]) Side Ground Each
Short Circuit
(Type Main
Rating Max.
Cat. No. Max. Quantity Lug (Lbs)
of Feed) Lugs
(DE3A) 1P AWG/ and
UL and AWG/
Ampere
Spaces
kcmil kcmil Pallet
EUSERC 2P Type Ampere (Al/Cu) Qty.
Circuits (Factory Circuits Tan- (Al/Cu)
Rating dems
(Max.) Installed) Max.
Ring Type, Homeline™
™
Surface Mount Only
100 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M100S 1 HOM2100 100 A 16 24 8 100 A
125 A A 6–2/0 6–2/0 32, 24
125 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M125S 1 HOM2125 125 A 16 24 8 [36]
200 A
200 A None OH/UG 22 kA SC2040M200S 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 [37] A-L 4–250 6–2/0 45, 10
200 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC2040M200C [38] 1 HOM2200 200 A 20 40 20 100 A A or 6–300 8–1/0 47, 18
A-L
200 A None UG 10 kA SU2040M200C [38] 1 HOM2200 200 A 20 40 20 100 A A or 6–300 8–1/0 47, 18
A-L
Semiflush Mount Only
100 A None OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M100F 1 HOM2100 100 A 16 24 8 100 A A or
B30- 6–2/0 6–2/0 44, 20
OH/UG 10 kA SC1624M125F 1 HOM2125 125 A 16 24 8 110 A 0
125 A None
OH[39]/UG 22 kA SC2040M125F 1 QOM2125VH 125 A 20 40 20 110 A
200 A A-L 4–250 8–2/0 51, 10
OH[39]/UG 22 kA SC2040M200F 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 [37]
200 A None SC2636M200FPV [41] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 26 36 10 100 A
OH[40]/UG 22 kA
SC3040M200F 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A
A-L 4–250 8–2/0 56, 10
SC3040M225F 1 QOM2225VH 225 A 30 40 10 200 A
225 A None OH[40]/UG 22 kA
SC2636M225FPV [41] 1 QOM2225VH 225 A 26 36 10 100 A
Surface Mount Only
100 A None OH[42] SO1020M100S 10 kA 1 HOM2100 100 A 10 20 10 80 A A 6–1 8–4 20, 42
200 A None OH[42] SO2040M200S 22 kA 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
SC3040M200S 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 4–250 8–2/0 50, 10
200 A None OH/UG 22 kA A-L
SC40M200S 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 40 40 0 200 A 4–250 8–2/0 52, 10
REVERSE All-In-One—Semiflush Mount with Service Disconnect (outdoor access) and Load Center (indoor access)
200 A None UG 10 kA SU3040M200R 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 200 A A or
30 40 10 [37] B30- 6–300 12–1/0 60, 15
225 A None UG 10 kA SU3040M225R 1 QOM2225VH 225 A 0
Ringless, Homeline
Surface Mount Only
100 A RC1624M100S 1 HOM2100 100 A 100 A
OH/UG
None [42] 10 kA 16 24 8 125 A 6–2/0 6–2/0 32, 24
125 A RC1624M125S 1 HOM2125 125 A [36]
125 A Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M125SH [43] [44] 1 QOM2125VH 125 A 20 40 20 125 A 43, 21
125 A Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M125CH [43][45] 1 QOM2125VH 125 A 20 40 20 125 A 40, 21
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M150SH [43] [44] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 20 40 20 150 A 43, 21
150 A Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M150CH [43][45] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 20 40 20 150 A 40, 21
Lever OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC3040M150SL [46] 1 QOM2150VH [36] 200 A 30 40 10 150 A A 76 / 12
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200S [43] [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 6–350 8–2/0 43, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200C [43] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 40, 21
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200SH [43] [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 43, 21
200 A
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200CH [43] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 40, 21
Lever OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC3040M200SL [46] 1 QOM2200VH [36] 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 76 / 12
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA RC2040M200CGP 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A 48 / 21
Ringless, QO
Surface Mount Only
OH/UG[42] QC2442M150SH [43]
150 A Horn 22 kA [44] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 24 42 18 150 A 43, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC2442M200S [43] [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 43, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC2442M200C [43] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 40, 21
200 A QC2442M200SH [43] A 6–350 8–2/0
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 43, 21
[44]
Horn OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC2442M200CH [43][45] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A 40, 21
None OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC3040M200S [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 40, 21
200 A Hom OH/UG[42] 22 kA QC3040M200SH [44] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A 40, 21
[34] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[35] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[36] 125 A Homeline™ 2P circuit breaker can be installed in top position only. All other positions are limited to 100 A max.
[37] Use only 15–110 A and 150–200 A circuit breakers.
[38] Convertible to semiflush with SC200F flange kit (order separately).
[39] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTK20). Order separately.
[40] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTK30). Order separately.
[41] For use with Photovoltaic Systems. Provisions for field-installed CT. If required by adopted code, order retaining kit PK2SCPV separately, see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33.
[42] Device does not meet EUSERC Specifications.
[43] Device supplied with barrel lock provisions factory-installed.
[44] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS, (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[45] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[46] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBL, (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
1-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones, Combination Service Entrance Devices
300–400 A
schneider-electric.us Class 4119, 4120
LOAD CENTERS
Service disconnects are supplied factory-installed, except where noted
• Ring or ringless type meter socket designs available
• Supplied with 100% branch neutrals; all unused terminals may be used for equipment
• UL Listed, suitable only for use as service equipment grounding wires
• Meets EUSERC standards where indicated. • Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2
Meter Mains: Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2, UL Listed,
suitable only for use as service equipment, 120/240 Vac, 1Ø3W, NEMA 3R Enclosure
Current Rating
Short Circuit
Cat. No.
Rating Max.
AWG/ AWG/ and
2P
Hub Type
kcmil kcmil Pallet
UL and Cir- Ampere
Ampere
Spaces
Tan- (Al/ (Al/Cu) Qty.
1
UL EU- cuits Type Rating Circuits Cu)
(Order separately (Max.) dems
SERC
(Max.) [50])
Ring Type, QO
Surface and Semiflush Mount [47]
CU12L400CN [51] 1 QDL22200 [52] 200 A — — — —
400 CU12L400FN [51] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53] 200 A — — — — (2)
None UG UG 25 kA A–L 4–250 98, 4
A QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
Class CU12L400CB [51] [56] 1 QDL22200 [52] 200 A — — — —
400 320 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53] 200 A — — — — (2)
Manual UG — 25 kA A–L 4–250 98, 4
A CU12L400FB [51] [56] QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
Bypass 4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
400 CU816D400CN [51] [57] QDL22200 [52] (2) 98, 4
None UG UG 25 kA A–L 4–250
A Studs
Class 200 A 8 16 8 200 A
1
400 320 CU816D400CB [51] [55] (2)
Manual UG — 25 kA QDL, QGL, QJL [53] A–L 4–250 98, 4
A [56] Studs
Bypass
Class
400 320 65 kA (2)
Manual UG — CUM400CB [51] [56] 1 LJL36400U31X [52] 400 A — 2 [58] — 200 A A–L 4–250 115, 4
A [47] Studs
Bypass
Ringless Type, QO
QDL22200 [52] 1 200 A — — — —
Class QDL, QGL, QJL [53]
400 QU12L400SL [59] [56] 1 200 A — — — — (2) 98, 4
320 UG — 25 kA A–L 4–250
A Lever QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
Surface Mount Only, Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and Provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
QU816D400SL [55] [59] QDL22200 [52]
400 [60] [56] (2) 98, 4
UG — 25 kA 1 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A–L 4–250
A QU816D400CK [57] [56] QDL, QGL, QJL [53] Studs
Surface and Semiflush Mount [47]
1 QDL22200 [52] 200 A — — — —
400 QU12L400CL [59] [61] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53] 200 A — — — — (2)
UG — 25 kA [56] A–L 4–250 98, 4
A QO, QO-VH or QOH Studs
Class 4 125 A [55] — — — —
[54]
320
Lever QU816D400CL [59] [55]
1 QDL22200 [52]
400 [61] [56] (2)
UG — 25 kA 8 16 8 200 A A–L 4–250 98, 4
A QU816D400FL [59] [55] 200 A Studs
1 QDL, QGL, QJL [53]
[61] [56]
Class 65 kA
400 QUM400CL [59] [56] LJL36400U31X [52] 2 [58] (2) 120, 4
320 UG — [47] 1 400 A — — 200 A A–L 4–250
A Lever Studs
K-4 Bolt-
400 On 65kA (2)
UG — QUM400CK [51] [56] 1 LJL36400U31X [52] 400 A — 2 [58] — 200 A A–L 4–250 123, 4
A [47] Studs
None
[47] UL short circuit current rating is equal to the lowest interrupting rating of any circuit breaker installed.
[48] To order branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10
[49] To order hubs, see Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs, page 1-33
[50] To order service disconnects, see Circuit Breakers for CSEDs, page 1-32 except as noted)
[51] For use only on 120/240 Vac 1Ø3W system (4-jaw meter socket).
[52] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[53] Additional service disconnect for field-installation: order prefix QBL at 10 kA, QDL at 25 kA, QGL at 65 kA, or QJL at 100 kA. Order separately. For complete circuit breaker catalog number,
see Digest Section 7.
[54] Order two pole circuit breakers for field installation: order catalog designation QO for 10 kA, QO-VH for 22 kA or QOH for 42 kA short circuit current rating. See Table 1.18 Plug-On Circuit
Breakers, page 1-10 or Table 1.68 Circuit Breakers for use with Meter Mains and All-In-One Devices, page 1-32.
[55] QO panel is rated 200 A maximum.
[56] Device configuration is not included in EUSERC standards. Consult applicable utility for acceptance.
[57] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs for 6 AWG–250 kcmil (Al/Cu) conductors.
[58] Option for field installation of two Q-frame, 200 A max. 2-pole branch circuit breakers used as mains for two downstream load centers. Purchase installation kit BMK2Q400 and two Q-frame
circuit breakers separately. Order QBL prefix at 10 kA, QDL prefix at 25 kA, or QGL prefix at 65 kA.
[59] Fifth jaw factory-installed.
[60] Device with suffix L has Class 320 lever bypass and device with suffix K has a K-4 bolt-on, no bypass.
[61] Knockout provided in cover for use with barrel lock kit SCBRLLOCK (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33).
1-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Combination Service Entrance Devices Circuit Breakers for CSEDs
Class 4119, 4120
1
schneider-electric.us
[65]
SU3040D400CN[63][64] 1 QDL22200 [66] 200 A
400 A None UG UG 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
SU3040D400FN[63][64] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
SU3040D400CB[63][64] QDL22200 [66]
Class [65] 1 200 A
400 A 320 UG — 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
Manual SU3040D400FB[63][64]
1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
[65]
Ringless, Homeline
RU3040D400CL[64][68] QDL22200 [66]
Class [65] 1 200 A
400 A 320 UG — 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
Lever RU3040D400FL[64][68]
1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
[65]
K-4 Bolt- RU3040D400CK[64][65] 1 QDL22200 [66] 200 A
400 A UG — 25 kA 30 40 10 200 A A–L (2) Studs 4–250 100, 4
on RU3040D400FK[64][65] 1 QDL, QGL, QJL [67] 200 A
[62] UL short circuit current rating is equal to the lowest interrupting rating of any circuit breaker installed.
[63] For use only on 120/240 Vac 1Ø3W system (4-jaw meter socket).
[64] Knockout provided in cover for use with barrel lock kit SCBRLLOCK (see Accessories).
[65] Device configuration is not included in EUSERC standards. Consult applicable utility for acceptance.
[66] Service disconnect supplied factory-installed.
[67] Additional service disconnect for field-installation: order prefix QBL at 10 kA, QDL at 25 kA, QGL at 65 kA, or QJL at 100 kA. Order separately. For complete circuit breaker catalog number,
see Digest Section 7.
[68] 5th jaw factory-installed.
[69] Do not exceed mains rating of device
[70] For additional interrupting rating circuit breakers, order circuit breaker prefix QBL at 10 kA, QGL at 65 kA or QJL at 100 kA.
[71] Reference National Electrical Code Article 230-79.
1-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Hubs for CSEDs Combination Service Entrance Devices
Class 4119, 4120
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
Closing Plate for “A” Hub opening ACP DE4
1.00 A100 DE4
1.25 A125 DE4
A 1.50 A150 DE4
2.00 A200 DE4
2.50 A250 DE4
Adapter plate to allow use of “A”
Hubs on “A-L” size hub openings AAP DE4
Closing Plate for “A-L” Hub opening ACPL DE4
2.00 A200L [72] DE4
2.50 A250L DE4
A-L 3.00 A300L DE4
3.50 A350L DE4
4.00 A400L DE4
Closing Plate for “B” Hub opening BCAP DE1A
0.75 B075 DE1A
1
1.00 B100 DE1A
1.25 B125 DE1A
B
1.50 B150 DE1A
2.00 B200 DE1A
2.50 B250 DE1A
B300 3.00 B300 DE1A
schneider-electric.us
(in.)
7.14 7.50
181 191 ▲ Driphood supplied factory-installed and is required for surface mount installation. For semi-flush installation,
remove driphood and install flange kit SC200F (order separately).
Drip Hood Semi-Flush End Wall
■ Unit supplied with blank top endwall (factory-installed) for surface mount installation. For semi-flush installation,
install flange kit FK400 (order separately). Kit includes replacement top endwall (with knockouts) and flanges.
♦ Unit supplied with semi-flush top endwall factory installed and semi-flush flanges factory included.
6.44 8.00
7.44 10.70 164 203
189 272
12.80 18.23
325 463 20.79
528
A,B C,D,E,F
A,B E,F,G,H 41.25
C,D,E,F 1048
A
Lever ByPass
Lever ByPassDevices
Devices
A
2 1 /2 " Ma x
14.81
A,B B,C 376
“A” Hub A,B A
D,F,G B,C D,F,G A,B
2 1 /2 " Ma x E,F,G,H
A,B “A” Hub or A,B,C
C,D,F D,E, F,G B300
S C8L125S (S h o wn ) A,B,C 32.23
C,D,E,F 819
RC8L125S RC816F100S H C,D,E,F QC816F100S H
QC12L200C S C8L125F (S h o wn ) RC816F125S H QC816F125S H
S C1624M100S QC816F100CH C,D, E,F S C1624M100F RC816F150S L QC816F150S ,S H (S h o wn )
S C1624M125S QC816F125C RC816F150S ,S H
RC1624M100S
RC816F200C S C1624M125F QC816F150S L
QC816F150C RC816F200CH RC816F200S L
RC1624M125S QC816F200C QC816F200S L
RC2040M125CH RC816F200S ,S H
QC816F200CH C,D,E,F RC12L200S QC816F200S ,S H
RC12L200C RC2040M150CH QC12L200S
A,B RC2040M125S H B,C
RC816F100CH RC2040M200C A RC2040M150S H QC2442M150S H A
RC816F125CH RC2040M200CH RC2040M200S ,S H QC2442M200S ,S H C,E,F,G,H A,B
C,D,F A,B A 3.4 0 2 1 /2 " Ma x
RC816F150C QC2442M200C 86 RC3040M150S L S O2040M200S “A-L” Hub
RC816F150CH QC2442M200CH RC3040M200S L QC3040M200S H
B,C C,D,E,F B,C
14.85
14.62 7.90 377 S U816D150Cq
371 201 7.50 Bla nk End Wa ll
191 S U816D200Cq
S U2040M200Cq
28.25 RC816D200CH q
CL 718
Top S C816D150C q
Bran ch S C816D200C q (S h o wn )
Circuit
Brea ke r 8.00
203 2 1/2 " Ma x “A” Hub
31.61 39.60
803 27.00 35.40 1006 5.80
686 899 147
21.50
48.00 546
1219
41.25
1048
10.30
S C3040M200S
262 11.10
CL 282
Me te r
S ocke t
29.50
S C40M200S
B,C B 749
32.30
C,E ,F,G, H 820
2 1 /2 " Ma x A
“A-L” Hub
A 37.30
947
B,C B A 4.40 C,D,E,F G,H,I,J
“A” Hub or 112 “A-L” Hub
B 3.5 0 S C816F200F
B300 Hu b 89 35.40 S C2040M125F
899 S C2040M200F (S h o wn ) C,D,F B,C C,D,E,F A
D,F,G B C,D
S C3040M200F S U3040D400CBc (S h o wn ) S U3040D300CBc C,E,F,G,H
S U3040M200R (S h o wn ) RU3040D400CLc 2 1 /2 " Ma x B,C
S C3040M2225F S U3040D400CNc “A-L” Hub
S U3040M225R S C2636M200FP V RU3040D400CKc RU3040D400FLf
39.60 S U3040D300FBf
1006 S C2636M225FP V RU3040D400FK f B
S U3040D400FBf CUM400CB c S C12L200S S C40M200S
S U3040D400FNf QUM400CL c S C816F150S S C2040M200S (S h o wn )
QUM400CK c S C816F200S S C3040M200S
1-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones, RC/QC Solar Ready CSEDs
150 to 200 A Maximum
schneider-electric.us Class 4120
LOAD CENTERS
installed except for Cat. No. SO2040M200SS which is a
Ring Style meter socket with no provisions for barrel lock to
•
where noted
• Provisions for Field Installed CTs All Devices
secure the meter cover
Supplied with 100% branch neutrals, all unused terminals
may be used for equipment grounding wires • Solar Ready kit SR69064A fits All Devices Below, order
from Table 1.66
• UL Listed, suitable only for use as service equipment
• Meets Federal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2
Rating Max.
Cur- Cat. No. 1P Lugs
Type Sepa- AWG/
rent rately AWG/ kcmil
Type
Circuits
Ampere
Spaces
Rating 2P kcmil
(Factory Installed Ampere Tan- [2]) (Al/Cu)
Circuits (Al/Cu)
except where Rating dems
(Max.)
noted)
1
Meter Mains[3]
Surface Mount Only
Surface Mount—Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and Provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
150 None OH/UG 22 kA QC816F150SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 8 16 8 150 A
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA QC816F150SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 8 16 8 150 A
A 350 8–2/0
200 None OH/UG 22 kA QC816F200SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA QC816F200SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A
Surface Mount—Supplied with Feed-Thru Lugs and provisions for Branch Circuit Breakers
150 None OH/UG 22 kA RC816F150SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 8 16 8 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC816F150SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 16 8 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
None OH/UG 22 kA RC816F200SS [4] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
200 Horn OH/UG 22 kA RC816F200SHS [4] [7] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 8 16 8 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A
Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC816F200SLS [4] [6] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 16 8 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
All-in-One Combination Service Entrance Devices [3]
Surface Mount Only
200 None OH/UG 22 kA QC2442M200SS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A Horn OH/UG 22 kA QC2442M200SHS [7] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 24 42 18 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
150 Horn OH/UG 22 kA RC2040M150SHS [7] [5] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 20 40 20 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC3040M150SLS [6] 1 QOM2150VH 150 A 30 40 10 150 A A 6-350 8–2/0
None OH/UG 22 kA RC2040M200SS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
200 Horn OH/UG 22 kA RC2040M200SHS [7] [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
A None OH 22 kA SO2040M200SS [5] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 20 40 20 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
Lever OH/UG 22 kA RC3040M200SLS [6] 1 QOM2200VH 200 A 30 40 10 200 A A 6-350 8–2/0
* Kit is to be installed between meter socket and Main Disconnect. May be used with Solar PV, Wind, fuel generators, and other power generation sources up to 80% of Mains Rating Maximum
160 A.
C,D,E,F
Ground
Ampere Rating
Max. Quantity
Current Rating
Bypass Type
Short Circuit
1P Lugs
Rating Max.
Cat. No.
Separately )
Type AWG/
AWG/ kcmil
2P Type kcmil
Bus Bar
Circuits
Ampere
Spaces
(Al/Cu) (Al/Cu)
Circuits (Factory Installed Tandems
(Max.) except where noted)
[1] To order load centers and branch circuit breakers, see QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-10 and Homeline Plug-On Circuit Breakers, page 1-21
[2] See Bolt-On Hubs, page 1-26
[3] Solar Ready Kit Part Number SR69064A * (This Kit Fits All Solar Ready Devices)
[4] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4AWG-250 kcmil Al/Cu conductors.
[5] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBS. See (see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[6] Suitable for load wires to exit top endwall with addition of Tunnel Kit OHBL. See(see Table 1.70 Accessories, page 1-33, check with local utility for approval.
[7] Device supplied with horn bypass and 5th jaw factory installed
1-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline Solar Ready PoN CSEDs Rainproof, Meter Mains and All-In-Ones,
125 to 225 A Maximum
1
where noted
• Meets Ferderal Specification W-P-115c as Type 1, Class 2 • Meets EUSERC requirements
Rating Max.
Breaker Rating Type Type Rating 1P Sepa- AWG/ AWG/
rately kcmil
Tandems
Type kcmil
Circuits
Ampere
Spaces
2P [2]) (Al/Cu)
(Factory Installed (Al/Cu)
Circuits
(Max.) except where
noted)
Semiflush Mount Only
200 A None OH[3]/UG 22 kA SC816F200PF [4] 1 QOM2200VH 8 16 8 200 A
125 A None OH[3]/UG 22 kA SC2040M125PF 1 QOM2125VH 20 40 20 110 A
225 A None OH[3]/UG 22 kA SC2040M200PF 1 QOM2200VH 20 40 20 200 A A-L 4-250 8-2/0
200 A
None OH[5]/UG 22 kA SC3042M200PF 1 QOM2200VH 30 42 12 200 A
225 A None OH[5]/UG 22 kA SC3042M225PF 1 QOM2225VH 30 42 12 200 A
Surface Mount Only
150 A None OH/UG 22 kA SC816F150PS [4] 1 QOM2150VH 8 16 8 150 A
None OH/UG 22 kA SC816F200PS [4] 1 QOM2200VH 8 16 8 200 A
225 A None OH/UG 22 kA SC2040M200PS 1 QOM2200VH 20 40 20 200 A A-L
200 A 4-250 8-2/0
None OH/UG 22 kA SC3042M200PS 1 QOM2200VH 30 42 12 200 A
None OH/UG 22 kA SC42M200PS 1 QOM2200VH 42 42 0 200 A
C,D,E,F
A,B
A
3.4 0
86
21.50
546
11.10
S C3042M200P S
282
42.60
38.40 1006
S C42M200P S
899 29.50
749
32.30
820
37. 30
8/16 - 20/40
947
.
30/42
10 30
262
C,D,E,F A
B,C B C,E,F,G,H
2 1 /2 " Ma x B,C
“A-L” Hub
C,E ,F,G, H
2 1 /2 " Ma x A
“A-L” Hub B
Surface Mount
C,D,E,F
Semiflush Mount
[1] Accepts Solar Ready Kit Part Number SR69064A. Check with local utility for approval and order separately.
[2] See Bolt-On Hubs, page 1-26
[3] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTKP20). Check with local utility for approval and order separately.
[4] Supplied with load side feed-thru lugs, for 4AWG-250 kcmil Al/Cu conductors.
[5] Suitable for OH service with addition of tunnel kit (SCTKP30). Check with local utility for approval and order separately.
1-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosed Devices
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
overcurrent protection
Ampere Box. No.
Service Rating General Purpose Rainproof
[1]
QO200TR 2, 9R [4]
240 Vac 60 A [2] [3] QO260NATS QO200TRNM 1NM
QO260NATR 1R
1
Table 1.79: Enclosed GFCI Circuit Breakers, GFCI Circuit Breaker Included—10 kA
Short Circuit Current Rating
QO200TRNM
Ampere Type 3R— Circuit Breaker Box. No.
Service Rating Rainproof Included [1]
1NM (Non-
QOE250GFINM QO250GFI metallic)
120/240 Vac 50 A
HOME250SPA HOM250GFI 1R (Metallic)
Table 1.80: 2-Pole Circuit Breaker Enclosures—22 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
Ampere Box. No.
Service [6] Rating General Purpose [7] Rainproof
[1]
QO3100BNF
With Cover Removed
1-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosed Devices
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
1
schneider-electric.us
Q22200NS
QOM22225NS With Cover Removed Q23225NF
With Cover Removed
(Order Q-Frame circuit breaker separately)
LOAD CENTERS
Provide temporary power at construction sites.
T T • Each receptacle protected by QO-GFI circuit breaker in compliance with NEC®
requirements.
T T T • Each enclosure is rainproof.
• 10 kA short circuit current rating.
1C 2C 3C • UL Listed as suitable for use as temporary site service equipment.
• Provided with neutral bonding provisions.
T T T T T T • Boxes have provisions for type “B’’ hubs to be field-installed.
Table 1.83: Construction Site Panels
Receptacles Main Wire
Power Mains Size
Outlet Service Ampere Circuit Breaker (Included)
(Included) Cat. No. [2] AWG [3]
4C 5C 6C Configuration [1] Rating
A C D E F Cu Al
1
1C 1Ø2W 40 A (1) QO120GFI 1 PAK10C1 14–6 12–6
T T T T T T 2C 1Ø2W 40 A (2) QO120GFI 2 PAK11C [4] 14–6 12–6
T T T (2) QO120GFI
2C 1Ø2W 40 A 2 PAK11C1 14–6 12–6
(1) QO120GFI
3C 1Ø3W 70 A (1) QO230GFI 1 1 PAK31CGFI 8–1 8–1
(1) QO120GFI
7C 8C 9C 4C 1Ø3W 70 A (1) QO220GFI 1 1 PAK36C1GFI 8–1 8–1
(1) QO120GFI
5C 1Ø3W 70 A (1) QO250GFI 1 1 PAK51CGFI 8–1 8–1
T T T T (1) QO120GFI
6C 1Ø3W 70 A (1) QO250GFI 1 1 PAK55CGFI 8–1 8–1
10C 11C 12C (2) QO120GFI
7C 1Ø3W 70 A (1) QO220GFI 2 1 PAK72CGFI 8–1 8–1
(2) QO120GFI
8C 1Ø3W 70 A (1) QO250GFI 2 1 PAK76CGFI 8–1 8–1
T
T
(1) QO120GFI
9C 1Ø3W 100 A (2) QO250GFI 1 2 PAK1004CGFI 14–1 12–1
13C 14C
schneider-electric.us
LOAD CENTERS
1-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 2
Metering Equipment
Meter Sockets 2-2
METERING EQUIPMENT
Ring and Ringless Devices 2-5
Ring and Ringless Type Devices 2-5
Individua l Me te r S ocke t
Tenant Circuit Breakers 2-7
Accessories for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers 2-7
Dimensions and Knockouts for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers 2-9
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 2-10
2
3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Side Tap) 2-20
3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Center Tap) 2-21
Tenant Circuit Breakers and EZM Accessories 2-22
Dimensions 2-24
11/10/2017
Meter Sockets Ring and Ringless Type Individual Meter
Sockets
Class 4131 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701 schneider-electric.us
UTRS202B UTH5203T
UTRS101B (Cover not shown) (Cover not shown) URTRS213B
METERING EQUIPMENT
UT2R1121B before installing. Contact your nearest Field Sales Office for additional catalog
numbers, if required by utility.
Table 2.2: Ringless Type, 1Ø3W, 600 Vac Max., Without Bypass or Jaw Release
Branch Ratings Top Endwall [12]
Main Lugs
Socket Mains Branch Lugs
Phase and Neutral Hub Type Closing Plate
Amperes No. of Jaw Service Rating Cat. No. Al/Cu Phase and Neutral Box No. [13]
(A) Al/Cu (AWG) (Order (Order
[14] Positions Qty. Type (AWG/kcmil) Separately) Separately)
[15]
2 200 UT2R1121B 6–250 13R
3 205 UT3R1121B 6–250 13R1
100 A 4 4 OH/UG 205 UT4R1131B 6–350 8–2/0 Series A ACP 14R
5 250 UT5R1131B 6–350 15R
6 300 UT6R1131B 6–350 16R
2 205 UT2R2122B 6–250 Series A ACP 17R
4 360 UT4R2352T 1/0–500 Series A-L ACPL 18R
1/0–500 or
200 A 5 4 OH/UG 500 UT5R2392TU 8–250 Series A-L ACPL 19R
(2)1/0–350
2
1/0–500 or
6 620 UT6R2392TU Series A-L ACPL 20R
(2)1/0–350
Hub Opening
D W Hub D W Hub Opening
Opening D W
Meter
Socket Meter Meter
Socket Main Socket Main
G,H,I,J H Lugs H Lugs H
S A S A
Meter Socket
Left position omitted on
5-Gang unit (15R) Hub Opening
D W
Hub Op ening
D W
7.50 Suppli ed wi th (2)
191 ACP C losing P lates .
Main
Me te r
Lugs H Order A-Hubs
Soc ket Ma in 22.44 separ ately f or
Lugs H 570
S A
overhead ser vice
S A
feed.
Main
Lugs H
S A A,B
METERING EQUIPMENT
• Surface mount, convertible to semi-flush with field installed flange kit.
• Ring type devices supplied with 4-jaw meter sockets (5th jaw kits available, order
separately).
• Ringless type devices supplied with 5-jaw meter sockets, available with and without
horn or lever bypass.
• Provisions for mounting 2-pole circuit breaker for each meter socket position (order
circuit breakers separately).
• Mounting channel supplied, except for box 1R (125 A, 2-position).
MP44125
• Combination overhead/underground feed.
2
H Ringless with Horn Bypass and 5th Jaw
L Ringless with Lever Bypass, Jaw Release and 5th Jaw
2 200 A
3 300 A
4 400 A
Bus Ampacity
5 500 A
6 600 A
8 800 A
2 2-Positions MP, MPH, MPL, and MPR
3 3-Positions MP, MPH, MPL, and MPR
Number of Meter Sockets 4 4-Positions MP, MPH, MPL, and MPR
5 5-Positions MP, MPH and MPR
6 6-Positions MP, MPH, MPL and MPR
125 125 A
Max. Tenant Circuit Breaker Amperage 200 200 A
225 225 A
2-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Ring and Ringless Devices
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
Table 2.10: Ring Type MP Meter-Pak Metering Equipment with 125 A (42 kA Maximum SCCR) or 200 A (22 kA Maximum SCCR) Meter
Socket Positions
Factory-Installed
Main Lugs Main Bus Line Lug Wire Circuit Semi-Flush
Amperes No. of Ampacity Breaker Type Box
per Pos. Ampacity Cat. No. Size Al/Cu Hub Prov. [2] Flange Kit Wt Lbs
Positions (A) (2P) No.
(alternate lugs [1]) AWG/kcmil
2 200 200 MP22125 [3] (1) 4–250 A/B300 MPSF12 46 1R
(1) 1/0–600 or
3 300 300 MP33125 [4] (2) 1/0–250 A-L MPSF14 95 2R
(1) 1/0–600 or QO,
2
(1) 1/0–600 or
3 400 400 MP43200 [4] (2) 1/0–250 MPSF23 99 4R
QOM2-MM, (4) A-L
200 (1) 1/0–600 or QOM2-MVH
4 400 600 MP64200 [4] (2) 1/0–250 MPSF24 135 5R
5 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MP85200 [4] (2) 3/0–500 MPSF26 173 6R
6 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MP86200 [4] (2) 3/0–500 MPSF26 173 6R
Table 2.11: Ringless Type MP Meter-Pak Metering Equipment with 125 A (42 kAMaximum SCCR) or 200 A Type MPR, MPH (22 kA
Maximum SCCR) or 225 A Type MPL (100 kA Maximum SCCR) Meter Socket Positions
Factory-Installed Line Lug Circuit Breaker
Amperes No. Main Lugs Main Bus Horn Lever Type Hub Semi-Flush
Per of No. Bypass Bypass Bypass Wire Size Wt Box
Ampacity Ampacity Cat. No. Al/Cu (2P) Prov. [2] Flange Kit Lbs No.
Pos. Pos. (alternate lugs [1]) Cat. No. Cat. No. [5].
AWG/kcmil
2 200 200 MPR22125 MPH22125 — (1) 4–250 A/B300 MPSF12 46 1R
(1) 1/0–600 or
3 300 300 MPR33125 MPH33125 — (2) 1/0–250 MPSF14 95 2R
A-L
(1) 1/0–600 or QO,
4 400 400 MPR44125 MPH44125 — (2) 1/0–250 QO-VH, MPSF14 97 2R
125
400 Al (1) 1/0–600 or QOH
5 500 MPR55125 MPH55125 — (2) 1/0–250 MPSF16 130 3R
500 Cu
(2) A-L
400 Al (1) 1/0–600 or
6 600 MPR66125 MPH66125 — (2) 1/0–250 MPSF16 132 3R
500 Cu
2 400 400 MPR42200 MPH42200 MPSF23 99 4R
(1) 1/0–600 or QOM2-MM,
200 3 400 400 MPR43200 MPH43200 — (2) 1/0–250 QOM2-MVH MPSF23 99 4R
4 400 600 MPR64200 MPH64200 MPSF24 135 5R
2 350 350 — — MPL32225 QBP-TM, N/A 105 7R
3 400 500 — — MPL53225 QDP-TM, N/A 147 8R
(1) 1/0–600 or QGP-TM or
QJ-TM (2) A-L
225 (2) 1/0–250
4 400 600 — — MPL64225 QO [6], N/A 200 9R
QO-VH [6]
or QOH [6]
5 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MPR85200 MPH85200 — (2) 3/0–500 QOM2-MM, MPSF26 173 6R
200 QOM2-MVH
6 600 Al, 750 Cu 800 MPR86200 MPH86200 — (2) 3/0–500 MPSF26 173 6R
NOTE: UL Listed short circuit current rating depends on lowest interrupting rating of
circuit breaker installed.
METERING EQUIPMENT
70 QO270 QO270VH —
80 QO280 QO280VH QOH280 [7] —
90 QO290 QO290VH QOH290 —
100 QO2100 QO2100VH QOH2100 —
125 QO2125 QO2125VH QOH2125 —
QOM2200MVH For use in 200 A Max. Type MP, MPR and MPH Meter-Pak Metering Equipment
100 QOM2100MM QOM2100MVH — —
125 QOM2125MM QOM2125MVH — —
150 QOM2150MM QOM2150MVH — —
175 QOM2175MM QOM2175MVH — —
200 QOM2200MM QOM2200MVH — —
Amperes 10 k AIR 25 k AIR 65 k AIR 100 k AIR
120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac 120/240 Vac
For use in 225 A MPL Lever Bypass Meter-Pak Metering Equipment
40 QO240 [8] QO240VH [7] [9] [8] QOH240 [10] [8] —
50 QO250 [8] QO250VH [7] [9] [8] QOH250 [10] [7] [8] —
60 QO260 [8] QO260VH [7] [9][8] QOH260 [10] [7] [8] —
QO2100VH 70 QBP22070TM QDP22070TM QGP22070TM QJP22070TM
2
2P, Plug-on Type 80 QBP22080TM QDP22080TM QGP22080TM QJP22080TM
Circuit Breaker 90 QBP22090TM QDP22090TM QGP22090TM QJP22090TM
100 QBP22100TM QDP22100TM QGP22100TM QJP22100TM
110 QBP22110TM QDP22110TM QGP22110TM QJP22110TM
125 QBP22125TM QDP22125TM QGP22125TM QJP22125TM
150 QBP22150TM QDP22150TM QGP22150TM QJP22150TM
175 QBP22175TM QDP22175TM QGP22175TM QJP22175TM
200 QBP22200TM QDP22200TM QGP22200TM QJP22200TM
225 QBP22225TM QDP22225TM QGP22225TM QJP22225TM
QDP22200TM
2P, Plug-on Type
Circuit Breaker
Accessories for MP Meter-Pak Meter Centers
Table 2.13: Accessories
Accessory Description Cat. No.
Fifth Jaw Kit Fifth Jaw Kit 5J
Horn Bypass Kit For MPR and MPH only MMHB
QO Adapter For Bolt-on Q2M tenant circuit breakers (40–125 A, 2P) EZM125QOA
Slider Type Manual 125 A Ring Style 2 Position Top Meter (Only) MM125MB [11]
Circuit Closing: 125 and 200 A Ring Style MM200MB [11]
Snap-on Aluminum 2920910001
Sealing Rings: Screw Type Aluminum 29008W
MMLK500 Snap-on Type Stainless Steel ARP00026
Meter Cover- Meter Cover-Lexan™ 29007
Lexan™
(1) 1/0–600 AWG/kcmil or
(2) 1/0–250 AWG/kcmil per phase MMLK250 [12][13]
Optional Lug Kits:
(2) 3/0–500 AWG/kcmil per phase MMLK500 [13]
(2) 2–600 AWG/kcmil per phase MMLK600 [13]
125 A 2 Position MPSF12
125 A 3–4 Position MPSF14
125 A 5–6 Position MPSF16
Semiflush Kits:
200 A 2–3 Position MPSF23
200 A 4 Position MPSF24
200 A 5–6 Position MPSF26
NEMA/EUSERC For 3 through 6 position 125 A and 200 A devices. Each pad rated
Lug Landing Kit: 600 A maximum and includes (2) 1/2-13 studs and mounting MMSK2 [13]
hardware.
NEMA Lug Landing For use ONLY on MPL43225, MPL53225 and MPL64225 with
optional lugs. See wiring diagram of each device for optional lugs. MMSK4
Kit:
2-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MP Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Ring and Ringless Devices
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
METERING EQUIPMENT
9.00
229
42.37
1076
18.50 11.19
470 C,D,F 284
C,D,F 11.19
C,D,F 284
C,D,F
E,F,G,H,I,J and A,B
C,D,F C,D,F A-L Hub Provision
D,F,G and A or
B300 Hub Provision
A E,F,G,H,I,J and
A A-L Hub Provision
Box 1R Box 2R A,B Box 3R
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
with ACPL Closing Plates
A-L Hub Opening Supplied
A-L Hub Opening Supplied 8.28 with ACPL Closing Plates
210
with ACPL Closing Plates
8.28
8.28 29.44 210
210 748
2
46.68
29.44 1186
748
Top Left
Top Position 9.00 Position
229
Omitted on Typ. Omitted on
2-Gang Unit 5-Gang Unit
9.00
9.00 229
229 Typ.
Typ. 52.00
1321
43.41
43.41 1103
1103
12.22
12.22 C,D,F 12.22 310
310 310 C,D,F
C,D,F
35.37
898
14.00
356
53.12 67.37
1349 1711
60.25
1530
14.00 14.00
356 356
34.00 Typ. Typ.
864
C,D,E,F C,D,E,F
13.43 13.43
C,D,E,F 341 341
Knockouts
Symbol A B C D E F G H I J
Conduit Size (in.) 1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
2-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Indoor/Rainproof EZM General Information
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
• 400, 600 and 800 A main disconnects may be end-mounted with branch units having
240 Vac Maximum, for use on AC systems, suitable 800 A or 1200 A continuous horizontal cross bus.
for use as Service Equipment. • 1000 and 1200 A main disconnect or terminal box must be center mounted when
used with branch devices with main bus rated 800 A continuous.
Utility Company Requirements Review local
utility requirements to ensure that metering • 1600 A main disconnect or terminal box must be center mounted.
equipment meets their standards. • 2000 A main disconnect must be center mounted and requires use of branch units
having 1200 A continuous horizontal cross bus.
EZ Meter-Pak meter center enclosures meet NEC • 400, 800 and 1200 A Type EZM-TBU terminal boxes supplied with lug landings to
meet EUSERC requirements.
wire bending requirements, and are designed for
wall mounting only (not suitable for floor mounting). Main Circuit Breaker ratings: 400, 600, 800, 1000, 1200, 1600 and 2000 A
All unmetered conductor compartments may be Main Fusible Switch ratings: 400, 600, 800, and 1200 A (1Ø3W only)
sealed by the utility company. Main Lugs Terminal Box ratings: 225, 400, 600, 800, 1200, 1600, and 2000 A
2-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Indoor/Rainproof EZM General Information EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
Configuration Information
Table 2.14: EZM Mains Devices
Number Segment Character Description EZM 1 1000 CB U CU
Device Name EZM EZ Meter-Pak Meter Center
1 1Ph, 3W
Service Feed
3 3Ph, 4W
225 A
400 A
600 A
800 A
Mains Rating 1000 A
1200 A
1600 A
METERING EQUIPMENT
2000 A
CB Main Circuit Breaker
FS Main Fusible Switch
Main Type TB Terminal Box
GCB Main Circuit Breaker (65 kAIC)
JCB Main Circuit Breaker (100 kAIC)
Blank Overhead / Underground
C Overhead / Underground
B Underground Only
Feed Direction
T Overhead Only
U Underground Only, Meets EUSERC Standards up to 1200 A max.
E Underground Only, Meets EUSERC Standards up to 1200 A max.
Blank Aluminum Horizontal Cross Bus Bar up to 1000A max.
Special Construction CU Copper Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
MS Includes Energy Reduction Maintenance Switch
This table is for interpreting existing part numbers only. All possible combinations are not
2
available.
Table 2.15: EZM Branch Devices
Number Segment Character Description EZM R 1 1 3 125 CU
Device Name EZM EZ Meter-Pak Meter Center
Blank Ring Type
R Ringless Type with 5th Jaw
H Ringless with Horn Bypass and 5th Jaw
Socket/Bypass Type
L Lever Bypass with 5th Jaw, 7th Jaw if Three Phase
T Ring Type Test-Block Bypass EUSERC
K K-Base Bolt-On Type
1 1Ph, 3W
Service Feed
3 3Ph, 4W
1 1Ph, 3W
Load Feed
3 3Ph, 4W
Number of Meter Sockets Meter Sockets
Available 1,2,3,4,5 or 6
125 125 A
Maximum Tenant Circuit Breaker
Amperage 225 225 A
400 400 A
Blank Aluminum Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
CA For 240/120 Vac Delta Systems
CU Copper Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
Special Construction
D Removable Drip Hood with Indoor Top Endwall with Knockouts
M10 10-Inch Meter Centers
X 1200A Copper Horizontal Cross Bus Bar
2-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Selection Information
Class 4141 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
Selection Information
• Review local utility
requirements to ensure that
• Using the SCCR table:
– Select meter center configuration, main lugs only (Six Disconnect Rule), or remote main, main circuit
metering equipment meets breaker, or main fusible switch.
their standards. – Read down to select SCCR equal to, or greater than desired rating.
• Check local utility to determine – Read across to select branch unit tenant circuit breaker type.
available fault current at the
meter center. – Continue reading across to select EZM main device type.
2
Table 2.16: UL Listed Meter Center Short Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR) [1]
EZM Meter Center Overcurrent Protection Devices
Short Circuit
Current Rating EZM Branch Unit Tenant Circuit Breaker
Figures (240 Vac Types Available (Branch Unit Amperes
EZM Main Device with Integral Mounted Main, Remote Mounted Main
Maximum) [2] max.,
METERING EQUIPMENT
[1] Tenant circuit breakers of same frame size having higher AIR values may replace tenant circuit breakers as listed in this table and maintain the series rating.
[2] Meter center short circuit current rating is equal to the lowest short circuit current rating given in table for any circuit breaker installed in any meter panelboard in the meter center.
[3] Short circuit current rating is measured at the LINE SIDE terminals of the integral mounted or remote mounted main providing overcurrent protection for the EZM metering equipment lineup.
[4] For three-tier series ratings refer to Data Bulletin 4100DB0301 and Instruction Bulletin 80043-303-22.
[5] Requires use of EZM125QOA adapter (order separately).
[6] 3P only tenant circuit breaker(s) are limited to: 100 kA Max. at 208Y/120 Vac or 65 kA Max at 240/120 Vac.
[7] Supplied with factory-installed circuit breaker(s), with an adjustable trip range of 125–400 A.
2-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
1 Phase Main Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4161 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
METERING EQUIPMENT
2. Select EZM 1Ø branch units from Table 2.19, Table 2.20 or Table 2.21.
3. Select proper 2P type QO, QO-VH, QOH, QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM
branch circuit breakers for use as tenant mains in branch unit from Table 2.33 and
Table 2.34.
4. Select accessories as required fromTable 2.35.
5. Dimensions; see page 2-24 and page 2-25.
Select Main Devices—NEMA 3R Construction
Table 2.17: Main Devices, Overhead Feed
Horizontal Cross Factory-Installed Line Side Lug
Ampere Width
Rating Bus Rating and Cat. No. [8] (in.) (Conductors per Phase and Neutral)
Bus Bar Material Wire Size (AWG/kcmil)
Main Circuit Breaker (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing)
65 kA 100 kA
400 400 A, Al EZM1400CB [9] — 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2) 1–250
2
600 600 A, Al EZM1600CB[9] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Al EZM1800CB[9] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1000 1200 A, Cu EZM11000CB[9] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM11200GCBT [10] EZM11200JCBT [10] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM11600GCBC [9][10] [11] EZM11600JCBC [9][10] [11] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM12000CB [9] [11] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
Main Fusible Switches (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing) Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
400 400 A, Al — EZM1400FS[9] 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2) 1–250
600 600 A, Al — EZM1600FS[9] 18.50 (3) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Al — EZM1800FS[9] 18.50 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM11200FST [9] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
Main Lug Terminal Boxes (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing)
225 800 A, Al — EZM1225TB [9][12] 11.66 (1) 4–300
400 800 A, Al — EZM1400TB [9] [13] 17.15 (2) 3/0–500
600 800 A, Al — EZM1600TB [9] [13] 17.15 (2) 1/0–750 or (4) 1/0–300
800 800 A, Al — EZM1800TB [9] [13] 18.66 (4) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Cu — EZM1800TBCU [9][13][14] 24.08 (4) 3/0–500
EZM11200FST
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM11600TB [9] [13][14] 22.48 (6) 1/0-600 or (12) 1/0-300
2000 1200 A, Cu — EZM12000TB [9][13] [11] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breaker (1Ø Incoming and 1Ø Outgoing) with Energy Reduction Maintenance (ERMS)
1200 1200 A, Cu EMZ11200GCBTMS [15] EZM11200JCBTMS [15] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1600 1200 A, Cu EMZ11600GCBCMS [9] EZM11600JCBCMS [9] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Cu EMZ12000CBMS [9] — 30.19 (6) 1/0-750 or (12) 1/0-250
[16] For mechanical lugs (3/0 AWG– 600 kcmil) order kit CMELK4. Kit includes 4 lugs only. Multiple kits may be required, consult factory. For crimp-type lugs refer to Anderson Electrical
Connector Products Catalog AEC-40R.
[17] Available by special order with main circuit breaker supplied with other standard ampere ratings, consult local Field Office (allow 6 weeks for delivery).
[18] Supplied with copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[19] Does not meet EUSERC requirements.
[20] Ampere rating of the circuit breaker supplied with this device can be changed to a LOWER value in the field by changing the setting on the circuit breaker.
[21] For field installed Lug Landing Kit, order catalog number EZM1200ULL. Order lugs separately.
[22] Terminal box is suitable for use on LINE or LOAD side of service equipment. Supplied with isolated neutral and provided with neutral bonding kit for use as required. Refer to page 2-12 for
appropriate short circuit current ratings.
2-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
1 Phase Branch Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4161 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
METERING EQUIPMENT
120/240 Vac 1200 A Cu EZM114125CUX EZMR114125CUX EZMH114125CUX
2P Branch 12.25
800 A Al EZM115125 [25] EZMR115125 [25] EZMH115125 [25]
Circuit Breakers 5
1200 A Cu EZM115125CUX EZMR115125CUX EZMH115125CUX
800 A Al EZM116125 [25] EZMR116125 [25] EZMH116125 [25]
6
1200 A Cu EZM116125CUX EZMR116125CUX EZMH116125CUX
225 A Maximum Branch Units (Order Type QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM Circuit Breakers Separately) [26]
800 A Al EZM112225 [25] EZMR112225 [25] EZMH112225 [25]
2
1200 A Cu EZM112225CUX EZMR112225CUX EZMH112225CUX
800 A Al EZM113225 [25] EZMR113225 [25] EZMH113225 [25]
1Ø3W 3
1200 A Cu EZM113225CUX EZMR113225CUX EZMH113225CUX
120/240 Vac 17.38
2P Branch 800 A Al EZM114225 [25] EZMR114225 [25] EZMH114225 [25]
4
Circuit Breakers 1200 A Cu EZM114225CUX EZMR114225CUX EZMH114225CUX
1200 A Al/Cu EZM115225 EZMR115225 EZMH115225
5
1200 A Cu EZM115225CU EZMR115225CU EZMH115225CU
EZMH114125
6 1200 A Cu EZM116225 EZMR116225 EZMH116225
2
(Order Type QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM Circuit Breakers Separately) [27]
Ringless Type 5-Jaw Meter Socket Ring Type 5-Jaw Meter Socket
Horizontal Cross with Test Block Bypass.
Number with Lever Bypass and Jaw Release
System Type of Meter Bus Meets EUSERC Requirements
Rating and Bus Bar
Sockets Width Width
Material Cat. No. Cat. No.
(in.) (in.)
1200 A Al/Cu EZML111225 EZMT111225 [28] 22.42
1 1200 A Cu EZML111225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML111225D [29] — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML112225 EZMT112225 [28] 22.42
2 1200 A Cu EZML112225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML112225D [29] — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML113225 EZMT113225 [28][30] 22.42
3 1200 A Cu EZML113225CU 19.44 — —
1200 A Al/Cu EZML113225D [29] — —
1Ø3W
120/240 Vac 1200 A Al/Cu EZML114225 — —
2P Branch 1200 A Cu EZML114225CU — —
Circuit
Breakers
4 19.44
EZMT111225 EZML114225D [29]
1200 A Al/Cu — —
EZML113225
1. Select 3Ø EZM main device below with an equal or higher short circuit rating than
the application from Table 2.22 and Table 2.23.
2. Select EZM 3Ø branch units from Table 2.24, Table 2.25, and Table 2.26.
3. Select proper 2P type QO, QO-VH, QOH, QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM
or 3P QBP-TM, QDP-TM, QGP-TM or QJP-TM branch circuit breakers for use as
METERING EQUIPMENT
tenant mains in branch unit; from Table 2.33 and Table 2.34.
4. Select accessories as required, from page 2-22.
5. Dimensions see page 2-24.
3 Phase Main Devices—NEMA 3R Construction
Table 2.22: Main Devices, Overhead/Underground Feed
Ampere Horizontal Cross Width Factory-Installed Line Side Lug
Bus Rating and Bus Cat. No.[33] (Conductors per Phase and
Rating (in.)
Bar Material Neutral) Wire Size (AWG–kcmil)
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
65 kA Short Circuit Current Rating (400–1600 A Max.), 100 kA Short Circuit Current Rating (2000 A Max.)
Short Circuit Rating 65 kA 100 kA
400 400 A, Al EZM3400CB [34] — 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2) 1–250
600 600 A, Al EZM3600CB[34] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Al EZM3800CB[34] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1000 1200 A, Al EZM31000CB[34] — 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al EZM31200GCBT [35] [36] EZM31200JCBT [35] [36] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM31600GCBC[36] [37] EZM31600JCBC[36] [37] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM32000CB [37] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
Main Fusible Switches (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
400 400 A, Al — EZM3400FS[34] 18.66 (1) 1–600 or (2 )1–250
600 600 A, Al — EZM3600FS[34] 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Al — EZM3800FS[34] 18.66 (3) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM31200FST [35] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
Main Lug Terminal Boxes (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
225 800 A, Al — EZM3225TB [38] 11.66 (1) 4–300
400 800 A, Al — EZM3400TB [39] 17.15 (2) 3/0–500
600 800 A, Al — EZM3600TB [39] 17.15 (2) 1/0–750 or (4) 1/0–300
800 800 A, Al — EZM3800TB [39] 18.66 (4) 3/0–500
800 800 A, Cu — EZM3800TBCU [39] [40] 24.08 (4) 3/0–500
EZM31200FST 1600 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM31600TB [37] [40] [39] 22.48 (6) 1/0-600 or (12) 1/0-300
2000 1200 A, Cu — EZM32000TB [39] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) with Energy Reduction Maintenance Switch (ERMS)
1200 1200 A, Cu EZM31200GCBTMS[35] EZM31200JCBTMS[35] 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1600 1200 A, Cu EZM31600GCBCMS[34] EZM31600JCBCMS[34] 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
2000 1200 A, Cu EZM32000CBMS[34] — 30.19 (6) 1/0–750 or (12) 1/0–250
METERING EQUIPMENT
1600 1200 A, Al/Cu EZM31600GCBU [43] [45][46] EZM31600JCBU [43] [45][46] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
2000 1200 A, Al/Cu — EZM32000CBU [43][46] 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Fusible Switches (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) Requires 300 Vac Class T Fuses (Order Separately)
400 400 A, Al — EZM3400FSU 20.46 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
600 600 A, Al — EZM3600FSU 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
800 800 A, Al — EZM3800FSU 26.19 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM31200FSB [43][44] 23.69 (4) 3/0-500
1200 1200 A, Al — EZM31200FSE 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Lugs Terminal Boxes (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
400 400 A, Al — EZM3400TBU [47] 17.16 1 (Order Lugs Separately)
800 800 A, Al — EZM3800TBU [47] 25.16 2 (Order Lugs Separately)
1200 1200 A, Cu — EZM31200TBU [47] 33.16 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
Main Circuit Breaker (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing) with Energy reduction Maintenance Switch (ERMS)
EZM31200GCBU 1200 1200 A, Cu EZM31200GCBUMS EZM31200JCBUMS 23.69 (4) 3/0–500
1200 1200 A, Cu EZM31200GCBEMS EZM31200JCBEMS 32.39 3 (Order Lugs Separately)
1600 1200 A, Cu EZM31600GCBUMS EZM31600JCBUMS 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
2
2000 1200 A, Cu EZM32000CBUMS — 30.19 6 (Order Lugs Separately)
[41] For mechanical lugs (3/0 AWG– 600 kcmil) order kit CMELK4. Kit includes 4 lugs only. Multiple kits may be required, consult factory. For crimp-type lugs refer to Anderson Electrical
Connector Products Catalog AEC-40R.
[42] Available by special order with main circuit breaker supplied with other standard ampere ratings, consult your nearest Field Sales Office (allow 6 weeks for delivery).
[43] Does not meet EUSERC requirements.
[44] For field installed Lug Landing Kit order catalog number EZM1200ULL.
[45] Ampere rating of the circuit breaker supplied with this device can be changed to a LOWER value in the field by changing the setting on the circuit breaker.
[46] Supplied with copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[47] Terminal box is suitable for use on LINE or LOAD side of service equipment. Supplied with isolated neutral and provided with neutral bonding kit for use as required. Refer to page 2-12 for
appropriate short circuit current ratings.
2-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 3 Phase Branch Devices
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
[48] For 1200 A main cross bus, add suffix “X” to catalog number. Example: EZMR313125X.. Allow 6 weeks for delivery.
[49] Snap-On aluminum sealing rings supplied as standard.
[50] Supplied with removable drip hood and equipped with an indoor top endwall with knockouts provided.
[51] Distance between meter sockets as measured from centerline to centerline is 10 inches.
[52] 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QO-H (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center SCCR) may be installed using EZM125QOA adapter kit, see page 2-22.
[53] For 240/120 Vac Delta Systems add Suffix “CA” to catalog number (Example: EZM314125CA). All meter sockets are phased A and C only. Price remains the same as the base catalog
number. Order only branch units, not stocked in PDS (6-week delivery).
[54] 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QO-H (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center SCCR) may be installed using EZM125QOA adapter kit, refer to.
[55] Supplied with bondable neutral, suitable for use as service equipment. Use main lugs terminal box type EZM-TBU for Six Disconnect Rule applications to feed this device. Supplied with
copper horizontal bus bars and aluminum vertical bus bars.
[56] Does not meet EUSERC 48 in. minImum / 75 in. maximum meter height requirements for outdoor installations. The bottom meter socket is 37 inches above ground when the device is
mounted with the top meter socket at 75 inches above ground. EUSERC indoor requirements are 36 in. minimum / 75 in. maximum.
For 400 A maximum Commercial Branch Units, see page 2-19.
2-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3 Phase Branch Devices EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
METERING EQUIPMENT
Delta
or 208Y/120 Vac
7-Jaw Meter Socket 2 1200 A Cu EZML332400 23.21 EZMK332400 27.56
EZMK311400 3P Circuit Breakers
2
C. Once meter socket(s) is selected to be phase balanced, remove individual meter
socket cover from each meter socket to be phase balanced. The vertical bus bars
running top to bottom in the branch unit behind each meter socket are phased: AØ, BØ,
CØ, left to right.
D. By moving only the line side meter socket “Z” shaped connectors per meter socket to
be changed, phase balancing can easily be accomplished on-site:
Starting Position Step 2: Loosen hex nut from AØ line side meter socket jaw Step 1: Remove hex nut from AØ line side connection to
Meter Socket Phaseing: AØ and CØ and slide “Z” connector down to free connector from stud. vertical bus.
Step 3: Rotate “Z” connector to right and align with stud on BØ Step 4: Slide “Z” connector up to engage stud on BØ vertical
vertical bus. bus. Torque hex nut of meter socket jaw to 75 lb-in (8 N•m). Step 6: Replace hex nut (removed in Step 1) onto stud of BØ
vertical bus and torque to 75 lb-in (9 N•m).
Phase balancing of meter socket is complete: BØ and CØ.
[57] Supplied with Class 320 lever bypass meter socket. Use anti-inversion clip kit, catalog number MMLRK, if required. See page 2-22.
[58] LJL circuit breaker has adjustable trip settings from 125-400 A. Use seal kit MICROTUSEAL, if required. LJL circuit breaker terminal lug kit factory-installed and accommodates (2) 2/0-500
kcmil Cu-Al per phase. Alternate lug kit AL400L61K3 for LJL circuit breaker is available, see page 2-22.
[59] For 240/120 Vac Delta Systems add Suffix “CA” to catalog number (Example: EZML312400CA). All meter sockets are phased A and C only. Price remains the same as the base catalog
number. “Order only” branch units, not stocked in PDS (4–6 week delivery). Order point Lexington.
2-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers 3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Side Tap)
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
[60] Requires use of branch units supplied with 1200 A horizontal cross bus.
2-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
3 Phase Main Devices (Busway Center Tap) EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
METERING EQUIPMENT
only. All possible combinations are not available. Please contact product support for
additional references needed.
2. Outgoing Feeder Bus Joint-Pak is included with each EZM CTM Section.
3. EZM Horizontal Cross Bus is 1200 A Copper Only
4. Busway Center Tap Mains are fully NEMA 3R Rated.
5. Mains Devices are fully sealable by utility.
6. EZM Branch units are installed using the mounting kit - EZMCTMKIT.
7. Short circuit current rating = 150,000 symmetrical amps.
8. EZM CTM is configured for neutral front only (G-> N-> C-> B->A-> G) as viewed front
to rear.
9. Compatible with I-LINE II Busway rated 2000–5000 A.
10. Includes factory installed PowerPact M- and P-frame Circuit Breakers and Switches
(Rated 600–1200 A.)
11. Fully compatible with all standard EZ Meter-Pak Branch Devices and Extenders.
2
Table 2.31: Part Number Coding
Number Segment Character Description EZM 3 1000 JCB C 20
Device Name EZM EZM Busway Center Tap Main
System Connection (Phase Order: Front to Back) 3 3 Phase (N, C, B, A)
600 600 A
800 800 A
Maximum Current of Main Service Disconnect
1000 1000 A
1200 1200 A
GCB 65 kAIC Circuit Breaker
Type of Main Service Disconnect (with AIC Rating) JCB 100 kAIC Circuit Breaker
FS 100 kAIC Fused Switch
C Copper
Material of I-Line II
A Aluminum
20 2000 A
25 2500 A
30 3000 A
Amperage of I-Line II
32 3200 A
40 4000 A
50 5000 A
This table is for interpreting existing part numbers only. All possible combinations are not
available.
Table 2.32: EZM Busway Center Tap Mains
Main CB MC
I-Line II Busway Height Width Depth
Ampere Rating Rating Material Cat. No. (in.) (in.) (in.) Height
(A) (in.)
Main Circuit Breakers (3Ø Incoming and 3Ø Outgoing)
SCCR 65 kA 100 kA
2000A, Al — EZM3600JCBA20 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
3000A, Al — EZM3600JCBA30 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al — EZM3600JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
600
4000A, Al EZM3600GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Cu EZM3600GCBC40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
2000A, Al EZM3800GCBA20 — 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
3000A, Al EZM3800GCBA30 — 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
3000A, Cu EZM3800GCBC30 — 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
800
3000A, Al — EZM3800JCBA30 43.08 22.70 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al — EZM3800JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al EZM3800GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al EZM31000GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
1000 4000A, Al — EZM31000JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Cu — EZM31000JCBC40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
4000A, Al EZM31200GCBA40 — 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
1200 4000A, Al — EZM31200JCBA40 43.08 27.96 14.78 56.11
2-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Tenant Circuit Breakers and EZM
Accessories
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701 schneider-electric.us
Circuit Breaker 90 —
100 QO2100 QO2100VH QOH2100 —
110 QO2110 QO2110VH QOH2110 —
125 QO2125 QO2125VH QOH2125 —
Table 2.34: 225 A Max. EZM Branch Unit Tenant Circuit Breakers
Poles Ampere Rating 10 k AIR 25 k AIR 65 k AIR 100 k AIR
METERING EQUIPMENT
METERING EQUIPMENT
Secondary Surge Arrester Mounting kit For use with 1 or 2-SDSA1175 or 1-SDSA3650 (order surge arrester separately) MMSAMK [65]
Stud Kit for EZM-TB 400–600 A terminal Includes (2) 1/2 in.-13 studs per pad and mounting hardware. Four pads per kit. EZMSK2
box
(1) 1/0–600 kcmil or (2) 1/0–250 kcmil per lug MMLK250
Al/Cu Lug Kits (2) 3/0–500 kcmil per lug
(Each kit includes three, 2-barrel lugs.) MMLK500
(2) 2–600 kcmil per lug MMLK600
Feed -Thru for EZM-TB 800 A Terminal Box (4) 750 kcmil Al/Cu lugs per phase and neutral. Al wire 600 A max. Cu wire 800 A max. EZM600FTLK3
Feed-Thru for EZM-TB 1600 A Terminal (24) additional lugs, 600 kcmil Al/Cu, (6) per phase and neutral. EZM1600FTLK3
Box
EZM Mains Right Side Closure Cap Replacement right side end cap for EZM Cross Bus Opening EZMSCAP
EZM Mains Left Side Closure Cap Replacement left side end cap for EZM Cross Bus Opening EZMCAP
Fifth Jaw Kit 1 per kit 5J [66]
Horn Bypass Kit Use with Type EZMR 1Ø meter socket only MMHB
Slider Type Manual Circuit Closer For (1) 125–225 A ring-type socket only—indoor/outdoor MM200MB [67] [68]
Anti-inversion Clip Rejects 100 A and 200 A watt-hour meters in Class 320 meter sockets in Type EZML branch units. MMLRK
QO Adapter for bolt-on Q-frame tenant For 2P Type QO (40–125 A, 10 kA max. meter center SCCR) or QO-VH and QOH (40–60 A, 100 kA max. meter center
SCCR) EZM125QOA
circuit breakers
2
LJL Circuit Breaker Alternate Lug (DE2) Kit includes (3) separate lugs for (1) #2 AWG - 500 kcmil Al or (1) #2 AWG - 600 kcmil Cu per lug. AL400L61K3
LJL Circuit Breaker Seal Kit Tamper-evident kit to seal LJL trip dial cover, (1) per circuit breaker, if required. Meets NEC 240-6 [c] MICROTUSEAL
Lexan Closing Plate—EZM, EZMR, EZMH, EZMT 29007
Meter Socket Closing Plates
Metal Closing plate—EZMR, EZMH, EZML RSG4
Snap-on (Stainless Steel) ARP00026
Sealing Rings Screw-Type (Aluminum) 29008W
Latch-Type (Aluminum)-standard 2920910001
For use on ringless EZM or MP branch unit covers, includes 6 each of head protectors, lock nuts and sealing caps. (Barrel
Barrel Lock Kit lock not included.) MMBLC
125 A Branches—2P Type QO (2 per opening)
Tenant Circuit Breaker Filler Plates QOFP
225 A Branches—2P and 3P Q-Frame
Lug Landing Kit For use with EZM 1200 A Mains suffix -CBU or -FSB. Order lugs separately. EZM1200ULL
Branch Section Mounting Kit for Riser This kit is needed when installing and connecting meter center branch sections to EZ-Meter Pak busway center tap mains in
Applications. multi-floor riser applications (1 per branch section) EZMCTMKIT
[65] Consult your nearest Schneider Electric sales office for details.
[66] All sockets include 5th Jaw factory-installed except EZM11__ devices.
[67] Meter center short circuit current rating is 10,000 RMS symmetrical amperes with manual circuit closers installed (bypass is not designed for use as continuous duty).
[68] For use on ring type meter sockets only.
2-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
EZ Meter-Pak™ Meter Centers Dimensions
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701
schneider-electric.us
EZM11200FST 46.90 23.69 13.69 13.75 EZM31200G/JCBE 66.20 32.39 13.69 50.09
W EZM11200FSE 66.20 32.39 13.69 50.09 EZM31200TBU 44.71 33.16 11.68 31.17
EZM11200G/JCBU 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11 EZM31200G/JCBU 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11
EZM11200FSB 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11 EZM31200FSB 65.30 23.69 13.69 49.11
EZM11200TBU 44.71 33.16 11.68 31.17 EZM31200FST 46.90 23.69 13.69 13.75
EZM11200GCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12 EZM31200FSE 66.20 32.39 13.69 51.09
EZM11200GCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09 EZM31200GCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12
METERING EQUIPMENT
MC (Mounting Channel)
EZM11200GCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75 EZM31200GCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09
EZM11200JCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12 EZM31200GCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75
EZM11200JCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09 EZM31200JCBUMS 65.30 23.69 13.63 49.12
H EZM11200JCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75 EZM31200JCBEMS 66.27 32.39 13.70 50.09
EZM11600G/JCBC 68.70 30.19 18.33 38.13 EZM31200JCBTMS 46.93 23.69 13.63 13.75
EZM11600G/JCBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 49.12 EZM31600G/JCBC 68.70 30.19 18.33 38.13
EZM11600TB 55.09 22.48 13.00 27.92 EZM31600G/JCBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 49.12
EZM11600GCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600TB 55.09 22.48 13.00 27.92
EZM11600GCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600GCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM11600JCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600GCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM11600JCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM31600JCBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM12000CB 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25 EZM31600JCBCMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
Main Device EZM12000CBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25 EZM32000CB 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25
EZM12000TB 71.09 30.19 21.46 37.62 EZM32000CBU 68.70 30.19 18.33 44.25
W EZM12000CBMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM32000TB 71.09 30.19 21.46 37.62
EZM12000CBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50 EZM32000CBMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
T EZM1225TB [71] 21.81 11.66 6.37 13.00 EZM32000CBUMS 68.91 30.19 18.31 44.50
EZM1400CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3225TB [71] 21.81 11.66 6.37 13.00
EZM1400CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3400CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1400FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3400CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
MC (Mounting Channel)
EZM1400FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3400FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1400TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29 EZM3400FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1400TBU 35.71 17.16 8.00 27.17 EZM3400TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29
H EZM1600CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3400TBU 35.71 17.16 8.00 27.17
EZM1600CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3600CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM16000FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3600CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1600FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM36000FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1600TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29 EZM3600FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1800CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3600TB 30.46 17.15 7.09 16.29
B EZM1800CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3800CB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1800FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3800CBU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1800FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37 EZM3800FS 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
Branch Device EZM1800TB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30 EZM3800FSU 69.03 20.46 11.50 49.37
EZM1800TBCU 51.76 22.48 7.09 28.01 EZM3800TB 53.97 18.66 11.50 34.30
EZM1800TBU 39.96 25.16 11.68 31.17 EZM3800TBCU 51.76 22.48 7.09 28.01
EZM1EXT [71] 19.34 11.66 6.37 11.85 EZM3800TBU 39.96 25.16 11.68 31.17
EZM1EXT6 [71] 19.34 6.00 6.37 11.85 EZM3EXT [71] 19.34 11.66 6.37 11.85
EZM1CORNER [69][71][72] 19.50 14.40 8.02 11.85 EZM3EXT6 [71] 19.34 6.00 6.37 11.85
EZM3CORNER [69] [71] [72] 19.50 14.40 8.02 11.85
MC (Mounting Channel)
H
METERING EQUIPMENT
B
Branch Device
Table 2.37: Single Phase Branch Device Dimensions (in.) [73]
Height Width Depth MC Top Bottom Height Width Depth MC Top Bottom
Cat. No. Channel Meter Meter Cat. No. Channel Meter Meter
[available suffix] (H) (W) (D) [available suffix] (H) (W) (D)
(MC) (T) (B) (MC) (T) (B)
EZM112225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23 EZML111400 44.55 23.21 9.44 37.81 24.02 21.53
EZM113125 [X, CUX] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19 EZML112225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39
EZM113225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23 EZML112225D 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 11.67 13.39
EZM114125 [X, CUX] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZML112400 69.61 23.21 9.44 37.81 20.64 21.53
EZM114225 [X, CUX] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23 EZML113225 [CU] 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM115125 [X, CUX] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZML113225D 53.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM115225 [CU] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23 EZML114225 [CU] 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
EZM116125 [X, CUX] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19 EZML114225D 67.06 19.44 9.44 39.51 11.67 13.39
2
EZM16225 69.94 17.387 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22 EZMR112225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23
EZMH112225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 22.18 12.23 EZMR113125 [X, CUX] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19
EZMH113125 [X, CUX] 42.37 12.25 7.09 31.30 13.18 11.19 EZMR113225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23
EZMH113225 [X, CUX] 43.41 17.38 8.09 32.34 13.18 12.23 EZMR114125 [X, CUX] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH114125 [X, CUX] 48.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR114225 [X, CUX] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23
EZMH114225 [X, CUX] 52.00 17.38 8.09 32.34 12.77 12.23 EZMR115125 [X, CUX] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH115125 [X, CUX] 57.12 12.25 7.09 31.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR115225 [CU] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23
EZMH115225 [CU] 61.00 17.38 8.09 32.35 12.77 12.23 EZMR116125 [X, CUX] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19
EZMH116125 [X, CUX] 66.12 12.25 7.09 40.30 9.93 11.19 EZMR116225 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22
EZMH116225 69.94 17.37 8.09 41.33 12.72 12.22 EZMT111225 25.45 22.42 9.38 16.19 4.67 20.45
EZMK111400 45.55 27.56 9.74 37.81 24.51 21.04 EZMT112225 60.56 22.42 9.38 43.63 12.67 28.89
EZMK112400 72.99 27.56 9.74 37.81 22.26 21.04 EZMT113225 79.56 22.42 9.38 48.25 12.67 28.89
EZML111225 [CU] 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39
EZML111225D 39.06 19.44 9.44 25.51 25.67 13.39
2-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 3
Safety Switches
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance 3-2
SAFETY SWITCHES
Terminal Lug Data 3-5
Dimensions for General Duty Safety Switches 3-6
Heavy Duty Safety Switches 3-7
3
NEMA Type 1 and 3R 3-20
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 7, 9, and 12 3-21
Double Throw Safety Switches 3-23
S ta inle s s S te e l He a vy Duty
11/10/2017
EZ Selector - Selection Assistance Safety Switches EZ Selector - Selection
Assistance
Class 4162 / Refer to Catalog 4100CT0701 schneider-electric.us
3-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Light Duty Safety Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
30 Plug L111N — — — —
SAFETY SWITCHES
General Duty—Up To 100 kA Short Circuit Current Rating
General duty safety switches are designed for residential and commercial applications
where durability and economy are prime considerations. Typical loads are lighting, air
conditioning, and appliances. They are suitable for use as service equipment when
equipped with a factory or field-installed neutral assembly or a field-installed service
grounding kit, (see page 3-5) as applicable.
General duty safety switches are UL Listed, File E2875, and meet or exceed the NEMA
Standard KS1.
240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches
Table 3.2: Fusible
Horsepower Ratings
NEMA NEMA Class R Max. (Dual
Type 1 Type 3R [1] Fuse Kits Std. (Fast Acting Element
System Amperes Fuse Indoor Rainproof [2] One-Time Fuses) Time-Delay
3
Fuses)
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. 1Ø 3Ø 1Ø 3Ø
2 Wire (1 Blade and Fuseholder, 1 Neutral)—120 Vac
Use Light Duty Device for this Application
30 Plug — — — —
(see above)
Use three-wire devices for this
30 Cart. application. — — — —
3 Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—120/240 Vac (Plug), 240 Vac (Cart.) Maximum
30 Plug D211N D211NRB — 1-1/2 — 3 —
3[3] 7-1/2
30 Cart. D221N D221NRB DRK30 1-1/2 3 [3]
D223N
60 Cart. D222N D222NRB RFK03H 3 7-1/2[3] 10 15[3]
100 Cart. D223N D223NRB RFK10 7-1/2 15[3] 15 30[3]
200 Cart. D224N [4] D224NRB [4] HRK1020 15 25[3] — 60[3]
400 Cart. D225N D225NR DRK40 — — — —
600 [5] Cart. D226N D226NR DRK600 — — — —
4 Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—240 Vac Maximum
30 Cart. D321N D321NRB DRK30 1-1/2 3 3 7-1/
2
60 Cart. D322N D322NRB RFK03H 3 7-1/2[6] 10 15[6]
100 Cart. D323N D323NRB RFK10 7-1/2 15[6] 15 30[6]
200 Cart. D324N [4] D324NRB [4] HRK1020 15 25[6] — 60[6]
400 Cart. D325N D325NR DRK40 — 50 — 125
400 [7] Class T D325NT D325NTR — — 50 — —
600 [5] Cart. D326N D326NR DRK600 — 75 — 150
600 [7] Class T D326NT D326NTR — — 75 — —
800 [7] Class T T327N T327NR — — 100 — —
[1] Bolt-on hubs —Refer to Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs, Table 1.27, page 3-14.
[2] When properly installed, the Class R Fuse Kit rejects all but Class R fuses.
[3] For corner grounded delta systems only. Use switching poles for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[4] For 200% neutral, order (1) additional neutral kit SN20A and (1) neutral jumper kit SN20NI.
[5] Order Class J Fuse Kit GDJK600 if using Class J fuses.
[6] If corner grounded delta, use outer switching poles for ungrounded conductors.
[7] D325NT, D325NTR, D326NT, D326NTR, T327N and T327NR accept only 300Vac Class T fuses.
3-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
General Duty Safety Switches General Duty—Up to 100 kA Short Circuit
Current Rating
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us
T [16] 100 kA
SAFETY SWITCHES
2 N. O. / 2 N. C.
Contacts 240 15.00 A 1.5 A 10.00 A 230 0.30 A 10.00 A
(-2 Suffix [24])
3
200 PKOGTA2 (2) 10 – 2/0 Cu or (2) 6 – 2/0 Cu Al
PK3GTA1 GTK0610 PK0TGA2
400, 600 PKOGTA2 [27] (2) 10 – 2/0 Cu or (2) 6 – 2/0 Cu Al
800 PKOGTA3 (6) 6 – 3/0 Al/Cu Max.
[21] Electrical interlock kit catalog numbers with -1 suffix indicate one normally open and one normally closed contact; -2 indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts. Kits are
UL Listed.
[22] Single-pole single-throw interlock kits are rated 1/2 hp at 110 and 220 Vac.
[23] -1 Suffix uses a 9007A01 limit switch.
[24] -2 Suffix uses a 9007C03 limit switch.
[25] Light duty safety switches.
[26] 60 A non-fusible switches accept PK3GTA1.
[27] Two required if ground conductors are run in parrellel.
[28] Not suitable for use on 400 A NEMA Type 3R.
[29] 30–100 A switches suitable for 60oC or 75oC conductors. 200–800 A switches suitable for 75oC conductors.
[30] Light duty switches only.
3-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
General Duty Safety Switches Dimensions for General Duty Safety
Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us
3-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
240 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
SAFETY SWITCHES
2-Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H221DS H221A H221AWK 1-1/2 3 [6] 3 7-1/2 [6] 5
30 — — H2212AWK [7] 1-1/2 — 3 — 5
Use three-wire devices
60 For two-wire applications H222DS — H222AWK 3 7-1/2 [6] 10 15 [6] 10
100 H223DS H223A H223AWK 7-1/2 15 [6] 15 30 [8] 20
200 H224DS H224A H224AWK 15 25 [6] — 60 [6] 40
400 H225 H225R H225DS — H225AWK — — — — 50
600 H226 H226R H226DS — H226AWK — 75 [6] — 200 [6] 50
800 H227 H227R — — H227AWK 50 — — — 50
1200 H228 H228R — — H228AWK 50 — — — 50
3-Wire (2 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H221N H221NRB 1-1/2 3 [6] 3 7-1/2 [8] 5
60 H222N H222NRB Use two-wire devices, 3 7-1/2 [6] 10 15 [6] 10
100 H223N H223NRB See Field-Installed Neutral Assemblies, page 3-16 7-1/2 15 [6] 15 30 [6] 20
200 H224N H224NRB 15 25 [6] — 60 [6] 40
3
400 H225N H225NR H225NDS — H225NAWK — 50 [6] — 125 [6] 50
600 H226N H226NR H226NDS — H226NAWK — 75 [6] — 200 [6] 50
800 H227N H227NR [9] — — H227NAWK 50 — — — 50
1200 H228N H228NR [9] — — H228NAWK 50 — — — 50
3-Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H321DS H321A H321AWK 1-1/2 3 3 7-1/2 5
60 Use four-wire devices H322DS H322A H322AWK 3 7-1/2 10 15 10
100 For three-wire applications H323DS H323A H323AWK 7-1/2 15 15 30 20
200 H324DS H324A H324AWK 15 25 — 60 40
400 H325 H325R H325DS — H325AWK — 50 — 125 50
600 H326 H326R H326DS — H326AWK — 75 — 200 50
800 H327 H327R [9] — — H327AWK 50 100 — 250 50
1200 H328 H328R [9] — — H328AWK 50 100 — 250 50
4-Wire (3 Blades and Fuseholders, 1 Neutral)—240 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H321N H321NRB 1-1/2 3 3 7-1/2 5
60 H322N H322NRB Use three-wire devices, 3 7-1/2 10 15 10
100 H323N H323NRB See Field-Installed Neutral Assemblies, page 3-16 7-1/2 15 15 30 20
200 H324N H324NRB 15 25 — 60 40
400 H325N H325NR H325NDS — H325NAWK — 50 — 125 50
600 H326N H326NR H326NDS — H326NAWK — 75 — 200 50
800 H327N H327NR [9] — — H327NAWK 50 100 — 250 50
1200 H328N H328NR [9] — — H328NAWK 50 100 — 250 50
4-Wire (4 Blades and Fuseholders)
30
60
100
Use 600 Vac devices. See 600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches, page 3-8.
200
400
600
[1] For Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs and Watertight Hubs see Hubs, page 3-14.
[2] Complete rating is NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5 and 12. For NEMA Type 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[3] See 316 Grade Stainless Steel—NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, 12, page 3-11.
[4] Also suitable for NEMA Type 3R application by removing drain screw from bottom endwall.
[5] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[6] For corner grounded delta systems, use switching poles for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[7] 60 ampere switch with 30 ampere fuse spacing and clips. Must use 60 A enclosure accessories including electrical interlocks.
[8] For corner grounded delta systems, use switching poles for ungrounded conductors.
[9] Suitable for NEMA Type 5 applications with drain screw installed.
3-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches 600 Volt—Single Throw Fusible Switches
Class 3130 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
[10] For Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs and Watertight Hubs see Hubs, page 3-14.
[11] Complete rating is NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5 and 12..
[12] See Table 3.18 316 Grade Stainless Steel 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc, page 3-11.
[13] Also suitable for NEMA Type 3R application by removing drain screw from bottom endwall.
[14] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[15] For corner grounded delta systems, use switching poles for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[16] Suitable for NEMA Type 5 applications with drain screw installed.
[17] 60 A switch with 30 A fuse spacing and clips. Must use 60 A enclosure accessories including electrical interlocks.
[18] Not suitable for use as service equipment.
3-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
600 Volt—Single Throw Non-Fusible Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
SAFETY SWITCHES
200 HU364 HU364RB HU364DS HU364A HU364AWK 15 60 50 125 50 150 40 50
400 HU365 HU365R HU365DS — HU365AWK — 125 — 250 — 350 50 50
600 HU366 HU366R HU366DS — HU366AWK — 200 — 400 — 500 50 50
800 HU367 HU367R [24] — — HU367AWK — — — 500 50 500 — 50
1200 HU368 HU368R [24] — — HU368AWK — — — — 50 500 — 50
4-Wire (4 Blades)—600 Vac, 600 Vdc [27] 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø
30 HU461 [28] — HU461DS — HU461AWK [29] 10 10 20 20 25 30 10[30] 15[30]
60 HU462 [28] — HU462DS — HU462AWK 20 20 40 50 50 60 10 30
100 HU463 [28] — HU463DS — HU463AWK 30 40 50 75 50 75 20 30
200 HU464 [28] — HU464DS — HU464AWK 50 60 50 125 50 150 40 50
400 HU465 — — — HU465AWK — 125 — 250 — 350 50 50
600 HU466 — — — — — 200 — 400 — 500 50 50
6-Wire (6 Blades)—600 Vac [27] 3Ø 3Ø 3Ø
30 — — HU661DS — HU661AWK — 10 — 20 — 30 — —
60 — — HU662DS — HU662AWK — 20 — 50 — 60 — —
100 — — HU663DS — HU663AWK — 50 — 75 — 75 — —
3
200 — — HU664DS — HU664AWK — 60 — 125 — 150 — —
[19] For Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs and Watertight Hubs see Hubs, page 3-14.
[20] Complete rating is NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5 and 12.
[21] For 316 stainless, see 316 Grade Stainless Steel—NEMA Type 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, 12, page 3-11.
[22] Also suitable for NEMA Type 3R application by removing drain screw from bottom endwall.
[23] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[24] Suitable for NEMA Type 5 applications with drain screw installed.
[25] Switches with EI suffix are stocked with factory-installed electrical interlocks with one normally-open and one normally-closed contact.
[26] Use 60 A enclosure accessories, including electrical interlocks.
[27] Not suitable for use as service equipment.
[28] No knockouts are provided.
[29] Requires 60 A accessories. See NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 7, 9, and 12, page 3-21 for series rating.
[30] HU461AWK (Series F6) is rated 5 hp@250 Vdc, 15 hp@600 Vdc.
3-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches UL Listed Maximum Short Circuit Current
Ratings—AC only
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us
30–100 HJ 65 kA 35 kA 25 kA
30–100 HL 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA
30–100 HR 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA
30–100 FA 14 kA 14 kA 14 kA
30–100 FH 18 kA 18 kA 18 kA
200 HD, JD 25 kA 18 kA 14 kA
200 HG, JG 65 kA 35 kA 18 kA
200 HJ, JJ 65 kA 35 kA 25 kA Up to 10
200 HL, JL 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA kA
200 HR, JR 65 kA 35 kA 35 kA
400 LA 22 kA 22 kA 22 kA
400 LH 25 kA 25 kA 25 kA
400–600 LD 25 kA 18 kA 14 kA
400–600 LG 65 kA 35 kA 18 kA
400–600 LJ 100 kA 65 kA 25 kA
400–600 LL 100 kA 65 kA 50 kA
400–600 LR 100 kA 65 kA 65 kA
[31] On 600 V, 200 A switches, 100,000 A max. on corner grounded delta when protected by Class J or R fuses.
[32] For NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester switches, see page 3-11.
[33] NEMA Type 7/9 SCCR 10 kAIR 600 Vac maximum.
[34] Ampere rating of fuse or circuit breaker not to exceed switch ampere rating.
3-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Special Applications Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
SAFETY SWITCHES
200 HU364SS — 125 — 150 50
400 HU365SS — 250 — 350 50
600 HU366SS — 400 — 500 50
3
H363DF
Table 3.19: Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester Enclosures NEMA Type 4X 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
Class R Electrical Interlock Kits Horsepower Ratings– 3Ø
Solid Neutral Fuse Kits Field-Installed Cat. No. 480 Vac [35] 600 Vac [35] 600 Vdc [36]
Amperes Cat. No. Assembly Kit
1 NO/1 NC 2 NO/2 NC Hubs[37]
Cat. No. Contacts Contacts Std. Max. Std. Max. Max.
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
30 H361DF SN03 RFK06 9999TC10 9999TC20 5 15 7-1/2 20 15 3/4
60 H362DF SN03 RFK06H 9999TC10 9999TC20 15 30 15 50 30 1-1/4
100 H363DF SN0610 RFK10 9999TC10 9999TC20 25 60 30 75 50 2
200 H364DF — HRK1020 9999R8 9999R9 50 125 60 150 50 2-1/2
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
30 HU361DF SN03 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 20 — 30 15 3/4
60 HU362DF SN03 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 50 — 60 30 1-1/4
100 HU363DF SN0610 — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 75 — 75 50 2
200 HU364DF — — 9999R8 9999R9 — 125 — 150 50 2-1/2
[35] Std.—Using fast acting, one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[36] For switching dc use two switching poles.
[37] Two hubs and hub drilling template are provided for field installation.
3-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Special Applications
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
H361DX
Table 3.20: KrydonTM Enclosures — NEMA Type 4X 3 Pole 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
Class R Fuse Electrical Interlock Kits Horsepower Ratings– 3Ø
Solid Neutral Kits Field-Installed Cat. No. 480 Vac [39] 600 Vac [39] 600 Vdc [40]
Amperes Cat. No. Hubs [38]
3
Assembly Kit
Cat. No. 1 NO/1 NC 2 NO/2 Std. Max. Std. Max. Max.
Contact NC Contacts
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
30 H361DX H60SN RFK06 9999TC10 9999TC20 5 15 7-1/2 20 15 3/4
60 H362DX H60SN RFK06H 9999TC10 9999TC20 15 30 15 50 30 1-1/4
100 H363DX SN0610 RFK10 9999TC10 9999TC20 25 60 30 75 50 2
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 600 Vdc
30 HU361DX H60SN — 9999TC10 9999TC20 — 20 — 30 15 3/4
SAFETY SWITCHES
Table 3.21: NEMA Type 7/9, 3 Pole Molded Case Switch, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc [41], Short
Circuit Current Rating 10 kA AIR
Enclosed Molded Solid Neutral Horsepower Ratings—3Ø Size of Threaded
H60XFA Case Switch [42] Assembly Conduit
Amperes
Openings
Cat. No. Cat. No. 240 Vac 480 Vac 600 Vac Provided (in.) [43]
60 H60XFA 100SNA 15 30 50 3/4
60 H60XFA1212 [44] 100SNA 15 30 50 3/4
100 H100XFA 100SNA 30 60 75 1-1/4
100 H100XFA1212[44] 100SNA 30 60 75 1-1/4
225 H225XJG[45] 225SNA 60 125 150 2-1/2
225 H225XJGAA[45] [44] 225SNA 60 125 150 2-1/2
[38] Two hubs and hub drilling template are provided for field installation.
[39] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[40] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles.
[41] For switching dc, use two outside switching poles. Not for use on dc motor applications.
[42] Includes PKDB1, breather and drain kit, required for rainproof application.
[43] Threaded conduit opening provided in top and bottom endwall.
[44] Includes 1NO/1NC auxiliary contacts.
[45] Not cULus listed due to wire bending space.
3-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Receptacle Switches Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
SAFETY SWITCHES
Enclosure
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H361WA H361DSWA H361AWA ACP3034BC 5 15 7-1/2 20 5 —
H362AWA 60 H362WA H362DSWA H362AWA ACP6034BC 15 30 15 50 10 —
Interlocked Receptacle 100 H363WA H363DSWA H363AWA ACP1034CD 25 60 30 75 20 —
Switch with Appleton Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
Powertite Receptacle
30 HU361WA HU361DSWA HU361AWA ACP3034BC — 20 — 30 — 5
60 HU362WA HU362DSWA HU362AWA ACP6034BC — 50 — 60 — 10
100 HU363WA HU363DSWA HU363AWA ACP1034CD — 75 — 100 — 20
Table 3.23: Appleton Powertite 600 Vac Short Circuit Current Rating
Amperes 10 kAIR 100 kAIR 200 kAIR 14 kAIR 18kAIR
Fuses Fuses Fuses Circuit Breaker Circuit Breaker
Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H, K — J, R — —
60 H, K — J, R — —
3
100 H, K — J, R — —
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
30 H, K J, R, T[50] J, R, T FA FH
60 H, K — J, R, T FA FH
100 H, K — J, R, T FA FH
Hubbellock Receptacle
• UL Listed
• Available in 30 -100 A, 600 Vac/250 Vdc, fused or non-fused, NEMA Type 1, and
NEMA Type 12
• Suitable for use as service equipment [52]
• Receptacles are zinc plated steel for NEMA Type 1 and 12 safety switches
• Short Circuit Current Rating for fusible switches is 10 kAIR maximum when used with
Class H, K, J or R fuses
• Short Circuit Current Rating for non-fusible switches is 10 kAIR maximum when
protected by Class H, K, J, R or T fuses
Table 3.26: Hubbellock Receptacle Safety Switch
NEMA NEMA Horsepower Ratings—3Ø
Use with Plug[53]
H362AWH Amperes Type 1 Type 12 480 Vac [54] 600 Vac [54]
Interlocked Receptacle
Switch with Hubbell™ Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Std. Max. Std. Max.
Hubbellock Receptacle Fusible—3P, 600 Vac
60 H362WH H362AWH SD12781 15 30 15 50
Non-Fusible—3P, 600 Vac
60 HU362WH HU362AWH SD12781 — 50 — 60
Square D by Schneider Electric brand heavy duty safety switches are UL listed for use
with the following accessories:
Rainproof Bolt-On Hubs
• UL Listed for indoor or rainproof applications
• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread
• NEMA Type 3R switches with catalog number ending in RB have a bolt-on closing cap
factory installed
– Accepts 3/4 in. through 2-1/2 in. bolt-on hubs
– No gaskets required
• NEMA Type 3R switches with R suffix have blank top endwalls
– Accepts 3 in. through 4 in. bolt on hubs
– Gaskets provided
– Conduit entry holes must be cut in the field
Watertight Hubs
• UL Listed for dusttight and watertight applications
• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread
• Watertight hubs are field installed on NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA
Type 12/3R and 12K enclosures
• Watertight hubs are available in zinc or chrome plated finish
• Gaskets provided
Table 3.28: Watertight Hubs [56]
Watertight Hubs
Conduit
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
Size
Standard-
Zinc
Hub Cat. H050 H075 H100 H125 H150 H200 H250 H300 H350 H400
No
Chrome
Plated
Hub Cat. H050CP H075CP H100CP H125CP H150CP H200CP — — — —
No.
SAFETY SWITCHES
Class R Fuse Kits
When installed, this kit rejects all but Class R fuses. Kits are available for field
installation. One kit required for a three pole switch. For factory installation, add “CLR’’
suffix to catalog number.
3
Amperes Class R Fuse Kit
Series Number Cat. No.
30 [63] F5–F6 RFK03H
30 A
Receptacle Switches F7 RFK06
30 A
F5–F6 RFK06
Four-Pole Switches
60 F5–F7 RFK06H
100 F5–F7 RFK10
200 F5–F6 HRK1020
400–600 E4–E5 HRK4060
[57] For series not shown in table refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[58] Electrical interlocks for NEMA Type 4X fiberblass reinforced polyester and KrydonTM see Table 3.19 and Table 3.20 respectively.
[59] See page 3-20 and page 3-21 for safety switch series.
[60] Electrical interlock kit catalog numbers ending in 1 indicates one normally open and one normally closed contact. These kits use a 9007A01 industrial snap switch. Electrical interlock kit
catalog numbers ending in 2 indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts. These kits use a 9007C03 industrial snap switch.
[61] For series not shown in the table, refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[62] Class R Fuse Kits for Fiberglass Reinforced Polyester enclosures and KrydonTM enclosures see Table 3, page 3-11 and Table 5, page 3-12 respectively.
[63] H361-2, H361-2A, H361-2AWK and H361-2RB use RFK06.
[64] Requires arc shield on 240 V switches be changed to 600 V arc suppressor. Contact the Customer Care Center at 1–888–778–2733 fo the arc suppressor part number.
3-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Accessories and Special Features
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
F5–F6 SN20A (1) 14-10 Al/Cu Svc Ground SN20C (1) 14-1/0 Cu Svc Ground
(4) 1-750 Al/Cu plus (2) 1-600 Cu and
400 and 600 E4–E5 H600SN H600SNC (2) 4-350 Cu plus
(1) 4-300 Al/Cu Svc Ground (2) 6-250 Cu Svc Ground
(6) 3/0-750 Al/Cu plus
800 E4 H800SNE4 (2) 6-350 Al/Cu Svc Ground – –
(8) 3/0-750 Al/Cu plus
1200 E4 H1200SNE4 (2) 6-350 Al/Cu Svc Ground – –
Table 3.34: Equipment Grounding Kits and Terminal Data [73] [74]
Amperes Series Number Standard Terminal Data Optional Copper Only Terminal Data
Cat. No. AWG/kcmil Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
(2) 14-4 Cu or (2) 12-4 Al
30 F5–F6 GTK03 [75] or GTK03C [75] [76] (2) 14-6 Cu
(4) 14-12 Cu or (4) 12-10 Al
(2) 14-1/0 Cu or (2) 12-1/0 Al
F5–F6 (2) 14-1/0 Cu and
60 GTK0610 and GTK0610C
(600 V) (2) 14-6 Cu or (2) 12-6 Al (2) 14-6 Cu
(2) 14-4 Cu or (2) 12-4 Al
F5–F6
60 (240 V) GTK03 or GTK03C (2) 14-6 Cu
(4) 14-12 Cu or (4) 12-10 Al
(2) 14-1/0 Cu or (2) 12-1/0 Al (2) 14-1/0 Cu and
100 F5–F6 GTK0610 and GTK0610C (2) 14-6 Cu
(2) 14-6 Cu or (2) 12-6 Al
(2) 10-2/0 Cu or
200 F5–F6 PKOGTA2 PKOGTC2 (2) 14-4 Cu
(2) 6-2/0 Al
(2) 10-2/0 Cu or
400 and 600 E4–E5 PKOGTA2 [77] PKOGTC3 (4) 14-1/0 Cu
(2) 6-2/0 Al
800 E4 PKOGTA7 (4) 4-350 Al/Cu — —
1200 E4 PKOGTA8 (8) 4-350 Al/Cu — —
[65] For series not shown in chart refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[66] 30 A 4 pole, H361-2 and H361-2RB Series F5, H361WA and H361WC Series F6 use FPK0610.
[67] For solid Neutral Assembly Kits for Krydon TM enclosure see Table 3.20.
[68] For Solid Neutral Assembly Kits for Fiberglass Reinforced Ployester enclosures see Table 3.19.
[69] Neutrals cannot be installed in 4 or 6 pole switches or receptable switches.
[70] See page 3-20 and page 3-21 for safety switch series.
[71] The following 30 A Series F5-F6 switches use SN0610 or SN0610C: H3612, H3612RB, H3612A, H3612AWK, HU3612, HU3612RB, HU3612A and HU3612AWK.
[72] For 200% neutral, order (2) SN20A Neutral Kits and (1) SN20NI Neutral Jumper Kit.
[73] For series not shown in table refer to the switch wiring diagram.
[74] Equipment Ground Kits (Al/Cu) are factory installed standard in 30-200 A Series F NEMA Type 4/4X/5 (stainless steel), 12 and 12K. Equipment Ground Kits are standard factory installed on
all receptacle switches and all Series F 30-200 A, 4 and 6 pole switches.
[75] H2212AWK accepts GTK03 or GTK03C. H3612A or AWK accepts GTK03C. H3612 and H3612RB accepts GTK0610 HU3612AWK accepts GTK03C. HU3612A accepts GTK0610C.
HU3612RB accepts GTK0610 or GTK0610C.
[76] Optional copper equipment grounding kit for the 4 and 6 pole 30 A F Series: H461DS, H461AWK, HU461DS, HU661DS and HU661AWK accepts GTK03C HU461AWK accepts GTK0610C.
[77] Two required if equipment grounding conductors are run in parallel.
3-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Special Features Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
SAFETY SWITCHES
Available factory- or field-installed the lock-off guard works by covering the lockout/
tagout opening whenever the switch is in the ON position. This prevents a padlock from
being inadvertantly inserted into the switch lockplate. The device is designed to help
prevent accidental misapplication of a lockout device. These kits are marked cURus (UL
Component Recognized) for field or factory installation.
3
Optional Lock-OFF Guard Kit Installed
Lock-ON Provisions
Lock-OFF provisions are standard on all heavy duty safety switches. Provision for one 3/
8 inch hasp padlock is available factory-installed on 30–1200 A, NEMA Type 1, 3R, 4-4X-
5 stainless steel 12 and 12K switches. Not avaliable on NEMA Type 4X, Fiberglass,
Krydon or NEMA Type 7 and 9 switches. This modification will allow the switch to be
locked in the “ON’’ position. UL Listed.
To order, add suffix SPLO to standard catalog number. Example: H364-SPLO
• UL Listed
• UL Marine Listed
– UL Marine listing is applicable ONLY to 30 - 200 A, NEMA Type 12/3R, NEMA Type
12K and NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel, safety switches
– When copper only lugs kits are factory installed the switch will bear the UL Marine
mark and be suitable for use on vessels over 65 feet long
– When the copper only lugs kits are field installed the switch will not bear the UL
Marine mark and would not be suitable for use on vessels over 65 feet long
• Not available for use on NEMA Type 4X Fiberglass, Krydon or NEMA Type 7 and 9
switches
• For field installation, order copper lug kits. See Table below
• For factory installation of copper lugs, add the suffix SLC to the standard catalog
number
Table 3.39: Copper Lug Kits [86]
Al/Cu to Cu Only Amperes Lug Kit Cat. No. Lug Wire Range AWG/kcmil
(1) 14-8 Cu solid or
30–60 CL0306F 14-4 Cu stranded
(1) 14-8 Cu solid or
100 CL10F
14-1/0 Cu stranded
200 CL20F (1) 6-250 Cu
(1) 1-600 Cu plus
400 CL40F (1) 6-250 Cu
600 CL60F (1) 4-350 Cu
800 — —
1200 — —
SAFETY SWITCHES
800 H8LKE2 (3) Line and (3) Load or
500 kcmil (CU)
500-750 kcmil (AI)
1200 H12LKE2 (4) Line and (4) Load or
500 kcmil (CU)
3
60 [92] or or C10–14,[91] D8–14–SK,
1 or
14–3 (Cu) 14–2 (Cu) —
E6–14
12–1/0 (Al) 12–1/0 (Al)
100 [93] 1 or or VCEL02114S1 VCELC02114S1
14–1/0 (Cu) 14–1/0 (Cu)
200 [94] 1 6–250 (Al/Cu) 6–300 (Al/Cu) VCEL030516H1 VCELC030516H1
VCEL07512H1 VCELC07512H1
1 1/0–750 (Al/Cu) 1/0–750 (Al/Cu) or or
400[95] or or or VCEL030516H1 [96] VCELC030516H1[97]
2 1/0–300 (Al/Cu) 1/0–300 (Al/Cu) and and
VCEL05012H1 VCELC05012H1
600 2 3/0–500 (Al/Cu) 3/0–500 (Al/Cu) VCEL05012H1 VCELC05012H1
800 3 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) H8LKE2[98] —
1200 4 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) 3/0–750 (Al/Cu) H12LKE2[98] —
[87] Kit contains 3 lugs. Order two kits for line and load lugs.
[88] 30–100 A switches suitable for 60°C or 75°C conductors. 200–1200 A switches suitable for 75°C conductors.
[89] Hubbell Versa-Crimp™ unless otherwise noted.
[90] For NEMA Type 1, 12/3R, 12K and 4/4X/5 stainless steel switches only.
[91] Order from Thomas and Betts.
[92] H60XFA and H60XFA1212 — use 75°C copper wire only. #6 AWG copper wire required for 60 A rating.
[93] H100XFA and H100XFA1212 — use 75°C copper wire only. #3 AWG copper wire required for 100 A rating.
[94] H225XJG and H225XJGAA — use 75°C copper wire only. Lug wire range is #3 AWG – 350 kcmil. Not UL Listed due to inadequate wire bending space (5” on ON end, 6” on OFF end).
[95] Maximum wire bending space allows for (1) 600 kcmil or (2) 300 kcmil Al/Cu on NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA Type 12 switches.
[96] Order two PK516KN mounting kits when installing VCEL030516H1 lugs. Only one kit is required on 2 pole switches. PK516KN consists of (4) 5/16-18 Keps Nuts.
[97] Order two PK516KN mounting kits when installing VCEL030516H1 or VCELC030516H1 lugs. Only one kit is required on 2 pole switches. PK516KN consists of (4) 5/16-18 Keps Nuts.
[98] For 800 and 1200 A compression lug kits see Table 3.41 for additional information.
[99] Hubs and hub drilling templates are provided for field-installation.
[100] Threaded conduit opening.
3-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety
Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us
H H
W/H D W/H D
Typical NEMA Type 1 Typical NEMA Type 3R
H223N F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267 H366, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H223NRB F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267 H366NR, R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H224N F5 29.00 737 17.13 435 8.25 210 18.50 470 H367, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H224NRB F5 29.25 743 17.25 438 8.50 216 18.63 473 H367NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H225, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 H368, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H225NR, R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 H368NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H226, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 H461 F5 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.85 174 16.13 410
H226NR, R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 H462 F5 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.85 174 16.13 410
H227, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H463 F5 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.85 174 16.13 410
H227NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H464 F5 29.00 737 23.25 591 8.75 222 24.88 632
H228, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H465 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H228NR, R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 H466 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H265 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 HU265 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H265R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU265R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H266 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 HU266 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H266R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU266R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H267 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU267 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H267R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU267R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H268 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU268 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H268R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU268R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H321N F5 14.60 371 6.50 165 4.88 124 7.55 192 HU361 F5 14.60 371 6.50 165 4.88 124 7.55 192
H321NRB F5 14.88 378 6.63 168 4.88 124 7.55 192 HU361RB F5 14.88 378 6.63 168 4.88 124 7.55 192
H322N F5 14.60 371 6.50 165 4.88 124 7.55 192 HU361WA F6 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
H322NRB F5 14.88 378 6.63 168 4.88 124 7.55 192 HU361WC F6 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
H323N F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU362 F5 17.50 445 9.00 229 6.38 162 10.50 267
H323NRB F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU362RB F5 17.50 445 9.00 229 6.38 162 10.50 267
H324N F5 29.00 737 17.13 435 8.25 210 18.50 470 HU362WA F6 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
H324NRB F5 29.25 743 17.25 438 8.50 216 18.63 473 HU362WC F6 16.75 425 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H325, N E4 50.25 1276 27.88 708 10.13 257 27.88 708 HU362WH F5 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
H325R, NR E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU363 F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267
H326, N E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702 HU363RB F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267
H326R, NR E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708 HU363WA F6 21.85 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
H327, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU363WC F6 21.85 555 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
H327R, NR E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU364 F5 29.00 737 17.13 435 8.25 210 18.50 470
H328, N E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU364RB F5 29.25 743 17.25 438 8.50 216 18.63 473
H328R, NR E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930 HU365 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H361, N F5 14.60 371 6.50 165 4.88 124 7.55 192 HU365R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H361-2 F5 17.50 445 9.00 229 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU366 E4 50.25 1276 27.63 702 10.13 257 27.63 702
H361NRB, RB F5 14.88 378 6.63 168 4.88 124 7.55 192 HU366R E5 50.31 1278 27.76 705 9.53 242 27.88 708
H361WA F6 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267 HU367 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H361WC F6 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267 HU367R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H362, N F5 17.50 445 9.00 229 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU368 E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H362NRB, RB F5 17.50 445 9.00 229 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU368R E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H362WA F6 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267 HU461 F5 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.85 174 16.13 410
H362WC F6 16.75 425 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267 HU462 F5 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.85 174 16.13 410
H362WH F5 18.19 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267 HU463 F5 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.85 174 16.13 410
H363, N F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU464 F5 29.00 737 23.25 591 8.75 222 24.88 632
H363NRB, RB F5 21.25 540 8.50 216 6.38 162 10.50 267 HU465 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H363WA F6 21.85 462 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267 HU466 E4 50.25 1276 33.88 861 10.13 257 33.88 861
H363WC F6 21.85 555 9.00 229 6.81 173 10.50 267
3-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety Heavy Duty Safety Switches
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 7, 9, and 12
See Table 3.42 Terminal Lug Data, page 3-19 for terminal lug data for the series switches
listed in the dimension table below.
Table 3.45: Approximate Dimensions
W H W D W/H
Cat. No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
H60XFA E1 15.93 405 9.87 251 6.96 177 9.87 251
H100XFA E1 15.93 405 9.87 251 6.96 177 9.87 251
H221AWK,A F6 14.60 371 6.63 168 4.96 125 7.55 192
H221DS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H221-2AWK F6 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H222AWK,A F6 14.60 371 6.63 168 4.96 125 7.55 192
H222DS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H H223AWK,A F6 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H223DS F6 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H224A,AWK F6 29.00 737 17.25 438 8.75 216 18.63 473
H224DS F6 29.00 737 17.75 451 8.88 226 19.25 489
H225AWK,DS E4 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H225NAWK,NDS E4 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H225XJG A1 22.56 573 10.88 276 7.75 197 10.88 276
H226AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H226NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
W/H D H227AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
Typical NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 12, 12K H228AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
(Stainless has flat front) H265AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H266AWK,A,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
W D
H267AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H268AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H321AWK,A F6 14.60 371 6.63 168 4.96 125 7.55 192
SAFETY SWITCHES
H321DS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H322AWK,A F6 14.60 371 6.63 168 4.96 125 7.55 192
H322DS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H H323AWK,A F6 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H323DS F6 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H324A,AWK F6 29.00 737 17.25 438 8.75 216 18.63 473
H324DS F6 29.00 737 17.75 451 8.88 226 19.25 489
H325AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H325NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H326AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H326NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
Typical NEMA Type 4X H327AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
Fiberglass and Krydon H328AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H361AWA F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H361AWC F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H361AWK,A F6 14.60 371 6.63 168 4.96 125 7.55 192
H361DS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H361DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
H361DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274
3
H361DF F1 16.50 419 11.00 279 8.80 224 11.00 279
H361DX F1 19.40 493 11.40 290 8.60 218 11.40 290
H361SS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
H H361-2AWK,A F6 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWA F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWC F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWH F6 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H362AWK,A F6 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H362DS F6 16.87 428 8.92 227 6.97 177 10.81 275
H362DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
W D H362DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274
H362DF F1 16.50 419 11.00 279 8.80 224 11.00 279
Typical NEMA Type 7, 9 H362DX F1 19.40 493 11.40 290 8.60 218 11.40 290
H362SS F6 16.87 428 8.92 227 6.97 177 10.81 275
H363AWA F7 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H363AWC F7 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H363AWK,A F6 20.50 521 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
H363DS F6 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H363DSWA F7 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H363DSWC F7 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H363DF F1 24.80 630 13.70 348 12.00 305 13.70 348
H363DX F1 25.25 641 11.40 290 8.60 218 11.40 290
H363SS F6 20.82 529 9.36 238 6.97 177 11.25 286
H364A,AWK F6 29.00 737 17.25 438 8.75 216 18.63 473
H364DS,NDS F6 29.00 737 17.75 451 8.88 226 19.25 489
H364NA,NAWK F6 29.00 737 17.25 438 8.75 216 18.63 473
H364DF E1 31.30 795 26.30 668 11.80 300 26.30 668
H364SS F6 29.00 737 17.75 451 8.88 226 19.25 489
H365AWK,DS,SS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H365NAWK,NDS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H366AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H366NAWK,NDS,SS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
H367AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H368AWK,NAWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
H461AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.80 173 16.13 410
H461DS F6 20.82 529 15.08 383 6.97 177 16.85 428
H462AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.80 173 16.13 410
H462DS F6 20.82 529 15.08 383 6.97 177 16.85 428
H463AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.80 173 16.13 410
H463DS F6 20.82 529 15.08 383 6.97 177 16.85 428
H464AWK F6 29.00 737 23.25 591 8.75 222 24.88 632
H464DS F6 29.00 737 23.75 603 8.88 226 25.25 641
H465AWK E5 46.25 1175 32.50 826 10.13 259 32.50 826
H663AWK F6 20.50 521 14.75 375 6.80 173 16.13 410
H663DS F6 20.82 529 15.08 383 6.97 177 16.85 428
H664AWK F6 29.00 737 23.25 591 8.75 222 24.88 632
H664DS F6 29.00 737 23.75 603 8.88 226 25.25 641
HU265AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
HU266AWK,DS E5 46.25 1175 26.25 667 10.13 259 26.25 667
HU267AWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
HU268AWK E4 69.13 1756 36.62 930 17.75 451 36.62 930
HU361AWA F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
HU361AWC F7 16.50 419 9.00 229 7.00 178 10.50 267
HU361AWK,A F6 14.60 371 6.63 168 4.96 125 7.55 192
HU361DS F6 14.93 379 7.22 183 5.11 130 8.67 220
HU361DSWA F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.81 275
HU361DSWC F7 16.87 428 8.92 227 5.11 130 10.79 274
3-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Heavy Duty Safety Switches Dimensions for Heavy Duty Safety
Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us
3-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Fusible and Non-Fusible Overview Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
SAFETY SWITCHES
30–100 A DT, DTU (Series F)
• Supplied as standard for switching one load between two power sources, and may be
field-converted to switch one power source between two loads.
NEMA Type 1
3
• UL Listed as suitable for use as service equipment
• Horsepower rated only as footnoted
Field-Installable Accessories
• Neutral
• Electrical Interlock
82,000 Line
• Grounding Terminals
NEMA Type 1
3-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches 240 Volt — Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
Load
Load
Load
30 T4 92251 [7] — — — — — — — —
200 E 82254 DTU224NRB [7] [8] — H82254 15 — — — —
400 A 82255 [7] 82255R [7] — H82255 [7] — — — — —
Non-Fusible—3P, 240 Vac—250 Vdc
Line 30 F DTU321 — — — — 3 [4] 5 [5] 10 [4] 5 [6]
60 F DTU322 — — — — — 10 [5] 15 [4] 10 [6]
Line
100 F DTU323 DTU323RB — — — — 15 [5] 30 [4] 20 [6]
Load
30 T4 92351 [7] — — — — — — — —
200 E 82354 [7] — — H82354 [7] — 15 — — —
200 E DTU324N [7] [8] DTU324NRB [7] [8] — — — 15 — — —
400 A 82355 [7] 82355R [7] — H82355 [7] — — — — —
600 A DTU326 DTU326R — — — 125 — — 50
Non-Fusible—4P, 240 Vac
30 T4 92451 — — — — — — — —
200 E 82454 [9] 82454R [9] — H82454 [10] — 15 [10] — — —
400 A 82455 82455R — H82455 — — — — —
600 A DTU426 DTU426R — — — 125 — — 50
[1] The starting current of motors or more than standard horsepower may require the use of fuses with appropriate time delay characteristics.
[2] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses.
[3] For switching dc, use two switching poles.
[4] If used on corner grounded delta systems, install neutral and use outer switching pole for ungrounded conductors. See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[5] Use outer switching poles.
[6] Maximum rating.
[7] 240 Vac only. Not Vdc rated.
[8] Neutral included with device.
[9] 240 Vac, 250 Vdc.
[10] Hp rating applies only to H82454.
3-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
600 Volt — Double Throw Safety Switches Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
Line
25 60 50
100 F DT363 DT363RB — — — — [19] [19] 30 75 — [20]
Load
1Ø 3Ø 1Ø [13] 3Ø [14] 1Ø 3Ø
Non-Fusible 3P, 600 Vac—600 Vdc [13] [14] [13]
[21] [21] [21]
[21] [21] [21]
Line 30 F DTU361 DTU361RB — — 5 10 7.5 20 10 30 5 15
DTU362AWK[22] 20[23] 50 60
60 F DTU362 DTU362RB DTU362DS 10 25 [24] 30 [25] 10 30
SAFETY SWITCHES
Line
100
100 F DTU363 DTU363RB DTU363DS DTU363AWK[22] 20 40[26] 40 75[26] 40 20 50
[26]
Load
82344DS [27]
200 E 82344 [27] 82344RB [27] H82344 [27] — — — 15 [29] — — — —
[28]
400 A 82345 [30] 82345R[30] 82345DS[30] H82345[30] — — — — — — — —
600 A DTU366[30] DTU366R[30] — DTU366AWK[30] — 125 — 250 — 350 50 —
Non-Fusible 4P, 600 Vac—600 Vdc 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø 2Ø 3Ø
Line DTU462AWK[22]
60 F DTU462[31] DTU462DS [31] 20 20 40 50 50 60 10 30
[31]
Use NEMA
Line Type 12 DTU463AWK[22]
100 F DTU463 [31] DTU463DS [31] 30 40 50 75 50 100 20 50
[31]
3
Load
Line DTU663AWK[22]
100 F — — — [31] — 40 — 75 — 100 20 50
Load
[11] The starting current of motors of more than standard horsepower may require the use of fuses with appropriate time delay characteristics.
[12] Std.—Using fast acting one time fuses. Max.—Using dual element time delay fuses. (Non-fusible switches have max rating unless noted.)
[13] Use outer switching poles.
[14] If used on corner grounded delta systems, install neutral and use outer switching pole for ungrounded conductors.See data bulletin 2700DB0202 for additional information.
[15] 480 Vac 1 Phase HP = 3 Std, 7.5 Max
[16] 10 Std, 15 Max
[17] 480 Vac 1 Phase HP = 5 Std, 20 Max
[18] 25 Std, 30 Max
[19] 480 Vac 1 Phase HP = 10 Std, 30 Max
[20] 40 Std, 50 Max
[21] Maximum HP
[22] Complete rating on switch is NEMA Type 3R, 5 or 12. For 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[23] Maximum HP is 15 for corner grounded delta systems.
[24] Maximum HP is 30 for corner grounded delta systems.
[25] Use 75oC #4 Cu or #2 Al conductors only on DTU362 and DTU362RB.
[26] Use 75oC #1 Cu conductors only.
[27] 480 Vac, 250 Vdc maximum
[28] Not UL Listed.
[29] Standard Hp rating.
[30] 250 Vdc maximum.
[31] Not suitable for use as service equipment.
[32] 480 Vac, 250 Vdc maximum.
3-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches Accessories and Lug Data
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
Accessories
Table 3.48: Electrical Interlocks (For Electrical Interlock Contact Ratings, see
Supplemental Digest Section 2)
Switch Field-Installed Electrical Interlock Kit Cat. No.[33]
30–100 A Type DT, DTU (Series F) EIK1, EIK2[34][35]
200 A Type 82000 and DTU (Series E)[36] [37]
400 A Type 82000 (Series A) EK400DTU2
600 A Type DTU (Series A) DS200EK2D
Viewing Windows: Accessory available on 30–100 A DTU switches only. Add the suffix
VW to the catalog number.
Key Interlock Systems: For factory-installed key interlocks, refer to page 3-17.
Phenolic Legend Plate: For factory-installed phenolic legend plates, refer to
Supplemental Digest section 2.
Lock-ON Provisions: Standard feature on 30–100 A type DT and DTU (Series F),
82,000 (400 A only) and type 92,000 switches.
Feature available as factory installed option for Type 82,000 (200 A only) and 200 A DTU
(Series E) switches. Add the suffix SPLO to the catalog number.
[33] Electrical interlock kit catalog numbers with “1” suffix indicate one normally open and normally closed contact; “2” indicates two normally open and two normally closed contacts. See Table
3.29 Electrical Interlock Kit, page 3-15 for electrical interlock ratings.
[34] 30–100 A Type DT, DTU (Series F) switches contain (2) separate switching mechanisms. Each mechanism will accept an electrical interlock. Some applications may therefore require (2)
electrical interlocks.
[35] Double throw switches 92251, 92351, and 92451 are not available with factory or field installed electrical interlocks.
[36] Electrical interlock EK400DTU2 can be added to 200 A, 4-pole Type 82000 switches in the field.
[37] Type 82000 and DTU switches are available with electrical interlock factory-installed only. Not UL listed. Electrical interlocks are furnished with 2 N.O./N.C. contacts and are installed in both
“ON” positions. To order, add suffix EI to standard switch catalog number.
[38] For 200 A Type 82000 and 30 A Type 92000 switches, a neutral assembly is available factory installed on 2P and 3P switches. Not UL Listed. To order, add suffix N to the standard catalog
number. Terminated data = (3) 4 - 250 Al / Cu plug, (1) 4 - 250 Al / Cu SVC ground.
[39] Neutral assembly catalog number DT200N can be added to 4P, 200 A, Type 82000 switches in the field.
[40] (3) 6-250 ground lugs are provided as standard. DS468GKD provides an additional (2) 6-250 ground lugs.
3-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories and Lug Data Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
Watertight Hubs
• UL Listed for dusttight and watertight applications
• Suitable for use with conduit having ANSI standard taper pipe thread
SAFETY SWITCHES
• Watertight hubs are field installed on NEMA Type 4/4X/5 stainless steel and NEMA
Type 12/3R and 12K enclosures
• Watertight hubs are available in zinc or chrome plated finish
• Gaskets provided
Table 3.53: Watertight Hubs [42]
Watertight Hubs
Conduit
1/2 3/4 1 1-1/4 1-1/2 2 2-1/2 3 3-1/2 4
Size
Standard-
Zinc
Hub Cat. H050 H075 H100 H125 H150 H200 H250 H300 H350 H400
No
Chrome
Plated
Hub Cat. H050CP H075CP H100CP H125CP H150CP H200CP — — — —
No.
3
240 V Double Throw: page 3-24
600 V Double Throw: page 3-25
Application Data: page 3-28
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30
Dimensions, 30, 200–600 A (Series E, T4, A): page 3-31
Loa d Line
[43] Rating applies to AC only. The UL Listed short circuit current rating for non-fusible switches is based on the switch being used in conjunction with the corresponding fuse type. Evaluation of
non-fusible switches in conjunction with molded case circuit breakers has not been performed.
[44] Any brand of circuit breaker or fuse not exceeding the ampere rating of the switch may be used ahead of a non-fusible safety switch when there is up to 10 kA short circuit current available.
[45] The DTU361 and DTU361RB are also suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than
(A) 18 kA, 600 Vac maximum when protected by Type FH circuit breaker rated 30 A maximum or
(B) 14 kA, 600 Vac maximum when protected by Type FA circuit breaker rated 30 A maximum.
[46] Any brand of circuit breaker or fuse not exceeding the ampere rating of the switch may be used ahead of a non-fusible safety switch when there is up to 10 kA short circuit current available.
3-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Terminal Lug Data Double Throw Safety Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
schneider-electric.us
Table 3.56: Terminal Lug Data for Types 82,000 and for A and E-Series DTU
devices [47]
Wire Range Wire Bending
Optional
Amperes Wires per Space Lug Wire Range
Phase Per NEC Table 373-6 AWG/kcmil Compression Lugs
Field-Installed
AWG/kcmil
12–2 Al
30 A (Series T4) 1 14–8 Al/Cu or —
SAFETY SWITCHES
14–2 Cu
200 1 6–300 Al/Cu 6–300 Al/Cu VCEL030516H1[49]
1 1/0–600 Al/Cu 1/0 - 750 Al/Cu
400 or or or —
2 1/0–300 Al/Cu 1/0 - 300 Al/Cu
600 2 250–500 Al/Cu 250–500 Al/Cu —
[47] 30-100 A switches suitable for 60° C or 75° C conductors. 200-600 A switches suitable for 75° C conductors.
[48] Order from Thomas and Betts
[49] Hubbell Versa-CrimpTM catalog numbers.
3-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Double Throw Safety Switches Dimensions for Double Throw Safety
Switches
Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602 schneider-electric.us
W/H D
NEMA Type 3R
W/H D
3-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions for Double Throw Safety Double Throw Safety Switches
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 3110 / Refer to Catalog 3100CT1602
Series A, E, and T4 Devices
Table 3.58: 200–600 A Types 82,000 and E-Series DTU and 30 A devices—
W/H Approximate Dimensions
W D H W W/H D
Cat. No. Series
in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm
DTU224NRB E1 32.50 826 20.63 524 24.00 610 10.63 270
82254 E1 30.88 784 15.75 400 19.63 499 9.75 248
82254NW E1 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
82344 E2 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
82344RB E1 32.50 826 20.63 524 24.00 610 10.63 270
82354 E1 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
92251 T4 10.00 254 8.00 203 9.75 248 4.75 121
H 82344DS E1 30.88 784 20.00 508 23.88 607 11.75 298
DTU324N E1 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
DTU324NRB E1 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
H82344 E2 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
H82444 E2 32.50 826 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H82454 E3 32.50 826 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
82454 E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
82444 E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
NEMA Type 1 82454R E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
82444R E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
H82254 E3 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
H82354 E3 32.50 826 24.50 622 26.25 667 10.63 270
W/H 82444DS E3 38.00 965 29.62 753 33.02 839 10.63 270
82255 A1 38.50 978 26.10 663 29.51 750 10.63 270
W D 82255R A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
82345 A1 38.50 978 26.10 663 29.51 750 10.63 270
82345DS A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
82345R A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
SAFETY SWITCHES
82355 A1 38.50 978 26.10 663 29.51 750 10.63 270
82355R A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
82445 A1 38.50 978 30.10 765 33.50 851 10.63 270
82445R A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H 82455 A1 38.50 978 30.10 765 33.50 851 10.63 270
82455R A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H82255 A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
H82345 A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
H82355 A1 39.00 991 26.62 676 30.02 763 10.63 270
H82445 A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
H82455 A1 39.00 991 30.21 767 33.61 854 10.63 270
DTU326 A1 63.31 1608 23.66 601 24.46 621 8.88 226
DTU—200 A DTU426 A1 63.31 1608 27.00 686 27.80 706 8.88 226
NEMA Type 3R DTU366 A1 63.31 1608 23.66 601 24.46 621 8.88 226
DTU466 A1 63.31 1608 27.00 686 27.80 706 8.88 226
DTU326R A1 63.76 1619 23.66 601 24.46 621 8.88 226
DTU426R A1 63.76 1619 27.00 686 27.80 706 8.88 226
DTU366R A1 63.76 1619 23.66 601 24.46 621 8.88 226
DTU466R A1 63.76 1619 27.00 686 27.80 706 8.88 226
DTU366AWK A1 63.76 1619 23.66 601 24.46 621 8.88 226
3
240 V Double Throw: page 3-24
600 V Double Throw: page 3-25
Accessories: page 3-26
Application Data: page 3-28
Dimensions, 30–100 A (Series F): page 3-30
3-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Photovoltaic Disconnect Switches 1000 Vdc Photovoltaic Heavy Duty
Disconnect Switch
Class 3110 schneider-electric.us
Table 3.59: 1000 Vdc Photovoltaic Heavy Duty Disconnect Switches [1] [2] [3] [4]
SAFETY SWITCHES
4 Pole Ungrounded
Section 4
Power Monitoring and Control
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Management Systems 4-2
CONTROL
Link150 Ethernet Gateway 4-28
Engineering Services 4-29
Integration and Equipment 4-31
System Integration 4-31
Com’X Da ta Logge rs Ethe rne t Ga te wa ys Factory Assembled Equipment 4-31
a nd Ene rgy S e rve rs PowerLogic High Density Metering 4-33
Support Services 4-34
Sepam Digital Protective Relays 4-35
4
Va mp 321 Arc Fla s h
S e pa m S e rie s 80 Pro te ction a nd Mitiga tion ReactiVar™ 4-39
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Introduction
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
so your installation is both optimized and more efficient. Our systems are modular and
interoperable for better continuity of supply, enhanced safety for people and equipment,
and more effective monitoring and control. Plus, our full range of in-person and remote
services keep your system operating at peak performance.
4-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Introduction PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Application
Data Presentment & Management Data Acquisition, Alarms & Monitoring
Online Energy Supervisory Control & Power Monitoring System Tenant Submetering
Enterprise Analysis Data Acquisition
Data Centers; Water/Wastewater, Heavy Industrial, large Commercial Buildings,
Industrial Buildings, Property Utilities Process Industry, Data commercial buildings, Government Buildings,
Management, Utilities Centers, Critical Power Military Bases, Healthcare Military Bases
Meter Application
Automatic Meter Reading • •••• ••
Revenue Metering • •••• ••
WAGES Utility Pulses •••
Sub-billing ••• ••• ••••
Measurement &
Verification •••• •• •••
Cost Allocation & Utility Billing
Energy Usage Analysis •••• ••• • •• •
Cost Procurement Optimization •• ••• • •
Management
Allocate Energy Costs • •
Interval Benchmarking &
Profiling •••• ••• • ••
Total Load Aggregation ••••
Energy Efficiency
Emissions Tracking •• •••
Power Factor Correction • • •••
Peak Demand Reduction •• • ••• •••
Demand Response &
Curtailment ••• •••
Improve Maintenance Practices
Commissioning &
Troubleshooting ••• ••••
Equipment Monitoring:
transformers, MCCs,
switchgear, switchboards,
circuit breaker status,
protective equipment, ••• ••••
capacitors, generators,
panelboards, PDU, UPS,
etc.
CONTROL
Stress •••
Equipment Asset
Optimization •• •• •••
Improve Efficiency
Balance Circuit Loading •••
Balance Generator Usage •••
Optimize Chiller &
Mechanical Equipment •
System Monitoring & Analysis
Transient Voltage
Detection ••••
Sag/Swell Disturbance
Monitoring ••••
Power Quality & Harmonic
••••
4
Analysis
Network
Management Power Quality
Compliance •••• • •••
Alarm & System Diagnositics
Electrical Distribution
Alarm & Event Analysis • ••• ••••
Waveform capture
viewing ••••
Remote alarm notification •••• •••
Energy Services
see Engineering
Total Energy Control
Services •••• Services, page •••
4-29
Peak Shaving/Generator see Engineering
Control •••• ••
Services, page 4-29
Load Management/ see Engineering Services, page 4-29
Shedding •••• ••
WAGES •••
Advanced Reliability Services
Auto Throw Over (ATO) •••• ••
Engineering Emergency Power Supply
System Test Reporting ••••
Services
Sequence of Events
Recording (1ms time/ see Engineering Services, page 4-29 •••• ••• see Engineering
stamp) Services, page 4-29
GPS Time Stamping •••• •••
Power System Control •••• •
Network Protection •••• ••
Consulting Services
System Studies (SC/TCC/
Arc Flash)
see Engineering Services, page 4-29
Power System
Assessments
4-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Monitoring Software
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Typical Applications
• Manage power quality, availability, and reliability
• Optimize use of your electrical and infrastructure • Monitor the facility electrical network to verify reliable operation and proactively
optimize performance
assets
• Drive energy efficiency initiatives and improve • Maximize facility uptime by improving response to power-related events and restore
operations quickly
financial performance
• Perform root cause analysis to power-related disturbances through sequence of
events reporting
• Analyze and isolate the source of power quality problems
• Analyze total energy use from all electrical and piped utilities identify waste and
reduce cost
• Improve sustainability performance with greenhouse gas emissions tracking and
industry compliance reporting
• Identify billing discrepancies and avoid contract penalties by validating utility bills to
4
verify accuracy
• Allocate energy costs to departments to drive accountability, awareness and support
energy action programs like ISO50001
• Reduce peak demand and power factor penalties with monitoring, alerts, and
corrective actions
POWER MONITORING AND
• Negotiate
programs
rates with energy suppliers and enable participation in demand response
4-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Monitoring Software PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Segment Editions:
Power Monitoring Expert also features segment-specific solutions for data centers,
healthcare, industry and buildings, delivering pre-engineered functionality customized to
meet your needs.
CONTROL
5 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDANCZZNPEZZ
25 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDBNCZZNPEZZ
50 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDCNCZZNPEZZ
100 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDDNCZZNPEZZ
200 Device Pack for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDFNCZZNPEZZ
Unlimited Devices for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWDZNCZZSPEZZ
Engineering Client for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWCENCZZNPEZZ
Web Client for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWCWNCZZNPEZZ
Unlimited Engineering and Web Clients for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWCZNCZZSPEZZ
Event Notification Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMVNCZZSPEZZ
Cost Allocation & Billing Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMBNCZZSPEZZ
Breaker Performance Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMXNCZZSPEZZ
Energy Analysis Module for Power Monitoring Expert software
4
PSWMZNCZZSPEZZ
Energy Awareness Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMYNCZZSPEZZ
UPS Performance Module for Power Monitoring Expert software PSWMUNCZZSPEZZ
EPSS Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (HealthCare) PSWMENCZZSPEZZ
Generator Performance Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data
Centers) PSWMGNCZZSPEZZ
IT Billing Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data Centers) PSWMTNCZZSPEZZ
Power Capacity Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data Centers) PSWMPNCZZSPEZZ
Power Efficiency Module for Power Monitoring Expert software (Data Centers) PSWMNNCZZSPEZZ
SQL Server 2012 License - 2 COREs IE7SQLCZSNPEZZ
4-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Monitoring Software
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
4-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — ION8650 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
• Harmonics—individual, total even, total odd up to the 63rd
• 64MB standard memory
• Historical logs up to 320 channels
• Modbus RTU Master on serial ports
• Cycle setpoint minimum response time
Feature set A adds the following to feature sets C and B:
• Waveform capture up to 1024 samples/cycle, PQ compliance monitoring, flicker to
EN50160 Ed2, IEC 61000-4-7/4-15 (also configurable to IEEE519 2014, IEEE159,
SEMI) CBEMA/ITIC
• Transient detection to 6517µs at 60Hz;
• Harmonics: magnitude, phase and inter-harmonics to the 50th
4
• 128MB standard memory
• Max 96 cycles of waveform logs and 800 channels of historical logs
Table 4.1: Typical PowerLogic ION8650 Power and Energy Meter Ordering
Configurations
Description Catalog No.
ION8650, feature set A, 9S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
10MB memory, 127–177 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with:
10BaseT, RS-232/485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 Digital S8650A0C0E6E1B0A
Inputs
ION8650, feature set A, 35S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
10MB memory, 120–480 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with:
10Base T, RS-232/485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 S8650A1C0E6E1B0A
Digital Inputs
ION8650, feature set C, 9S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
2MB memory, 120–277 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with: RS-232/ S8650C0C0E6A0B0A
485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 Digital Inputs
ION8650, feature set C, 35S socket base, 5 A nominal current inputs,
2MB memory, 120–277 Vac, 60 Hz, communications card with: RS-232/ S8650C1C0E6A0B0A
485, RS-485, Optical port, 4 Digital Outputs, 3 Digital Inputs
4-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Quality Meters — ION7550 / ION7650
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
up to 16 users
• 65 configurable 1/2 cycle setpoints for single, multi-condition and dial out on alarm and
math, logic, trig, log, linearization formulas
• Password protection and anti-tamper seal protection enhance meter security
• Extensive standard I/O includes: 8 digital inputs, 4 digital outputs and 3 onboard relays
POWER MONITORING AND
NOTE: Please refer to www.schneider-electric.us for the most complete and up-to-
date list of feature availability. Some features are optional.
4-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — CM4000T PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
• Sequence of events recording using GPS synchronization technology
• Oscillatory transient detection and recording
• UL Listed, CSA Approved, NOM Approved, FCC compliant
PowerLogic Series 4000 Circuit Monitor Optional Displays
• High visibility remote VF (vacuum fluorescence) display
• Displays metering data, min/max values, alarms, inputs
• Remote LC (liquid crystal) display with backlighting also available
• Optional user configurable display screens
Table 4.3: Series 4000 Circuit Monitors
Description Catalog No.
4
Series 4000 Circuit Monitors
Instrumentation, On-board Data Logging, Waveform Capture, Disturbance Recording, Configurable
I/O, 0.04% Accuracy, Impulsive Transient Detection and Flicker (IEC 61000-4-15) CM4000T
Series 4000 Circuit Monitor Accessories
Field installable I/O card with 3 relay outputs, 1 pulse output (KYZ) and 4 status inputs IOC44
I/O Extender module with 4 DC status inputs, 2 DC digital outputs, 1 analog input and 1 analog
output IOX2411
I/O Extender module with 4 status inputs and 4 analog inputs (4–20 mA) IOX0404
I/O Extender module with 8 status inputs IOX08
I/O Extender module with no pre-installed I/O [1] IOX
Ethernet Communications Card; 100 MB Fiber or 10/100 MB UTP Ethernet port and 1 RS-485
master port ECC21
Current/Voltage module with high speed transient detection CVMT
4-line x 20—character liquid crystal display with backlighting CMDLC
ECC21 IOC44 I/O Card
4-line x 20—character vacuum fluorescent display with proximity sensor CMDVF
4 foot display cable CAB4
12 foot display cable CAB12
30 foot display cable CAB30
[1] Contact your nearest Square D/Schneider Electric sales office for additional I/O options.
4-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power Quality Meters — ION7400
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
PowerLogic ION7400
Applications and benefits
• Maximize profits by providing the highest output
possible with the least amount of risk to
availability.
• Optimize availability and reliability of electrical
systems and equipment.
• Monitor power quality (PQ) for compliance and to
prevent problems.
• Meters fully supported by StruxureWare Power
Monitoring Expert and PowerSCADA Expert
Software.
Main Characteristics
• Precision metering
• PQ compliance reporting and basic PQ analysis
• Used with StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert
software, provides detailed PQ reporting across
entire network
• Onboard data and event logging
• Alarming and control
• Excellent quality: ISO 9001 and ISO 14000
certified manufacturing.
Table 4.5: PowerLogic ION7400 Meters
Description Catalog Number
ION7400 Panel mount meter
(integrated display with optical METSEION7400
port and 2 energy pulse LEDs)
DIN rail mount - utility meter base METSEION7403
4-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — PM8000 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
Time stamping ■
GPS synchronization (+/- 1 ms) ■
Memory (in Mbytes) 512
10 MB for Frameworks
Display and I/O
Front panel display 89 mm (3.5 in.) TFT ■
Wiring self-test ■
Pulse output 1
Digital 6 in / 2 out
Analogue 4 in / 2 out
1 digital
Digital or analogue outputs (max, including pulse output) 8 relay
8 analog
Communication
4
RS 485 port 1
10/100BaseTX 2
Serial port (Modbus, ION, DNP3) ■
Ethernet port (Modbus/TCP, ION TCP, DNP3 TCP, IEC 61850 [2]) ■
ANSI C12.19 Optical port ■
Standards
IEC 61000-4-30, IEC 61000-4-7, IEC 61000-4-15, IEC 61326-1, ANSI C12.20, IEC 62052-11, IEC 62053-22, CLC/
TR50579
[3] Specifications represent maximum capabilities with all options installed. Some options are not available concurrently. This is not a complete feature list, please refer to detailed product
specifications.
4-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power Quality Meters — Selection PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
ION8650
Features [4] ION7650 ION7550 CM4000T ION7400 PM8000
A B C
Power supply options AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC AC/DC
Power and energy measurements
Voltage, current, frequency, power factor • • • • • • • •
Power / Demand •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Energy / time-of-use (energy per shift) •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
IEC / ANSI energy accuracy class (% of reading) 0.2(1) 0.2(1) 0.2(1) 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2 0.2
Loss compensation • • • • • - - -
Power quality analysis
EN50160 compliance reporting / IEC 61000-4-30 Class A or S •/A •/S -/- •/A -/- •/- •/S •/S
Flicker measurement • • - • - • - -
Transient detection duration 17 μs - - 17 μs - 200 ns - -
Sag and swell monitoring / disturbance direction detection •/- •/- •/- •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Harmonic distortion: total/ individual / inter •/•/• •/•/- •/•/- •/•/• •/•/- •/•/- •/•/- •/•/-
Waveform capture • - - • • • • •
On-board data and event logging
Trending / forecasting / billing •/-/• •/-/• •/-/• •/•/• •/•/• •/•/• •/•/• •/•/•
Minimum and maximum • • • • • • • •
Events and alarms with timestamps • • • • • • • •
Timestamp resolution (seconds) 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001 0.001
Time sync: Network / GPS / IRIG-B / DCF77-B •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/•/- •/•/-/- •/•/-/- •/•/-/• •/•/•/- •/•/•/-
Setpoints, alarms and control
Log alarm conditions / call out on alarm •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Trigger data logging / waveform capture •/• •/- •/- •/• •/• •/• •/• •/•
Trigger relay or digital output • • • • • • • •
Special features
Custom programming • • • • • • • •
Downloadable firmware • • • • • • • •
Communications
Ports:
Ethernet: Copper / Fiber •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• •/• 2/- 2/-
Ethernet-to-serial gateway • • • • • • 2/- •
Telephone modem • • • • • - - -
Modem-to-serial gateway • • • • • - - -
CONTROL
Protocols: IEC61850 / Jbus / M-Bus / LON / BACnet •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/- •/-/-/-/-
NOTE:
1. The ION8650 is two times more accurate than the 0.2 IEC/ANSI accuracy
classes according to the same conditions used to specify the 0.2 accuracy class.
2. ION8800, ION8650, ION8600, ION7650, ION7550, PM8000 also offer Modbus
Master capabilities.
[4] Specifications represent maximum capabilities with all options installed. Some options are not available concurrently. This is not a complete feature list, please refer to detailed product
specifications.
4-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power and Energy Meters — PM5000
Management Systems Series
schneider-electric.us
NOTE: Please refer to www.schneider-electric.us for the most complete and up-to-
date list of feature availability. Some features are optional.
CONTROL
Rogowski CT, 300 mm (12”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR30500
Rogowski CT, 460 mm (18”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR46500
Rogowski CT, 600 mm (24”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR60500
Rogowski CT, 900 mm (35”), 600 Vac, 5 kA, U018 equivalent METSECTR90500
LVCT Series Current Transformers
LVCT current transducers provide a 0.333 V output for use with EM3500 series meters.
Available in both solid and split core styles.
• Solid core accuracy ±0.5 of reading from 5% to 120% of rated current
• Split core accuracy 1% from 10% to 100% of rated current
• Leads 22 AWG, 600 Vac, UL 1015 bonded pair, 6 ft. (1.8 m) standard length
4
Table 4.14: LVCT Series Current Transformers
Description Catalog Number
Split core
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 0, 50 A:0.33 V LVCT00050S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 1, 100 A:0.33 V LVCT00101S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 2, 100 A:0.33 V LVCT00102S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 1, 200 A:0.33 V LVCT00201S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 2, 200 A:0.33 V LVCT00202S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 2, 300 A:0.33 V LVCT00302S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 3, 400 A:0.33 V LVCT00403S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 3, 600 A:0.33 V LVCT00603S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 3, 800 A:0.33 V LVCT00803S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 800 A:0.33 V LVCT00804S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 1000 A:0.33 V LVCT01004S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 1200 A:0.33 V LVCT01204S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 1600 A:0.33 V LVCT01604S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 2000 A:0.33 V LVCT02004S
Low-Voltage CT, Split Core, Size 4, 2400 A:0.33 V LVCT02404S
Solid core
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 0, 50 A:0.33 V LVCT20050S
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 0, 100 A:0.33 V LVCT20100S
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 2, 200 A:0.33 V LVCT20202S
Low-Voltage CT, Solid Core, Size 3, 400 A:0.33 V LVCT20403S
4-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power and Energy Meters — PM3000
Management Systems Series
schneider-electric.us
Communication
RS-485 port • •
Modbus protocol • •
4-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power and Energy Meters — iEM3000 PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
Measurement parameters Multiple Tariffs
• Total and partial kWh shows consumption behavior • Save up to four different time slots to manage multiple tariffs (peak/off-peak,
• Four-quadrant metering differentiates energy workday/weekend)
consumption • Control tariffs via digital inputs, internal clock, or communication
• Target green technologies (delivered/received) Digital Inputs
• Reduce utility penalties (active/reactive) • Use the meter as a pulse counter for another meter (WAGES monitoring)
• Additional parameters (P, Q, S, 3xI, V, PF, F) to • Manage double-source applications (e.g., utility main plus on-site generator)
monitor network balance and overload behavior • Monitor circuit breaker status or cabinet door opening
Smart Alarm Digital Outputs
• kW overload alarm helps prevent utility demand
charges
• Use to trip a light or sound an alarm
• Configure as a pulse output
4
Table 4.18: iEM3000 Series Energy Meters
Description Catalog Number
iEM3100 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1 A9MEM3100
iEM3110 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, pulse out, MID, one (1) DO A9MEM3110
iEM3135 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, M-Bus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3135
iEM3150 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, Modbus A9MEM3150
iEM3155 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3155
iEM3165 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3165
iEM3175 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 63A, Class 1, LON, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3175
iEM3200 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S A9MEM3200
iEM3210 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, pulse out, MID one (1) DO A9MEM3210
iEM3235 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, M-Bus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3235
iEM3250 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, Modbus A9MEM3250
iEM3255 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3255
iEM3265 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3265
iEM3275 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, 1A or 5A CT, Class 0.5S, LON, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3275
iEM3300 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1 A9MEM3300
iEM3310 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, pulse out, MID, one (1) DO A9MEM3310
iEM3335 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, M-Bus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3335
iEM3350 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, Modbus A9MEM3350
iEM3355 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3355
iEM3365 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3365
iEM3375 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, direct connect 125A, Class 1, LON, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3375
iEM3455 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, LVCT, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3455
iEM3465 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, LVCT, Class 0.5S, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3465
iEM3555 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, Rogowski coil, Class 0.5S, Modbus, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3555
iEM3565 3PH energy meter, DIN rail mount, Rogowski coil, Class 0.5S, BACnet, MID, 4-quadrant energy, one (1) DI, one (1) DO A9MEM3565
4-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Power and Energy Meters — iEM3000
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Schneider Electric’s Multi-Meter Unit (MMU) enclosures are the ideal complement for the
iEM3000 Series of energy meters. This compact solution saves wall space and is
scalable for the exact number of meters required. Factory-assembled, pre-wired, and
tested enclosures can speed installation, reduce the amount of field wiring, and save
time troubleshooting.
Multi-meter unit enclosures and iEM3000 meters provide the highest quality, best value
hardware for tenant sub-metering, and are designed for contractor convenience and
simplicity.
4
08 = 8 mete rs, 20"H x 2 0"W x 6"D Ga te wa y/Da ta Logge r/Ene rgy S e rve r
24 = 24 mete rs, 30"H x 24"W x 6"D N = None ( Re quire d if Me te r Type
is B or D, or Meter Cap acity = 04)
Numb er o f Mete rs Ins ta lle d
L = EGX150 ga tew a y
01 = 1 meter D = EBX210 d a ta logger
Meter Type (Sen s or, S e ria l P rotocol)
xx = up to cap acity limit E = EBX510 energ y se rve r
A = iEM3455 (LVCT, Modbus)
X = EGX300 energ y se rve r
B = iEM3465 (LVCT, BACnet) B = EGX300 energ y se rver
C = iE M3555 (Rogo wsk i, Modbus) with Tenant Bill 32 applic a tion
T = EGX300 energ y se rver with Te na nt Bill
D = iEM3565 (Rogo wsk i, BACnet) 64 applic a tion
4-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power and Energy Meters — Selection PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
- - - - - - - -
Modem-to-serial gateway - - - - - - - -
Infrared port - - - - - - - -
RS485/RS232 •/- •/- -/- •/- •/- •/- •/- •/-
Misc: Web server / Email / SNMP / XML -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- •/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/- -/-/-/-
Protocols: Modbus / DNP / MV-90 / DLMS •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/- •/-/-/-
Protocols: IEC61850 / Jbus / M-Bus / LON / BACnet -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/• -/-/-/-/- -/-/-/-/• -/-/-/-/- -/-/•/•/•
[6] Specifications represent maximum capabilities with all options installed. Some options are not available concurrently. This is not a complete feature list, please refer to detailed product
specifications.
4-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power PowerLogic Energy Meter
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Table 4.19: Basic 120/240 V to 208Y/120 V Table 4.20: Extended Range 120/240 V to 480Y/277 V
Description Catalog No. Description Catalog No.
Basic 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 1 CT EMB1010 Extended Range 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 1 CT EME1010
Basic 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 1 CT EMB1021 Extended Range 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 1 CT EME1021
Basic 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 1 CT EMB1032 Extended Range 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 1 CT EME1032
Basic 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 2 CTs EMB2010 Extended Range 100 A, n.518"x1.28" ID, 2 CTs EME2010
Basic 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 2 CTs EMB2021 Extended Range 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 2 CTs EME2021
Basic 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 2 CTs EMB2032 Extended Range 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 2 CTs EME2032
Basic 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EMB2043 Extended Range 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EME2043
Basic 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EMB2083 Extended Range 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 2 CTs EME2083
Basic 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 3 CTs EMB3010 Extended Range 100 A, .518"x1.28" ID, 3 CTs EME3010
Basic 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 3 CTs EMB3021 Extended Range 200 A, 0.75” x 1.10” ID, 3 CTs EME3021
Basic 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 3 CTs EMB3032 Extended Range 300 A, .90"x1.90" ID, 3 CTs EME3032
Basic 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EMB3043 Extended Range 400 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EME3043
Basic 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EMB3083 Extended Range 800 A, 2.45"x2.89" ID, 3 CTs EME3083
Basic 800 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EMB3084 Extended Range 800 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EME3084
Basic 1600 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EMB3164
Extended Range 1600 A, 2.45"x5.50" ID, 3 CTs EME3164
• Compact size for easy in-panel mounting, DIN rail or screw mount options
• Easy integration with a variety of CT form factors – split-core, solid-core, and Rope-
Style Rogowski (METSECTR), and compatibility from 5 to 5000A
• Seamless integration with StruxureWare Power Monitoring Expert (PME),
StruxureWare Building Operation (SBO), and StruxureWare Building Expert (SBE)
• Configurable with or without power
• Quick connection with auto protocol, baud rate, and uni-directional/bi-directional
detection
• Native Modbus and BACnet protocols along with uni-directional and bi-directional
feature sets in one unit
EM4200 Series Enercept
Table 4.23: EM4200 Enercept Meter
Description Catalog Number
Enercept Power Meter, Class 0.2S, Modbus/BACnet
RS485, ANSI wire code, compatible with LVCT and EM4236
Rogowski coils, order separately
[7] Energy Meter communication board (EMCB) can be used with all models of the Energy Meter. Order one EMCB for each Energy Meter where either kW demand and/or communication is
specified.
4-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic Enercept™
™ Meter PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
Open style submeter display, no enclosure SMD OPN
2-Wire 232–485 Conv 30502W485C
Enercept Mounting Brackets (Set of 3) 3050EMBK-3
4
Meters, data loggers, chart recorders and other instruments the 3090 SCCT series
provides a cost-effective means to transform electrical service amperages to a 0–5A
level compatible with monitoring equipment.
Table 4.27:
Description Catalog No.
Split Core CT—200 A (sz.2): 1.25" x 1.51 3090SCCT022
Split Core CT—300 A (sz.2): 1.25" x 1.51 3090SCCT032
SA Split-Core Current Transformers
Split Core CT—400 A (sz.3): 2.45" x 2.89 3090SCCT043
Split Core CT—600 A (sz.3): 2.45" x 2.89 3090SCCT063
Split Core CT—800 A (sz.3): 2.45" x 2.89 3090SCCT083
Split Core CT—800 A (sz.4): 2.45" x 5.05 3090SCCT084
Split Core CT—1200 A (sz.4): 2.45" x 5.50 3090SCCT124
Split Core CT—1600 A (sz.4): 2.45" x 5.50 3090SCCT164
NOTE: Max. Voltage without additional insulation 600 Vac. Do not apply 600 V Class
current transformers to circuits having a phase-to-phase voltage greater than 600 V,
unless adequate additional insulation is applied between the primary conductor and
the current transformers. Square D assumes no responsibility for damage of
equipment or personal injury caused by transformers operated on circuits above
their published ratings.
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 80mA low-power CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM408016
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 80mA low-power CTs; 277V control power 60 Hz METSEEM408036
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 333mV low-power CTs; 120V control power 60 Hz METSEEM403316
EM4000 series; Ethernet; Modbus RTU over RS-485; compatible with 333mV low-power CTs; 277V control power 60 Hz METSEEM403336
200 A current transformer (CT), 80 mA secondary, solid-core (1 CT) METSECT80200
POWER MONITORING AND
150 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 0.75 in Window Size ECT075150SC
200 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 0.75 in Window Size ECT075200SC
100 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125100SC
150 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125150SC
200 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125200SC
400 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 1.25 in Window Size ECT125400SC
200 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 2.00 in Window Size ECT200200SC
400 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 2.00 in Window Size ECT200400SC
600 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 2.00 in Window Size ECT200600SC
600 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 3 x 5 in Window Size ECT300600SC
800 A .333 V Split Core Current Transformer with 3 x 5 in Window Size ECT300800SC
4-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
50 A CT
4
100 A CT
200 A CT
4-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
72-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC272S
84-circuit solid-core branch current meter, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPMC284S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPME042S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), ¾ in. spacing BCPME084S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 1 in. spacing BCPME142S
POWER MONITORING AND
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 1 in. mm spacing BCPME184S
24-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME224S
36-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME236S
42-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (2 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME242S
CONTROL
48-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME248S
72-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME272S
84-circuit solid-core power & energy meter w/Ethernet, 100A CTs (4 strips), 18 mm spacing BCPME284S
4-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic Branch Circuit Power Meter PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
200A 16 x 20 mm LVCT00101S BCPM 100A split core CTs, Quantity 6, 1.8 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT1
200A 32 x 32 mm LVCT00202S BCPM 100A split core CTs, Quantity 6, 6 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT1R20
100A 30 x 31 mm LVCT00102S BCPM 200A split core CTs, Quantity 1, 1.8 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT3
200A 30 x 31 mm LVCT00202S BCPM 200A split core CTs, Quantity 1, 6 m lead lengths BCPMSCCT3R20
300A 30 x 31 mm LVCT00302S
400A 62 x 73 mm LVCT00403S
600A 62 x 73 mm LVCT00603S Table 4.34: Additional Accessories for use with BCPM Products
800A 62 x 73 mm LVCT00803S Description Catalog Number
800A 62 x 139 mm LVCT00804S BCPM circuit board cover BCPMCOVERS
1000A 62 x 139 mm LVCT01004S CT repair kit for solid core BCPM (includes one CT) BCPMREPAIR
1200A 62 x 139 mm LVCT01204S Additional 100A split core CT for use with solid core repair kit H6803R-0100
1600A 62 x 139 mm LVCT01604S
Modbus to BACnet protocol converter E8951
2000A 62 x 139 mm LVCT02004S
Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 0.45 m CBL008
2400A 62 x 139 mm LVCT02404S
Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.2 m CBL016
4
Table 4.32: 1/3 V Low-Voltage Solid-Core CTs for Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.5 m CBL017
Aux Inputs (Mains) Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.8 m CBL018
Amperage Rating Inside Dimensions Catalog Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 2.4 m CBL019
Number Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 3.0 m CBL020
50A 10 mm LVCT20050S Flat Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 6.1 m CBL021
100A 10 mm LVCT20100S Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 1.2 m CBL022
200A 25 mm LVCT20202S
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 3 m CBL023
400A 31 mm LVCT20403S
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 6.1 m CBL024
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 0.5 m CBL031
Round Ribbon cable (quantity 1) for BCPM, length = 0.8 m CBL033
4-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power PowerLogic Multi-Circuit Meter
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Table 4.35:
Description Catalog No.
Multi-Circuit Meter 8364 MCM8364
4
view data on a remote PC via a network connection. Touch pad buttons provide a
convenient way to view downstream devices on the power-monitoring network. The
display is RS-485 Modbus RTU compatible. It has additional RS-485 and RS-232
Modbus ports for networking to additional displays or to a master PC. The submeter
CONTROL
display is compatible with the following metering devices: BCM, BCPM, EM3500, MCM,
& Enercept™ meters.
Table 4.36:
Description Catalog No.
Submeter display mounted in enclosure SMD
Open style submeter display, no enclosure SMD OPN
Submeter Display
4-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Communications PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us Class 3030
CONTROL
The Com’X 510 Energy Server further includes embedded web pages that display data
in a meaningful way so you can make informed decisions about your energy usage. Web
pages display real-time data in easy to understand tabular and summary formats. In
addition, you can access simple analysis of historical data in bar graph or trending
formats. Pages are accessible via any standard web browser without plug-ins or
additional components.
4
Zigbee USB stick EXBAUSBZIGBEE
GPRS modem with SIM card EBXAGPRSSIM
GPRS modem without SIM card EBXAGPRS
External GPRS antenna EBXAANT5M
4-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Communications — Link150 Ethernet
Management Systems Gateway
Class 3030 schneider-electric.us
Security
• Secure user interface including user’s name and password for login
• Advanced security features to allow users to specify which Modbus TCP/IP master
devices may access attached serial slave devices
– Modbus TCP/IP filtering feature
– Allows user to specify the level of access for each master device as Read-only or
Full access
4-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Engineering Services PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
• Time current coordination analysis showing both • Arc flash label affixation
existing and recommended over/current device
settings • NFPA 70E—Safe Workplace Practices Training
provided by OSHA authorized outreach instructors
• Short-circuit study to ensure adequacy of equipment
• Recommendations and solutions to reduce potential
• Onsite verification and documentation of equipment arc flash hazards
CONTROL
Square D offers onsite power quality engineering studies and solutions to eliminate
process disruptions, power system shutdowns, and equipment damage due to electrical
power system disturbances. A power quality study is used to...
Harmonic Control in Electrical Power Systems • Identify disturbances originating on electric utility
system and improvements to reduce the number and
guidelines
severity
• Identify most cost-effective solution to power quality
problems
• Solve process disruptions due to power disturbances
4
Square D offers engineering services to meet a variety of power system needs …
4-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Engineering Services
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Engineered Solutions
Schneider Electric provides an engineered solution approach to your specific power
system applications. Our total solutions for power monitoring and power system controls
allow greater safety, reliability, and energy efficiency of your power systems. As a long
4
standing industry leader in Power Monitoring and Control Systems, we understand your
power system requirements and needs.
All of our Engineered Solutions are tailored to your specific system requirements.
Schneider Electric is your total Solution provider.
POWER MONITORING AND
detailed reporting, testing and analysis capabilities for your systems and related
components.
• EPSS Emergency Power Supply Systems– The PowerLogic EPSS Test Report
provides information regarding the health and status of the emergency power supply
system, including automatic transfer switches and generators.
• SER Sequence of Events Recording– The PowerLogic Sequence of Events
Recorder (SER) Module is a root-cause analysis tool for rapid response for problem
resolution that is ideal for pinpointing the cause of a service disruption in very large
complex power systems.
• WAGES Water, Air Gas, Electric, Steam– PowerLogic energy and power
management systems can provide instantaneous readings, alarm notifications, and
graphical diagrams for monitoring electrical and piped utilities (Water, Air, Gas,
Electric, Steam).
• ENM Event Notification Module– The PowerLogic Event Notification Module allows
automatic paging to alphanumeric pagers, cell phones and PCs.
4-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integration and Equipment PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
System Integration
System Design and Engineering
Our Square D Engineering Services solution specialists can work with you to design or
upgrade your existing system to best achieve your energy and power management
objectives and informational needs. With expertise in electrical systems,
communications, and automatic control systems, we can integrate, install, and
commission your system for optimal performance.
CONTROL
• Assemblies include meters & devices wired to terminal blocks, disconnects, and
shorting blocks or test switches
• Tailored to any system voltage :
– 208/120 V, 480/277 V & 600/347 V Wye
– 240 V, 480 V & 600 V Delta
– Utilization of PT's required for higher voltage levels
• Wall mountable and easy to install using concealed holes in the back of the enclosure.
• Complete with necessary documentation and mounting hardware for quick and easy
installation
• Carbon steel construction, with industry standard ANSI 61 gray powder coat finish
• Equipped with concealed hinged door, and universal pad-lockable latch.
4
• Custom engraved nameplates available for all units.
Table 4.39: Industrial Enclosure Types 12 & 4, UL & CUL 508A Listed
Available Meter Types Digital Inputs Digital Outputs Analog Inputs Analog Outputs
ION6200 N/A Up to 2/ Meter N/A N/A
PM5563RD Up to 4 / Meter Up to 2 / Meter N/A N/A
PM8244 Up to 15 / Meter Up to 5 / Meter Up to 4 / Meter Up to 2 / Meter
CM4000T Up to 8 / Meter Up to 7 / Meter Up to 1 / Meter Up to 1 / Meter
ION 7550 & 7560 Up to 16 / Meter Up to 7 / Meter Up to 4 / Meter Up to 4 / Meter
• Supports Single or Multiple Voltage Sources for Indoor (Types 1 and 12) & Outdoor
(Type 4) applications
• Available with 1–4 meters per panel. Serial & Ethernet Communications are options
for all units
• EGX & ION RTU Communication Enclosures with 1–4 devices per panel also
available
4-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Integration and Equipment
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
Management Systems.
• Industrialized PC’s, Touch Screens (Magelis), and Human Machine Interfaces (HMI’s)
with Custom System Graphics.
• Designed to fit any environment – Indoor (Type 1 & 12) & Outdoor (Type 3R & 4)
applications
For additional information and pricing please contact your local PowerLogic sales
specialist or PowerLogic Inside Sales Support at 615-287-3535. Equipment pricing
and literature available for download on our website at www.powerlogic.com/
products/enclosures.
To better serve you please have the following information on hand when calling.
• Enclosure
Corrosive)
type (Indoor or Outdoor) and Environment details (Corrosive or Non-
• Power System Voltage Level and Type (Direct Current (DC) or Alternating Current
(AC))
• Digital & Analog Input and Output requirements
• Device Type and Quantity per enclosure
• Ethernet and Serial Communication Requirements
• For Drawout Retrofits, need existing cradle type (i.e. GE, Westinghouse, etc.)
4-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integration and Equipment PowerLogic™ Energy and Power
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
applications
High Density Meter Enclosure with PM5560 meters; Dual wiring for both
HDM PM5560 1, 4 or 8 1–8 Type 1 or Type 3R Modbus RTU serial and Modbus TCP Ethernet communicaions; Ideal for
single or three phase indoor commercial building applications
4
7.42 7.12 1.43
[189] [181] [36]
1.95
[50]
8.5 16.0
Top Vie w for 1X a nd 4X [406.4]
[215.9]
0.25 / [6.4]
13.8 0.38 / [9.7]
7.40 [350]
[188] in.
Dual Dimensions:
[mm]
Top Vie w
30.8 0.33
1.95 [782]
[50] [8.382] 14.00
7.42 7.12 1.43 21.13 24.75 [355.6]
[189] [180.85] [36] [536.7] [628.7]
13.8
[350] 14.88
[378]
11.33 8.00
[288] [203]
4.75 4.8
Front V iew Side V iew Front V iew Side V iew 0.78 / [19.8]
[121] [122] 7.38 0.38 / [9.652]
Back V iew Back V iew [187.5] 21.88 / [555.8]
1X Enclosure Dimensions 4X Enclosure Dimensions 8X Enclos ure Dime ns ions
[9] Meters Ordering Notes: Please indicate the number of meters to be pre-installed when placing your order. You may order any number of meters in the enclosure between one and the
maximum number of meters each cabinet will hold.
4-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerLogic™ Energy and Power Support Services
Management Systems
schneider-electric.us
we’re happy to assist you with troubleshooting or answer your questions at no extra cost.
Priority Support: Excellent Service, Free Software Upgrades, Training Discounts & More!
Energy Performance Services
Unleash Your System’s True Potential with the Power of Partnership
POWER MONITORING AND
Energy Performance Services helps you improve and sustain energy performance,
reduce costs, and support compliance efforts. From facility insight to optimization
solutions, let us customize an energy management program that’s right for you. Contact
your representative and ask them about power quality analysis or an energy health
CONTROL
check.
Solutions to fit your needs:
• Facility Insight Solutions—These core energy health checks designed to evaluate your
existing systems
• Optimization Solutions—Let our team of experts monitor or fine-tune your systems to
maximize energy savings, efficiency and power quality.
Choose from remote or onsite solutions to ensure sustained results year over year.
Various funding options available. Visit www.schneider-electric.com/eps or contact us at
615-287-3535.
Power Management University (PMU)
Attending a PMU sponsored course will enable attendees to better utilize their
Schneider-Electric power monitoring solution thus enabling them to realize energy
savings as quick as possible. PMU offers a variety of options with instructor led options
being 80% hands-on, with each student having their own lab workstation. Below is a list
of the different training options offered by PMU.
Course Course No. Length
Factory Courses: Software Solutions
Power Monitoring Fundamentals Bundle
(includes 12-mo. On-Demand Campus access) 3000PMUFUNDSPMCR 4 Days
Power Monitoring Fundamentals
3000PMUFUNDSPM 4 Days
(without 12-mo. On-demand Campus access)
Power Monitoring Designer 3000PMUPROG 4 Days
Power Monitoring Administrator 3000PMUADMINSPM 4 Days
Other Software Courses
Hardware Installation and Troubleshooting 3000PLUC100 4 Days
PowerSCADA Expert Administrator 3000PMUPLSADMIN 4 Days
Online Training Solutions
On-Demand Campus (one-year subscription—online access) 3000PMUDEMAND12 12 months
SMSTrainer (one-year subscription—online access) 3000PMUSMSTRAINER 12 months
EEMTrainer (one-year subscription—online access) 3000PMUEEMTRAINER 12 months
webED, custom webinar training for up to five people
(call or email for more information) 3000PLUCWEBCST 3–4 hours
4-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series 20, 40, 60, and 80 Features Sepam Digital Protective Relays
schneider-electric.us
Sepam Series 10
The Sepam Series 10 relays are suitable for basic protection applications involving
current metering.
Applications covered:
• Substation
• Transformer
CONTROL
Applications covered:
• Substation
• Transformer
• Motor
• Busbar
Sepam Series 40
The Series 40 family of protection relays are designed for demanding applications
requiring current, voltage and/or frequency metering.
Applications covered:
4
• Substation
Sepam Series 20 and 40 • Transformer
• Motor
• Generator
Sepam Series 80
The Series 80 relays are for custom applications requiring enhanced protection of
electrical distribution networks.
Applications covered:
• Substation
• Transformer
• Motor
• Generator
• Busbar
• Capacitor
Sepam Series 80
4-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Sepam Digital Protective Relays Series 20, 40, 60, and 80 Features
schneider-electric.us
Protection Configurations
Four relay series with increasing protection capabilities for six types of applications to
provide all possible protection configurations
[1] LPCT: low-power current transducer complying with standard IEC 60044-8.
[2] Control matrix for simple assignment of information from the protection, control and monitoring functions.
[3] Logipam ladder language (PC programming environment) to make full use of Sepam Series 80 functions.
[4] Standard lithium battery 1/2 AA format 3,6 V front face exchangeable.
4-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VAMP V321 Arc Flash Protection and Mitigation
Systems
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
VAM 12L I/O Unit VAM 10L I/O Unit VAM 4C I/O Unit VAM 3LX I/O Unit VAM 3L I/O Unit
• VAM 12L, VAM 12LD: Light-sensing point sensor I/O units with connections for 10 arc
sensors and 3 trip contacts
• VAM 10L, VAM 10LD: Light-sensing point sensor I/O units with connections for 10 arc
sensors and 1 trip contact
4
• VAM 3L, VAM 3LX: Light-sensing fiber arc sensor I/O units with connections for 3 fiber
loops and 1 trip contact
• VAM 4C, VAM 4CD: Dedicated I/O units used to measure current from alternative
locations
All VAMP V321 I/O units provide active indication when appropriately placed inside the
switchgear enclosure. They are connected to each other using intra-unit cabling supplied
by Schneider Electric.
VA1EH-x VA1DA-x
4-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Arc Flash Protection and Mitigation VAMP V321
Systems
schneider-electric.us
• Point sensor VA1EH-x (pipe) Installed typically in the tube or next to the
compartment window.
• Point sensor VA1DA-x (surface) Compartment wall or mounting plate installation.
• Arc SLm-x Used when a large number of compartments are to be monitored.
• VX001 Modular Cable Intra-unit cabling that is used to connect the I/O units to the
central unit.
Arc SLm-x VX001
VAMP V321 is currently available in solution-based projects. Please contact a Schneider
Electric representative for more information.
[email protected]
4
POWER MONITORING AND
CONTROL
4-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Reactive Power Compensation and ReactiVar™
Harmonic Mitigation
schneider-electric.us
Power factor is a measure of how efficiently you are using electricity. In an electric power
system, a load with low power factor draws more current than a load with a high power
factor for the same amount of real power transferred. Utility customers with a low power
factor could realize an increase or penalty in their electric bill. Over time, these penalties
may reach into thousands of dollars, depending upon the utility’s rate structure.
Harmonics may disrupt normal operation of other devices and increase operating costs.
Symptoms of problematic harmonic levels include overheating of transformers, motors
and cables, thermal tripping of protective devices, logic faults of digital devices and
drives.
Harmonics can cause vibrations and noise in electrical machines (motors, transformers,
reactors).
The life span of many devices can be reduced by elevated operating temperature.
CONTROL
Table 4.44: Descriptions, Applications, and Features
Product Description LV MV Application Product Features
Suited for applications where the load does not change or where the
ReactiVar Fixed Power Factor Capacitors X X Power Factor correction capacitor is switched with the load, such as on the load side of a
motor contactor.
ReactiVar Standard Automatic Power Factor Capacitor Suited for centralized power factor correction in applications where
Banks plant loading is constantly changing, resulting in the need for varying
X X Power Factor correction amounts of reactive power. Designed for electrical networks with little
(AV5000/MV5000)
or no harmonic content.
ReactiVar Anti-Resonant Automatic Power Factor Suited for centralized power factor correction in applications
Power Factor Correction and
Capacitor Banks X X Harmonics Filtering containing harmonic energies that would otherwise damage
(AV6000/MV6000) standard fixed or automatic capacitor banks.
ReactiVar Harmonic Filtering Automatic Power Factor
Capacitor Banks Power Factor Correction and Provides power factor correction as well as harmonic filtering with
X X Harmonics Filtering specific harmonic order (5th) in industrial networks.
(AV7000/MV7000)
4
ReactiVar Transient Free Reactive Compensation Enhanced technology utilizing solid state switching elements that
Power Factor Correction and
Systems X replace standard electromechanical contactors. Provides quicker
(AT6000/AT7000) Harmonics Filtering response to load fluctuations with transient free capacitor switching.
Monitors a distorted electrical signal and determines the frequency
and magnitude of harmonics in the signal. Cancels the harmonic
AccuSine™ (PCS) Active Harmonic Filter X X [1] Active Harmonic Filtering content with the dynamic injection of opposing phase current in the
distribution system or individual load.
Reactive Power Compensation Provides real-time reactive power compensation, and voltage
ReactiVar Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC) X X [1] (Real-time) support in networks with highly cyclical load profiles.
schneider-electric.us
Table 4.45: Unfused 208 V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2] Table 4.46: Unfused 240 V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2]
Recom- Recom- Recommended circuit
Regular duty Rated Recommended circuit Regular duty Rated mended
kVAR rating mended protection kVAR rating protection
Indoor NEMA 1 Current (A) copper wire Indoor NEMA Current (A) copper
unit device rating[4] 1 unit device rating[4]
size[3] wire size[3]
@ 208 V Catalog @ 208 V Circuit @ 240 V Catalog @ 240 V AWG Fuse Circuit
AWG Fuse Number breaker
Number breaker
2 PFCD1002 6.3 14 15 15 3 PFCD2003 7.2 14 15 15
5 PFCD1005 13.6 10 30 20 6 PFCD2006 15.6 10 35 25
6 PFCD1006 17.7 10 40 25 8 PFCD2008 20.5 8 45 30
7.5 PFCD1007 20.9 8 45 30 10 PFCD2010 24.1 8 50 35
10 PFCD1010 27.1 8 60 40 13 PFCD2013 31.3 6 70 45
13 PFCD1013 35.4 6 75 50 15 PFCD2015 36.1 6 75 50
15 PFCD1015 41.7 4 90 60 17.5 PFCD2017 40.9 6 90 60
17 PFCD1017 48 4 100 70 20 PFCD2020 48.1 4 100 70
21 PFCD1021 59.4 3 125 90 22.5 PFCD2023 55.3 3 125 80
25 PFCD1025 68.8 2 150 100 25 PFCD2025 61.4 3 125 90
27 PFCD1027 75.1 2 150 110 27.5 PFCD2028 68.6 2 150 100
30 PFCD1030 83.4 1 175 125 30 PFCD2030 72.2 2 150 100
34 PFCD1033 93.8 1/0 200 150 32.5 PFCD2033 79.4 1 175 110
37.5 PFCD1037 104.3 2/0 225 150 37.5 PFCD2036 86.6 1 175 125
41 PFCD1040 114.7 2/0 250 175 40 PFCD2040 96.2 1/0 200 150
45 PFCD1045 125.1 3/0 250 175 45 PFCD2045 108.3 2/0 225 150
49 PFCD1048 135.5 4/0 300 200 50 PFCD2050 120.3 2/0 250 175
53 PFCD1053 147 4/0 300 225 60 PFCD2060 144.4 4/0 300 200
60 PFCD1060 168.9 300 kcmil 350 250 70 PFCD2070 169.6 300 kcmil 350 250
70 PFCD1070 198.1 350 kcmil 450 300 80 PFCD2080 194.9 350 kcmil 400 300
80 PFCD1080 222 500 kcmil 450 350 90 PFCD2090 218.9 400 kcmil 450 300
100 PFCD2100 239.4 500 kcmil 500 350
Table 4.47: Unfused 480V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2] Table 4.48: Unfused 600V 3 phase/ 60Hz unit [2]
Regular duty Recommend- Recommended circuit Regular Recom-
Rated duty Recommended circuit
kVAR rating Indoor ed copper protection kVAR Rated mended
Current (A) device rating[4] Indoor protection
NEMA 1 unit wire size[3] rating Current (A) copper wire
NEMA 1 device rating[4]
@ 480 V Catalog @ 480 V Circuit size[3]
AWG Fuse unit
Number breaker
6 PFCD4006 7.2 14 15 15 Catalog @ 600 V Circuit
600 V AWG Fuse
Number Breaker
8 PFCD4008 10.2 12 20 15
10 PFCD6010 9.6 12 20 15
10 PFCD4010 12 12 25 20
15 PFCD6015 14.4 10 30 20
12.5 PFCD4012 15 10 30 25
20 PFCD6020 19.2 10 40 30
15 PFCD4015 18 10 40 30
23 PFCD6022 22.1 8 50 35
17 PFCD4017 19.8 8 40 30
25 PFCD6025 24 8 50 35
20 PFCD4020 24 8 50 35
27 PFCD6027 26 8 50 40
25 PFCD4025 30 6 60 45
30 PFCD6030 28.8 8 60 45
27.5 PFCD4027 33 6 70 50
35 PFCD6035 33.6 6 70 50
30 PFCD4030 36 6 75 50
40 PFCD6040 38.4 6 80 60
33 PFCD4033 39.6 6 80 60
45 PFCD6045 43.2 4 90 60
35 PFCD4035 42 4 90 60
50 PFCD6050 48 4 100 70
40 PFCD4040 48 4 100 70
60 PFCD6060 57.6 3 125 80
45 PFCD4045 54 4 110 75
70 PFCD6070 67.2 3 150 100
50 PFCD4050 60 3 125 90
75 PFCD6075 72 2 150 100
60 PFCD4060 72 2 150 100
80 PFCD6080 76.8 1 150 110
65 PFCD4065 78 1 175 110
90 PFCD6090 86.4 1 175 125
70 PFCD4070 84 1 175 125
100 PFCD6100 96 1/0 200 150
75 PFCD4075 90 1/0 200 125
125 PFCD6125 120 3/0 250 175
80 PFCD4080 96 1/0 200 150
150 PFCD6150 144 4/0 300 200
90 PFCD4090 108 2/0 225 150
175 PFCD6175 168 300 kcmil 350 250
100 PFCD4100 120 2/0 250 175
125 PFCD4125 150 250 300 225
150 PFCD4150 180 300 400 250
175 PFCD4175 210 400 450 300
200 PFCD4200 240 500 500 350
[2] For fused unit, add suffix “F” to the existing part number. Consult Schneider Electric sales office for pricing.
[3] Conductor should be copper and rated 90 °C min. Refer to local electrical codes for proper wire size
[4] Consult local electrical codes for proper sizing of molded case circuit breaker frame or disconnect switch rating
4-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
LV Standard Automatic Capacitor Banks ReactiVar™
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
components in the electrical distribution system. Capacitors are a low impedance path
for these higher frequency components and thus absorb the harmonic energies.
Combinations of capacitors and system inductances (motors and transformers) can form
series and parallel tuned circuits which can resonate at certain frequencies. The
harmonics caused by non-linear loads can excite a standard capacitor bank into
resonance. The resonance can magnify currents and voltages, causing system wide
damage and equipment failure. This problem is growing in today's distribution systems.
The Solution: Anti-Resonant Automatic Capacitor Banks The AV6000 anti-
resonance capacitor bank's primary function is power factor correction. Iron core
reactors are added in series with the capacitor modules. The 3 phase reactors are
custom designed and manufactured under tight tolerance specifically for the AV6000.
The reactors tune the bank below the first dominant harmonic (usually the 5th, or 300
4
Hz). Below the tuning point, the system appears capacitive and thus corrects power
factor. Above the tuning point, the system appears Inductive and thus resonance is
minimized. The AV6000 design has the added advantage of removing up to 50% of the
AV 6000 Capacitor Bank 5th harmonic to reduce overall voltage distortion.
Harmonic Filtering Automatic Capacitor Banks Although the AV7000 looks identical
to the AV6000, its primary function is harmonic mitigation, with power factor correction
being a secondary benefit. The distinction between an AV6000 and an AV7000 is the
tuning point. By definition, if the tuning point of the capacitor/reactor combination is within
±10% of the target harmonic it is intended to absorb, it is referred to as a filter. If the
tuning point is outside the ±10% limit, it is referred to as an anti-resonant system.
Schneider Electric power quality solution experts should be consulted prior to
recommending AV7000 to customers.
Main Features:
• Standard offering available up to 480 kVAR at 208 V, 1200 kVAR at 480 or 600 Vac
• Capacitor modules are designed with higher than standard voltage and current ratings
to provide long life on systems with high harmonic energies. Reactors are designed to
operate at 115 °C rise over a maximum 40 °C ambient temperature.
• In addition to the standard features provided in the AV5000 systems, the reactors in
the AV6000 and AV7000 have an embedded thermistor temperature detector. The
stage will shut down and annunciate if the reactor is overheated, usually a result of
excessive harmonic energies
Application Assistance: Schneider Electric power quality experts can provide
engineering assistance for the application of capacitors in harmonic rich environments.
Specialists can assess the likelihood of application problems and arrange for more
detailed study if required. Solutions can include computer modeling and system
simulation. Our application engineers can arrange for systems studies, provide custom
engineering proposal, perform installation and commissioning, as required by the
application. Please contact Schneider Electric power quality experts or email us at
[email protected].
4-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
ReactiVar™ Current Transformer Selection Information
schneider-electric.us
CT Selection
The current transformer is located on a phase A bus or cable at the main service
entrance as illustrated in Diagram 1.
CT catalog number: TRAI• • • •SC ♦ ♦ where • • • • is current rate code of bus/cable and ♦
♦ is window size code. Codes are listed in table 4.42. e.g. TRAI1000SC07 is a CT for
1000 A bus with 7"x4" window.
Table 4.49: CT Selection Table
Current Rating of Bus/Cable Window Size
Amperes Rating Code 7" x 4" Size Code 11" x 4" Size Code
•••• ♦♦ ♦♦
300 0300 07 11
400 0400 07 11
500 0500 07 11
600 0600 07 11
750 0750 07 11
800 0800 07 11
1000 1000 07 11
1200 1200 07 11
1500 1500 07 11
1600 1600 07 11
2000 2000 07 11
2500 2500 07 11
3000 3000 07 11
3500 3500 07 11
4000 4000 07 11
5000 5000 N/A 11
6000 6000 N/A 11
4-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Fixed Capacitors ReactiVar™
schneider-electric.us
Low Voltage Capacitor Bank General Specifications
208, 240, 480, 600 Vac standard, other
Voltage:
voltages available
Ambient temperature: -5 °C to 40 °C
Average temperature <=40 °C within 24 hours, <35 °C over 1 year
limit:
Elevation: <=1800 meter (6000 feet)
Humidity: 0–95% non-condensing
Overvoltage limit: 110% maximum (continuously)
Dielectric withstand test 2.15 times rated voltage or 1000 V,
level: whichever is higher for 10s
Overcurrent limit: 135% maximum (continuously)
Incoming: Top (standard), bottom.
Main lug: Copper mechanical standard, compression
optional
Main breaker (BT): PowerPact™ with Micrologic™ trip unit. LI
standard, LSI available
Enclosure rating: NEMA 1 standard, N3R available
ANSI 49 standard, ANSI 61, ANSI 70
Color: optional
Standards: CSA C22.2 No. 190, UL810
CONTROL
Medium Voltage Fixed Capacitors
The ReactiVar MVC fixed capacitors are ideally suited for power factor correction in
applications where the load does not change or where the capacitor is switched with the
load, such as the load side of a motor contactor. ReactiVar capacitor sizes are available
up to 300 kVAR as individual units, and up to 900 kVAR in banks.
Main Features:
• Standard rating up to 900 kVAR, 4800 V (for specials, consult factory)
• Extra low dielectric loss (<0.15w/kVAR), including discharge resistors
• Internally mounted discharge resistors
• Internally delta connected capacitor elements
4
• Built to applicable NEMA, IEEE, and IEC standards
• Available in indoor (Type 1/12) and outdoor (Type 3R) enclosures
• Painted ASA 70 gray
Application Note:
Capacitors are low impedance path for the harmonic currents produced by variable
frequency drives, motor soft starters, welders, computers, PLCs, robotics and other
electronic equipment. These harmonic currents can cause the capacitor to overheat, and
shorten its life. Furthermore, the resonant circuit formed by shunt capacitors coupled with
system inductances (motors and transformers) can amplify harmonic currents and
voltages in the electrical network. This amplification can cause nuisance fuse operation
and/or damage to electrical equipment including capacitors and other electronic devices.
If power factor correction is required in the network where harmonic is present, please
contact your nearest Square D/Schneider Electric sales office for assistance.
MVC systems are suitable for
power factor correction of steady
and harmonic-free motor loads.
4-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
ReactiVar™ Medium Voltage Metal Enclosed Capacitor
Systems
schneider-electric.us
to cover project specific utility application, and installation needs. Typically these
compensation systems are open style, rack mounted, installed in utility substation areas.
Main Features:
• Custom designed and built per requested applicable standards
POWER MONITORING AND
• Inrush current limiting or tuned (anti-resonant or filtered) air core, open style reactors
4-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter AccuSine™
Class 5820
schneider-electric.us
CONTROL
or load balancing
• Full color touch screen HMI (Human Machine Interface)
• UL Type 1, UL Type 2, UL Type 12, IP31, and IP54 enclosures
• Seismic rated per ICC IBC and ASCE 7
• UL, CE, ABS, and CSA certified
AccuSine PCS+ Sizing
For proper sizing of AccuSine units, contact the Schneider Electric sales office or e-mail
[email protected]. To expedite the product selection process,
please have a single line diagram and/or details of the application including sizes of
transformers, non-linear and linear loads, and any existing filters and capacitors.
4
Table 4.50: PCS+ Active Harmonic Filter Selection
Harmonic and PF Correction (380–480 V models, 50/60 Hz)
Enclosure Information
Rated Current (A) Frequency (Hz) Catalog Number Frame Weight (kg)
Rating Style Cable Entry
PCSP060D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 1 88
PCSP060D5N2 UL Type 2
277
60 50/60 PCSP060D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 2
PCSP060D5N12 UL Type 12
280
PCSP060D5IP54 IP54
PCSP120D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 3 113
PCSP120D5N2 UL Type 2
287
120 50/60 PCSP120D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 4
PCSP120D5N12 UL Type 12
293
PCSP120D5IP54 IP54
PCSP200D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 5 171
PCSP200D5N2 UL Type 2
397
200 50/60 PCSP200D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 6
PCSP200D5N12 UL Type 12
402
PCSP200D5IP54 IP54
PCSP300D5IP00 IP00 (UL Type Open) Wall Mount Bottom 7 210
PCSP300D5N2 UL Type 2
422
300 50/60 PCSP300D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 8
PCSP300D5N12 UL Type 12
436
PCSP300D5IP54 IP54
NOTE: Contact Schneider Electric sales office for other voltage models.
4-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
AccuSine™ PFV+ Active Harmonic Filter
Class 5820
schneider-electric.us
EVCP060D5N2 UL Type 2
277
60 50/60 EVCP060D5IP31 IP31
Floor Standing Top or Bottom 2
EVCP060D5N12 UL Type 12
280
EVCP060D5IP54 IP54
CONTROL
Table 4.52: AccuSine PCS+ and AccuSine PFV+ Table 4.53: AccuSine+ Wall Mount Kits
IP20 Cable Entry
Exterior Dimensions Assembled Dimensions — IP20 Assembly Enclosure
Catalog Number
Frame Exterior Dimensions Unit Rating
(A) Height Width Depth Weight (kg) Weight (kg)
Size Height (mm) Width (mm)
1 1300 421 PCSPWMKIT60A 60 1530 421 349 97.3 8.7
2 2092 800 PCSPWMKIT120A 120 1730 421 384 122.0 9.3
3 1400 421 PCSPWMKIT300A 200 1642 575 435 180.0 8.6
4 2089 800 PCSPWMKIT300A 300 1882 575 435 218.6 8.6
5 1323 582
6 2089 900
7 1560 582
8 2092 900
4-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Current Transformers AccuSine™
Class 5820
schneider-electric.us
4-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
AccuSine™ Hybrid VAR Compensator (HVC)
Class 5890
schneider-electric.us
reactive power requirement within 1/4 cycle, reduce voltage sags created by inductive
load switching, welding operation, etc.
HVC systems can alleviate most of the problems created by cyclical loads that require
Main Features: large amount of reactive power for short duration. HVC system can be applied in the low
voltage and medium voltage system from 480 V up to 33 kV.
• Real-time reactive power compensation for
POWER MONITORING AND
transient or cyclical loads Unique, cost-effective construction: The ReactiVar HVC is a custom engineered
• Infinite VAR resolution product designed for specific reactive power compensation requirements. It consists of
both passive and active components. The passive component may consist of capacitors
• Transient free compensation
CONTROL
only or include tuned reactors. Depending on the application, the passive portion may
• Improves voltage stability, reduces flicker include contactor or solid state switching device to permit some adjustment of the
• Constructed with 12 gauge steel frame passive elements. The active component is provided by Schneider Electric’s AccuSine
PFV+ unit. HVC systems also can prevent resonance by including custom designed iron
core reactors in series with each three phase capacitor module when required. The
series reactor/capacitor combinations prevent resonance by turning the network below
the first dominant harmonic (usually the 5th and 300 Hz). In doing so, HVC can also
reduce harmonic voltage distortion, which further improves overall network conditions.
The HVC employs a fixed capacitor bank to inject leading reactive current (leading
kVAR) into the network at all times, and an AccuSine PFV+ unit to precisely adjust the
total output of the HVC according to the load reactive power demand profile. When load
reactive demand is zero, the AccuSine PFV+ injects lagging reactive current to cancel
the leading reactive current of the fixed capacitor bank such that the total output of the
HVC is minimized. As the load kVAR demand increases, the AccuSine PFV+ adjusts its
output such that the total output of the HVC precisely matches the load demand. If load
demand increases above the fixed capacitor bank capability, then the AccuSine PFV+
injects leading reactive current. This continues until the full leading kVAR capacity of the
AccuSine PFV+ is met. Thus, the HVC total output provides leading kVAR compensation
to match load demand.
To optimize system design, Schneider Electric expert will normally need to take real-time
measurements on the network site. Please contact Schneider Electric power quality
experts or email us at [email protected].
4-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks
schneider-electric.us
Key Features
• Auxiliary transformer (120 V) included
• Top cable entry and connections
• NEMA 1
Options
• Incoming circuit breaker protection option with rotary handle
• Plinth accessory for floor mounting
– Included for VLVAF4P and VLVFF4P version.
Plinth for Floor Mounting – For VLVAW2N and VLVAW3N versions, order the following:
for Enclosure VLVAW2N: order NSYSPF8100 and NSYSPS4100
for Enclosure VLVAW3N: order NSYSPF10100 and NSYSPS4100
• Communication option: NRC12 controller + modbus communication module. Order
your reference with addition of suffix C.
• Sprinkler proof: Included in 600 V offer
Table 4.55: General Characteristics
VarSet
Environment
Installation Indoor
Humidity up to 95%
Maximum altitude 2000 m
CONTROL
Steps
Step protection With circuit breaker
Electrical Characteristics
Connection type Three-phase
< 2.5 W/kVAR without detuned reactors
Power losses
< 6 W/kVAR with detuned reactors
Tuning order (VarSet Detuned) 4.2 p.u. (60 Hz ref)
Maximum permissible over voltage 1.1 x Un, 8 h every 24 h
Standards
CSA 22.2 No. 190
UL810, UL508a
Incoming Connection Short Circuit With Incoming Circuit Breaker With Lugs
Rating
65 kA (480 V)
4
From 25 to 100 KVAR/no reactors 25 kA
50 kA (600 V)
65 kA (480 V)
From 125 to 300 KVAR/no reactors 25 kA
50 kA (600 V)
65 kA (480 V)
With reactors 25 kA
50 kA (600 V)
NOTE: A Current Transformer is required for automatic Control. In order to have
automatic control, a current transformer must be ordered in addition to the PFC
bank. A current transformer (not included) is necessary to provide accurate network
information to the VarSet’s controller in order to apply the correct quantity of kVAR at
any given time. It is recommended to choose a Split Core Current Transformer
Model 270R from the following list of options.
NOTE: CT must be sized to your network and have a secondary rating of 5A. More
details on the CT can be found in document 4210CT9701.
NOTE: When selecting a CT, be sure to use proper rating factors for ambient
temperature conditions.
Table 4.56: Current Transformers
Catalog Number Current Rating (Amperes)[1]
270R-501 500:5
270R-102 1000:5
270R-152 1500:5
270R-202 2000:5
270R-302 [2] 3000:5
270R-402 [2] 4000:5
schneider-electric.us
VarSet Selection[3]
Table 4.57: 480 V/60 Hz, Low-Polluted Network Table 4.58: 600 V/60 Hz, Low-Polluted Network
Standard Catalog Numbers Standard Catalog Numbers
Power Lugs Incoming CB Power Lugs Incoming CB
25 VLVAW2N66025AA VLVAW2N66025AB 25 VLVAW2N76025AA VLVAW2N76025AB
50 VLVAW2N66050AA VLVAW2N66050AB 50 VLVAW2N76050AA VLVAW2N76050AB
75 VLVAW2N66075AA VLVAW2N66075AB 75 VLVAW2N76075AA VLVAW2N76075AB
100 VLVAW2N66100AA VLVAW2N66100AB 100 VLVAW2N76100AA VLVAW2N76100AB
125 VLVAW3N66125AA VLVAW3N66125AB 125 VLVAW3N76125AA VLVAW3N76125AB
150 VLVAW3N66150AA VLVAW3N66150AB 150 VLVAW3N76150AA VLVAW3N76150AB
175 VLVAW3N66175AA VLVAW3N66175AB 175 VLVAW3N76175AA VLVAW3N76175AB
200 VLVAW3N66200AA VLVAW3N66200AB 200 VLVAW3N76200AA VLVAW3N76200AB
225 VLVAW3N66225AA VLVAW3N66225AB 225 VLVAW3N76225AA VLVAW3N76225AB
250 VLVAW3N66250AA VLVAW3N66250AB 250 VLVAW3N76250AA VLVAW3N76250AB
275 VLVAW3N66275AB VLVAW3N66275AB
300 VLVAW3N66300AB VLVAW3N66300AB
Table 4.59: 480 V/60 Hz, Polluted Network, Detuned Reactors Table 4.60: 600 V/60 Hz, Polluted Network, Detuned Reactors
Automatic Catalog Numbers Automatic Catalog Numbers
Power Lugs Incoming CB Power Lugs Incoming CB
75 VLVAF4P66075AA VLVAF4P66075AB 75 VLVAF4P76075AA VLVAF4P76075AB
100 VLVAF4P66100AA VLVAF4P66100AB 100 VLVAF4P76100AA VLVAF4P76100AB
125 VLVAF4P66125AA VLVAF4P66125AB 125 VLVAF4P76125AA VLVAF4P76125AB
150 VLVAF4P66150AA VLVAF4P66150AB 150 VLVAF4P76150AA VLVAF4P76150AB
175 VLVAF4P66175AA VLVAF4P66175AB 175 VLVAF4P76175AA VLVAF4P76175AB
200 VLVAF4P66200AA VLVAF4P66200AB 200 VLVAF4P76200AA VLVAF4P76200AB
Fixed Catalog Numbers Fixed Catalog Numbers
Power Lugs Incoming CB Power Lugs Incoming CB
75 VLVFF4P66075AA VLVFF4P66075AB 75 VLVFF4P76075AA VLVFF4P76075AB
100 VLVFF4P66100AA VLVFF4P66100AB 100 VLVFF4P76100AA VLVFF4P76100AB
125 VLVFF4P66125AA VLVFF4P66125AB 125 VLVFF4P76125AA VLVFF4P76125AB
150 VLVFF4P66150AA VLVFF4P66150AB 150 VLVFF4P76150AA VLVFF4P76150AB
175 VLVFF4P66175AA VLVFF4P66175AB 175 VLVFF4P76175AA VLVFF4P76175AB
200 VLVFF4P66200AA VLVFF4P66200AB 200 VLVFF4P76200AA VLVFF4P76200AB
Table 4.61: Physical and Electrical Steps (480 V and 600 V/60 Hz)
Num
Type Min Step Mechanical Num Electrical Sequence Electrical Steps (Resolution)
kVAR Resolution
POWER MONITORING AND
schneider-electric.us
VLVAW2N
VLVAW3N
CONTROL
Weight 265 kg / 585 lbs.
[4] Does not include plinth for VLVAW2N and VLVAW3N, optional, which adds 100 mm to height.
4-51
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
VarSet Low-Voltage Capacitor Banks
schneider-electric.us
4
POWER MONITORING AND
CONTROL
4-52
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 5
Advanced Products
Wis e r™ Air Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions 5-2
Cone xt™ CL
ADVANCED PRODUCTS
5
11/10/2017
Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions Wiser™ Energy Efficiency Solutions
schneider-electric.us
Wiser Air
Wiser Air is a complete home energy management solution that gives you peace of mind
through effortless control of comfort and savings. Wiser Air works with most heating and
cooling low voltage systems and connects to your home Wi-Fi to allow you to see your
energy use remotely, using a smart phone, tablet, or laptop.
• Simplicity – Wiser Air is easy to install and has a sleek, intuitive design with familiar
touch screen display to keep you informed.
• Comfort – Enjoy features like Comfort Boost that quickly delivers comfort at the touch
of a button and helps you use energy more efficiently.
• Insight – See how your system is running from a distance, with Wiser Pulse that
glows a different color depending on different modes.
• Control – Control and manage your home energy use from anywhere with your smart
phone, tablet or laptop. Wiser Air is a stand-alone, Wi-Fi thermostat.
Model Faceplate Color Country of Use
WISERAIR10BLKUS Black USA
WISERAIR10WHTUS White USA
WISERAIR10BLKCA Black Canada
WISERAIR10WHTCA White Canada
Wiser Air is designed for use with HVAC systems using 24 Vac control signaling.
Connection to a WPA-2 encrypted WiFi network is necessary for communication. More
information can be found at www.wiserair.com.
Wiser Air Specifications
Unit Dimensions 4 in. (10.2 cm) H Wire Gauge 18−22 AWG (0.33−0.82
4 in. (10.2 cm) W mm²)
1.2 in. (3 cm) D
Trim Plate Dimensions 4.8 in. (12.2 cm) H Temperature Resolution: 1ºF (0.5°C)
6.3 in. (16 cm) W Control accuracy: 1ºF (0.5°
0.1 in. (0.3 cm) D C)
Cooling setpoint range: 48
5
−95°F (9−35°C)
Heating setpoint range:
45.5−92°F (7.5−33°C)
Display range: 40−95°F (5
−35°C)
Remote sensor
compatibility: 10 k NTC,
Type 2
ADVANCED PRODUCTS
5-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Solar Inverters Residential Solar Power Solutions
schneider-electric.us
ADVANCED PRODUCTS
issue and help to improve long-term reliability Enclosure Rating Type 4 (electronics) Type 4 (electronics) Type 4 (electronics)
• Designed and qualified for applications in tropical Cooling Fan cooled Fan cooled Fan cooled
environments through salt fog testing and use of Inverter Weight 119 lb. (54 kg) 119 lb. (54 kg) 137 lb. (62 kg)
conformal coating Wiring Box Weight 33 lb. (15 kg) 33 lb. (15 kg) 51 lb. (23 kg)
• SunSpect Alliance profile, wire line and wireless
(optional) communication
Inverter Dimensions
(H x W x D)
28.1 x 26.5 x 10.5 in.
(71.4 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm)
28.1 x 26.5 x 10.5 in.
(71.4 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm)
28.1 x 26.7 x 12.0 in.
(71.4 x 67.8 x 30.7 cm)
Wiring Box Dimensions 14.2 x 26.5 x 10.5 in. 14.2 x 26.5 x 10.5 in. 15.6 x 26.7 x 12.0 in.
• Easy installation and service, including pre-wired (H x W x D) (36.1 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm) (36.1 x 67.4 x 26.8 cm) (39.6 x 67.8 x 30.7 cm)
wiring box, detachable inverter, and EasyConfig -13–140°F -13–140°F -13–140°F
tool to allow for fast commissioning. Ambient Air Temp. for Operation (-20–60°C) (-20–60°C) (-20–60°C)
Max Operating Altitude w/o 6560 ft. (2000 m) 6560 ft. (2000 m) 6560 ft. (2000 m)
Derating
Relative Humidity % 4...100 condensing 4...100 condensing 4...100 condensing
Noise Emission (at 1 m distance) < 55 dBA < 55 dBA < 58 dBA
[1] An external fuse protection shall be installed if base model from available product variants is chosen.
[2] Preliminary specification. Specifications are subject to change without notice.
[3] Base model 2/1.
[4] Under unbalanced condition.
5-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential Solar Power Solutions Solar Inverters
schneider-electric.us
5-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Solar Inverters Residential Solar Power Solutions
schneider-electric.us
ADVANCED PRODUCTS
Intelligent Features Grid sell, peak load shave, generator support, prioritized consumption of battery or external DC energy
Auxiliary Port 0–12 V, maximum 250 mA DC output, selectable triggers
Off-grid AC Coupling Frequency Control
Multi-unit Operation Single and split phase: up to four units in parallel, three phase: up to 12 units in multi-cluster configuration with
external AC contractor
Regulatory Approval
Safety UL1741, CSA 107.1
EMC Directive FCC and Industry Canada Class B
Interconnect IEEE 1547 and CSA 107.1
Compatible Products
Conext XW+ Power Distribution Panel 865–1014–01
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050
Conext Automation Generator Start 865–1060
Conext MPPT 60 150 865–1030–1
Conext MPPT 80 600 865–1032
Conext ComBox 865–1058
5
Conext Battery Monitor 865–1080–01
Conext Battery Fuse Combiner Box 865–1031–01
Conext Portable Installation / Configuration Tool 865–1155–01
schneider-electric.us
• Supports AC and DC coupled off-grid and grid-tie Storage Ambient Temperature Range -40–185°F (-40–85°C)
architectures Humidity Operation / Storage < =95% RH, non-condensing
Ingress Protection Rating Indoor Only, IP20
• Intelligent functionality enables self-consumption Altitude (operating) 6562 ft. (2000 m)
with solar prioritization, peak shaving, and
assisting small generators with heavy loads Product Weight 49.0 lb. (22.3 kg) 62.0 lb. (28.1 kg) 62.0 lb. (28.1 kg)
Shipping Weight 60.0 lb. (27.2 kg) 77.1 lb. (35.0 kg) 77.1 lb. (35.0 kg)
• Monitor, troubleshoot or upgrade firmware with Product Dimensions (H x W x D) 16.5 x 13.4 x 7.6 in. (41.8 x 34.1 x 19.7 cm)
Conext ComBox
Shipping Dimensions (H x W x D) 22.0 x 17.3 x 12.6 in. (56.0 x 44.0 x 32.0 cm)
• Global support and training System Network and Remote Monitoring Available Available Available
• Replaceable boards and spare parts Warranty (Depending on the Country of
2 or 5 years 2 or 5 years 2 or 5 years
• Configures quickly into compact wall-mounted Installation)
system Part Number 865–2524 865–4024 865–4048
Regulatory Approvals
• Companion circuit breaker panels integrate Safety c(CSA) us mark, CSA C22.2 No. 107.1–01, UL1741 Ed. 2
inverter with battery bank and solar charge
controllers Compatible Products
Universal DC Distribution Panel 865–5548–01
• Mounting bracket design makes hanging inverter AC Distribution Panel (120/240 V) 865–1017
on the wall easy AC Distribution Panel (230 V) 865–1017–61
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050
Conext Automation Generator Start 865–1060
Conext ComBox 865–1058
Conext MPPT 60 150 Solar Charge 865–1030–1
Controller
Conext SW On/Off Remote Switch 865–1052
Conext SW Stacking Kit 865–1019–61 for 230 Vac, 865–1019 for 120/240 Vac
Conext Portable Installation and
Configuration Tool 865–1155–01
schneider-electric.us
ADVANCED PRODUCTS
• Available remote monitoring and configuration Part Number 865–1032
• Compatible with any brand of PV module, any
grounding method
Regulatory Approval
CSA Certified (UL1741, CSA 107.1) and CE Marked for Low
Safety Voltage Directive (EN50178)
• Stand-alone application or full integration with
Context XW inverter charger system EMC
FCC and Industry Canada (Class B), CE Marked for the
EMC Directive (EN61000-6-1, -6-3), C-Tick Compliant
• Fewer string wires Compatible Products
• Smaller AWG wire Conext XW+ Interver/Charger (230 V) XW 7048 E product no. 865-7048-61
XW 8548 E product no. 865-8548-61
• No need for combiner box or GFI circuit breaker Conext XW+ Interver/Charger (120/240 V) XW 5548 NA product no. 865-5548-01
XW 6848 NA product no. 865-6848-01
SW 2524 product no. 865-2524-61
Conext SW (230 V) SW 4024 product no. 865-4024-61
SW 4048 product no. 865-4048-61
SW 2524 product no. 865-2524
Conext SW (120 V) SW 4024 product no. 865-4024
SW 4048 product no. 865-4048
Conext System Control Panel 865–1050
5
Conext Automatic Generator Start 865–1060
Conext ComBox 865–1058
Conext Portable Installation and Configuration Tool 865–1155–01
schneider-electric.us
Section 6
Surge Protective Devices (SPDs)
Comme rcia l Applica tions
Externally Mounted SPDs 6-2
Overview 6-2
EMA Series SPDs 6-2
Replacement Modules 6-3
EBA Series SPDs 6-4
Internally Mounted SPDs 6-4
Overview 6-4
Internally Mounted—New Construction/Factory Assembled 6-4
EMA Ser ie s S P Ds Internally Mounted SPDs—Retrofit/Ready to Install 6-4
Internally Mounted—Retrofit/Ready to Install 6-5
SurgelogicTM SurgeLoc for NQ Panelboards 6-5
OEM/Assembler Kits 6-6
Nipple-Mounted SPDs 6-7
TM
S urge logic Sur ge Loc
11/10/2017
Externally Mounted SPDs Overview
Class 1310 / Refer to Catalog 1310CT0202
schneider-electric.us
• Standard. UL 1449 Type 1 SPDs can be located at any point in the electrical
system, on the line or load side of the equipment overcurrent device.
• Remote Monitor. This option displays the alarm status of the surge protective
device up to 1000 feet from the unit.
EMA Series SPDs
• Enhanced Filtering Module. Sine wave tracking circuitry provides enhanced EMI/
RFI filtering of -54 dB at 100 kHz and establishes the power surge clamping window
relative to the sine wave voltage to increase performance at distribution and branch
panel applications.
• Disconnect Switch. The integral switch provides a mechanical means to electrically
isolate the entire surge suppressor before opening the enclosure door to facilitate
servicing of the unit’s components.
6-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Replacement Modules Externally Mounted SPDs
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Replacement Modules
All module assemblies are US and Canadian UL® Recognized to UL 1449 standards.
Complies with requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA C22.2 No. 8-M1986 as
appropriate.
6 (SPDS)
MCC Surgelogic™
SPD Unit
(SPDS)
SurgelogicTM SurgeLoc
• 10 year product warranty
• 10 modes of protection
• 200 kA SCCR
• Audible alarm with enable/disable switch, dry contacts and surge counter standard
• Indicator LEDs; normal (green) and fault condition (red) for each phase
OEM/Assembler Kits
Surgelogic™ OEM/assembler kits allow manufacturers to add industry-leading surge
suppression directly to customized equipment. Manufacturers benefit from shorter wire
lengths that optimize the clamping voltage of the SPD. Products come with a backplane-
mounted SPD, mounting hardware and diagnostic display with 36-inch cables. Audible
alarm, silence switch, remote monitoring contacts, and surge counter are standard.
Available as UL 1449 Type 2 (or 1 with optional suffix in catalog number).
US and Canadian UL® Recognized to UL 1449 and UL 1283 standards. Complies with
requirements of NEC® Article 285 and CSA 22.2 No. 8-M1986 as appropriate. Complies
with UL 96A 12th Edition Master Label requirements for Lightning Protection Systems.
120 TVS1IMA12O( )
120/240 V, 1-phase,
160 TVS1IMA16O( )
3-wire + ground
240 TVS1IMA24O( )
208Y/120 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS2IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground [14] [15] 160 TVS2IMA16O( )
Wye TVS2IMA24O( )
240
240/120 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS3IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground 160 TVS3IMA16O( )
High-leg Delta TVS3IMA24O( )
240
120 TVS6IMA12O( )
240 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [14] [16] 160 TVS6IMA16O( )
Delta 240 TVS6IMA24O( )
480Y/277 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS4IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground [14] [16] 160 TVS4IMA16O( )
Wye TVS4IMA24O( )
OEM Kit 240
120 TVS5IMA12O( )
6
480 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [17] 160 TVS5IMA16O( )
Delta 240 TVS5IMA24O( )
600Y/347 V, 3-phase, 120 TVS8IMA12O( )
4-wire + ground [14] 160 TVS8IMA16O( )
Wye
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
240 TVS8IMA24O( )
120 TVS9IMA12O( )
600 V, 3-phase,
3-wire + ground [18] 160 TVS9IMA16O( )
Delta 180 TVS9IMA18O( )
( ) For a Type 1 SPD, add a “1” suffix to the catalog number.
(SPDS)
(SPDS)
• HEPD80: 5 year/$75,000 connected equipment warranty
Table 6.13: HEPD Whole House Surge Protective Devices
HEPD80MKF Description Surge Current Rating Cat. No.
HEPD80MKF 50kA Home Electronic Protective Device 50 kA HEPD50
80kA Home Electronic Protective Device 80 kA HEPD80
Flush Mount Kit for HEPD80 HEPD80MKF
6
6-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential SPDs Plug on Neutral QO™ and Homeline™ Load
Center SPDs
schneider-electric.us
HOM250PSPD • Industry First: No wires or tools required • Whole House Protection: 50 kA surge
QO250PSPD for installation current capacity per phase
• Installation Flexibility: Works on Plug-on
• LED indicates operational status
Neutral design QO or HOM loadcenters
using two-pole spaces • Peace of mind: 5 year/ $50,000
connected equipment warranty
Table 6.14: QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Surge Protective Device
Description Cat. No.
Plug on Neutral QO™ Surgebreaker QO250PSPD
Plug on Neutral Homeline™ Surgebreaker HOM250PSPD
6
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
(SPDS)
6-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Residential SPDs
Surge Protective Devices
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701
• QO2175SB for QO™ load centers, • Plug-on design requires two pole
spaces
combination devices, and NQ
panelboards • LED indicates operational status
• HOM2175SB for Homeline™ load
centers and combination devices • 22.5 kA per phase
Table 6.15: QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center Surge Protective Devices
QO217SB HOM217SB Description Cat. No.
QO™ Surgebreaker for QO and NQ QO2175SB
Homeline™ Surgebreaker HOM2175SB
6-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Residential SPDs QO™, NQ, and Homeline™ Load Center
Surge Protective Devices
Refer to Catalog 6671CT9701 schneider-electric.us
6
SURGE PROTECTIVE DEVICES
(SPDS)
6-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 7
Miniature and Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Selection Information 7-1
J-Frame L-Frame
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories 7-54
P-Frame
R-Frame
11/10/2017
Selection Information Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
[1] For dimensions for QOB2150VH, QOB3110VH, QOB3125VH and QOB3150VH, see page 7-76
[2] 2P 150–200 A requires 4P width.
[3] See the Supplemental Digest, Section 3 for 3Ø corner grounded systems.
[4] 22 kA @ 240 Vac for 3P only.
[5] 1P and 2P, 10–70 A and 3P 10–60 A only.
[6] See the Supplemental Digest Section 10 for circuit breakers with IEC ratings.
[7] HACR on QO, QOB 1P 10–70 A, 2P 15–100 A, 3P 10–100 A; QOB-VH 1P 15–70 A, 2P 15–125 A, 3P 15–100 A.
[8] Factory-installed option only.
[9] Factory-installed accessories are not available on QOB-VH 2P150 A and 3P 110–150 A.
7-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Miniature Circuit Breakers Selection Information
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
7-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
Plug-on — — — — —
Circuit
Breaker Bolt-on — — EDB EGB EJB
Type UL 489 UL1077
Unit Mount C60SP [25] C60H-DC — — —
C60BP
Number of Poles 1 2 3 1 2 3,4 1 2 1 2, 3 1 2, 3 1 2, 3
Current Range (A) 0.5–63 0.5–63 0.5–63 0.5–63 1–63 1–63 0.5–63 0.5–63 15–70 15–125 15–70 15–125 15–70 15–125
Interrupting Ratings
120 Vac 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [27] 14 [27] 14 [27] — — 25 25 65 65 100 100
UL/CSA 120/240 Vac 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [27] 14 [27] 14 [27] — — 18 25 35 65 65 100
Rating
(kA RMS) 240 Vac [28] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [26] 14 [27] 14 [27] 14 [27] — — 18 25 35 65 65 100
(50/60 Hz) 277 Vac — — — 10 [29] 10 [29] 10 [29] — — 18 18 35 35 65 65
480Y/277 Vac 10 [30] 10 [31] 10 [31] — 10 [29] 10 [29] — — — 18 — 35 — 65
48 Vdc — — — — 10 — 5 5 — — — — — —
60 Vdc 10 10 — 20 — — 5 5 — — — — — —
65 Vdc — — — — — — 5 5 — — — — — —
DC Ratings
125 Vdc — 10 — — — — 5 5 — — — — — —
250 Vdc — — — — — — 5 5 — — — — — —
500 Vdc — — — — — — — 5 [32] — — — — — —
IEC 60947-2 240 Vac 10 20 20 10 20 20 — — 20 — — — — —
(50/60 Hz)
Icu 415 Vac — 10 10 — 5 5 — — 10 — — — — —
Special Ratings
CCC X X X X X X X X — — — — — —
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X — — — — — X X X X X X
Other Standard IEC HACR
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X X X X X X X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33]
Undervoltage Trip X X X X X X X X — — — — — —
Auxiliary Switches X X X X X X X X X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33]
Alarm Switch X X X X X X X X X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33] X [33]
Handle Operators X X X X X X X X — — — — — —
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X X X X X X X X X X X X
Molded Case Switch — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
Dimensions (1P Unit Mount)
Dimensions Height 4.05 (103) 3.19 (81) 3.19 (81) 5.66 (144)
(1P Unit Mount) Width 0.71 (18) 0.71 (18) 0.71 (18) 1.42 (36) 0.98 (25)
in. (mm) Depth 2.76 (70) 2.76 (70) 2.56 (65) 4.05 (103)
Pages page 7-23 See Section 9
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.
7-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600, 800
schneider-electric.us
[34] 2P in a 3P module.
[35] 70–250 A with electronic trip system
[36] Not available with electronic trip units
[37] Dual UL and IEC ratings and CE markings on circuit breakers. For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest, Section 10.
[38] Not available in HD and HG 2P rating (2P module).
[39] 3P only.
[40] Not UL Listed due to wire bending space.
7-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Molded Case Circuit Breakers Selection Information
Class 500, 600, 800
schneider-electric.us
[41] I-Line Q-frame circuit breakers are available 70–225 A only. 250 A Q-frame unit-mount circuit breakers are limited to Cu conductors only.
[42] Not available with electronic trip units
[43] Ungrounded UPS systems only. See page 7-50. Special DC J-Frame only.
[44] Dual UL and IEC ratings and CE markings on circuit breakers. For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest, Section 10.
[45] Factory-installed option only.
[46] Requires factory-installed “G” shunt trip and 3P module.
[47] Enclosure rating 1, 3R, 5 and 12.,
7
7-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 600, 612, 800
schneider-electric.us
Pages page 7-71 and Catalog 0613CT0001 page 7-71 and Catalog 0613CT0001
NOTE: All circuit breakers on this chart are UL Listed and CSA Certified unless otherwise noted.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[52] Tested to show arc flash hazard risk category as reference by NFPA70E.
[53] See Catalog 0613CT0001 for additional ratings and other information.
7
7-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selection Information Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600, 800
schneider-electric.us
IEC 50/60 Hz For additional IEC ratings, see the Supplemental Digest
Section 10.
Special Ratings
CCC — — —
Fed. Specs W-C-375B/GEN X X X
HACR (2P, 3P) — X X
Connections/Terminations
Unit Mount X X X
I-Line™ X X X
Rear Connection X X X
Drawout — — —
Optional Lugs X X X
Accessories and Modifications
Shunt Trip X X X
Undervoltage Trip X X X
Auxiliary Switches X X X
Alarm Switch X X X
Motor Operator X X X
Handle Operators X X X
Mechanical Interlocks (3P) — X [57] X [57]
Handle Padlock Attachment X X X
Cylinder Lock (3P) [54] X X X
Optional GF Protection [58] — — —
Trip System Type
Thermal-magnetic X X X
Instantaneous-only (MCP) — X X
Molded Case Switch (Automatic) — — X
Electronic — — —
Enclosures (page 7-76–page 7-78)
General Purpose (NEMA 1) X X X
Raintight (NEMA 3R) X X X
Dust-tight (NEMA 12) X X X
Watertight (NEMA 4, 4X, 5) X X X
Explosion Proof (NEMA 7, 9) — — —
Dimensions Height 11 (279)
(3P Unit Mount) Width 6 (152)
in. (mm) Depth 5.84 (148)
7
QO2200 2P 200 A
4 Spaces Required
[1] See Digest Section 1 for load centers, and Section 9 for panelboards and interiors.
[2] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[3] UL Listed 5 k AIR on corner grounded Delta systems.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[6] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu.) Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[7] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[8] Order only. Contact your local Field Office.
[9] UL Listed for use ahead of QO, QO-GFI, QO-EPD, QOT, QO-AFI, and QO-PL 10 k AIR circuit breakers to permit their application at 22 kA fault level.
[10] 100 A maximum branch mounted opposite.
7
7-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 730, 731, 733 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us
QOT 1P Tandem
Replacement Tandem Circuit Breakers Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030
1 Space Required and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.
[11] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[12] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[13] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[14] Includes two circuit breakers (one QO2030 and one QO3020) and handle tie QOTHT.
7-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us
1P QO-DF 1P QO-DF
Plug-on Neutral Pigtail
QO-GFI
Qwik-Gard™ circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection, combined with
Class A ground fault protection. Class A denotes a ground fault circuit interrupter that will
trip when a fault current to ground is 6 mA or more, for people protection. Do not connect
to more than 250 feet of load conductor for the total one-way run to prevent nuisance
tripping.
QO-EPD/EPE
QO-EPD/EPE circuit breakers provide overload and short circuit protection combined
with Class B ground fault protection. They are designed to provide ground fault
protection of equipment at a 30 mA level (EPD) or 100 mA level (EPE). They are not
designed to protect people from electrical shock.
[15] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[16] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
[17] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[18] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[19] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[20] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[21] See note in Instruction Bulletin when using in an enclosure with a QO403 or QON prefix.
[22] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
7
7-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QO Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 685, 690, 730, 912, 950 / Refer to Catalog: 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us
QO-SWN
Switch Neutral Common Trip 2008 NEC® 514.11
QO-HID
HID circuit breakers are for use on circuits feeding fluorescent and high intensity
discharge (HID) lighting systems such as mercury vapor, metal halide, or high pressure
sodium. These circuit breakers are physically interchangeable with QO circuit breakers.
QO-K
Key operated QO circuit breakers are available in single-pole construction and can be
mounted in any single-pole space which will accept a standard QO. These circuit
breakers can be turned ON or OFF or to RESET with a special key (catalog number
QOK10) included with the circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are UL Listed and
available as shown in the table.
Table 7.12: QO-K Circuit Breakers
120 Vac—10 k AIR (1 Space Required)
Ampere Ampere
Rating [23] Cat. No. Rating [23] Cat. No.
10 QO110K
QO115K 25 QO125K
15 30 QO130K
20 QO120K
QO-K Key Operated
QO-HM
High magnetic trip circuit breakers are recommended for applications where high initial
inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.
[23] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[24] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[25] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[26] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
7-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 1130 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
Trips the circuit breaker from a Monitors circuit breaker contact status and
remote location by means of a trip provides a remote signal indicating the circuit
coil energized from a separate breaker contacts are OPEN or CLOSED.
120
circuit. A 120 Vac shunt trip will Application
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[27] Not suitable for use in 3Ø panels. Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
7
7-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QO™ Mounting Bases
Class 652 / Catalog 0730CT9801, 0860CT0201
schneider-electric.us
QO Mounting Bases
Table 7.17: QO OEM Mounting Bases—UL Recognized Components
Main Lug 1P Max. No. Mounting Bases Main Wire Size
Voltage System
Rating Spaces 1P Cat. No. AWG/kcmil
QO Plug-On Mounting Bases—For unit mounting QO, QO-GFI, QO-AFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers
70 A 2 2 QON2L70 14–4 Cu, 12–3 Al
125 A 4 4 SK9948BW 12–1/0 Cu/Al
125 A 4 4 SK9842 12–1/0 Cu/Al
1Ø2W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC
(Without Neutral Assembly) 125 A 6 6 SK9795 12–1/0 Cu/Al
125 A 6 6 SK9801 12–1/0 Cu/Al
150 A 6 6 SK9796BW 8–3/0 Cu/Al
150 A 8 8 SK9797 8–3/0 Cu/Al
40 A 2 2 QON2L40 14–6 Cu, 12–6 Al
70 A 2 4 QON24L70 14–4 Cu, 12–3 Al
SN12125 100 A 6 12 QON612L100 8–1/0 Cu/Al
100 A 8 16 QON816L100 8–1/0 Cu/Al
100 A 12 12 QON12L100 12–2/0 Cu/Al
100 A 12 12 QON12L100SF[28] 6–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 12 12 QON112L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 12 24 QON11224L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 16 16 QON116L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 16 24 QON11624L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
1Ø3W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC 125 A 20 20 QON120L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 24 24 QON124L125I 6–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 32 32 QON132L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 20 24 QON12024L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
150 A 24 24 QON124L150I 4–250 Cu/Al
200 A 12 12 QON124L200I 4–250 Cu/Al
200 A 12 12 QON12L200FTL [28] 4–250 Cu/Al
QON2L40
200 A 24 24 QON124L200I 4–250 Cu/Al
200 A 24 24 QON124L200DL [28] (2) 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 30 30 QON130L200I 4–250 Cu/Al
225 A 42 42 QON142L225I 4–300 Cu/Al
125 A 12 12 QON312L125 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 20 20 QON320L125 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 24 24 QON324L125 4–2/0 Cu/Al
3Ø3W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC
(Without Neutral Assy.) 200 A 18 18 QON318L200 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 24 24 QON324L200 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 30 30 QON330L200 4–300 Cu/Al
225 A 42 42 QON342L225 4–300 Cu/Al
60 A 3 3 QON403L60N 12–6 Cu/Al
125 A 12 12 QON312L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
125 A 20 20 QON320L125I [29] 4–2/0 Cu/Al
3Ø4W 240 Vac Max. 125 A 24 24 QON324L125I 4–2/0 Cu/Al
10 k AIC 200 A 18 18 QON318L200I 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 24 24 QON324L200I 4–300 Cu/Al
200 A 30 30 QON330L200I [29] 4–300 Cu/Al
225 A 42 42 QON342L225I 4–300 Cu/Al
QO Plug-On Mounting Bases—For unit mounting QO, QO-GFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers
1Ø2W 240 Vac Max. 10 k AIC 70 A 1 1 QOMB1 14–4 Cu 12–2 Al
(Without Neutral Assembly) 70 A 2 2 QOMB2 14–4 Cu 12–2 Al
70 A 3 3 QOMB3 14–4 Cu 12–2 Al
QOB Bolt-On Mounting Bases—For unit mounting QOB, QOB-GFI, QOB-EPD circuit breakers
3Ø3W 240 Vac Max.10 k AIC
100 A 3 3 QON3B 12–1 Cu/Al
QON120L1251 (Without Neutral Assembly)
Main lug kit for US mounting bases, 1 lug per kit, for 6 AWG to 300 kcmil cable USMBLK
Terminal cover for US mounting base; provides IP20 ingress protection per IEC 60529; suitable for
jumper bars or cable USMBTC
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QO™ and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers / QYU
Supplementary Protectors
Class 720 / Refer to Catalog 0730CT9801 schneider-electric.us
7-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QOU Accessories Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 720 / Refer to Catalog 0730CT9801
schneider-electric.us
QOU Accessories
Table 7.25: Accessories for QOU Low Ampere Circuit Breakers (Except as Noted)
Order
Description Qty. Cat. No.
Factory-installed ring tongue terminal, 10–32 screw, for 1P, 2P, 3P QOU, 10–60 A — Suffix -5283
Hex drive 5/32 in. wire binding screw for QOU — Suffix -5280
For padlocking 1P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF or ON position — QOU1PA
For padlocking 2P and 3P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF or ON position — QOU1PL
For padlocking 1P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF position only — QOU1PAFLA
For padlocking 2P and 3P low ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF position only — QOU2PAFLA
For padlocking 2P and 3P high ampere QOU circuit breaker in OFF position only — Suffix -7100
Handle lock-out, ON or OFF position — HLO1
4P 100 A Jumper bar assy. w/front wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU14100JBAF
4P 100 A Jumper bar assy. w/right side wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU14100JBAR
4P 100 A Jumper bar assy. w/left side wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU14100JBAL
1Ø, 4P, 100 A Jumper bar base with front wiring 40 QOU14100BAFB
1Ø, 4P, 100 A Jumper bar base with left side wiring 40 QOU14100BALB
1Ø, 4P, 100 A Jumper bar base with right side wiring 40 QOU14100BARB
QOU14100JBAF
4P Jumper bar cover 40 QOU14100CAB
Mounting screw for jumper bar cover 40 QOU1CMSB
6P 150 A Jumper bar assy. w/front wiring with base, cover and screw 1 QOU16150JBAF
1Ø, 6P, 150 A Jumper bar base with front wiring 40 QOU16150BAFB
1Ø, 6P, 150 A Jumper bar base with left side wiring 40 QOU16150BALB
1Ø, 6P, 150 A Jumper bar base with right side wiring 40 QOU16150BARB
6P jumper bar cover 40 QOU16150CAB
Vertical rainproof cover 2P and 3P QO, QOU, FA and KA 1 BCV [32]
10 BCVB [32]
Horizontal rainproof cover 2P QO, QOU, and 3P Q2, EH 1 BCH [32]
10 BCHB [32]
1P Fingersafe™ cover for high ampere QOU circuit breaker 1 QOUHFSC1
40 QOUHFSC1B
1P Fingersafe cover for low ampere QOU circuit breaker 1 QOULFSC1
40 QOULFSC1B
Cover plate for one 2P QOU circuit breaker 1 QOUCP2
40 QOUCP2B
2P DIN-Mounted QOU Circuit Breaker
Cover plate for one 3P QOU circuit breaker 1 QOUCP3
40 QOUCP3B
Cover plate for two 2P QOU circuit breakers 1 QOUCP4
40 QOUCP4B
Cover plate for three 2P QOU circuit breakers 1 QOUCP6
40 QOUCP6B
Field-installable ring tongue terminal adaptor 1 QOURT
80 QOURTB
Quick connector end connection wiring 1 QOUEC
40 QOUECB
Quick connector forward or reverse wiring 1 QOUFR
Mounting Foot 40 QOUFRB
QOUMF1 1P QOU mounting foot 1 QOUMF1[32]
80 QOUMF1B [32]
2P QOU mounting foot 1 QOUMF2 [32]
40 QOUMF2B [32]
3P QOU mounting foot 1 QOUMF3 [32]
24 QOUMF3B [32]
Tapped mounting foot for QOU, 1P and 2P 10–70 A, 3P 10–60 A
Packaged with circuit breaker Suffix -3100
Individually packaged 1 QOUMFS1
Bulk packed 80 QOUMFS1B
Mechanical interlock attachment: Used to interlock two circuit breakers mounted
side-by-side so that only one circuit breaker can be ON at a time. A 1P or 2P circuit
breaker can be mounted on the left and interlocked with a 2P or 3P circuit breaker 1 QOU2DTILA [33]
on the right.
The QOU uses the same electrical accessories as the QO. See the QO information for available electrical
accessories.
7-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
[1] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated. Suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[2] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[3] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
[4] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[5] For 120/240 V only, not for 208Y/120 V.
7-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-On Circuit Breakers Homeline™ Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
[6] 15– 20 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 25– 50 A tandem or quad tandem circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC
conductors only.
[7] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating and refrigeration equipment haing motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
7
7-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Homeline™ Circuit Breakers Plug-On Circuit Breakers
Class 1170 / Refer to Catalog 1100CT0501
schneider-electric.us
[8] 15–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60oC or 75oC conductors. 40–125 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75oC conductors.
[9] 50–125 A QOM1 frame size; 100–225 A QOM2 frame size.
[10] Requires four spaces (1 AWG–300 kcmil Al/Cu). Use only in 1Ø panel rated 150 A or greater.
7-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
C60BP and C60BPR Circuit Breakers Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us
C60BPR 1P
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
C60BPR 2P
C60BPR 3P
7
7-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers C60SP Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us
7-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
C60H-DC Circuit Breakers Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us
7-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers GFP Ground Fault Protectors
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us
63 26 30 M9R81263 —
4P
26 30 — M9R81425
25 86 100 — M9R12425
260 300 — M9R84425
26 30 — M9R81440
40
260 300 — M9R84440 8
26 30 — M9R81463
63
86 100 — M9R12463
86 100 — M9R12491
100
260 300 — M9R84491
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9 Circuit Breakers Busbar Offer Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us
7-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers Multi 9 Circuit Breakers Busbar Offer
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog LVCATM9OEM_EN
schneider-electric.us
Function
• The comb busbars make it easier to install Schneider Electric circuit breakers UL1077
supplementary protection.
• The Tooth Caps are insulated protectors which may be
slipped onto the unused teeth of the comb busbar.
• Power supply directly in the cage of the circuit breaker. • They come in strips with 1-pole spacing, but can be
snapped apart to be used individually.
Number of poles 1P 2P 3P All
Voltage rating (Ue) 480Y/277 Vac 480Y/277 Vac 480Y/277 Vac —
Catalogue numbers 10285 10286 10287 60488
Number of 18 mm modules 12 (8.5 in./216 mm) 12 (8.5 in./216 mm) 12 (8.5 i./216 mm) —
Set of 1 1 1 20
Technical Specifications
Insulation voltage (Ui) 690 Vac —
Impulse withstand voltage 12 kV under 240 V —
(Uimp) 5 kV under 480Y/277 V or 277 V
Acceptable current at 40°C 63 A with 1 central power supply point 100 A with 2 power supply points —
(Ie) —
7-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
C60 Accessories Multi 9™ Miniature Circuit Breakers
Class 860 / Refer to Catalog 0860CT0201
schneider-electric.us
Ring Tongue
Terminal Kit Spacer
SD OF MX MN
Auxiliary Shunt trip + Aux Undervoltage C60
Alarm Switch
Switch Switch Release
C60 Padlock
Attachment Heavy-Duty Padlock Table 7.43: Multi 9 C60 Electrical Accessories
Attachment Control Voltage Width in 9 mm C60 UL/IEC
Descriptions
Vac Vdc Modules Cat. No.
OF Auxiliary Switch (1a1b) 12–277 12–125 1 M9A26924
SD Alarm Switch (1a1b) 12–277 12–125 1 M9A26927
24 24 2 M9A26948
MX Shunt Trip + OF Auxiliary
Switch (1a1b) 48 48 2 M9A26947
110–240–277 125 2 M9A26946
24 24 2 M9A27108
48 48 2 M9A26961
MN Undervoltage Release
120 — 2 M9A27107
240 — 2 M9A26960
Multi-9 GFP UL 1053 Listed 120 to 480Y/277 Vac; 30, 100, and 300 mA; 2P and 4Ps.
Ground Fault Protectors See Multi 9 GFP Ground Fault Protectors, page 7-26 or Catalog LVCATM9OEM_
EN
Rotary Handle
Table 7.44: Multi 9 C60 Mechanical Accessories
Descriptions C60 Cat. No.
Ring tongue terminal kit for UL1077 C60 For one pole M9A17400
Spacer for DIN rail, Not UL Recognized 9 mm wide 27062
Padlock Attachment (1 per for 1P, 2P, 3P or 4P) 2 per pack 26970
Heavy-duty Padlock Attachment for C60, Locks OFF only 2 per pack M9PAF
Padlocking Device Left Side Mount, Locks OFF only [1] MGN26380
1 per pack
Padlocking Device Right Side Mount, Locks OFF only [2] MGN26381
1P MG26983
Front Mounting Kit for C60
1P, 2P, 3P, 4P 2P MG26984
Front Mounting Kit
(1 per circuit breaker) 3P MG26985
4P MG26989
Terminal Screw Shield (Not UL Recognized) Bag of two 26981
4P shields
1P 26975
2P 26976
Terminal cover (Not UL Recognized) 26975 +
3P
26976
4P 26978
Rotary Handle for C60 (Non UL Recognized)
Operating Subassembly 27046
Door Interlock Handle 2P/3P/4P 27047
Fixed Handle (Front or Lateral) 27048
Multi-pole Front Mounting Kit
Rail Support (20 of 9 mm modules) 14211
MGN26380 Locking MGN26380 Locking Hinged Transparent Cover 14210
Device Left Side Mount Device Right Side Mount
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
Multi-Pole
Front Mounting Kit
[1] Left-side mounted padlocking device cannot be used in conjunction with accessories SD, OF, MX or MN. Use right-side mounted padlocking device when accessories are required.
[2] Right-side mounted padlocking device cannot be used in conjunction with VIGI module. Use left-side mounted padlocking device when VIGI Module is required.
7
7-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers PowerPact Family
Class 611, 612
schneider-electric.us
Electronic Trip
Version
Electronic Trip
Version
Description
B-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-31
H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-32
Q-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-36
L-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-37
P-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-39
R-Frame Circuit Breakers, page 7-40
PowerPact™ H- and J-Frame Electronic Motor Circuit Protectors, page 7-42
7
Motor Circuit Protectors and Motor Protector Circuit Breakers, page 7-45
Automatic Switches, page 7-49
500 Vdc Circuit Breakers, page 7-50
Mission Critical Circuit Breakers, page 7-52
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
B-Frame
Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit
Table 7.47: PowerPact B-Frame 125 A Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers (600Y/347 Vac) with EverLink Lugs
Cur- Interrupting Rating
rent D G J K
Rat- 2 Pole 3 Pole 4 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole 4 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole 4 Pole 2 Pole
ing @ 1 Pole 1 Pole 1 Pole 1 Pole
600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347 600Y/347
40o C 347 Vac 347 Vac 347 Vac 347 Vac
Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac Vac
15 A BDL16015 BDL26015 BDL36015 BDL46015 BGL16015 BGL26015 BGL36015 BGL46015 BJL16015 BJL26015 BJL36015 BJL46015 BKL16015 BKL26015
20 A BDL16020 BDL26020 BDL36020 BDL46020 BGL16020 BGL26020 BGL36020 BGL46020 BJL16020 BJL26020 BJL36020 BJL46020 BKL16020 BKL26020
25 A BDL16025 BDL26025 BDL36025 BDL46025 BGL16025 BGL26025 BGL36025 BGL46025 BJL16025 BJL26025 BJL36025 BJL46025 BKL16025 BKL26025
30 A BDL16030 BDL26030 BDL36030 BDL46030 BGL16030 BGL26030 BGL36030 BGL46030 BJL16030 BJL26030 BJL36030 BJL46030 BKL16030 BKL26030
35 A BDL16035 BDL26035 BDL36035 BDL46035 BGL16035 BGL26035 BGL36035 BGL46035 BJL16035 BJL26035 BJL36035 BJL46035 — —
40 A BDL16040 BDL26040 BDL36040 BDL46040 BGL16040 BGL26040 BGL36040 BGL46040 BJL16040 BJL26040 BJL36040 BJL46040 — —
45 A BDL16045 BDL16045 BDL36045 BDL46045 BGL16045 BGL26045 BGL36045 BGL46045 BJL16045 BJL26045 BJL36045 BJL46045 — —
50 A BDL16050 BDL26050 BDL36050 BDL46050 BGL16050 BGL26050 BGL36050 BGL46050 BJL16050 BJL26050 BJL36050 BJL46050 — —
60 A BDL16060 BDL26060 BDL36060 BDL46060 BGL16060 BGL26060 BGL36060 BGL46060 BJL16060 BJL26060 BJL36060 BJL46060 — —
70 A BDL16070 BDL26070 BDL36070 BDL46070 BGL16070 BGL26070 BGL36070 BGL46070 BJL16070 BJL26070 BJL36070 BJL46070 — —
80 A BDL16080 BDL26080 BDL36080 BDL46080 BGL16080 BGL26080 BGL36080 BGL46080 BJL16080 BJL26080 BJL36080 BJL46080 — —
90 A BDL16090 BDL26090 BDL36090 BDL46090 BGL16090 BGL26090 BGL36090 BGL46090 BJL16090 BJL26090 BJL36090 BJL46090 — —
100 A BDL16100 BDL26100 BDL36100 BDL46100 BGL16100 BGL26100 BGL36100 BGL46100 BJL16100 BJL26100 BJL36100 BJL46100 — —
110 A BDL16110 BDL26110 BDL36110 BDL46110 BGL16110 BGL26110 BGL36110 BGL46110 BJL16110 BJL26110 BJL36110 BJL46110 — —
125 A BDL16125 BDL26125 BDL36125 BDL46125 BGL16125 BGL26125 BGL36125 BGL46125 BJL16125 BJL26125 BJL36125 BJL46125 — —
Table 7.48: B-Frame Termination Options Table 7.49: B-Frame Interrupting Ratings
Interrupting Rating
Termination Letter Voltage
A = I-Line (See Section 9) BDL36100 D G J K
For factory-installed 240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 100 kA
F = No Lugs (includes terminal nut kit on both
ends) termination, place 480/277 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA
termination letter in 480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 65 kA
L =EverLink Lugs both ends the third block of the 600Y/347 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA
M = Lugs ON end Terminal Nut Kit OFF end circuit breaker catalog
number.
P = Lugs OFF end Terminal Nut Kit ON end Table 7.51: PowerPact B-Frame 125 A Magnetic Trip Values
Current Rating @ Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Table 7.50: B-Frame Lug Options 40o C Hold Trip
Lug Option Suffix 15 A 400 A 600 A
No Suffix = EverLink Lugs both ends B D L 3 6 1 0 0 LU 20 A 400 A 600 A
LU = EverLink Lug with Control Wire For factory-installed 25 A 400 A 600 A
Terminal ON end; EverLink Lug OFF end lug option, place suffix 30 A 400 A 600 A
after the amperage in
LV = EverLink Lug ON end; EverLink Lug the circuit breaker 35 A 400 A 600 A
with Control Wire Terminal OFF end catalog number. 40 A 400 A 600 A
LW = EverLink Lug with Control Wire 45 A 400 A 600 A
Terminal both ends 50 A 480 A 720 A
LC = Copper Mechanical Lugs both ends 60 A 640 A 960 A
LH = Aluminum Mechanical Lugs both ends 70 A 640 A 960 A
80 A 800 A 1200 A
90 A 1000 A 1500 A
100 A 1000 A 1500 A
110 A 1000 A 1500 A
125 A 1000 A 1500 A
7-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
HD and HG 2P
Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit H-Frame
(2P HJ, HL in 3P module) Thermal-Magnetic Trip Unit
Table 7.52: H-Frame 150 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting [5] Circuit Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) [6] With Factory Sealed Trip Unit
Suitable for Reverse Connection [7]
Interrupting Rating
Current Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
D G J [6] L [6]
Rating @
40o C Standard Standard Standard Standard
Hold Trip (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated
H-Frame, 150A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc [8]
15 A 350 A 750 A HDL26015 HDL26015C HGL26015 HGL26015C HJL26015 HJL26015C HLL26015 HLL26015C
20 A 350 A 750 A HDL26020 HDL26020C HGL26020 HGL26020C HJL26020 HJL26020C HLL26020 HLL26020C
25 A 350 A 750 A HDL26025 HDL26025C HGL26025 HGL26025C HJL26025 HJL26025C HLL26025 HLL26025C
30 A 350 A 750 A HDL26030 HDL26030C HGL26030 HGL26030C HJL26030 HJL26030C HLL26030 HLL26030C
35 A 400 A 850 A HDL26035 HDL26035C HGL26035 HGL26035C HJL26035 HJL26035C HLL26035 HLL26035C
40 A 400 A 850 A HDL26040 HDL26040C HGL26040 HGL26040C HJL26040 HJL26040C HLL26040 HLL26040C
45 A 400 A 850 A HDL26045 HDL26045C HGL26045 HGL26045C HJL26045 HJL26045C HLL26045 HLL26045C
50 A 400 A 850 A HDL26050 HDL26050C HGL26050 HGL26050C HJL26050 HJL26050C HLL26050 HLL26050C
60 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26060 HDL26060C HGL26060 HGL26060C HJL26060 HJL26060C HLL26060 HLL26060C
70 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26070 HDL26070C HGL26070 HGL26070C HJL26070 HJL26070C HLL26070 HLL26070C
80 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26080 HDL26080C HGL26080 HGL26080C HJL26080 HJL26080C HLL26080 HLL26080C
90 A 800 A 1450 A HDL26090 HDL26090C HGL26090 HGL26090C HJL26090 HJL26090C HLL26090 HLL26090C
100 A 800 A 1700 A HDL26100 HDL26100C HGL26100 HGL26100C HJL26100 HJL26100C HLL26100 HLL26100C
110 A 900 A 1700 A HDL26110 HDL26110C HGL26110 HGL26110C HJL26110 HJL26110C HLL26110 HLL26110C
125 A 900 A 1700 A HDL26125 HDL26125C HGL26125 HGL26125C HJL26125 HJL26125C HLL26125 HLL26125C
150 A 900 A 1700 A HDL26150 HDL26150C HGL26150 HGL26150C HJL26150 HJL26150C HLL26150 HLL26150C
H-Frame 150A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
15 A 350 A 750 A HDL36015 HDL36015C HGL36015 HGL36015C HJL36015 HJL36015C HLL36015 HLL36015C
20 A 350 A 750 A HDL36020 HDL36020C HGL36020 HGL36020C HJL36020 HJL36020C HLL36020 HLL36020C
25 A 350 A 750 A HDL36025 HDL36025C HGL36025 HGL36025C HJL36025 HJL36025C HLL36025 HLL36025C
30 A 350 A 750 A HDL36030 HDL36030C HGL36030 HGL36030C HJL36030 HJL36030C HLL36030 HLL36030C
35 A 400 A 850 A HDL36035 HDL36035C HGL36035 HGL36035C HJL36035 HJL36035C HLL36035 HLL36035C
40 A 400 A 850 A HDL36040 HDL36040C HGL36040 HGL36040C HJL36040 HJL36040C HLL36040 HLL36040C
45 A 400 A 850 A HDL36045 HDL36045C HGL36045 HGL36045C HJL36045 HJL36045C HLL36045 HLL36045C
50 A 400 A 850 A HDL36050 HDL36050C HGL36050 HGL36050C HJL36050 HJL36050C HLL36050 HLL36050C
60 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36060 HDL36060C HGL36060 HGL36060C HJL36060 HJL36060C HLL36060 HLL36060C
70 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36070 HDL36070C HGL36070 HGL36070C HJL36070 HJL36070C HLL36070 HLL36070C
80 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36080 HDL36080C HGL36080 HGL36080C HJL36080 HJL36080C HLL36080 HLL36080C
90 A 800 A 1450 A HDL36090 HDL36090C HGL36090 HGL36090C HJL36090 HJL36090C HLL36090 HLL36090C
100 A 800 A 1700 A HDL36100 HDL36100C HGL36100 HGL36100C HJL36100 HJL36100C HLL36100 HLL36100C
110 A 900 A 1700 A HDL36110 HDL36110C HGL36110 HGL36110C HJL36110 HJL36110C HLL36110 HLL36110C
125 A 900 A 1700 A HDL36125 HDL36125C HGL36125 HGL36125C HJL36125 HJL36125C HLL36125 HLL36125C
150 A 900 A 1700 A HDL36150 HDL36150C HGL36150 HGL36150C HJL36150 HJL36150C HLL36150 HLL36150C
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[5] Circuit breakers with J and L interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[6] Standard lug kit: AL150HD. Terminal wire range: 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[7] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[8] HD and HG circuit breakers are true two-pole construction.
7-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.53: J-Frame 250 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting [9] Circuit Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit
Suitable for Reverse Connection [10]
Adjustable AC Interrupting Rating
Current Magnetic Trip
Rating D G J [9] L [9] R [9]
@ 40oC High Standard Standard Standard Standard Standard
Low (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated (80% Rated) 100% Rated
J-Frame 250A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A[11] 750 A 1500 A JDL26150 JDL26150C JGL26150 JGL26150C JLL26150 JLL26150C JLL26150 JLL26150C — —
175 A[11] 875 A 1750 A JDL26175 JDL26175C JGL26175 JGL26175C JLL26175 JLL26175C JLL26175 JLL26175C — —
200 A[12] 1000 A 2000 A JDL26200 JDL26200C JGL26200 JGL26200C JLL26200 JLL26200C JLL26200 JLL26200C — —
225 A[12] 1125 A 2250 A JDL26225 JDL26225C JGL26225 JGL26225C JLL26225 JLL26225C JLL26225 JLL26225C — —
250 A[12] 1250 A 2500 A JDL26250 JDL26250C JGL26250 JGL26250C JLL26250 JLL26250C JLL26250 JLL26250C — —
J-Frame 250A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
150 A[11] 750 A 1500 A JDL36150 JDL36150C JGL36150 JGL36150C JJL36150 JJL36150C JLL36150 JLL36150C JRL36150 JRL36150C
175 A[11] 875 A 1750 A JDL36175 JDL36175C JGL36175 JGL36175C JJL36175 JJL36175C JLL36175 JLL36175C JRL36175 JRL36175C
200 A[12] 1000 A 2000 A JDL36200 JDL36200C JGL36200 JGL36200C JJL36200 JJL36200C JLL36200 JLL36200C JRL36200 JRL36200C
225 A[12] 1125 A 2250 A JDL36225 JDL36225C JGL36225 JGL36225C JJL36225 JJL36225C JLL36225 JLL36225C JRL36225 JRL36225C
250 A[12] 1250 A 2500 A JDL36250 JDL36250C JGL36250 JGL36250C JJL36250 JJL36250C JLL36250 JLL36250C JRL36250 JRL36250C
[9] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[10] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[11] Standard lug kit: AL175JD. Terminal wire range: 4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[12] Standard lug kit: AL250JD. Terminal wire range: 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
7
7-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
5 .2 E
.9 5 .9 6
0 .9 4 .9 7
>11
>30 .9 3 .9 8
.9 2
% Ir 1
.9 Io )
>30
A Ir 4( x
M icor lo g ic
5
3 6
2 .5 8
2 10
1 .5 x Ir )
Is d(
H-Frame
Micrologic™ Trip Unit J-Frame H-Frame Circuit Breaker
Micrologic Trip Unit Optional FDM and IFM Module
Table 7.56: H-Frame 150 A and J-Frame 250 A Electronic Trip UL Current-Limiting [13] Standard (80% Rated) Circuit Breakers (600 Vac)
With Factory Sealed Trip Unit [14] Suitable for Reverse Connection [15]
Electronic Trip Unit Interrupting Rating (80% Rated)
Sensor Rating
Type Function Trip Unit D G J [13] L [13] R [13]
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
60 A [17] HDL36060U31X HGL36060U31X HJL36060U31X HLL36060U31X HRL36060U31X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U31X HGL36100U31X HJL36100U31X HLL36100U31X HRL36100U31X
LI 3.2 [16]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150U31X HGL36150U31X HJL36150U31X HLL36150U31X HRL36150U31X
250 A [18] JDL36250U31X JGL36250U31X JJL36250U31X JLL36250U31X JRL36250U31X
60 A [17] HDL36060U33X HGL36060U33X HJL36060U33X HLL36060U33X HRL36060U33X
Micrologic 3.2S [16] 100 A [17] HDL36100U33X HGL36100U33X HJL36100U33X HLL36100U33X HRL36100U33X
LSI [19]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150U33X HGL36150U33X HJL36150U33X HLL36150U33X HRL36150U33X
250 A [18] JDL36250U33X JGL36250U33X JJL36250U33X JLL36250U33X JRL36250U33X
60 A [17] HDL36060U43X HGL36060U43X HJL36060U43X HLL36060U43X HRL36060U43X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U43X HGL36100U43X HJL36100U43X HLL36100U43X HRL36100U43X
LSI 5.2A
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150U43X HGL36150U43X HJL36150U43X HLL36150U43X HRL36150U43X
250 A [18] JDL36250U43X JGL36250U43X JJL36250U43X JLL36250U43X JRL36250U43X
60 A [17] HDL36060U53X HGL36060U53X HJL36060U53X HLL36060U53X HRL36060U53X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U53X HGL36100U53X HJL36100U53X HLL36100U53X HRL36100U53X
Energy LSI 5.2E
150 A [17] HDL36150U53X HGL36150U53X HJL36150U53X HLL36150U53X HRL36150U53X
250 A [18] JDL36250U53X JGL36250U53X JJL36250U53X JLL36250U53X JRL36250U53X
60 A [17] HDL36060U44X HGL36060U44X HJL36060U44X HLL36060U44X HRL36060U44X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U44X HGL36100U44X HJL36100U44X HLL36100U44X HRL36100U44X
LSIG 6.2A [20]
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150U44X HGL36150U44X HJL36150U44X HLL36150U44X HRL36150U44X
250 A [18] JDL36250U44X JGL36250U44X JJL36250U44X JLL36250U44X JRL36250U44X
60 A [17] HDL36060U54X HGL36060U54X HJL36060U54X HLL36060U54X HRL36060U54X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100U54X HGL36100U54X HJL36100U54X HLL36100U54X HRL36100U54X
Energy LSIG 6.2E
150 A [17] HDL36150U54X HGL36150U54X HJL36150U54X HJL36150U54X HRL36150U54X
250 A [18] JDL36250U54X JGL36250U54X JJL36250U54X JLL36250U54X JRL36250U54X
Table 7.57: H-Frame 150 A and J-Frame 250 A Electronic Trip UL Current-Limiting [13] 100% Rated Circuit Breakers (600 Vac) With Factory
Sealed Trip Unit [14] Suitable for Reverse Connection [15]
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Interrupting Rating (100% Rated)
Type Function Trip Unit Rating D G J [13] L [13] R [13]
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
60 A [17] HDL36060CU31X HGL36060CU31X HJL36060CU31X HLL36060CU31X HRL36060CU31X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU31X HGL36100CU31X HJL36100CU31X HLL36100CU31X HRL36100CU31X
LI 3.2 [16]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150CU31X HGL36150CU31X HJL36150CU31X HLL36150CU31X HRL36150CU31X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU31X JGL36250CU31X JJL36250CU31X JLL36250CU31X JRL36250CU31X
60 A [17] HDL36060CU33X HGL36060CU33X HJL36060CU33X HLL36060CU33X HRL36060CU33X
Micrologic 3.2S [16] 100 A [17] HDL36100CU33X HGL36100CU33X HJL36100CU33X HLL36100CU33X HRL36100CU33X
LSI [19]
Standard 150 A [17] HDL36150CU33X HGL36150CU33X HJL36150CU33X HLL36150CU33X HRL36150CU33X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU33X JGL36250CU33X JJL36250CU33X JLL36250CU33X JRL36250CU33X
60 A [17] HDL36060CU43X HGL36060CU43X HJL36060CU43X HLL36060CU43X HRL36060CU43X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU43X HGL36100CU43X HJL36100CU43X HLL36100CU43X HRL36100CU43X
LSI 5.2A
Ammeter 150 A [17] HDL36150CU43X HGL36150CU43X HJL36150CU43X HLL36150CU43X HRL36150CU43X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU43X JGL36250CU43X JJL36250CU43X JLL36250CU43X JRL36250CU43X
60 A [17] HDL36060CU53X HGL36060CU53X HJL36060CU53X HLL36060CU53X HRL36060CU53X
Micrologic 100 A [17] HDL36100CU53X HGL36100CU53X HJL36100CU53X HLL36100CU53X HRL36100CU53X
Energy LSI 5.2E
150 A [17] HDL36150CU53X HGL36150CU53X HJL36150CU53X HLL36150CU53X HRL36150CU53X
250 A [18] JDL36250CU53X JGL36250CU53X JJL36250CU53X JLL36250CU53X JRL36250CU53X
7
[13] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[14] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[15] For applications requiring communications see page 7-69.
[16] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[17] Standard lug kit: AL150HD. Terminal wire range: 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[18] Standard lug kit: AL250JD. Terminal wire range: 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
[19] Fixed ST and LT delays.
[20] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications in order to have ground fault protection. Additional metering capabilities will not work properly on the unconnected
phase.
7-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
7-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers Q-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 0734 / Refer to Catalogs: 0734CT0201
schneider-electric.us
[21] Replacement lugs and electrical accessories are not available for PowerPact Q-frame circuit breakers.
[22] 250 A lugs are suitable for copper conductors only.
[23] Q-frame circuit breakers are 240 Vac only.
[24] 3P QJ circuit breakers are rated at 208Y/120 Vac only.
7-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
L-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 611 / Refer to Catalogs: 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.64: L-Frame 600 A 100% Rated UL Current-Limiting [25] Circuit Breakers with Lugs and Factory-Sealed Electronic Trip Units
Suitable for Reverse Connection [26][27]
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Interrupting Rating (100% Rated)
Rating Terminal
Type Function Trip Unit D G J [25] L [25] R [25]
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
250 A LDL36250CU31X LGL36250CU31X LJL36250CU31X LLL36250CU31X LRL36250CU31X AL400L61K3 [29]
Micrologic Standard LI 3.3 [28]
400 A LDL36400CU31X LGL36400CU31X LJL36400CU31X LLL36400CU31X LRL36400CU31X AL600LS52K3 [30]
3.3S [28] 250 A LDL36250CU33X LGL36250CU33X LJL36250CU33X LLL36250CU33X LRL36250CU33X AL400L61K3 [29]
Micrologic Standard LSI [31] 400 A LDL36400CU33X LGL36400CU33X LJL36400CU33X LLL36400CU33X LRL36400CU33X AL600LS52K3 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSI 5.3A 400 A LDL36400CU43X LGL36400CU43X LJL36400CU43X LLL36400CU43X LRL36400CU43X
Micrologic Energy LSI 5.3E 400 A LDL36400CU53X LGL36400CU53X LJL36400CU53X LLL36400CU53X LRL36400CU53X
AL600LS52K3 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSIG 6.3A 400 A LDL36400CU44X LGL36400CU44X LJL36400CU44X LLL36400CU44X LRL36400CU44X
Micrologic Energy LSIG 6.3E [32] 400 A LDL36400CU54X LGL36400CU54X LJL36400CU54X LLL36400CU54X LRL36400CU54X
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 4P
250 A LDL46250CU31X LGL46250CU31X LJL46250CU31X LLL46250CU31X LRL46250CU31X AL400L61K4 [29]
Micrologic Standard LI 3.3
400 A LDL46400CU31X LGL46400CU31X LJL46400CU31X LLL46400CU31X LRL46400CU31X AL600LS52K4 [30]
250 A LDL46250CU33X LGL46250CU33X LJL46250CU33X LLL46250CU33X LRL46250CU33X AL400L61K4 [29]
Micrologic Standard LSI 3.3S
400 A LDL46400CU33X LGL46400CU33X LJL46400CU33X LLL46400CU33X LRL46400CU33X AL600LS52K4 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSI 5.3A 400 A LDL46400CU43X LGL46400CU43X LJL46400CU43X LLL46400CU43X LRL46400CU43X
Micrologic Energy LSI 5.3E 400 A LDL46400CU53X LGL46400CU53X LJL46400CU53X LLL46400CU53X LRL46400CU53X
AL600LS52K4 [30]
Micrologic Ammeter LSIG 6.3A 400 A LDL46400CU44X LGL46400CU44X LJL46400CU44X LLL46400CU44X LRL46400CU44X
Micrologic Energy LSIG 6.3E 400 A LDL46400CU54X LGL46400CU54X LJL46400CU54X LLL46400CU54X LRL46400CU54X
N Plug In LGL36600U44X
D Drawout
L-Frame Circuit Breaker
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
S Rear Connected
[25] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[26] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field interchangeable trip units.
[27] For applications requiring communications see page 7-69.
[28] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[29] AL400L61K3 terminal wire ranges are (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu or 1) 2 AWG–500 kcmil Al.
[30] AL600LS52K3 terminal wire range is (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu.
[31] Fixed ST and LT delays.
[32] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications in order to have ground fault protection. Additional metering capabilities will not work properly on the unconnected
phase.
7
7-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers M-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Accessories see page 7-54
Table 7.66: Interrupting Ratings
Optional Lugs see page 7-59
Interrupting Rating
Dimensions see page 7-77 Voltage
D G J L R
Enclosures see page 7-78
240 Vac 25 kA 65 kA 100 kA 125 kA 200 kA
480 Vac 18 kA 35 kA 65 kA 100 kA 200 kA
600 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 50 kA 100 kA
[33] The ET 1.0 trip unit cannot be field replaced or have the long-time trip point setting adjusted. It is considered an electronic equivalent of a thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.
7-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
P-Frame Circuit Breakers PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
7-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Molded Case Circuit Breakers R-Frame Circuit Breakers
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.74: R-Frame 3000 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic
Trip Unit
Electronic Trip Unit[36] Sensor
Rating Cat. No. [37]
Type Function Trip Unit
Fixed 1200 A R■F36120
Basic Electronic Trip 1600 A R■F36160
Unit long-time, ET1.0I
(Not Interchangeable) Adjustable 2000 A R■F36200
Instantaneous 2500 A R■F36250
600 A R■F36060(C)U31A
800 A R■F36080(C)U31A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U31A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U31A
LI 3.0
1600 A R■F36160(C)U31A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U31A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U31A
Micrologic 3000 A R■F36300(C)U31A
Interchangeable
Standard Trip Unit 600 A R■F36060(C)U33A
800 A R■F36080(C)U33A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U33A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U33A
LSI 5.0
1600 A R■F36160(C)U33A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U33A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U33A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U33A
600 A R■F36060(C)U41A
800 A R■F36080(C)U41A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U41A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U41A
LI 3.0A
1600 A R■F36160(C)U41A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U41A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U41A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U41A
600 A R■F36060(C)U43A
800 A R■F36080(C)U43A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U43A
Micrologic
Interchangeable 1200 A R■F36120(C)U43A
Ammeter LSI 5.0A
1600 A R■F36160(C)U43A
Trip Unit
2000 A R■F36200(C)U43A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U43A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U43A
600 A ■F36060(C)U44A
800 A R■F36080(C)U44A
1000 A R■F36100(C)U44A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U44A
LSIG 6.0A
1600 A R■F36160(C)U44A
2000 A R■F36200(C)U44A
2500 A R■F36250(C)U44A
3000 A R■F36300(C)U44A
600 A R■F36060(C)U63AE1
800 A R■F36080(C)U63AE1
1000 A R■F36100(C)U63AE1
1200 A R■F36120(C)U63AE1
7
LSI 5.0P
1600 A R■F36160(C)U63AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U63AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U63AE1
Micrologic 3000 A R■F36300(C)U63AE1
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
Interchangeable Power
Trip Unit 600 A R■F36060(C)U64AE1
800 A R■F36080(C)U64AE1
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
1000 A R■F36100(C)U64AE1
1200 A R■F36120(C)U64AE1
LSIG 6.0P
1600 A R■F36160(C)U64AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U64AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U64AE1
3000 A R■F36300(C)U64AE1
Micrologic LSI 5.0H 600 A R■F36060(C)U73AE1
Table 7.74 R-Frame 3000 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic
Trip Unit (cont'd.)
Electronic Trip Unit[38] Sensor
Rating Cat. No. [39]
Type Function Trip Unit
Interchangeable 800 A R■F36080(C)U73AE1
Harmonic Trip Unit R■F36100(C)U73AE1
1000 A
1200 A R■F36120(C)U73AE1
1600 A R■F36160(C)U73AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U73AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U73AE1
3000 A R■F36300(C)U73AE1
600 A R■F36060(C)U74AE1
800 A R■F36080(C)U74AE1
1000 A R■F36100(C)U74AE1
1200 A R■F36120(C)U74AE1
LSIG 6.0H
1600 A R■F36160(C)U74AE1
2000 A R■F36200(C)U74AE1
2500 A R■F36250(C)U74AE1
3000 A R■F36300(C)U74AE1
7-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors PowerPact™ H- and J-Frame Electronic
Motor Circuit Protectors
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001 schneider-electric.us
Interrupting Rating
Adjustable
Sensor Full Load Instantane- J L R
Frame Amperes Suffix (See SCCR (See SCCR (See SCCR
Rating ous Trip
Range Range Table Below) Table Below) Table Below)
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Standard 30 A 1.5–25 A 9–325 A M71 HJL36030M71 HLL36030M71 HRL36030M71
Energy Efficient
Energie Efficace
H- 50 A 14–42 A 84–546 A M72 HJL36050M72 HLL36050M72 HRL36050M72
Energia Eficiente Frame 100 A 30–80 A 180–1040 A M73 HJL36100M73 HLL36100M73 HRL36100M73
150 A 58–130 A 348–1690 A M74 HJL36150M74 HLL36150M74 HRL36150M74
J-Frame 250 A 114–217 A 684–2500 A M75 JJL36250M75 JLL36250M75 JRL36250M75
7-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors Instantaneous Trip Circuit Breakers
schneider-electric.us
• For other motors order a special thermal-magnetic circuit breaker with magnetic trip
settings for the specific motor— specify motor horsepower, voltage, frequency, full-
load current and code letter or locked rotor current.
• Determine motor hp rating from the motor nameplate.
• Refer to the tables and select an instantaneous-trip circuit breaker with an ampere
rating recommended for the hp and voltage involved.
• Select an adjustable trip setting of at least 800%, not to exceed 1300%, of the motor
full-load amperes (FLA) for other than Design E motors. For Design E motors, select
an adjustable trip setting of at least 1100% not to exceed 1700% of FLA.
• The NEC 1300% maximum setting may be inadequate for instantaneous-trip circuit
breakers to withstand current surges typical of the magnetization current of
autotransformer type reduced voltage starters, or open transition wye-delta starters
during transfer from “start” to “run,” constant hp multi-speed motors, and motors
labeled “high efficiency.” Select thermal-magnetic circuit breakers from page 7-47 for
those applications.
• Part-winding motors, per NEC 430.3, should have two circuit breakers selected from
the above at not more than one half the allowable trip setting for the horsepower
rating. The two circuit breakers should operate simultaneously as a disconnecting
means per NEC 430.103.
• Based on NEC 430.52 and NEC Table 430.150. See page 7-45 for available
Adjustable Instantaneous-Trip Circuit Breakers.
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors and Motor Motor Circuit Protectors
Protector Circuit Breakers
schneider-electric.us Class 580, 585, 680, 685
Table 7.81: Magnetic Only 3 Pole, 600 Vac, 50/60 Hz [6]—Three Device Solutions [7]
Trip Adjustable [8]
Ampere Rating 250 Vdc Multiplier Cat. No.
Unit Trip Range (A)
500–1000 A LAL3640022M
750–1600 A LAL3640028M
1000–2000 A LAL3640030M
Motor Circuit Protector 1125–2250 A High = 1.2 LAL3640031M
LAL 400 — 1250–2500 A Low = 1.4 LAL3640032M
1500–3000 A LAL3640033M
Motor Protector Circuit Breaker 1750–3500 A LAL3640035M
2000–4000 A LAL3640036M
For PowerPact L- and P-Frames, an instantaneous-only version of the electronic trip
circuti breaker is also available for motor circuit protection. These MCPs comply with
NEC® requirements for providing short-circuit protection when installed as part of a
Listed combination controller having motor overload protection.
Table 7.82: Magnetic Only 3 Pole, 600 Vac, 50/60 Hz[6]—Three Device Solutions [7]
Trip Adjustable [8] Interrupting Rating
Sensor Rating
Unit Trip Range (A) G J L R
PowerPact 400 500–1200% LGL36400M37X LJL36400M37X LLL36400M37X LRL36400M37X
L-Frame [6] 1.3 M
600 500–1200% LGL36600M37X LJL36600M37X LLL36600M37X LRL36600M37X
600 — 1200–10000 A — PJL36060M68 PLL34060M68 —
PowerPact 800 — 1200–10000 A — PJL36080M68 PLL34080M68 —
PJL, PLL [6] 1000 — 1500–10000 A — PJL36100M69 PLL34100M69 —
1200 — 1800–10000 A — PJL36120M70 PLL34120M70 —
Table 7.83: H-Frame (150 A), J-Frame (250 A) and L-Frame (600 A) Electronic Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (UL Ratings)—
Two Device Solutions [9]
Electronic Trip Sensor Full Load Interrupting Rating
Frame Trip Unit Amperes Isd (x FLA)
Unit Type Rating G J L R
Range (FLA)
30 14–25 5-13 x FLA HGL36030M38X HJL36030M38X HLL36030M38X HRL36030M38X
50 14–42 5-13 x FLA HGL36050M38X HJL36050M38X HLL36050M38X HRL36050M38X
H-Frame
100 2.2 M 30–80 5-13 x FLA HGL36100M38X HJL36100M38X HLL36100M38X HRL36100M38X
Standard [10] 150 58–130 5-13 x FLA HGL36150M38X HJL36150M38X HLL36150M38X HRL36150M38X
J-Frame 250 114–217 5-13 x FLA JGL36250M38X JJL36250M38X JLL36250M38X JRL36250M38X
400 190–348 5-13 x FLA LGL36400M38X LJL36400M38X LLL36400M38X LRL36400M38X
L-Frame 2.3 M
600 312–520 5-13 x FLA LGL36600M38X LJL36600M38X LLL36600M38X LRL36600M38X
[6] These electronic magnetic-only motor circuit protectors are available with I-Line constructions. Consult the factory.
[7] Three-device solutions are the traditional solutionss: motor circuit protector plus motor starter plus overload relay.
[8] UL magnetic trip tolerances are -20%/+30% from the nominal values shown.
[9] Two-device solutions (these electronic motor protector circuit breakers include short circuit and overload protection)
—1 electronic motor circuit protector with a Micrologic 2.2 M plus
—1 contactor
[10] The standard trip unit offers Class 5, 10 and 20 and phase unbalance or phase loss protection.
7
7-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors H-, J-, and LA-Frame MCP Selection
Class 680
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.85: LAL Adjustable Instantaneous-Trip Circuit Breakers for Single Motor
Circuit Protection
Hp Ratings of Induction Type Squirrel- Magnetic Trip
Cage and Wound Rotor Motors Full Load Mag-Gard
Circuit Breaker Settings[13]
3Ø 60 Hz Amperes[11]
Cat. No.
200 Vac 230 Vac 460 Vac 575 Vac MIN MAX
75 221 LAL3640033M 700% 1400%
200 240 LAL3640035M 700% 1500%
250 242 LAL3640035M 700% 1400%
100 248 LAL3640035M 700% 1400%
100 285 LAL3640036M 700% 1400%
300 289 LAL3640036M 700% 1400%
250 302 LAL3640036M 700% 1300%
125 312 LAL3640036M 600% 1300%
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
[11] Motor full-load currents are taken from NEC Table 430.150. Select wire and circuit breakers on basis of horsepower rather than nameplate full-load current per NEC 430.6 (A) for general
motor applications. Do not use these values to select overload relay thermal units. See Digest Secti0on 14 for selection of thermal units when actual full load current is not known. The
voltages listed are rated motor voltages. Corresponding nominal system voltages are 200–208, 220–240, 440–480 and 550–600 V.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[12] To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (G, J, L or R).
[13] Only MIN and MAX settings are shown, intermediate settings are available on all circuit breakers.
7-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Protection Selection Tables Motor Circuit Protectors
Class 601
schneider-electric.us
[14] Motor full load currents thru 200 hp are taken from NEC Tables 430.147, 148 and 150. Above 200 hp from UL 98. Select wire size, circuit breakers, or fuses on basis of hp rather than
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
nameplate full load current per NEC 430.6. Do not use these values to select overload relay thermal units. See Digest pages 16-129—16152 for selection of thermal units when actual full
load current is not known. Voltages listed are rated motor voltages. Corresponding nominal system voltages are 110–120 V, 200–208 V, 220–240 V, 440–480 V and 550–600 V
[15] Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions, based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Table 430.52.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
Under some conditions, the next size larger switch or circuit breaker rating may be necessary to accommodate the motor starting current and is permitted by NEC 430.52(C)(1) Exception 2.
High starting currents are anticipated with Design E and other energy efficient motors. For explanation of Code letter markings, see NEC 430.7(B). For Busway Plug-in units, see page 9-7.
[16] Type LC, LI, LX, LXI, and LE circuit breakers are NOT recommended for use on single motor branch circuits.
[17] Switch size only is shown in table. Selected fuses should not exceed maximum percent of full-load current as given in NEC Table 430.52. Above 50 hp dc switches are not hp rated by UL as
Motor Circuit Switches, but as General Use Switches only and are not necessarily capable of interrupting the max. operating overload current of a motor. See NEC 100 for definition of
General Use Switch. When protecting a 3Ø, Design E energy efficient motor, the switch is required by NEC 430.109 to have a hp rating of not less than 1.4 times that of a motor rated 3–100
hp, or not less than 1.3 times that of a motor rated over 100 hp. Switches shown in this table do not necessarily comply with that requirement.
[18] NEC 430.22 for Single Motor, Smaller conductors may be permitted for light duty-cycle service per 430.22 (B) Exception No. 1. DC motors operating from rectified 1Ø power supply will
require larger conductors per 430.22 (A) Exception No. 1. For motor-generator arc welders, see 630.11
[19] Thermal-magnetic breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions and based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Tables 430.7(B)
and 430.52.
[20] Ordinary service for normal starting duty only, acceleration time of 10 sec. or less.
[21] Heavy service is jogging or plugging duty or cycling load with over 25 starts per hour or over 5 starts per minute. Energy efficient motors are polyphase motors defined in NEMA Standard
MG1 and exhibit high starting current.
[22] 200 V motors are commonly used on 208 V services.
[23] 8 XHHW requires 3/4 in. conduit for 3W.
7
7-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Circuit Protectors Motor Protection Selection Tables
Class 601
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.86 Selection Tables for Conductors, Safety Switches and Thermal-Magnetic Circuit BreakersBased on 2005 NEC® Tables
430.147, 430.148 & 430.150 (cont'd.)
Horsepower Ratings Amperage of Thermal-Magnetic [25][26] QMB Minimum Size metallic Conduit
Squirrel-Cage and Wound- Inverse Time Circuit Breaker and 75° C, C Wire Field-Installed Sized
Rotor Motors with Norm. Average Direct Heavy for 125% FLA[28]
Torque Characteristics 1Ø Current Motors Full For Motor Code Duty
10 Hz ac Operating at Load Letter B to E For Switch Conduit 3 W
Operating at Usual Speeds Motor
Base Speed Amperage with
3Ø 60 Hz [24] Code Time AWG
Ordinary Heavy Service Letter F kcmil THHN
200 200 Service and Energy Delay
230 460 575 115 230 120 240 to V [29] Fuses THWN THW
Vac Vac [30] Efficient [31] XHHW
[32] Vac Vac Vac Vac [32] Vac Vdc Vdc [27]
25 78.2 A
30 7-1/2 80.0 A
25 89.0 A 225 A
2 1 in. 1-1/4 in.
30 92.0 A 125 A
75 96.0 A
200 A 250 A
100 99.0 A
1 1-1/4 in. 1-1/2 in.
10 100.0 A 150 A
40 104.0 A
225 A
30 106.0 A 300 A
175 A 1/0 1-1/4 in. 1-1/2 in.
40 120.0 A
250 A 200 A
100 124.0 A
125 125.0 A 250 A
350 A 2/0 1-1/2 in. 1-1/2 in.
50 130.0 A
200 A
40 140.0 A
300 A
150 144.0 A
50 150.0 A
3/0 1-1/2 in. 2 in.
60 154.0 A 400 A
225 A
125 156.0 A 350 A
50 173.0 A
60 177.0 A 4/0 2 in. 2 in.
250 A
150 180.0 A 400 A 500 A
75 200 192.0 A 250 2 in. 2 in.
75 221.0 A 300 A 450 A 300 2 in. 2-1/2 in.
600 A
200 240.0 A
250 242.0 A 350 A 500 A 400 A 350 2-1/2 in. 2-1/2 in.
700 A
100 248.0 A
100 285.0 A
600 A
300 289.0 A 400 A 500 3 in. 3 in.
800 A
250 302.0 A
125 312.0 A 450 A 700 A (2) 3/0 (2) 2-1/2 in. (2) 2 in.
350 336.0 A 500 A
900 A
125 359.0 A
(2) 4/0 (2) 2 in. (2) 2 in.
150 360.0 A
800 A
300 361.0 A 600 A 1000 A
400 382.0 A
600 A (2)300 (2) 2 in. (2) 2-1/2 in.
150 350 414.0 A 900 A
500 472.0 A
1200 A
400 477.0 A 1000 A (2) 350 (2) 2-1/2 in. (2) 2-1/2 in.
800 A
200 480.0 A
200 552.0 A
500 590.0 A 1200 A 1600 A — (3) 300 (3) 2 in. (3) 2-1/2 in.
900 A
250 602.0 A
Contact your local Field Office for circuit breaker selection on constant horsepower multi-
speed motors.
7
[24] Motor full load currents thru 200 hp are taken from NEC Tables 430.147, 148 and 150. Above 200 hp from UL 98. Select wire size, circuit breakers, or fuses on basis of hp rather than
nameplate full load current per NEC 430.6. Do not use these values to select overload relay thermal units. See Digest pages 16-129—16152 for selection of thermal units when actual full
load current is not known. Voltages listed are rated motor voltages. Corresponding nominal system voltages are 110–120 V, 200–208 V, 220–240 V, 440–480 V and 550–600 V
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
[25] Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions, based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Table 430.52.
Under some conditions, the next size larger switch or circuit breaker rating may be necessary to accommodate the motor starting current and is permitted by NEC 430.52(C)(1) Exception 2.
High starting currents are anticipated with Design E and other energy efficient motors. For explanation of Code letter markings, see NEC 430.7(B). For Busway Plug-in units, see page 9-7.
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[26] Type LC, LI, LX, LXI, and LE circuit breakers are NOT recommended for use on single motor branch circuits.
[27] Switch size only is shown in table. Selected fuses should not exceed maximum percent of full-load current as given in NEC Table 430.52. Above 50 hp dc switches are not hp rated by UL as
Motor Circuit Switches, but as General Use Switches only and are not necessarily capable of interrupting the max. operating overload current of a motor. See NEC 100 for definition of
General Use Switch. When protecting a 3Ø, Design E energy efficient motor, the switch is required by NEC 430.109 to have a hp rating of not less than 1.4 times that of a motor rated 3–100
hp, or not less than 1.3 times that of a motor rated over 100 hp. Switches shown in this table do not necessarily comply with that requirement.
[28] NEC 430.22 for Single Motor, Smaller conductors may be permitted for light duty-cycle service per 430.22 (B) Exception No. 1. DC motors operating from rectified 1Ø power supply will
require larger conductors per 430.22 (A) Exception No. 1. For motor-generator arc welders, see 630.11
[29] Thermal-magnetic breaker ampere ratings recommended are approximate for average conditions and based on trip characteristics of Square D circuit breakers and NEC Tables 430.7(B)
and 430.52.
[30] Ordinary service for normal starting duty only, acceleration time of 10 sec. or less.
[31] Heavy service is jogging or plugging duty or cycling load with over 25 starts per hour or over 5 starts per minute. Energy efficient motors are polyphase motors defined in NEMA Standard
MG1 and exhibit high starting current.
[32] 200 V motors are commonly used on 208 V services.
7-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact Automatic Switches Automatic Switches
Class 600 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.87: PowerPact™ B-Frame Automatic Molded Case Switches, 600 Vac
D Withstand G Withstand J Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Poles Trip Terminal Wire Range
Breaker Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
Point
2 [1] 125 A BDL26000S12 1625 A BGL26000S12 1625 A BJL26000S12 1625 A LV426973 14–2/0 AWG Cu
B-Frame
3 125 A BDL36000S12 1625 A BGL36000S12 1625 A BJL36000S12 1625 A LV426974 14–2/0 AWG Cu
Table 7.88: H-, J-, and L-Frame PowerPact™ Automatic Molded Case Switches, 600 Vac
G Withstand L Withstand R Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Poles Trip Terminal Wire Range
Breaker Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
Point
150 A HGL26000S15 [1] 2250 A HLL26000S15 2250 A — — AL150HD 14 AWG–3/0 AWG Al/Cu
2 175 A JGL26000S17 3125 A JLL26000S17 3125 A — — AL175JD 4–4/0 AWG Al/Cu
H-Frame 250 A JGL26000S25 3125 A JLL26000S25 3125 A — — AL250JD 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al/Cu
J-Frame 150 A HGL36000S15 2250 A HLL36000S15 2250 A — — AL150HD 14 AWG–3/0 AWG Al/Cu
3 175 A JGL36000S17 3125 A JLL36000S17 3125 A JRL36000S17 3125 A AL175JD 4–4/0 AWG Al/Cu
250 A JGL36000S25 3125 A JLL36000S25 3125 A JRL36000S25 3125 A AL250JD 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al/Cu
400 A LGL36000S40X 4800 A LLL36000S40X 4800 A LRL36000S40X 4800 A AL150HD AL600LS52K3
3 (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu
600 A LGL36000S60X 6600A LLL36000S60X 6600 A LRL36000S60X 6600 A AL250JD
L-Frame
400 A LGL46000S40X 4800 A LLL46000S40X 4800 A LRL46000S40X 4800 A AL150HD AL600LS52K4
4 (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu
600 A LGL46000S60X 6600A LLL46000S60X 6600 A LRL46000S60X 6600 A AL250JD
Table 7.89: P-Frame and R-Frame PowerPact™ Automatic Molded Case Switches [2], 600 Vac
Ampere J Withstand K Withstand L Withstand
Frame Poles Rating Terminal Wire Range
Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
600 A PJL26000S60 10 kA PKL26000S60 24 kA PLL24000S60 [3] 10 kA (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL800M23K
800 A PJL26000S80 10 kA PKL26000S80 24 kA PLL24000S80 [3] 10 kA Al or Cu
2
1000 A PJL26000S10 10 kA PKL26000S10 24 kA PLL24000S10 [3] 10 kA (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL1200P25K
1200 A PJL26000S12 10 kA PKL26000S12 24 kA PLL24000S12 [3] 10 kA Al or Cu
P
600 A PJL36000S60 10 kA PKL36000S60 24 kA PLL34000S60 [3] 10 kA (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL800M23K Al or Cu
800 A PJL36000S80 10 kA PKL36000S80 24 kA PLL34000S80 [3] 10 kA
3
1000 A PJL36000S10 10 kA PKL36000S10 24 kA PLL34000S10 [3] 10 kA (4) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil
AL1200P25K
1200 A PJL36000S12 10 kA PKL36000S12 24 kA PLL34000S12 [3] 10 kA Al or Cu
1200 A — — RKF26000S12 57 kA RLF26000S12 48 kA
1600 A — — RKF26000S16 57 kA RLF26000S16 48 kA
2 R-frame circuit breakers can be
2000 A — — RKF26000S20 57 kA RLF26000S20 48 kA
2500 A — — RKF26000S25 57 kA RLF26000S25 48 kA bus-connected or cable-connected.
For cable connections, RLTB kit or
R 1200 A — — RKF36000S12 57 kA RLF36000S12 48 kA equivalent bus structure is required.
1600 A — — RKF36000S16 57 kA RLF36000S16 48 kA Kit is included with 3000 A switches.
3 2000 A — — RKF36000S20 57 kA RLF36000S20 48 kA For all others, see page 7-62.
2500 A — — RKF36000S25 57 kA RLF36000S25 48 kA
3000 A — — RKF36000S30 57 kA RLF36000S30 48 kA
Table 7.90: Q-Frame (240 Vac) PowerPact™ Automatic Molded Case Switches
Accessories see page 7-54 and Supplemental Digest Section 3 J Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Optional Lugs see page 7-59 and Supplemental Digest Section 3 Poles Rating Wire Range
Breaker Cat. No. Trip Point
Dimensions see page 7-76 and page 7-77 Q-Frame 2 225 A QBL22000S22 4500 A
[4] 4 AWG–300 kcmil
Enclosures see page 7-78 3 225 A QBL32000S22 4500 A
Table 7.91: B-, H-, J-, L- P-, and R-Frame Withstand Ratings [5]
Withstand
Voltage
D G J K L R
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
7-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
500 Vdc Circuit Breakers UL Listed 500 Vdc Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
[1] Magnetic trip tolerances are -20%/+30% from the nominal values shown.
7-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL Listed 500 Vdc NW Circuit Breakers 500 Vdc Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
7-51
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mission Critical Circuit Breakers Selective Coordination
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.96: J-Frame 250 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical 100% Rated Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) with Factory Sealed Trip Units
Suitable for Reverse Connection
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous Cat. No.
Unit Type Trip Unit Terminal
Function Current D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Standard LI 3.2 W 250 A JDL34250WU31X JGL34250WU31X JJL34250WU31X JLL34250WU31X AL250JD [1]
Standard LSI 3.2S-W 250 A JDL34250WU33X JGL34250WU33X JJL34250WU33X JLL34250WU33X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.2A-W 250 A JDL34250WU43X JGL34250WU43X JJL34250WU43X JLL34250WU43X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.2E-W 250 A JDL34250WU53X JGL34250WU53X JJL34250WU53X JLL34250WU53X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.2A-W 250 A JDL34250WU44X JGL34250WU44X JJL34250WU44X JLL34250WU44X AL250JD [1]
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.2E-W 250 A JDL34250WU54X JGL34250WU54X JJL34250WU54X JLL34250WU54X AL250JD [1]
[1] AL250JD terminal wire range is (1) 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu.
[2] Add TS suffix for circuit breaker without terminal nut kit.
7-52
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Selective Coordination Mission Critical Circuit Breakers
Class 500, 600
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.99: L-Frame 600 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) with Factory Sealed Trip Units Suitable for
Reverse Connection [3]
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous Cat. No.
Unit Type Trip Unit Terminal
Function Current D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting.
480/277 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
250 A LDL34250WU31X LGL34250WU31X LJL34250WU31X LLL34250WU31X AL400L61K3 [4]
Standard LI 3.3 W 400 A LDL34400WU31X LGL34400WU31X LJL34400WU31X LLL34400WU31X
AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU31X LGL34600WU31X LJL34600WU31X LLL34300WU31X
250 A LDL34250WU33X LGL34250WU33X LJL34250WU33X LLL34250WU33X AL400L61K3 [4]
Standard LSI 3.3S-W 400 A LDL34400WU33X LGL34400WU33X LJL34400WU33X LLL34400WU33X
AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU33X LGL34600WU33X LJL34600WU33X LLL34300WU33X
400 A LDL34400WU43X LGL34400WU43X LJL34400WU43X LLL34400WU43X
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.3A-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU43X LGL34600WU43X LJL34600WU43X LLL34300WU43X
400 A LDL34400WU53X LGL34400WU53X LJL34400WU53X LLL34400WU53X
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.3E-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU53X LGL34600WU53X LJL34600WU53X LLL34300WU53X
400 A LDL34400WU44X LGL34400WU44X LJL34400WU44X LLL34400WU44X
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.3A-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU44X LGL34600WU44X LJL34600WU44X LLL34300WU44X
400 A LDL34400WU54X LGL34400WU54X LJL34400WU54X LLL34400WU54X
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.3E-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL34600WU54X LGL34600WU54X LJL34600WU54X LLL34300WU54X
480/277 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 4P
250 A LDL44250WU31X LGL44250WU31X LJL44250WU31X LLL44250WU31X AL400L61K4 [4]
Standard LI 3.3 W 400 A LDL44400WU31X LGL44400WU31X LJL44400WU31X LLL44400WU31X
AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU31X LGL44600WU31X LJL44600WU31X LLL44300WU31X
250 A LDL44250WU33X LGL44250WU33X LJL44250WU33X LLL44250WU33X AL400L61K4 [4]
Standard LSI 3.3S-W 400 A LDL44400WU33X LGL44400WU33X LJL44400WU33X LLL44400WU33X
AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU33X LGL44600WU33X LJL44600WU33X LLL44300WU33X
400 A LDL44400WU43X LGL44400WU43X LJL44400WU43X LLL44400WU43X
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.3A-W AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU43X LGL44600WU43X LJL44600WU43X LLL44300WU43X
400 A LDL44400WU53X LGL44400WU53X LJL44400WU53X LLL44400WU53X
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.3E-W AL600LS52K3 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU53X LGL44600WU53X LJL44600WU53X LLL44300WU53X
400 A LDL44400WU44X LGL44400WU44X LJL44400WU44X LLL44400WU44X
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.3A-W AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU44X LGL44600WU44X LJL44600WU44X LLL44300WU44X
400 A LDL44400WU54X LGL44400WU54X LJL44400WU54X LLL44400WU54X
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.3E-W AL600LS52K4 [5]
600 A LDL44600WU54X LGL44600WU54X LJL44600WU54X LLL44300WU54X
[3] Standard rating (100%) for 250 A and 400 A only. Standard rating 80% for 600 A.
[4] AL400L61K3 terminal wire ranges are (1) #2 AWG–500 kcmil Al or (1) #2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu.
[5] AL600LS52K3 terminal wire ranges are (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu.
7
7-53
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Electrical Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
PowerPact Accessories
Table 7.100: Electrical Accessories
B-, H-, J-, and L-Frame M-, P-, and R-Frame
H- and J-
B-Frame L-Frame
Factory Frame
Accessory Description Rated Voltage Factory Field-
Installed Field-
Field- Field- Field- Installed Installable
Cat. Installable Cat. Suffix Cat. No.
Suffix Installable Installable Installable
Pre-Wired
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
Cat. No.
1 auxiliary switch (OF) 1a1b AA LV426950 LV426951 S29450 S29450 AA S29450
2 auxiliary switch (OF) 2a2b AB — — 2x S29450 2x S29450 AB 2x S29450
Auxiliary and
Alarm Switches 3 auxiliary switch (OF) 3a3b AC — — — 3x S29450 AC 3x S29450
(OF, SD, SDE) Alarm Switch (SD) 1a1b BC LV426950 LV426952 S29450 S29450 BC S29450
Standard Overcurrent trip switch (SDE)
1a1b BD — — — S29450 BD S29450
Min
Load = Consisting OF Switch — — — S29450 — — —
10mA of: SDE Adapter — — — S29451 — — —
with
24V Alarm switch and Overcurrent
trip switch BE — — — 2x S29450 BE 2x S29450
Provides
circuit breaker Consisting OF Switch — — — 2x S29450 — — —
contact status. of: SDE Adapter — — — S29451 — — —
Note: The
Auxiliary Switch/Alarm Switch/
B-Frame location of the Adapter (OF/SD/SDE) Kit — — — — — — S33801 [1]
accessory in
the circuit One auxiliary switch (OF) 1a1b AE — — S29452 S29452 AE S29452
breaker Two auxiliary switches (OF)
determines its 2a2b AF — — 2x S29452 2x S29452 AF 2x S29452
function.
3 auxiliary switches (OF) 3a3b AG — — — 3x S29452 AG 3x S29452
Low Alarm Switch (SD) 1a1b BH — — S29452 S29452 BH S29452
Level Overcurrent trip switch (SDE)
Min BJ — — — S29452 BJ [2] S29452
1a1b
Load =
1mA with Consisting OF Switch — — — S29452 — — —
24V of: SDE Adapter — — — S29451 — — —
Alarm switch and Overcurrent
H-, J-, L-, M-, P, and trip switch BK — — — 2x S29452 BK [2] 2x S29452
R-Frame
Consisting OF Switch — — — 2x S29452 — — —
of: SDE Adapter [3] — — — S29451 — — —
Shunt Trip (MX) 24 SK LV426841 LV426861 S29384 S29384 SK S33659
48 SL LV426842 LV426862 S29385 S29385 SL S33660
110–130 SA LV426843 LV426863 S29386 S29386 SA S33661
AC 220–240 SD, SF — — — — SC S33662
208–277 SD LV426844 LV426864 S29387 S29387 SD S33663
380–480 SH LV426846 LV426866 S29388 S29388 SH S33664
525–600 SJ — — S29389 S29389 — —
B-Frame Trips the circuit breaker 12 SN — — S29382 S29382 SN S33658
from a remote location by 24 SO LV426841 LV426861 S29390 S29390 SK S33659
means of a trip coil
energized from a separate 30 SU — — S29391 S29391 SK S33659
supply voltage circuit. 48 SP LV426842 LV426862 S29392 S29392 SL S33660
60 SV — — S29383 S29383 SL S33660
DC 125 SR LV426843 LV426863 S29393 S29393 SA S33661
externally mounted 100–130 — S33681 [4] — S33681 [4] S33681 [4] — S33681 [4]
adjustable time delay unit
for UVR of 0.5, 0.9, 1.5, AC/DC 220–250 — S33682 [4] — S33682 [4] S33682 [4] — S33682 [4]
3.0 seconds before circuit
breaker trips 380–480 — — — — — — S33683 [4]
S29426 [4] S29426 [4] S29426 [4]
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
7-54
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Motor Operators and Rotary Handles PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
7-55
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Motor Operators and Rotary Handles
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Rotary Handles
Door-Mounted
Direct-Mounted Handle
Handle
Table 7.105: Installation Accessories for B-, H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Field-Installable Cat. No.
Description
B-Frame H- and J-Frame L-Frame
Front Panel Escutcheon for Toggle Breakers — S29315 32556
Front Panel Escutcheon for Rotary Handle, Motor Operator, or
extended escutcheon — S29317 S32558
Phase Barriers (set of 6) LV426920 S29329 32570
Handle Rubber Boot[14] — S29319 S32560
Sealing Accessories (for front cover screws) S29375 S29375 S29375
Handle Rubber DIN rail mounting kit (requires 15 mm depth on a 35 mm DIN
rail)[14] Standard S29305 —
Boot
DIN rail adapter Standard — —
Handle Extensions (set of 5) — S29313 S432553
Rear Insulation Kit (2P) LV426921 — —
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
7-57
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Locks, Installation Accessories, and Rear
Connections
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us
Table 7.106: Installation Accessories for M-, P-, and R-Frame Circuit Breakers
Description Field-Installable
Frame Cat. No.
M-, P-Frame S33718
Accessory Cover
R-Frame S33929
Door Escutcheon
Toggle Handle M-, P-Frame S33717
Drawout P-Frame S33857
Short lug cover 3P S33932
Door Escutcheon
Terminal Covers Short lug cover 4P S33933
Terminal Covers P-Frame
Long lug cover 3P S33934
Long lug cover 4P S33935
Standard R-Frame S33997
Replacement Handle Standard Short M-, P-Frame S46998
Long M-, P-Frame S46996
[15] Kit contains 4 short rear connections, 2 long rear connections (4 long rear connections for 4P), hardware, and 2 terminal covers..
[16] For use with 3P circuit breakers only.
7-58
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mechanical Lugs PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Mechanical Lugs
Table 7.108: Mechanical Lug Kits for B-Frame Circuit Breakers [17]
Circuit Breaker Application Number of Wires Field-
Description Ampere Rating Factory-Installed Qty Per
Per Lug and Wire Range Installable
Standard Ampere Rating Optional Cat. Suffix Cat. No. Kit
Table 7.109: Mechanical Lug Kits for H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers [17]
Circuit Breaker Application Number of Wires Qty Per
Description Ampere Rating Per Lug and Wire Range Kit Cat. No.
Standard Ampere Rating Optional Kit
HD, HG, HJ, HL 15–150 A (1) 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu AL150HD 3
Al Lugs for Use with JD, JG, JJ, JL (1) 4-4/0 AWG Al or Cu
150–175 A AL175JD 3
Al or Cu Wire
JD, JG, JJ, JL 200–250 A JD,JG,JJ,JL 150–175 A (1) 3/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu AL250JD 3
Cu Lugs for Use with HD,HG,HJ,HL 15–150 A (1) 14–2/0 AWG Cu CU150HD 3
Cu Wire Only JD,JG,JJ,JL 150–250 A (1) 1/0–300 kcmil Cu CU250JD 3
Control Wire Terminal for H-frame lug kit S37423 2
Control Wire Terminal for J-frame lug kit S37424 2
Table 7.110: Mechanical Lug Kits for L-Frame Circuit Breakers [19]
Circuit Breaker Application Qty
Descrip- Number of Wires
Ampere Unit Per Lug and Wire Range Kit Cat. No. Per
tion Poles I-Line Kit
Rating Mount
250 3 X X (1) 2 AWG–500 kcmil Al AL400L61K3 3
4 X — (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu AL400L61K4 4
Al Lugs for
Use with Al 400/600 3 X — AL600LS52K3 3
(2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
or Cu Wire 4 X — AL600LS52K4 4
400/600 3 X X (2) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu AL600LF52K3 3
250 3 X X CU400L61K3 3
Cu Lugs for (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu
4 X — CU400L61K4 4
Use with 400/600 3 X — CU600LS52K3 3
J-Frame Lug L-Frame Lug Cu Wire (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Cu
Only 4 X — CU600LS52K4 4
400/600 3 X X (2) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Cu CU600LF52K3 3
Table 7.111: Mechanical Lug Kits for M-, P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers [20]
Descrip- Circuit Breaker Application Wires per Lug Lugs
and Wire Range Cat. No. Per
tion Standard Rating Optional Rating Kit
AL800M23K 3
800 A — 800 A (3) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil
AL800M23K4 4
MG, MJ, PG, (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil AL1200P24K [21]
1200 A PJ, PK, PL 800 A 1
M-Frame, AL800P6K [21] 3
P-Frame MG, MJ, PG, (2) 3/0 AWG-600 kcmil
— PJ, PK, PL 800 A
AL800P6K4 [21] 4
M- and P-Frame Lugs
(800 A and below) (2) 3/0 AWG-750 kcmil AL800P7K [21] 3
MG, MJ, PG, 750 kcmil: compact AL
— PJ, PK, PL 800 A
only AL800P7K4 [21] 4
Al Lugs
for AL or PG, PJ, PK, AL1200P25K [22] 3
Cu Wire 1200 A 800 A (4) 3/0 AWG-500 kcmil
PL AL1200P25K4 [22] 4
P-Frame
PG, PJ, PK, 800– AL1200P6KU [22] 3
— (3) 350-600 kcmil
PL 1200 A AL1200P6KU4 [22] 4
(3) 3/0 AWG-750 kcmil AL1200P7KU [22] 3
PG,PJ,PL PG, PJ, PK, 1200 A 750 kcmil: compact AL
—
PL only AL1200P7KU4 [22] 4
1200 A I-Line — (4) 3/0 AWG-600 kcmil AL1200R53K 1
R-Frame
2500 A Unit Mount — (1) 3/0 AWG-750 kcmil AL2500RK [23] 2
100– (1) 1-1/0 AWG CU250P1K [25]
— PJ 3
150 A
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
7-59
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Compression Lugs and Power Distribution
Connectors (PDC)
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us
Compression Lugs
P-Frame R-Frame
Compression Lug Kit Compression Lug Kit
J-Frame
Compression Lug
[26] Not for use on I-Line™ circuit breakers unless wire bending space is adequate.
[27] All unit-mount R-frame circuit breakers require terminal pads for mounting lugs of any type. See page 7-62.
[28] 9 lugs for 3000 A circuit breakers
7-60
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Compression Lugs and Power Distribution PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Connectors (PDC)
schneider-electric.us Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
Power Distribution Connectors
Table 7.113: Power Distribution Connectors for B-Frame, H-Frame, J-Frame and L-
Frame Circuit Breakers [29]
Use with Qty.
Ampere (Wires Per Terminal) Dimension A
Circuit Breaker Rating Wire Range (in.) Cat. No. Per
Type Kit
PDC6HD6 PDC6JD4 125 A (3) 14 - 2 AWG 1.2 PDC3BD2 3
BD, BG, BJ
125 A (6) 14 - 6 AWG 1 PDC6BD6 3
HD, HG, HJ, HL 15–150 A (6) 14–6 AWG Cu 1.0 PDC6HD6 3
[30] 15–150 A (3) 14–2 AWG Cu 1.2 PDC3HD2 3
JD, JG, JJ, JL 150–250 A (6) 14–4 AWG Cu 1.0 PDC6JD4 3
PDC3HD2 PDC3JD20 [30] 150–250 A (2) 14–1 AWG and (1) 3–2/0 AWG Cu 1.5 PDC3JD20 3
LD, LG, LJ, LL 150–600 A (3) 14–1 AWG and (2) 3–2/0 AWG 1.28 PDC5DG20L3 3
[31] 150–600 A (12) 14–4 AWG 1.31 PDC12DG4L3 3
Table 7.114: Power Distribution Connectors for M-Frame and P-Frame Circuit
Breakers [29]
Ampere (Wires Per Terminal) Qty
Rating Wire Range Cat. No. Per
Kit
Use for multiple load connections on one circuit (6) 12–2/0 AWG Cu PDC6P20 3
breaker in place of standard distribution block to 250–1200 A
(6) 12–2/0 AWG Cu PDC6P204 4
PDC12P4 PDC6P20 save space and time.
• Use on load end of circuit breaker only PDC12P4 3
Crimp lugs or PDC connectors extension “A” past end of circuit • Use in UL508 Industrial Control applications only.
breaker • Use in UL1995/CSA C22.2 No. 236 heating and 250–1200 A (12) 10–4 AWG Cu
cooling equipment. PDC12P44 4
“A” See Ta ble • For Cu wire only.
Molded Case
w/Mechanical
Lugs
7-61
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Terminal Nuts, Terminal Pads, Terminal
Shields and Accessories
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us
Terminal Accessories
Table 7.115: Terminal Nuts for Bus Bar Connection of B-, H- and J-Frame Circuit
Breakers
Description Tap Qty Per
Frame Cat. No.
Kit
B-Frame Terminal Nut Insert-Metric BD/BG/BJ (2P) M6 LV426962 2
B-Frame Terminal Nut Insert-Metric BD/BG/BJ (3P) M6 LV426963 3
H-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English HD/HG/HJ/HL 1/4-20 S37425 2
H-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English HD/HG/HJ/HL 1/4-20 S37444 3
H-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–Metric HD/HG/HJ/HL M6 S37426 2
J-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English JD/JG/JJ/JL 1/4-20 S37427 2
J-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–English JD/JG/JJ/JL 1/4-20 S37445 3
J-Frame Terminal Nut Insert–Metric JD/JG/JJ/JL M8 S37428 2
Control Wire Terminal for H-Frame Terminal Nut HD/HG/HJ/HL S37429 2
H-Frame Lug with Control Wire Terminal for J-Frame Terminal Nut JD/JG/JJ/JL S37430 2
Terminal Nut Insert
Table 7.116: Bus Bar Connections Hardware for L-, M-, and P-Frame Circuit
Breakers
Frame Description Term. No. Poles Cat. No.
L-Frame Set of 4 terminal screws and washers for one side F 4 S36967
M- and P-Frame Bus Connector Kit for one pole, one end 1 S33928
Table 7.119: Miscellaneous H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breaker Accessories
Molded Case Field-Installable
w/Mechanical Accessory Description
Cat. No.
Lugs Bag of screws for accessory cover, L-frame S432552
Spare Parts 1 spare toggle extension, L-frame 32595
Set of 10 identification labels LV429226
“B” See Ta ble
R-Frame
Phase Barrier
[32] Short lug shields provide IP20 protection for mechanical lugs and are compatible with control wire terminals.
[33] J-frame terminal shield is not compatible with the YA250J35 compression terminal.
7-62
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-In and Drawout Mountings PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories
Class 611, 612 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001,0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Mountings
Table 7.120: Plug-In and Drawout Mountings for H- and J-Frame Circuit Breakers
(3P or 2P in a 3P module)
Factory Field-
Description Installed Installable
Cat. No. Cat. No.
Complete Factory- Plug-in base shipped with circuit breaker N
Assembled Circuit Breakers Drawout cradle shipped with circuit breaker D
Circuit breaker Only HJ00
Plug-In Base
Plug-in base kit S29278
Special Order Options for Circuit breaker only HJ00
Plug-In and Drawout Circuit Plug-in base kit S29278
H- and J-Frame H- and J-Frame Breakers Drawout
Cradle Cradle side plates (fixed part of chassis) S29282
Plug-In Mounting Drawout Mounting
Circuit breaker side plates (moving part
of chassis) S29283
H-Frame Shutter Kit (set of two) S37442
J-Frame Shutter Kit (set of two) S37443
Fixed part 9-wire connector (mounted on
base) S29273
Secondary
Disconnect Moving part 9-wire connector (mounted
Blocks on circuit breaker) S29274
Accessories for Plug-In and
Drawout Support for 2-moving connectors S29275
Extended escutcheon with extended toggle handle S29284
Two position indicating switches (connected/
disconnected) S29287
H-Frame Short Terminal Cover (3P S37436
J-Frame Short Terminal Cover (3P) S37440
Table 7.121: Plug-In and Drawout Mountings for L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Plug-in Mounting Drawout Mounting
Description Poles Factory- Field- Factory- Field-
Installed Installed Installed Installable
Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
3 N D
Kit (stationary and moving parts)
4 N D
3 S32514 S32514
Plug-in base
Stationary Part 4 S32515 S32515
Fixed part of chassis S32532
Circuit breaker only HJ00 HJ00
Moving part of chassis S32533
L-Frame L-Frame Moving Part
3 2x S32562 2x S32562
Plug-In Mounting Drawout Mounting Short terminal covers
4 2x S32563 2x S32563
Table 7.122: Plug-In and Drawout Accessories for L-Frame Circuit Breakers
Field-
Description Installable
Cat. No.
Fixed Part 9-wire connector S29273
9-wire connector S32523
Secondary Disconnecting Blocks Moving Part
Support for 3 moving connectors S32525
Fixed + Moving 9-wire manual auxiliary connector S29272
Shutters Two shutters for plug-in base 32521
Extended escutcheon for toggle S32534
L-Frame Locking Device Chassis Accessories Locking device (key lock is not included) S29286
L-Frame Disconnecting Blocks Two position indicating switches (connected/disconnected) 29287
Table 7.123: Termination Options Table 7.124: Drawout Cradle and Accessories for P-Frame Circuit Breakers
Description Cat. No.
Termination Letter Termination No. Product
N = Plug-in LGL36400U31X Drawout Cradle
Selector
For factory-installed termination, place Front Connected Flat (FCF) SFCF12 [34]
termination letter in the third block of the Cradle
D = Drawout Connectors
circuit breaker catalog number. Rear Connected T Horizontal/Vertical (RCTH/RCTV) SRCTV12 [34]
Modbus™ cradle communication module S33852
Safety shutters S48933
Secondary disconnects terminal shield S33763
Cradle position switch 1a/1b Form C— Connected/test/disconnected S33170
Low level cradle position switch 1a/1b Form C—Connected/test/disconnected S33171
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
7-63
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact™ Circuit Breaker Accessories Plug-In and Drawout Mountings
Class 611, 612 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001,0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-64
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Trip Units Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
70-80-100-125-150-175-200-225-250
LI 3.3 125-150-175-200-225-250-300-350-400
200-225-250-300-350-400-450-500-600
Standard
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
70-80-100-125-150-175-200-225-250
LSI 3.3S 125-150-175-200-225-250-300-350-400
200-225-250-300-350-400-450-500-600
125–400
LSI 5.3A
200–600
Ammeter
125–400
LSIG 6.3A
200–600
125–400
LSI 5.3E
200–600
Energy
125–400
LSIG 6.3E
200–600
[1] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
7
7-65
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Trip Units
Class 611 / Refer to Catalog 0611CT1001
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.127: Micrologic Trip Units [2] for PowerPact H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit
Breakers
x– Standard Feature o – Available Option
Standard Ammeter Energy
Features
3.2/3/3 3.2S/3.3S 5.2A/5.3A 6.2A/6.3A 5.2E/5.3E 6.2E/6.3E
LI x
LSI [3] x x x
LSIG / Ground-Fault Trip[4] x x
Ground-Fault Alarm/Trip[4] x x
Current Setting Directly in Amperes x x x x x x
True RMS Sensing x x x x x x
UL Listed x x x x x x
Thermal Imaging x x x x x x
LED for Long-time Pickup x x x x x x
LED for Trip Indication x x x x x x
LED for Green “Ready” x x x x x x
Up to 12 Alarms Used Together x x x x
Digital Ammeter x x x x
Zone-selective Interlocking [5] x x x x
Communications o o o o o o
LCD Display x x x x
Front Display Module FDM121 o o o o
Advanced User Interface x x x x
Neutral Protection[4] x x x x
Contact Wear Indication [6] x x x x
Incremental Fine Tuning of Settings x x x x
Load Profile [6],[7] x x x x
Power Measurement x x
Power Quality Measurements x x
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-67
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units PowerPact P- and R-Frame Trip Units
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
[8] The standard rating plug supplied with a trip unit will be the “A” rating plug. To specify an alternative adjustable rating plug, please add the letter designation to the end of the catalog number.
Please refer to page 7-69for a complete listing of adjustable settings available with each plug. (Example: S143B would specify a “B” rating plug instead of the standard "A" plug.) Use suffix
“N” if no rating plug is required, deduct.
[9] When replacing a standard trip unit with Type A (Ammeter), P (Power metering) or H (Harmonic analysis) trip unit, order the 12-pin connector kit S33101 for the Masterpact NW and NT and
the PowerPact P-frame drawout circuit breakers or kit S33100 for PowerPact P-frame and R-frame unit-mount and I-Line circuit breakers. See page 7-69.
[10] Requires Circuit Breaker Communications Module.
[11] Requires neutral current transformer in 3Ø4W systems.
[12] Alarm history is available through the trip unit display and communications. Local indication of an alarm requires an M2C or M6C Programmable Contact Module.
7-68
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Trip Unit Accessories Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units
Class 612, 612 / Refer to Catalogs 0611CT1001 and 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Table 7.135: Sensor Plugs for P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers [18][19]
Circuit Sensor Plug Sensor Plug
Circuit Breaker Frames Accepting Sensor Plug
Breaker Range Catalog No.
P-Frame Circuit Breaker 250 A 400 As 600 As 630 A [20] 800 A 1000 A 1200 A 1250 A [20] 1600 A
250 A S47052 X
400 A S47053 X X X
600 A S48823 X X X X
UL
800 A S33092 X X X
1000 A S33093 X X
1200 A S48824 X
630 A S33091 X X X X X
800 A S33092 X X X X
IEC 1000 A S33093 X X X
1250 A S33094 X X
1600 A S33095 X
R-Frame Circuit Breaker 600 A 800 As 1000 As 1200 A 1600 A 2000 A 2500 A 3000 A 3200 A
600 A S48823 X X X X
800 A S33092 X X X X
1000 A S33093 X X X X
1200 A S48824 X X X X
UL
1600 A S33095 X X X X
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
2000 A S33982 X X X
2500 A S33983 X X
3000 A S48825 X
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
1600 A S33095 X X X X X
2000 A S33982 X X X X
IEC
2500 A S33983 X X X
3200 A S33984 X
[13] Long-time pickup amperes (Ir) = Sensor Rating (In) X Setting of rating plug. “Fine adjustment tuning” is included on Micrologic Power and Harmonic trip units, allowing for incremental
settings of 1 A between the plug setting and.40 X Sensor Rating.
[14] Includes NCTWIRING kit.
[15] Used for testing Micrologic trip units. Included in the price of the Hand-held/Full-function Test Kits. Kit for replacement only.
[16] Used for testing STR trip units. Included in the price of the Hand-held/Full-function Test Kits. Kit for replacement only.
[17] Included with the Full-function Test Kit. Kit for replacement only.
[18] For use only with circuit breakers with date codes later than 07011.
[19] See rating plug for long-time pickup range page 7-65.
[20] IEC Only.
7
7-69
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units Micrologic™ Trip Unit Accessories
Class 612, 612 / Refer to Catalogs 0611CT1001 and 0612CT0101
schneider-electric.us
7-70
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterpact™ NT/NW Circuit Breakers Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit
Breakers
schneider-electric.us Class 613 / Refer to Catalog 0613CT0001
Table 7.137: Trip Unit Field-Installable Accessories, Wire Harness [21] and ULP
Cords for H-, J-, and L-Frame Circuit Breakers [22]
Description Factory-Installed Field-Installable
Cat. No. Suffix Kit Cat. No.
External Accessories
Isolated Modbus Repeater Module — STRV00211
ZSI Interface Module — S434212
Internal Accessories
NSX Cord [23] L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) EA S434201
(for Modbus Communication) L = 3 m (9.84 ft) EB S434202
BSCM (Breaker Status and Control Module) with L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) EG [24] S434201BS
NSX Cord [23] L = 3 m (9.84 ft) EH [24] S434202BS
ZSI Interface Module Replacement BSCM — S434205
(Connects PowerPact H/J/L L = 1.3 m (4.27 ft) EK [24] S434204BS
circuit breakers to BSCM with NSX Cord for V > 480 Vac [23]
L = 3 m (9.84 ft) EL [24] S434303BS
SDTAM Module PowerPact P/R and Masterpact
(Remote indication relay NT/NW 24 Vdc Terminal Block EN S434210
for motor applications) circuit breakers) SDTAM 24/415 Vac/dc Module [25] V S429424
SDX Module 24/415 Vac/dc [26] V S429532
ZSI Wire Harness, H/J Frame YH3 S434300
ZSI Wire Harness, L-Frame YH3 S434301
ENCT Wire Harness YH2 S434302
OF Wire Harness YH1 S434500
SD/SDE Wire Harness YH1 S434501
SDx/SDTAM Wire Harness YH1 S434502
MN Wire Harness YH1 S434503
MX Wire Harness YH1 S434504
24 Vdc Terminal Block Wire Harness [27] YH1 S434505
Motor Operator Wire Harness YH1 S434506
Communicating Motor Operator Wire Harness YH1 S434507
NSX Wire Harness [27] YH1 S434508
ENCT and ZSI Wire Harness YH4 —
Table 7.138: Trip Unit Field-Installable Accessories for P- and R-Frame Circuit Breakers
Factory- Field-Installable Kit Cat. No.
Installed P-Frame R-Frame
Description
Cat. No. Motor With Rotary
Suffix Unit Mount I-Line Operated Drawout Unit Mount I-Line
Handle
Circuit Breaker Communication Module (BCM) (Modbus) E1 S64205 S64205 S64207 S64206 S64205 S64205 S64205
Two Programmable Contacts Module (M2C) V S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273 S64273
Six Programmable Contacts Module (M6C) W S64204 S64204 S64204 S64202 S64204 S64201 S64201
External Voltage Sensing (EVS) YV S64203 S64203 S64210 S64209 S64210 S64208 S64208
Full-Featured Performance
The Masterpact universal power circuit breaker offers a family of circuit protection
products meeting the most common world standards, ANSI, UL and IEC. The basic
design platform for each is common. The final result is UL, ANSI and IEC circuit breakers
with the same basic external dimensions, features and accessories.
• Complete product offering up to 200 k AIR without fuses
• Circuit
NFPA70E
breakers tested to show arc flash hazard risk category as referenced by
[21] Wire harness is required for I-Line applications, optional for unit-mount applications
YH1 = all installed accessories but ZSI and ENCT
YH2 = ENCT and all installed accessories
YH3 = ZSI and all installed accessories
YH4 = ZSI, ENCT and all installed accessories
[22] For proper selection, see catalog 0611CT1001.
[23] Installation requires IFM (STRV00210) for Modbus communication and/or FDM (STRV00121) for external display.
[24] If using with motor operator requires communicating motor operator (suffix NC).
[25] Remote indication relay for motor applications
[26] Remote indication relay
[27] I-Line wire harness is included for communication network accessories.
Optional wire harness for unit mount requires YH1 suffix.
7
7-71
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit Masterpact™ NT/NW Circuit Breakers
Breakers
Class 613 / Refer to Catalog 0613CT0001 schneider-electric.us
[1] 4000 A standard width circuit breaker is not available in L1 interrupting rating code or drawout construction (fixed mounting only).
[2] Drawout mounted only.
[3] 24 kA RMS for 800 A circuit breaker frame with 100 A or 250 A sensor.
[4] 65 kA RMS for 2000 A.
[5] None except 24 kA RMS for 800 A circuit breaker frame with 100 A or 250 A sensor.
[6] 40 kA RMS for 2000 A.
[7] The endurance rating for 2000 A, N/H/L/LF is 10,000 for mechanical and 1000 for electrical.
7-72
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Masterpact™ NT/NW Circuit Breakers Masterpact™ Universal Power Circuit
Breakers
schneider-electric.us Class 613 / Refer to Catalog 0613CT0001
Table 7.140: Masterpact NT Circuit Breaker Ratings
ANSI C37 Certified/
Standard UL 1066 Listed UL 489 Listed
Frame Rating 1600 A [8]
Interrupting Code 800 A 800 A 1200 A
N1 N H L1 L LF [9] N H L1 L LF [9] N H L1 L
240 Vac 42 50 65 100 200 200 50 65 100 200 200 50 65 100 200
Interrupting Current
(kA RMS) 50/60 Hz 480 Vac 42 50 50 65 100 100 50 50 65 100 100 50 50 65 100
600 Vac — 35 50 — — — 35 50 — — — 35 50 N/A N/A
Short-time Withstand Current (kA RMS) 42 35 35 10 10 10 35 35 10 10 10 35 35 10 10
Built-in Instantaneous Override (kA RMS ±10%) — 40 40 10 10 10 40 40 10 10 10 40 40 10 10
Close and latch rating (kA RMS) 40 25 25 10 10 10 25 25 10 10 10 25 25 10 10
Tested to show the arc flash hazard risk
category as referenced by NFPA70E — — — — — Yes — — — — Yes — — — —
25–30 ms with no
Breaking time 25–30 ms with no intentional delay (9 ms for L and LF)
intentional delay
Closing time < 50 ms
100–250 A 100–250 A 600–1200 A
Sensor Rating 800–1600 A
400–800 A 400–800 A —
Endurance Rating (C/O Cycles) Mechanical 12,500 12,500 12,500 12,500
With No Maintenance Electrical 2800 2800 2800 2800
7-73
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ground-Fault Protection Vigirex™ Ground-Fault Relay System
Class 931, 840, 960
schneider-electric.us
[1] 30 mA is instantaneous only, except for RH99M and RH99P models. Their suffix TD indicates time delay at 30 mA. For models with no time delay (IEC compliant) consult catalog
0972CT0401.
[2] Use as a guideline for sizing wire through sensor.
7-74
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Add-On Ground-Fault and Earth-Leakage Ground-Fault Protection
Modules
schneider-electric.us Class 931, 940, 960
[3] At 250 A, the GFM250JD can be used with 80% rated circuit breakers only.
[4] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for additional GFMs.
[5] At 250 A, the ELM250JD can be used with 80% rated circuit breakers only.
[6] For Factory Installation of ELM Module: For termination designation (3rd letter of catalog number) use ONLY “M”. Add factory installed 48 Vdc shunt trip (suffix SP) to breaker plus suffix VL
or VM.
7
7-75
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions and Shipping Weights Miniature and Molded Case Circuit
Breakers
Class 931, 940, 960 schneider-electric.us
Figure 21 Figure 22
C60 E B E Figure 23
Figure 13 Figure 14 Figure 15 Figure 16 G B B
D
A A A A G D
C E HH C
C/L
C/L
B B B B F A F A
E F A
E
E E
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[1] 35–70 A is 3.12 in; 80–100 A 2P and 70–100 A 3P are 3.50 in.
[2] QO-PL is 4.55 in.
[3] 80–100 A 1P and 80–125 A 2P are 4.45 in.
[4] 80–100 A 1P and 80–125 A 2P are 6.78 in.
[5] 70–100 A is 6.78 in.
[6] Dimensions E are 1.59 in at ON end and 0.63 in at OFF end.
[7] All weights are for 3P circuit breakers unless otherwise noted.
7-76
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Molded Case Circuit Breakers Dimensions and Shipping Weights
Class 931, 940, 960
schneider-electric.us
A
Table 7.152: Shipping Weights [9]
F Approx. Shipping Approx. Shipping
Frame Size Weight (Lbs.) Frame Size Weight (Lbs.)
B-Frame 1P 1 H-Frame 2P 4
B-Frame 2P 2 H-Frame 3P 5
B-Frame 3P 3 J-Frame 5
B-Frame 4P 4 L-Frame 14
B EDB 1P 2 M-Frame 29
C
EDB 2P 3 P-Frame 32
D EDB 3P 4 R-Frame (Without RLTB) 52
Figure 29 Figure 30
Figure 35
Figure 36
Figure 31 1P E
B E 2P B
E B B E E B
A C A F H
D A F H
A A
Figure 33
Figure 32 B D
C
G C
C D
D
E Figure 37 Figure 38
E B
3P B E 4P B E
AF
A C
E
D
A F H A F H
Figure 34
B
G D
F C
G C G C
D D
AE
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-77
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us
FA100DS
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
[8] Use only 90°C (minimum) rated wire sized per ampacity of 75°C rated conductors for 100% rated circuit breakers.
[9] Rated for 240 Vac maximum. Short circuit current rating is 25 kAIR at 240 Vac.
[10] Accepts standard 80% rated circuit breakers only. Not rated for 100% rated circuit breakers.
[11] Use copper conductors only.
[12] Rated 480 Vac maximum. Short circuit current rating is 18 kAIR at 480 V.
[13] For conduit entry through the top end wall use one of the following Square D conduit hubs: A200L for 2.00 in., A250L for 2.50 in., A300L for 3.00 in., A350L for 3.50 in. or A400L for 4.00 in.
[14] Add suffix BE if no knockouts are required on the end walls.
[15] For access to the circuit breaker’s standard, ammeter or energy trip unit panel/LCD, add suffix T.
[16] For 200% neutral use copper wire only.
[17] Complete rating is NEMA 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 5, and 12.
[18] For NEMA 3R applications, remove drain screw from bottom endwall.
[19] Add suffix VW for visibility to the standard, ammeter or energy trip unit of the PowerPact circuit breaker.
[20] Will accept PowerPact L-frame circuit breakers and Motor Protectors with suffixes M38X
[21] Will accept PowerPact L-frame Molded Case Switches.
[22] When the QJL circuit breaker is installed in the enclosure, the enclosure is limited to Short Circuit Current ratings of 65 kAIR at 240 V and 100 kAIR at 208 V.
[23] Limited to 200 A.
7
7-79
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us
[29] NEMA 7 — Indoor Hazardous Locations — Division 1 and 2, Class I, Groups C and D; Class II, Groups E, F and G; Class III
[30] NEMA 9 — Indoor Hazardous Locations — Division 1 and 2, Class ii, Groups E, F and G; Class iii
[31] Short circuit current rating: 65 kAIR at 240 Vac, 25 kAIR at 480 Vac, and 18 kAIR at 600 Vac
[32] Not cULus listed due to wire bending space.
[33] Catalog number in table is enclosure only. For complete installation, the following must be ordered separately: WB Circuit Breakers (qty. 2, Supplemental Digest Section 3), Walking Beam
Assembly (Supplemental Digest Section 3), Mounting Pan (Supplemental Digest Section 3) and Neutral and Service Ground Kits, below
[34] Enclosure has blank top endwall.
[35] For applications above 200 A requiring a neutral, use copper wire only.
7
7-81
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosure Accessories and Dimensions
Class 610
schneider-electric.us
Enclosure Accessories
Table 7.162: Neutral Kit Terminal Data
Neutral Kit Terminal Lug Data -Total Available (Line All Copper Neutral Terminal Lug Data -Total
Catalog Number plus Load) AWG/kcmil AL/CU Available (Line plus Load) AWG/kcmil
(2) 14–1/0 Cu or
100SNA (2) 12–1/0 Al plus (1) 14–4 Cu —
(4) 14–1/0 Cu or
SN100FA (4) 12–1/0 Al —
SN225KA (2) 4–300 Al/Cu plus (2) 14–1/0 Al/Cu —
225SNA (4) 6–350 Al/Cu —
(2) 1–600 or
400SN (4) 1–250 Al/Cu, plus (2) 4–300 Al/Cu —
(2) 1–600 or
SN400LA (4) 1–250 Al/Cu, plus (2) 4–300 Al/Cu —
SN1000MA (6) 3/0–500 Al/Cu, plus (1) 1–4/0 Al/Cu —
SNC400LX — (2) 2–-600 Cu, plus (2) 6–250 Cu
SNC800LX — (4) 2–600 Cu, plus (1) 2–4/0 Cu
AL800SN (6) 3/0–500 Al/Cu, plus (2) 6–250 Al/Cu —
SN1200 (8) 3/0–750 Al/Cu, plus (2) 6–350 Al/Cu —
S33576MK (8) 3/0–500 Al/Cu, plus (2) 4–300 Al/Cu —
7-82
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Enclosure Accessories and Dimensions Circuit Breaker Enclosures
Class 610
schneider-electric.us
Enclosure Dimensions
H
H
H H H
W D W D
W WB enclosure WB enclosure uses 2 circuit breakers W D
uses 2 circuit breakers NEMA Type 3R NEMA Type 7, Type 9
(Uses side hinge cover) W D
NEMA Type 1
NEMA Type 4, 4X, 5, 12, 12K
7-83
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breaker Enclosures Enclosure Accessories and Dimensions
Class 610
schneider-electric.us
7
MINIATURE AND MOLDED CASE
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
7-84
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 8
8
TeSys™ VLS Disconnect Switches 8-9
Disconnect Switches, 16–125 A 8-9
TeSys™ VLS Accessories 8-11
Fourth Pole Add-on 8-11
Add-on Blocks 8-12
Sequence and Maximum Combination of Add-on Blocks 8-13
UL508 VLS S witc h UL98 VLS S witc h Rotary Handles 8-16
Shaft Extensions, Terminal Covers, Fuse Holders, and Fuse Blocks 8-18
Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect Switches 8-19
Wiring Diagrams 8-22
Technical Specifications, VLS Range, 16–125 A 8-23
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches 8-24
9421 Typ e L LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible Disconnect Switches 8-24
UL98 S tyle Fla n g e Ha n d le Circ u it Bre a ke r LK4 Nonfusible Disconnect Switches 8-24
Dis c o n n e c t S witc h Me c h a n is m GS2 Fusible Disconnect Switches 8-26
Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches 8-27
Accessories, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible 8-27
Accessories 8-27
Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible 8-28
LK4JU3N / LK4MU3N / LK4QU3N, 100–400 A Nonfusible Disconnect
Switches—Dimensions 8-28
GS2QU3N, 400 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses 8-32
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated 8-32
Introduction 8-45
Types M5, M6, M1, and M8 8-46
Single and Multi-Door Enclosures 8-47
Types M5, M6, M1, and M8 8-48
Operating Mechanisms, Accessories 8-49
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms and Disconnect Selection Guide
Switches
8
Selection Guide
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
8-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches
Enclosed Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
8
Model (V-Vario, K-Operator)
Mini-Vario
Table 8.2: Assembled Switches—Degree of Protection IP65, Type 1 and 12
Complete Switches for Rear
Complete Switches for Door Mounting (3- Mounting, Includes Extension Shaft
Padlock)
Rating (A) (3-Padlock)
Red/Yellow (Single Black/Gray (Single Red/Yellow (Single Hole)
Hole) Hole)
UL IEC Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
10 12 VCDN12 VBDN12 VCCDN12
16 20 VCDN20 VBDN20 VCCDN20
VN12
VN12/KCC1YZ
Table 8.3: Mini-Vario Enclosed Switches
Complete Switches Mounted in IP55 Non-Metallic Enclosure
Catalog No.
Description
VCFN12GE Red/Yellow Mounted In Sealable Enclosure,
VCFN20GE Non-UL Listed, Non-NEMA Rated
Vario
Table 8.6: NEMA Type 1 and 12 Assembled Switches for Door Mounting
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
Rating (A) Red/Yellow (Four Black/Gray (Four Red/Yellow (Single Black/Gray (Single
Hole) Hole) Hole) Hole)
UL IEC Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
10 12 VCF02 VBF02 VCD02 VBD02
16 20 VCF01 VBF01 VCD01 VBD01
20 25 VCF0 VBF0 VCD0 VBD0
20 32 VCF1 VBF1 VCD1 VBD1
25 40 VCF2 VBF2 VCD2 VBD2
45 63 VCF3 VBF3 — —
63 80 VCF4 VBF4 — —
100 125 VCF5 VBF5 — —
115 175 VCF6 VBF6 — —
Table 8.7: NEMA Type 1 and 12 Assembled Switches for Rear Mounting
Complete Switches for Rear Mounting Switches with Handles Installed
with Extension Shaft (3-Padlock)[3] on Unit, DIN Rail Mount Only
Rating (A)
Red/Yellow (Four Red/Yellow (Single Red/Yellow (1- Black/Gray (No-
Hole) Hole) Padlock) Padlock)
UL IEC Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
10 12 VCCF02 VCCD02 — —
16 20 VCCF01 VCCD01 — —
20 25 VCCF0 VCCD0 VVE0 VVD0
20 32 VCCF1 VCCD1 VVE1 VVD1
25 40 VCCF2 VCCD2 VVE2 VVD2
45 63 VCCF3 — VVE3 VVD3
63 80 VCCF4 — VVE4 VVD4
100 125 VCCF5 — — —
115 175 VCCF6 — — —
VC•GUN
[3] Complete switch includes handle operator, shaft, door interlock plate, and line terminal shroud.
[4] Assembled, includes switches mounted in enclosure with handle.
[5] Refer to Table 8.11 Vario Manual Motor Control Switches, IEC, page 8-5 and Table 8.12 Vario Manual Motor Control Switches, page 8-5 for horsepower ratings.
8-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Assembled and UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches
Enclosed Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Vario switches meet UL508 requirements as both enclosed and open manual motor
controllers. They are also marked “Suitable as Motor Disconnect” allowing installation on
the load side of the motor branch circuit short-circuit and ground-fault protection. If motor
branch circuit short-circuit and ground-fault protection is needed, use a GS1 or 9422
fusible switch or circuit breaker meeting NEC 430.52 requirements.
8
Class 9421 NEMA Type 1 V1G30, V2G30 Class 9421 NEMA Type 4, 4X, 12
V1W30, V2W30, V1A30, V2A30
Table 8.14: NEMA Type 1 and 12 Handle Operators: V02–V2 (6 mm Shaft), V3–V6
(8 mm Shaft) [8]
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
45 x 45 mm 45 x 45 mm 45 x 45 mm 45 x 45 mm
No. of Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
Switches
Padlocks
V02–V2 0 KCC1LZ KCE1LZ KAC1BZ KAE1BZ
Single-Hole Operator Four-Hole Operator V02–V2 1 KCC1YZ KCE1YZ — —
(All except KDF3PZ Red/Yellow Single Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Single Black/Gray Four
and KBF3PZ) Operator Type Hole Hole Hole Hole
60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm 60 x 60 mm
V02–V2 0 KDD1PZ KDF1PZ KBD1PZ KBF1PZ
V3–V4 0 — KDF2PZ — KBF2PZ
V02–V2 3 KCD1PZ KCF1PZ KAD1PZ KAF1PZ
V3–V4 3 — KCF2PZ — KAF2PZ
Red/Yellow Four Black/Gray Four
Operator Type Hole Hole
90 x 90 mm 90 x 90 mm
Four-Hole Operator V5–V6 0 KDF3PZ KBF3PZ
KDF3PZ and KBF3PZ V5–V6 3 KCF3PZ KAF3PZ
0.51 0.51
0.12 0.22 13.0 0.22
3.0 13.0
5.5 5.5
0.5
12.7
2.67
1.89
68
48
0.88 2.67
22.5 1.89
48 68
Single-Hole
Mounting Dimensions Four-Hole 60 x 60 Four-Hole 90 x 90
Mounting Dimensions [9] Mounting Dimensions [9]
[8] When using these handles for replacements on the non-metallic enclosed switches, the handle shaft that comes with the enclosure must be reused. See Section 15 of the Supplemental
Digest.
[9] The door interlock plate included with VCC Kits has the same drilling as the handle operators.
8-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Mini-Vario and Vario™ Accessories UL 508 Motor Disconnect Switches
Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
schneider-electric.us
8
V02 to V2 16.9 429 VZ30 KZ 32 KZ83
V3, V4 16.5 419 VZ31 KZ 74 KZ81
V5, V6 17.7 450 VZ31 KZ 74 KZ81
schneider-electric.us
The MD motor disconnect switch is listed UL 508 Suitable for Motor Control
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
(UL File E164864) and conforms to IEC standard 60947-3. It is in a compact NEMA 4X
enclosure suitable for use in NEMA 1, 3, 3R, 4, 4X, and 12 applications. The MD's key
benefits are an extremely small footprint, a more economically efficient NEMA 4X
solution, and a handle interlock preventing cover removal when the switch is in the ON
position.
Switch features:
• Suitable for NEMA 1, 3R, 4, 4X, and 12 enclosure applications.
• Complies with OSHA lockout/tagout requirements—accepts up to three 8 mm
padlocks.
• For accessories, see Table 8.20.
Table 8.26: MD Motor Disconnect Switch—Non-Metallic NEMA 1, 3, 3R, 4, 4X, and
12 Enclosure
Maximum Horsepower Ratings
Height Width Depth
D Amperes Cat. No. Three-Phase Vac (in.) (in.) (in.)
220–240 440–480 600
30 MD3304X 7.5 20 25 6.38 3.9 4.37
60 MD3604X 20 40 40 8.27 4.94 4.37
H
Table 8.27: MD Motor Disconnect Accessories
Cat. No. Description
MDSAN20 2 N.O. auxiliary contact module
MDSAN11 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. auxiliary contact module
MDS30P 30 A add on power pole
W
MD Motor Disconnect Switch
8-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Disconnect Switches UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
8
Fuse holder ● ● ●
Mechanical 6-8 pole coupling system ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
Mechanical interlock for line switching ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ● ●
Example VLSH 2 S 5 R
Description Rotary handle 1 = Recessed, 65 x 65 mm H = Hole fixing 5 = 5 mm shaft opening B = Black
2 = Protruding, 65 x 65 mm S = Screw mounting 7 = 7 mm shaft opening BC = Black, changeover
3 = Pistol grip, 75 mm dia. BD = Black, defeatable
4 = Protruding, 48 x 48 mm R = Red
RD = Red, defeatable
Example VLS 1N R 1
Description Ground and Neutral 1G = 1 Pole Ground terminal R = DIN rail mounted 1 = Small size (16–63 A), UL 508
Terminals 1N = 1 Pole Neutral terminal D = Door mounted 2 = Large size (63–125 A), UL 98
Example VLS A 11 R 1 S
Description Auxiliary contacts A = Auxiliary contact 10 = 1 N.O. R = DIN rail mounted Blank = Size 1 and 2 S = Simultaneous closing
11 = 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. D = Door mounted 1 = Size 1 E = Early make closing
2 = Size 2
8-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Disconnect Switches
Switches
8
Product Overview
Compact Size
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
The three-pole 16–63 A disconnect switches are made up of a single unit body, a mere
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
36 mm (1.4 in.) wide, while those rated 63–125 A are only 70 mm (2.8 in.) wide.
Accessory Flexibility
Mounting and removal of the fourth pole and add-on blocks are simple and quick
operations with no need for tools.
Certifications
All VLS disconnect switches are certified by cCSAus and are UL Listed for Canada and
VLS3P016R1– USA:
VLS3P063R1
• 16–63 A types: certified according to UL 60947-4-1 / CSA 22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14
standards
• 63–125 A types: certified according to UL 98 / CSA 22.2 n° 4 standards
Three-Pole Disconnect Switches
Table 8.29: Certifications and Compliance (● = certification obtained)
Catalog number cULus per UL 60947-4-1 / cULus per UL 98 / IEC/EN 60947-1,
CSA C22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14 CSA C22.2 n° 4 IEC/EN 60947-3
UL Listed (File E487906) UL Listed (File E487907)
VLS3P016R1–
VLS3P040R1 ● —
VLS3P063R1 ● —
VLS3P016D1–
VLS3P040D1 ● — Compliant
VLS3P063R2–
VLS3P125R2 — ●
VLS3P063D2–
VLS3P125D2 — ●
[1] Ratings are valid for VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D• types, according to UL 60947-4-1 and CSA 22.2 n° 60947-4-1-14. UL Listed for USA and Canada (cULus - File E487907) as Manual Motor
Controllers, while the UL designation is “General Purpose Switch. Interrupteur Usage General” and “Suitable As Motor Disconnect.”
8-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Catalog number Horsepower General use Short-circuit rating Max. fuse rating
1 phase 3 phase at 600 Vac at 600 Vac at 600 V
(A) (kA) (A)
120 V 240 V 200–208 V 240 V 480 V 600 V
VLS3P063R1 2 7.5 10 15 30 30 60 5 45 (Type RK5)
UL 98 and CSA C22.2 n° 4 [2]
VLS3P063•• 3 7.5 20 [3] 20 40 40 60 50 60
VLS3P080•• 3 10 25 [3] 25 40 40 100 50 100
VLS3P100•• 5 10 30 [3] 30 50 50 100 50 100
VLS3P125•• 7.5 10 30 [3] 30 60 60 100 50 100
8
Early-make closing with respect to switch poles
Size Compact and modular
[2] Ratings are valid for VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D• types, according to UL 98 and CSA C22.2 n° 4. UL Listed for USA and Canada (cULus - File E487907) as Open Type Switches – Open
type unfused switch, while UL designation is “General Purpose Switch. Interrupteur Usage General.”
[3] Voltage value is not considered in UL98 / CSA 22.2 n° 4 standards, and so is not indicated in the UL product marking.
[4] For VLS3P016R1–040R1 only.
[5] For VLS3P063R1 only.
[6] For VLS3P016D1–040D1 only.
[7] For VLS3P063R2–125R2 only.
[8] For VLS3P063D2–125D2 only.
8-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8
Add-on Blocks
Table 8.35: Operational Specifications
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
Auxiliary contacts
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Other devices
Tightening torque VLS1NR1/D1, VLS1GR1/D1 terminals 1.8–2 N•m (16–18 lb-in)
VLS1NR2/D2, VLS1GR2/D2 terminals 5–6 N•m (45–54 lb-in)
VLS8C1/C2, VLS8M1/M2 mounting: 0.5 N•m (4.4 lb-in)
extension with handle: 0.8 N•m (7.1 lb-in)
VLSA11RS VLSA11DS
VLS3P063R2/D2…VLS3P125R2/D2 55°
Main poles
VLS1NR• VLSA11RS/DS 45°
VLS1GR• Auxiliary contacts (1 NO + 1 NC) NO
VLS1ND• NC
VLS1GD• 25°
VLSA10R2E Travel 0Õ 1 55°
Auxiliary contact
(1EB – NO early break) Travel 1Õ 0 65°
Off On
VLS8C•
VLS8M•
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
DIN Rail Mounting Disconnect Switches
Table 8.37: VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1 (DIN Rail Mounting)
VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P040R1E VLS3P016R1 VLS1P040R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P040R1S VLS3P025R1 VLS1P040R1S
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P032R1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — VLS3P040R1 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1
8
1 1 1 1 — — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — — 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — 1 — — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1
VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P063R1E VLS3P063R1 VLS1P063R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P063R1S VLS1P063R1S
1 1 1 — 1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — — 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — 1 — — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1
VLS1NR2 VLS1GR2 VLSA11RS VLSA10R2E VLS1P125R2E VLS3P063R2 VLS1P125R2E VLSA10R2E VLSA11RS VLS1GR2 VLS1NR2
VLS1P•••R•S VLS3P080R2 VLS1P•••R•S
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P100R2 — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — VLS3P125R2 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 — 1 — 1 1 — —
— — 1 1 — 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 1 — — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — — 1 1 — —
— — 2 — — — — 2 — —
1 1 — — — 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — 1 — — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1
8-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8
8-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Table 8.42: VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS8C1–VLS8M1 (Rear Mounting)
VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P040R1E VLS8C1–VLS8M1 VLS1P040R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P040R1S VLS1P040R1S
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P016R1 + 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P016R1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — VLS3P025R1 + 1 — 1 1 1
VLS3P025R1
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P032R1 + — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — VLS3P032R1 1 — 1 1 1
8
1 1 1 1 — VLS3P040R1 + — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — VLS3P040R1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — 1 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1
VLS1NR1 VLS1GR1 VLSA11RS VLSA10R1E VLS1P063R1E VLS8C1– VLS1P063R1E VLSA10R1E VLSA11RS VLS1GR1 VLS1NR1
VLS1P063R1S VLS8M1 VLS1P063R1S
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P063R1 + 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 VLS3P063R1 — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — 1 — 1 1 1
1 1 1 1 — — — 2 1 1
1 1 2 — — — 1 1 1 1
1 1 2 — — — — 2 1 1
1 1 — — 1 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1
VLS1NR2 VLS1GR2 VLSA11RS VLSA10R2E VLS1P125R2E VLS8C2 - VLS8M2 VLS1P125R2E VLSA10R2E VLSA11RS VLS1GR2 VLS1NR2
VLS1P•••R•S VLS1P•••R•S
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P063R2 + 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P063R2 — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — VLS3P080R2 + 1 — 1 — —
VLS3P080R2
— — 1 — 1 VLS3P100R2 + — 1 1 — —
— — 1 1 — VLS3P100R2 1 — 1 — —
— — 1 1 — VLS3P125R2 + — — 2 — —
— — 2 — — VLS3P125R2 — 1 1 — —
— — 2 — — — — 2 — —
1 1 — — 1 1 — — 1 1
1 1 — — — — — — 1 1
8-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8
Rotary Handles
Table 8.45: Selection—Rotary Handles (NEMA 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4X. IEC IP65 unless
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
otherwise specified)
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Catalog Specifications
number
Door Mounting and Rear Mounting Handles, Padlock-ready[11]
Red/yellow, rotating
VLSH1S5R For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Recessed selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) [12].
VLSH2S5R For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2H5R For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1. Ring mounting. Protruding selector.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12] [13]
VLSH1S5R (65 x 65 mm) VLSH2H5RD For VLS3P•••R•. Ring mounting. Protruding selector with release, defeatable per UL60947-4-1;
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH3S7RD For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2, and VLS8M2. Screw mounting. Pistol grip with release,
defeatable per 60947-4-1; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.). IEC IP66. [14]
VLSH4S5R For For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. 48 mm square.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
Black, rotating
VLSH1S5B For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Recessed selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2S5B For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2H5B For VLS3P•••R•, VLS3P063R1, VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1. Ring mounting. Protruding selector.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12] [13]
VLSH2H5BD For VLS3P•••R•. Ring mounting. Protruding selector with release, defeatable per 60947-4-1.
□ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH2S5R (65 x 65 mm) VLSH3S7BD For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2, and VLS8M2. Screw mounting. Pistol grip with release,
defeatable per UL60947-4-1; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.). [14]
VLSH2S5BC For VLS8C• mechanical interlock mechanism (I-O-II). □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
VLSH4S5B For For VLS3P•••R• and VLS3P•••D•. Screw mounting. Protruding selector. □ 5 mm (0.2 in.). [12]
Accessories for Rear Mounting Control For VLSH3S7RD and VLSH3S7BD handles.
VLSHA7 Adapter, □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) for VLS3P063R2-–VLS3P125R2.
[11] Catalog numbers ending in BD or RD are for rear mounting units only.
[12] For VLS3P•••R• disconnect switches, separately purchase VLSS shaft extensions.
[13] Snap-on mounting of VLS3P016–VLS3P040D1 disconnect switches with the handle.
[14] Separately purchase the VLSS•••7 shaft extension and a VLSHA7 handle having a 7 mm (0.3 in.) square section—not required for VLS8M2.
8-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ VLS Accessories UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Handle mounting ring or screw
VLSH1S5R/B
Mounting handle interaxis VLSH2S5R/B 36 x 36 mm (1.4 x 1.4 in.) or 48 x 48 mm (1.9 x 1.9 in.)
(compatible with the pre-existing drillings of the VLSH2S5BC
most common types in the marketplace)
VLSH3S7RD/BD 36 x 36 mm (1.4 x1.4 in.)
Padlocks 1–3 for all handles Ø4–8 mm (Ø0.2–0.3 in.)
Mounting ring types 2.3 N•m (20.4 lb-in)
VLS8M1 0.8 N•m (7 lb-in)
Tightening torque
VLSH3S7RD/BD 1.5 N•m (13.3 lb-in)
All others 1 N•m (9 lb-in)
IEC / EN: IP65 for all except VLSH3S7RD/BD, which are IP66.
UL / CSA: VLSH1S5R/B and VLSH3S7RD/BD are Type 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4X outdoor use with all VLS switch models.
Degree of protection
VLSH2S5R/B, VLSH2H5R/B, VLSH2H5RD/BD and VLSH2S5BC are Types 1, 12, 3R, 4, and 4X outdoor use with
VLS3P016R1/D1–VLS3P040R1/D1 and VLS3P063R1 models, otherwise Type 1 only.
VLS3P016D1
VLS3P025D1
8
VLSS1 505 VLS3P016D1 VLS3P032D1
VLSS3 005 VLS3P025D1 VLS3P040D1
VLSS5 005 VLS3P032D1
( 5 mm)
VLS3P016R1 VLS3P040D1 VLSH2H5R/B
VLSH2S5RD/BD
VLS3P025R1 VLSH1S5B
VLS3P032R1
VLS3P040R1 VLSH2H5R/B VLSH2H5R/B
VLS3P063R1 VLSH2H5R/B VLSH2H5RD/BD
VLSH1S5B
VLS3P063D2
VLSH2S5R/B VLS3P080D2
VLS3P100D2
VLS3P125D2
VLSH1S5R/B
VLSH1S5R/B
VLSH2S5R/B
VLSH4S 5R/B
VLSHA7
B
VLSS1507
C VLSS3007
VLS3P063R2 VLSH4S5R/B
VLS3P080R2 A
( 5 mm) E
VLS3P100R2 E E
D
VLS3P125R2 D
E VLSH3S7RD/BD
D
E Figure 8.3: Door mounting version
D Certifications and Compliance:
D
See Table 8.46 for details.
Figure 8.2: Changing the DIN rail mounting version for rear
mounting
8-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect TeSys™ VLS Accessories
Switches
8
Table 8.48: Selection—Shaft Extensions, Terminal Covers, Fuse Holders, and Fuse
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Blocks
Catalog Specifications Qty per Weight,
number package kg (lb)
Shaft extension for rear-mounting handles VLSH1S5R–VLSH2H5RD, VLSH1S5B–VLSH2H5BD, VLSH2H5BC;
interlocking changeover type VLS8C1, VLS8C2; and mechanical disconnect switch system VLS8M1
VLSS1505 150 mm long; □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) 1 0.032
(0.07)
VLSS•••5 (5 mm) VLSS•••7 (7 mm) VLSS3005 300 mm long; □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) 1 0.068
(0.15)
VLSS5005 500 mm long; □ 5 mm (0.2 in.) 1 0.090
(0.20)
Shaft extension for rear-mounting handles VLSH3S7RD/BD, and mechanical coupling system VLS8M2
VLSS1507 150 mm long; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) 1 0.090
(0.20)
VLSS3007 300 mm long; □ 7 mm (0.3 in.) 1 0.160
(0.35)
Set of 2 one-pole terminal covers for fourth pole
VLSC1P1 For VLS1P040R1S, VLS1P040D1S, VLS1P040R1E, VLS1P040D1E, 1 0.009
VLS1P063R1E, VLS1P063R1S (0.02)
VLSC1P2 For VLS1P063R2S–VLS1P125R2S, VLS1P063D2S–VLS1P125D2S, 1 0.012
VLS1P125R2E, VLS1P125D2E (0.03)
Set of 2 three-pole terminal covers
VLSC VLSFH1UL VLSC3P1 For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P040R1, VLS3P063R1, VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1 1 0.018
(0.04)
VLSC3P2 For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2, VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2 1 0.030
(0.07)
Fuse holder/block for disconnect switches
VLSFH1UL For VLS3P016R1–VLS3P032R1 (suitable for Class CC fuses) 1 0.135
(0.30)
Terminal covers
VLS1P…R1
VLS1P…R2
VLS3P…R1
VLS3P...R2
VLS C1P 1
VLS C1P 2
VLS C3P 1
VLS C3P 2 VLSC1P1
VLSC1P2
VLSC3P1
VLSC3P2
VLS 1P …D1
VLS 3P …D1
VLS 3P...D2 VLS 1P …D2
8-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
45 (1.77)
78 (3.07)
74 (2.91)
(1.28)
100 (3.94)
94 (3.70)
32.5
(1.77)
45
Dim. = mm (in.)
(1.65)
41.9
22 14.2 (0.56)
(0.87)
38.2 14.4 (0.57)
(1.50)
8
VLS3P016D1–VLS3P040D1 VLS3P063D2–VLS3P125D2
36 19.9 48.6
(1.42) 52.7 (2.07) 70 (2.75) (1.91) 20.8
(0.78)
(0.82)
55.5 (2.18)
78 (3.07)
(1.76)
44.8
100 (3.94)
65 (2.56)
Dim. = mm (in.)
78 (3.07)
78 (3.07)
(1.28)
(1.64)
32.5
41.6
Dim. = mm (in.)
For VLS3P063R2–VLS3P125R2
Auxiliary contacts Fourth pole
VLSA11RS VLS1P125R2E, VLS1P063R2S–VLS1P125R2S
VLSA10R2E VLS1NR2 neutral, VLS1GR2 ground terminals
12 48. 9 (1.93) 23 70 (2.75)
9 (0.47) 46.2 (0.90) 5 43.9
(0.35) (1.82) (0.20) (1.73)
72.6 (2.86)
100 (3.94)
78 (3.07)
(1.64)
41.6
Dim. = mm (in.)
(1.77)
100 (3.94)
45
(1.77)
45
Dim. = mm (in.)
VLS8C1 - VLS8M1
VLS8C2 - VLS8M 2
8-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect
Switches Switches
8
46.2 43
12
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
72.6 (2.86)
78 (3.07)
78 (3.07)
(1.64)
41.6
Dim. =
mm (in.)
72.6 (2.86)
100 (3.94)
100 (3.94)
(1.64)
41.6
Dim. =
mm (in.)
VLSA11DS
VLS1P063D2S, VLS1P080D2S, VLS1P100D2S,
VLS1P125D2S, VLS1P125D2E, VLS1ND1,
VLS1ND2, VLS1GD1, VLS1GD2
Dim. =
Ø16 (0.63)
(1.10–1.26)
61.8 (2.43)
Ø16 (0.63)
48 (1.89)
36 (1.42)
65 (2.56)
65 (2.56)
36 (1.42)
mm (in.)
28–32
Ø3 (0.12) Ø3 (0.12)
VLSH2H5R/B VLSH2H5RD/BD
34.3 (1.35) 35 (1.38) 35.5 1–4
3.3 (0.13) (1.40) (0.04–0.16) 3.3 (0.13)
1–4 35
65 (2.56) (0.04–0.16) 65 (2.56) (1.38)
(0.79)
Ø20
Dim. =
37 (1.46)
65 (2.56)
65 (2.56)
(0.96)
2.5
Ø32.9
(1.29)
2.5
(0.96)
24.3
mm (in.)
24.3
Ø2 .88) Ø2 0.88)
(0 (
(0.87)
Ø22
VLSH3S7RD/BD VLSH2S5BC
1–4 1–4 48 (1.89)
(0.04–0.16) (0.04–0.16) 36 (1.42)
98 (3.86) 46 36 (1.42) 22 35
(1.81) 65 (2.56) (0.87) (1.38)
60 (2.36)
Ø16 (0.63)
36 (1.42)
65 (2.56)
48 (1.89)
Dim. =
Ø66 (2.60)
Ø48 (1.89)
36 (1.42)
75 (2.95)
2
Ø3 .26) mm (in.)
(1
Ø3
(0.12)
Ø4.2 (0.16)
VLSH4S5R/B
36 (1.42) Dim. =
28–32 mm (in.)
16 (1.10–1.26)
48 (1.89) (0.63) 21.8
(0.86)
(1.10–1.26)
Ø16 (0.63)
36 (1.42)
28–32
1–4 Ø3 (0.12)
(0.04–0.16)
8-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions: 16–125 A Disconnect UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
Switches Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
5 (0.20) 5 (0.20)
65 (2.56) A 65 (2.56) A
65 (2.56)
65 (2.56)
Dim. =
mm (in.)
8
Length Type of handle
Extension mm (in.)
VLSH VLSH VLSH VLSH VLSH
1S5• 2S5• 2H5R 2H5RD 2S5BC
VLSS1505 150 (5.90) 194 (7.64) 192 (7.56) 197 (7.75) 211 (8.31) 192 (7.56)
VLSS3005 300 (11.81) 344 (13.54) 342 (13.46) 347 (13.66) 361 (14.21) 342 (13.46)
VLSS5005 500 (19.68) 544 (21.42) 542 (21.34) 547 (21.53) 561 (22.09) 542 (21.34)
100 (3.94)
65 (2.56)
Dim. =
mm (in.)
23
(0.90) 20
VLSS… VLSH… (0.90)
VLS3P016R1–063R1 VLSS...5 VLSH2S5BC
VLS3P063R2, VLS3P080R2,
VLS3P100R2, VLS3P125R2
Table 8.56: Dimension A1 for VLSS used with VLS8C1, VLS8C2, and VLS8M1
Extension (5 mm) Length A1 maximum, mm (in.)
mm (in.) Used with VLS8M1 Used with VLS8C1/VLS8C2
Type of handle
VLSH1S5• VLSH2S5• VLSH2H5R VLSH2H5RD VLSH2S5BC
VLSS1505 150 (5.90) 211 (8.31) 209 (8.23) 214 (8.42) 228 (8.98) 209 (8.23)
VLSS3005 300 (11.81) 361 (14.21) 359 (14.13) 364 (14.33) 378 (14.88) 359 (14.13)
VLSS5005 500 (19.68) 561(22.09) 559 (22.01) 564 (22.20) 578 (22.75) 559 (22.01)
75 (2.95)
Ø66
100 (3.94)
Dim. =
75 (2.95)
mm (in.)
19
(0.75)
VLSS...7 VLSH3S7RD,
VLSH3S7RD/BD VLSH3S7BD
VLSS•••7 VLS3P063R2–125R2
40 19 1–4
VLS3P063R2–125R2 (1.57) 1–4 (0.75) (0.04–0.16)
48 (1.89) 19 (0.04–0.16)
(0.75)
Length B B1
Extension (7 mm) with VLSH3S7RD/BD handle
mm (in.) mm (in.) mm (in.)
VLSS1507 176 (6.93) 118–229 (4.64–9.01) 119–205 (4.68–8.07)
VLSS2007 226 (8.90) 118–279 (4.64–10.99) 119–255 (4.68–10.03)
VLSS3007 326 (12.83) 118–379 (4.64–14.92) 119–355 (4.68–13.98)
8-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect Wiring Diagrams
Switches
8
80.1 (3.15)
(0.47) (1.42)
(1.04)
(1.46)
26.4
37
10 (0.39)
9.9 (0.39)
VLSC1P2, VLSC3P2
VLSC1P1 VLSC3P1 VLSC1P2 VLSC3P2 8.6 (0.34)
(0.39)
(0.39)
12.7 (0.50)
10
10
12 36 23 70 (2.75) 46 (1.81)
(0.47) (1.42) 46 (1.81) (0.90)
(1.04)
26.4
(1.47)
37.3
Dim. =
mm (in.)
T1 T2 T3
Load 7 L4 7 L4
8 T4 8 T4
Load Load
Add-on Blocks and Accessories
Auxiliary contacts Neutral terminal Earth/Ground terminal Fuse holder
VLSA11•S VLSA10R1E–VLSA10R2E VLS1NR1/D1–VLS1NR2/ VLS1GR1/D1–VLS1GR2/ VLSFH1
D2 D2
13 21 57 N PE L1 L2 L3
68
14 22 N PE
67
T1 T2 T3
58
8-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Technical Specifications, VLS Range, 16– UL 60947-4-1 and UL 98 Disconnect
125 A Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9400CT1601
8
AC23A
690 V kW 11 22 22 22 22 45 45 45 45
IEC reactive power for capacitor control 400 V kvar 7.5 10 12.5 15 15 25 30 40 50
IEC protection against short-circuit
Rated short-time withstand current (1 s), Icw A rms 800 2500
Rated conditional short-circuit current kA rms 50
With fuse class gG A 16 25 32 40 63 63 80 100 125
IEC making capacity (AC23A 400 V) A 400 450 1250
IEC breaking capacity (AC23A 400 V) A 320 360 1000
Mechanical life (depending on the application) cycles 100,000 100,000 30,000
Electrical life (IEC AC21A) cycles 100,000 15,000 30,000
UL/CSA general use at 600 V A 16 25 32 40 50 60 100 100 100
UL/CSA short-circuit rating at 600 V kA 5 5 5 5 5 50 50 50 50
UL/CSA fuse class/max rating at 600 V Type/A RK5/20 RK5/30 RK5/35 RK5/45 RK5/45 –/100 –/100 –/100 –/100
UL/CSA Hp ratings
120 V hp 1 1.5 2 2 2 3 3 5 7.5
Single phase
240 V hp 2 3 5 5 7.5 7.5 10 10 10
200–208 V hp 5 7.5 10 10 10 20 25 30 25
240 V hp 5 7.5 10 15 15 20 30 30 30
Three phase
480 V hp 10 15 20 20 30 40 40 50 50
600 V hp 10 20 20 25 30 40 40 60 40
Terminals
Type Lug clamp
IEC/EN 60947-1 designation: Pillar terminal.
A 5.6 mm (0.22 in.) 12.4 mm (0.49 in.)
B
8-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible
Disconnect Switches
8
600 A, LK4SU3N Shaft 320 mm, GS2AE6 Black Handle, GS2AH150 Lugs Kit, GS1AW503
Example:
LK4SU3N (600 A non-fusible switch) + GS2AE6 (320 mm Style D shaft) + GS2AH150 (black/black, locking)
To add auxiliary contacts:
For front-mounted contacts order LK4AD30N (front-mounted auxiliary contact holder) + GS2AM110.
Table 8.61: Kits for Compact Switches LK4: 30, 60 and 100 A
Pieces Included [2]
Rating Kit Catalog
(A) Number Compact 400 mm Handle Color / Handle Guide Cone
Switch Shaft NEMA Rating
Black /
LK4DUKB1 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0110CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4DUKB4 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0410CN GS2AEH12
30 A
Red /
LK4DUKR1 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0120CN GS2AEH12
Red /
30–100 A Compact LK4DUKR4 LK4DU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0420CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4GUKB1 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0110CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4GUKB4 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0410CN GS2AEH12
60 A
Red /
LK4GUKR1 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0120CN GS2AEH12
Red /
LK4GUKR4 LK4GU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0420CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4JUKB1 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0110CN GS2AEH12
Black /
LK4JUKB4 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0410CN GS2AEH12
100 A
Red /
LK4JUKR1 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 1, 12, 3R LK4AH0120CN GS2AEH12
Red /
LK4JUKR4 LK4JU3CN LK4AE41CN NEMA 4, 4X LK4AH0420CN GS2AEH12
[1] No longer sold as components. Purchase Kits containing Switch, Handle, Shaft, and Guide Cone as listed inTable 8.61.
[2] Components are NOT sold separately. Only 400 mm shaft can be purchase separately.
8-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 Fusible UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Disconnect Switches
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
GS2AH130
GS2AH170
NOTE: Switches in the shaded area are now available as Kits. SeeTable 8.61.
8
(A) 320 mm 400 mm 500 mm Style Bracket
Catalog No. Type Color Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
NOTE: Switches in the shaded area are now available as Kits.
30–100 LK4AH110CN[4] 1, 3R, 12 Black
30–100 LK4AH1120CN[4] 1, 3R, 12 Red/Yellow
LK4AE12CN — — GS2AEH12 AL —
30–100 LK4AH410CN[4] 4, 4X Black
30–100 LK4AH420CN[4] 4, 4X Red/Yellow
100–400 GS2AH130 1, 3R, 12 Black
100–400 GS2AH140 1, 3R, 12 Red
GS2AE2 GS2AE21 GS2AE23 GS2AEH12 B GS2AESB
100–400 GS2AH430 4, 4X Black
100–400 GS2AH440 4, 4X Red/Yellow
600 GS2AH150 1, 3R, 4, 4X, Black
12
600 GS2AH160 1, 3R, 4, 4X, Red/Yellow
12
GS2AE6 GS2AE61 — GS2AEH12 D —
800–1200 GS2AH170 1, 3R, 4, 4X, Black
12
1, 3R, 4, 4X,
800–1200 GS2AH180 Red/Yellow
12
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Table 8.71: Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches [10] [11]
Catalog No. Description
200 A and Below
GS2AH36F 36 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH60F 60 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH120F 120 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH144F 144 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
GS2AH180F 180 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 200 A and Below
400 A
GS2AH460F 60 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
GS2AH4120F 120 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
GS2AH4144F 144 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
GS2AH4180F 180 in. Cable Operator Kits for GS2 Switches, 400 A
Flange Handle Table 8.72: Handles for use with Cable Operator Kits
Cable Operator Kit Catalog No. NEMA Type Enclosure Type of Handle
8
9422A1 1, 3, 3R, 4, (Sheet Steel) 6 in.
9422A2 4, 4X (Stainless) 6 in.
9422A3 1, 3, 3R, 4, (Sheet Steel) 4 in.
9422A4 4, 4X (Stainless) 4 in.
Accessories
Table 8.73: Terminal Lugs
No. of Lug Kit
No. of Lugs Lug Size Wire Lugs
For Use On: Rating Wires (AWG) Type Catalog
per Lug per Terminal per Kit
Number
LK4DU3CN 30 1 1 #12–2/0 Cu — Standard
LK4GU3CN 60 1 1 #12–2/0 Cu — Standard
LK4JU3N 100 1 1 6–300 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW403
LK4MU3N 200 1 1 6–300 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW403
2 1 350 MCM—6 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW603
LK4QU3N 400 1 600 MCM—4
1 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW606
2 250 MCM—1/0
LK4SU3N 600 2 1 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW503
LK4TU3N 800 2 2 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 12 GS1AW903
LK4UU3N 1000 2 2 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 12 GS1AW903
LK4WU3N 1200 2 2 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 12 GS1AW903
GS1DDU3 30 1 1 #14–#10 Cu — Standard
GS1DU3 30 1 1 #14–#10 Cu — Standard
GS2EEU3 30 1 1 #14–#10 Cu — Standard
GS2EU3N 30 1 1 #14–#6 Cu — Standard
GS2GU3N 60 1 1 #10–#6 Cu — Standard
GS2JU3N 100 1 1 #12–#1 Cu — Standard
GS2MU3N 200 1 1 6–300 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW403
Terminal Lugs
2 1 350 MCM—6 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW603
GS2QU3N 400 1 600 MCM—4
1 Cu/Al 6 GS1AW606
2 250 MCM—1/0
GS2SU3 600 2 1 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW503
GS2TU3 800 2 1 2 x 2–600 kcmil Cu/Al 6 GS1AW503
[10] Does not include handle. For handle, see Table 8.72.
[11] Not compatible with GS2EEU3..
[12] Cannot be used on GS2JU3N.
8-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2
Fusible
8
Disconnect Switches
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
3.133
79.6
2.53 1.02 1.02
64.3 0.543 26 26
13.8 4
5.169
131.3
2.078
52.8
Ha ndle P a rt No.
1.74
GS2AH130
(44.2) GS2AH140
GS2AH430
GS2AH440
3.07
(78)
3.07
Ø 1.57
(78)
F B (40)
1.22
Ø 1.10
(31)
(28)
0.27
4x Ø
(7)
4.925
(125.1)
in .
Dim e n s io n s :
mm
D A
C
8-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Fusible
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
H M
Z J
0.51
13
N1
X
AC
AA
N
8
3.15
80
F
8-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2
Fusible
8
in.
Dime ns ions :
mm
Example:
GS1DU3
8-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2 UL 98 IEC Style Disconnect Switches
Fusible
schneider-electric.us Refer to Catalog 9421CT0301
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Handle for 100 A, 200 A, and 400 A Fusible Disconnect Switches
8
GS2MU3N, 200 A Fusible Disconnect Switches, Class J Fuses
8-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Dimensions, LK4 Nonfusible and GS2
Fusible
8
8-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Disconnect Switches Flange Mounted and Cable Operated
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 8.75: 9422 Disconnect Switches, Flange Mounted and Variable Depth
Switch and Switch Used with Switch and Operating
Maximum Horsepower Ratings Fuse Clip Rating Cable Operators Mechanism with Handle
(A), Non- Operating
Mechanism ONLY ONLY (No Handle Mechanism, Overpacked[2]
Disconnect Variable Interchangeable Mechanism or
AC Systems Volts Fuse Type, For Class H, (No Handle
Switch Depth Cable Operator) Type A1 Handle Type A2 Handle
(Motor Volts) Vdc Type J, K or R Fuses Mechanism)
Size (in.) [1]
208 240 480 600
250 600 250 V 600 V Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
8
(200) (230) (460) (575)
None — — 9422TCN30 9422TCN30C 9422ATCN301 9422ATCN302
30 A 6.625–18 7.5 7.5 15 20 5 15 H, J, 30 — 9422TCF30 9422TCF30C 9422ATCF301 9422ATCF302
K, R 60 30 9422TCF33 9422TCF33C 9422ATCF331 9422ATCF332
None — — 9422TDN60 9422TDN60C 9422ATDN601 9422ATDN602
60 A 6.625–18 — 15 30 50 10 30 H, J, 60 30 9422TDF60 9422TDF60C 9422ATDF601 9422ATDF602
K, R — 60 9422TDF63 9422TDF63C 9422ATDF631 9422ATDF632
None — — 9422TEN10 9422TEN10C 9422ATEN101 9422ATEN102
100 A 6.625–18 25 30 60 75 20 50 H, J,
K, R 100 100 9422TEF10 9422TEF10C 9422ATEF101 9422ATEF102
None — — 9422TF1 — 9422ATF11 9422ATF21
9.12–19.25 200 200 9422TF2 — 9422ATF12 9422ATF22
200 A [3] 40 60 125 150 40 50 H, J,
K, R — 400 9422TF3 [4] — 9422ATF13 [4] 9422ATF23 [4]
11.38
400 A (A5 or A6
Fixed Depth [5] None — — 9422TG1 [6][7] —
Handle) For handle selection, see page 8-
75 125 250 350 50 50
400 A 15.87–19 34.
Variable Depth (A7 or A8 H, J, 9422TG2 [6][9]
K, R 400 400 —
[5] Handle) [8]
The 9422 Bracket Mount Disconnect Switch is designed for combiner boxes and control
panel applications. The Bracket Mount Disconnect Switch is shipped with the switch and
external handle assembled to a bracket, ready for quick installation. A protective trim
plate is provided to prevent any mounting screws from being accessible from the front.
The trim plate also provides an attractive installation feature. The switches are fully
compatible with the 9423 closing mechanisms.
[1] See Table 8.81 for ordering information for the cable operator.
[2] Variable depth only — no cable operator.
[3] 9422 R2 will extend maximum mounting depth 7 inches, see Table 8.86for information.
[4] Accommodates Class J fuses only.
[5] Switches are fixed-depth or adjustable depending on handle selection.
[6] Commercially available enclosures may not accept 9422TG1 and 2 operating mechanisms. Contact enclosure manufacturer for availability of enclosures for use with these switches.
[7] Right hand flange mounting only and requires a special enclosure.
[8] Variable in increments of 0.63 inches.
[9] Right hand flange mounting only and requires a special enclosure.
[10] Space saving design—Type J fuses mounted on the non-fused bracket.
8-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Accessories, Disconnect Switches
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
the enclosure. Two flange mounting methods are offered. For right or left hand flange
mounting use Types A1–A4 and Types A9–A10 kits. For right-hand mounting only, use
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Type A5–A8 handles. The type AP1 and AP2 handles are used exclusively on the
PowerPact™ M and P operating mechanisms, 9422 RM1 and 9422 CMP. The
dimensions are identical to 9422 A1.
Type A1
Table 8.77: 9422 Disconnect Switch and Circuit Breaker Handle Mechanisms
NEMA Type 1, 3, 3R, 4, 12 NEMA Type 4, 4X Stainless
Handle Depth (in.) Enclosures Steel Enclosures
Cat. No. Cat. No.
4 [11] 9422A3 9422A4
6 [11] 9422A1 9422A2
6 [12] 9422AP1 9422AP2
10 [13] 9422A9 9422A10
10 9422AP9 9422AP10
12 [14] [15] 9422A7 9422A8
Accessories
Class R Fuse Kits
When installed, this kit rejects all fuses except Class R. The kits are available for field
installation. With rejection kit and Class R fuses installed, the switch is UL component
recognized for use on systems with fault current up to 200,000 RMS symmetrical
amperes.
[11] Use with 30–200 A 9422 switches and all circuit breaker mechanisms.
[12] Use only with 9422 RM1, 9422 CMP and PowerPact M and P operating mechanisms.
[13] Use with Type D2 remote or dual adapter kit.
[14] Use only with 400 A 9422TG1 and 9422TG2 disconnect switch.
[15] Adjustable depth.
[16] Use Discount Schedule DE1, not CP1.
[17] Use Discount Schedule DE1 for price, not CP1.
[18] 1 N.C. or N.O. Contact depending on wiring.
[19] 2 N.C. or N.O. or 1 N.O. or 1 N.C. Contact depending on wiring.
8-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories, Disconnect Switches Flange Mounted and Cable Operated
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Provides an additional barrier that helps prevent accidental contact with live parts. Field-
installed transparent barriers do not restrict visual inspection of the switch. Barriers
provide IEC529 IP2X “finger safe” protection when door of enclosed disconnect switch is
open. A convenient door allows use of test probes without accessing fuses and
replacement of fuses without removing barrier. Barrier must be used with the skirt kit to
enclose a panel mounted 9422 disconnect.
8
Cable Operators for 9422 Disconnect Switches
Table 8.81: Cable Operators for 9422 Disconnect Switches
Cable Mechanisms with
Cable Mechanisms [21] A1 Handle for NEMA Type 1,
Switch Type 3, 3R, 4, and 12 Enclosures
Cable Length
(inches) Cat. No. Cat. No.
36 9422CFT30 9422CFT31
TCN30C, TCF30C, TCF33C, 48 9422CFT40 —
TDN60C, TDF60C, TDF63C,
TEN10C, TEF10C 60 9422CFT50 9422CFT51
120 9422CFT10 9422CFT11
schneider-electric.us
Table 8.84: Dimensions 30, 60, and 100 A Class 9422 Disconnect Switches
Switch Maximum Voltage Fuse Type Dimension A Dimension B
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
Type
30 A, 250 V H, K, R 1.625
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
30 A 30 A, 600 V H, K, R 4.25
30 A, 600 V J 1.625
—
60 A, 250 V H, K, R 2.25
60 A 60 A, 600 V H, K, R 4.75
60 A, 600 V J 1.625
100 A, 250 V H, K, R 3.25
100 A 100 A, 600 V H, K, R — 5.25
100 A, 600 V J 3.25
F
0.38
10
C
0.38
10
Disconnect
Device ON
A E
OFF
Non Fused
D 0.38 and Circuit
10
Breaker
Disconnect
Device Fused
(2) 0.38 Dia. Mounting Holes
10
(For back panel support if necessary.)
[22] The minimum enclosure depth is greater than Dimension D since additional space is needed when mounting the mechanism.
8-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Dimensions, Disconnect Switches Flange Mounted and Cable Operated
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
[23] The dimensions shown may be extended 7 in. by using 9422R2 (two required per switch).
8-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flange Mounted and Cable Operated Dimensions, Disconnect Switches
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
400 A Disconnect Switches Nonfusible and Non-Interchangeable Fuse Clip Type Fusible
Switches
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
8.50
CL of Operating 216
Defeater
Guide Handle 7.50
3.63 191
for
Class 9423
92 23.81
Type M1 Kit 605
Figure 1
Figure 3
*D 13.54
Table 8.88: Nonfusible and Fusible Switches 5.50 1.86 1.40 12.14
344
0.86
Dimension D = Distance from outside of flange to 140 47 36 308 22
disconnect switch mounting surface. 0.60
15 B
For Type TG1 or TG2 with:
Type A7 or A8 adjustable 15.87 19
depth handle mechanism D= to
403 483
In steps of 0.63
16
Weld
NOTE: Copper lugs are standard on all Type TG
disconnect switches. CL of Operating
Mechanism
* D = Mounting depth measured from the switch mounting surface to 23.80 25.00
604 635
the surface of flange.
24.00
610
8.38
213
6.97
177
3.97
101
Class J use
F
Weld 400 A 600Volt
Class H, ,KR F
uses Enclosure
400 A 250Volt Provision for (2) 5/16 Mtg. Screws
Class H, ,KR Fuses
400 A 600Volt
8.13
206
Dim. = in.
mm
8-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Door Mounted Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers
Class 9421 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
8
PowerPact™ B 2–3 125 9421LB1 9421LB4 9421LB3
10.75 21.38 21.38
9421 Type L PowerPact H and J; 5.50– 5.50– 5.50–
Circuit Breaker Operating Mechanism 2–3 250 9421LJ1 9421LJ4 9421LJ3
NSF 10.75 21.38 21.38
7.25– 7.25– 3 in. handles are not
PowerPact D and L 2–3 600 9421LD1 12.06 9421LD4 22.63 recommended for use
PowerPact M and P 9421LW1 9.00– 9421LW4 9.00– with these circuit
[2] 3 1200 [3] 12.50 [4] 23.50 breakers.
Table 8.92: Auxiliary and Alarm Switches for PowerPactTM Circuit Breakers [8]
Description B-Frame H- and J-Frame D- and L-Frame D- and L-Frame
1 Auxiliary Switch 1a 1b LV26950 S29450 S29450 S29450
2 Auxiliary Switch 2a 2b — 2 x S29450 2 x S29450 2 x S29450
3 Auxiliary Switch 3a 3b — — 3 x S29450 3 x S29450
NOTE: The location of the accessory in the circuit breaker determines its function.
[1] Mounting depth measured in inches from circuit breaker mounting surface (control panel) to outside of enclosure door.
[2] These circuit breaker operating mechanisms must use the 9421LHP** or LCP** handles only.
[3] Type LW1 and LW4 include an 8 in. handle (9421LHP8) rather than a 6 in. handle.
[4] Type LW1 and LW4 include an 8 in. handle (9421LHP8) rather than a 6 in. handle.
[5] Mounting depth measured in inches from circuit breaker mounting surface (control panel) to outside of enclosure door.
[6] For a red handle and yellow bezel, add suffix RY to catalog number, e.g., 9421LH6RY.
[7] 3 in. handles are not recommended for use with these circuit breakers.
[8] Discount Schedule: DE2.
8-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers Door Mounted
Class 9421 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
Operating Mechanisms: 9421LJ1, 9421LJ4, and 9421LJ7 Operating Mechanisms: 9421LD1, 9421LD4, and 9421LD7
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
8-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flexible Cable Mechanisms Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
• Specially designed for tall, deep enclosures where placement flexibility is required
Table 8.94: Flexible Cable Mechanisms for use with Schneider Electric™ (formerly
Merlin Gerin™) Circuit Breakers and PowerPact™ 3-Pole Circuit Breakers
Circuit Breaker Cable Mechanism
Type No. of Poles Frame Size (A)
Length Catalog No.
36 in. 9422CSB30
PowerPact 60 in. 9422CSB50
2–3 125
B-Frame 84 in. 9422CSB70
120 in. 9422CSB10
36 in. 9422CSF30
MG-NSF 60 in. 9422CSF50
PowerPact 2–3 250
8
H- and J-Frame 84 in. 9422CSF70
120 in. 9422CSF10
36 in. 9422CSF304
MG-NSF 4 250 60 in. 9422CSF504
120 in. 9422CSF104
36 in. 9422CSJ30
Flexible Cable Mechanism MG-NSJ PowerPact
3 600 60 in. 9422CSJ50
9422CSJ30 D- and L-Frame
120 in. 9422CSJ10
36 in. 9422CSJ304
MG-NSJ PowerPact
D- and L-Frame 4 600 60 in. 9422CSJ504
120 in. 9422CSJ104
48 in. 9422CMP40
PowerPact M- and
P-Frame [9] 3 1200 50 in. 9422CMP50
120 in. 9422CMP10
[9] Must use 9422AP1 or 9422AP2 Handle with this operating mechanism.
8-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers Flexible Cable Mechanisms
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
PowerPact™ B, D, H, J, and L circuit breakers through 600 A frame sizes. The cable
mechanisms allow for a single handle operator, Class 9422Ax, to operate both circuit
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
breakers. The cable mechanism is designed especially for tall, deep enclosures where
placement flexibility is required. There are numerous cable arrangements to choose from
to accommodate many applications.
Features
Handle Mechanisms
These handle mechanism kits are used with the circuit breaker variable depth and cable
operating mechanisms. The kits contain all parts necessary for mounting the handle to
the flange of the enclosure. Types A1/AP1 to A4 are suitable for right or left-hand flange
mounting.
For handle selection, see Table 8.77.
NOTE: See Handle Information, page 8-34 for dimensional information.
Handle Mechanisms
[10] Must use the 9422AP1 or 9422AP2 operating handle with this operating mechanism.
8-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Flexible Cable Mechanisms Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Designed for installation in custom built control enclosures where main or branch circuit
protective devices are required. All circuit breaker operating mechanisms are suitable for
either right- or left-hand flange mounting, convertible on the job.
NOTE: The operating mechanisms do not include handle mechanisms. You must
select a 9422A• handle to complete the installation.
Table 8.96: Variable-Depth Operating Mechanisms for Use with Schneider
Electric™ Brand Circuit Breakers (Formerly Merlin Gerin™ Brand)
Use with Operating Mechanism
Frame Variable Depth (Does Not Include Handle
No. of Mtg. Range (in.) Mechanism)
Circuit Breaker Frame Size Size
9422 Type R Poles [11]
A Cat. No.
Circuit Breaker Mechanism
Schneider Electric (formerly Merlin Gerin) Circuit Breakers and PowerPact™ Frame 3-Pole Circuit Breakers
PowerPact B-Frame 2–3 125 5.88–17.75 9422RB1
MG-NSF PowerPact H- and J-Frame 2–3 250 5.88–17.75 9422RQ1
MG-NSJ PowerPact D-and L-Frame 3 600 9.00–17.75 9422RS1
PowerPact M- and P-Frame [12] 3 1200 10.50–18.38 9422RM1
8
Table 8.97: Electrical Interlocks—Class 9999
Description Cat. No.
Single Pole, Double Throw 9999R26
Double Pole, Double Throw 9999R27
[11] Class 9422 Type R2 will extend mounting depth 7 inches—not recommended for use with the 9422RM1 operating mechanism (see Table 8.77).
[12] These circuit breaker operating mechanisms must use the 9422APx handles.
8-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms for Circuit Breakers Flexible Cable Mechanisms
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
Dimensions
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
8-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Introduction Door Closing Mechanisms
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
8
1. Determine enclosure construction (no. of doors, door height, hinge location, etc.).
2. Determine Class 9422 disconnect device to be used—either a disconnect switch or a
circuit breaker mechanism.
3. Determine the location of the disconnect device and handle mechanism (right- or
left-hand flange or center channel).
4. Select the door closing mechanism required.
5. Select the auxiliary door closing mechanisms and multi-door interlocking hardware, if
required. (A complete system for interlocking all auxiliary doors of a multi-door
enclosure with center channel is available for the medium and large enclosures.)
Table 8.98: Door Closing Mechanism
60 in. Maximum Door 46–60 in. Door 61–91 in. Door
Opening Opening Opening
(Recommended) (Recommended) (Recommended)
• 2 Point Locking is
Standard
• For use on Single
or
• For use on Single or
Multi-Door
• A Third Roller
Latch Kit is
Multi-Door
Enclosures
•
Enclosures
For use with Doors
Available for 3
Point Locking
• For use with
Doors Hinged on
Hinged on Right or
Left Side
• For 3/4 in. Door
Right or Left Side
• Referred to as the 8
Depths • Referred to as the
6 in. Vault Handle
in. Vault Handle
Mechanism
Mechanism • For 1-1/8 in. Door
• For 3/4 in. Door
Depths
Depths
Type M4 Latch bar not included, but most prepunched enclosures that
accept Square D™ operating mechanisms supply a pre-drilled latch
bar.
The door closing mechanisms listed below are for use on small to medium size single
door control enclosures. They are designed to be used in conjunction with Class 9422
flange-mounted disconnect switches and circuit breaker operating mechanisms;
however, they can be used independently as well. When used on properly designed and
gasketed NEMA Type 12 enclosures, they meet NFPA 79 standards.
Table 8.99: Single Door Enclosures—NEMA Type 4 or 12 with 60 in. High Maximum
Opening
For Use On: Door Suggested
Use in Latch Door
Description (Enclosure Conjunction Handle Maximum Cat. No.
Type) Door Opening Depth
With: Length
NEMA Class 9422 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M4
Two point, roller latch, Type 4 and 12 Types A1, A3, 4 in. Less than 39 in. [1] 9423M10
door closing mechanism Sheet Steel A9
for use on enclosures with 6 in. 60 in. 3/4 in. 9423M9
doors hinged on the left NEMA Type 4 Class 9422
side. and 12 Stainless Types A2, A4, 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M24
Steel A10
Circuit Breaker
Operating Mechanism NEMA Type 4 Class 9422 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M4L
Two point, roller latch, and 12 Sheet Types A1, A3, 4 in. Less than 39 in. [1] 9423M10L
door closing mechanism Steel A9
for use on enclosures with 6 in. 60 in. 3/4 in. 9423M9L
doors hinged on the right NEMA Type 4 Class 9422
side. and 12 Stainless Types A2, A4, 4 in. Less than 39 in. 3/4 in. 9423M24L
Steel A10
NEMA Type 4 Class 9423
Third roller latch kit for and 12 Sheet Types M4, M9, — — 3/4 in. 9423M3
3 point locking; for use Steel M4L, M9L
where 3 point locking is
desired or where the door NEMA Type 4 Class 9423
opening is ≥39 in. and 12 Stainless Types M24, — — 3/4 in. 9423M23
Steel M24L
[1] Suitable for door depths of 1-1/8 in., 1-1/4 in., 1-3/8 in. and 1-1/2 in.
8-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Door Closing Mechanisms Types M5, M6, M1, and M8
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
Table 8.100 shows the requirements for the door closing mechanism, the locking bar kit,
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Table 8.100: Single or Multi-Door Enclosures—NEMA Type 12 with 40 in. to 60 in. Door Opening
Single-Door Enclosure Multi-Door Enclosure
Without Interlocking With Interlocking Without Interlocking With Interlocking
For Master door: For each Auxiliary door:
1—M6 door closing mechanism For each door: 1—M6 door closing mechanism 1—M6 door closing mechanism
1—M6 door closing mechanism 1—Type M660 locking bar kit
1—M6 door closing mechanism 1—Type M660 locking bar kit 1—Type M660 locking bar kit
1—Type M660 locking bar kit 1—Type M5 (use with 9422A 1—Type M660 locking bar kit 1—Type M5 (for use with 9422A Necessary quantities of Types M2
handles)
handles) and M7 for each door (see below)
NOTE: All mechanisms listed on this page are suitable for either left or right hand
mounting.
1/4 in. Dia. Rod (supplied by user)
8-46
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Single and Multi-Door Enclosures Door Closing Mechanisms
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 8.103: Single Or Multi-Door Enclosures—NEMA Type 12 with 61 in. to 91 in. Door Openings
Single-Door Enclosure Multi-Door Enclosure
Without Interlocking With Interlocking Without Interlocking With Interlocking
For Master door: For each Auxiliary door:
1—M8 door closing mechanism For each door: 1—M8 door closing mechanism 1—M8 door closing mechanism
1—M8 door closing mechanism 1—Type M891 locking bar kit
1—M8 door closing mechanism 1—Type M891 locking bar kit 1—Type M891 locking bar kit
1—Type M891 locking bar kit 1—Type M1 (for use with 9422A 1—Type M891 locking bar kit 1—Type M1 (for use with 9422A Necessary quantities of Types M2
handles)
handles) and M7 for each door (see below)
NOTE: All mechanisms listed on this page are suitable for either left or right hand
mounting.
1/4 in. Dia. R
od (supplied by user)
Table 8.104: Door Interlocks
8
Type Description
The Class 9423 Type M8 door closing mechanism is designed to close and seal
Type M8 Door Closing 1.125 in. deep doors of single or multi-door NEMA Type 12 enclosures. The Type
Mechanism M8 can be used on doors hinged on either the left or right hand side.
Recommended door openings are from 61–91 in. Vault type handle length is 8 in.
The lock bar kit for the Type M8 door closing mechanism contains two lock bars
Type M891 Locking Bar Kits and is available from stock. The bars can be cut to fit door openings through 91 in..
Locking Locking One lock bar kit is required for each Type M8 ordered.
Bar Bar
The Class 9423 Type M1 mechanical interlock kit is designed to interlock a Class
9422 handle mechanism with the Type M8 door closing mechanism. This kit
Type M1 prevents the opening of the master door (or single door) with the disconnect handle
in the “ON” position, making it mandatory to use a screwdriver to gain entry to the
enclosure at any time, regardless of the disconnect handle position.
A
B
Door Table 8.105: Required Accessories for
Opening Auxiliary Doors
Type Description
One Type M2 kit is required for each auxiliary door. This kit is required to interlock
Type M2 any auxiliary door(s) with the master door.
The first auxiliary door requires 2 Type M7 kits. Additional auxiliary doors require
only 1 Type M7 kit. The 0.25 in. diameter rod used to interconnect the M7 kits is
C Type M7
furnished by the user. If the distance between any two Type M7 kits exceeds 36 in.,
an additional Type M7 kit should be installed to prevent the rod from buckling.
Locking Locking
Bar Bar
8-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Door Closing Mechanisms Types M5, M6, M1, and M8
Class 9423 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
Types M5 and M6
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
Drilling and location information below is complete for a single door enclosure with door
hinged on left side, incorporating a Type M6, M5, and Class 9422 handle mechanism.
Transpose all horizontal dimensions for doors hinged on right side.
Dimension A
• Single door enclosures: A minimum = 1 in.
• Multi-door enclosures without overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 1 in.
• Multi-door enclosures with overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 4–1/2 in.
NOTE: Overhead interlocking system consists of the required number of Class 9423
Type M2 and M7 kits for interlocking the auxiliary doors with the master door. See
page 8-46.
Table 8.106: Dimension B (Minimums)
Type If A = 1 If A = 4–1/2
Disconnect Device C
Minimum B = Minimum B =
TCF, TCN, TDF, TDN, TD 60 A Disconnect Switch 3-/16 2-1/2 3-3/16
TE, TEF, TEN 100 A Disconnect Switch 5-1/4 2-1/2 3-3/16
TF 200 A Disconnect Switch 11-5/8 8-1/8 3-3/16
TG 400 A Disconnect Switch 15-1/16 11-9/16 6-3/4
RN1 FAL, FHL, Circuit Breaker 4-27/32 2-1/2 3-3/16
RP1 KAL, KHL Circuit Breaker 11-5/32 7-21/32 3-3/16
RR2 ILL Circuit Breaker 17-31/32 14-15/32 3-3/16
MAL, MHL, MEL, MXL Circuit
RT1 Breaker 18-5/8 15-1/8 3-3/16
8-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers Operating Mechanisms, Accessories
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
For Types M1 and M8
Drilling and location information below is complete for a single door enclosure with the
door hinged on the left side, incorporating a Type M8, M1, and Class 9422 handle
mechanism. Transpose all horizontal dimensions for doors hinged on the right side.
Dimension A
• Single door enclosures: A minimum = 1-1/2 in.
• Multi-Door enclosures without overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 1-1/2 in.
• Multi-Door enclosures with overhead interlocking system:
A minimum = 4-1/2 in.
NOTE: Overhead interlocking system consists of the required number of Class 9423
Type M2 and M7 kits for interlocking the auxiliary doors with the master door. See
page 8-46.
Table 8.107: Dimension B (Minimums)
8
If A = 1–½ If A = 4–½
Type Disconnect Device Minimum Minimum C
B= B=
TCF, TCN, TDF, TDN, TD 60 A Disconnect Switch 2-15/16 2-1/2 3-3/16
TE, TEF, TEN 100 A Disconnect Switch 4-3/4 2-1/2 3-3/16
TF 200 A Disconnect Switch 11-1/8 8-1/8 3-3/16
TG 400 A Disconnect Switch 14-9/16 11-9/16 5-7/8
RN1 FAL, FHL Circuit Breaker 4-11/32 2-1/2 3-3/16
RP1 KAL, KHL Circuit Breaker 10-21/32 7-21/32 3-3/16
RR2 ILL Circuit Breaker 17-15/32 14-15/32 3-3/16
RT1 MAL, MHL, MEL, MXL Circuit Breaker 18-1/8 15-1/8 3-3/16
Additional Accessories
Table 8.108: Additional Accessories
Accessory Description Cat. No.
Permits mounting Class 9422 Type A1 or A2 handle mechanisms in
Alternate Mounting Kit 9422AM2
enclosures with flange thickness of 16 gauge to 0.5 in.
Auxiliary kit recommended for use with the Class 9422 Type A-1
flange handle to facilitate padlocking the handle in the “OFF”
Alternate Mounting Kit position. Primarily used when the handle is mounted on the center
Auxiliary Lock Plate 9422L1
channel of a multi-door enclosure. Also in any case where the
enclosure doors interfere with the normal padlock slot in the flange
handle. Meets both the Automotive and NFPA 79 specifications.
Copper Lugs only—Specify Form Y157 —
Tin Plated Aluminum Lugs for 400 A Type TG Switch—Specify Form
Special Lugs for Y1572 (000–750 kcmil Cu/Al wire) —
Channel/Flange Disconnect Switches Anderson Type VCEL Compression Lugs—Specify Form Y1574
Support Kit Exceptions: None of the 30 A or 60 A disconnect switches are —
available with compression lugs.
Standard operating rod for use with Class 9422 variable depth 9422R1
mechanisms. Included as standard in each kit.
Operating Rods Extra long operating rod for use with Class 9422 variable depth
mechanisms. Can be used as a substitute for the standard rod
included in each kit to increase the maximum mounting depth 7 in. 9422R2
(Two are required for Types ARR, RR, ART, RT, ATE, TE, ATF, TF).
Auxiliary Lock Plate
8-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms, Accessories Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
8
schneider-electric.us
OPERATING MECHANISMS AND
DISCONNECT SWITCHES
8-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 9
Panelboards
Series Ratings 9-3
PANELBOARDS
NQ and NF Panelboard Merchandised Selection Procedure 9-14
NQ Merchandised Panelboards 9-15
NQ Panelboards
NQ Main Lug Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-15
NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-16
NQ Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-16
NQ 14-inch-wide—240 Vac, 48 Vdc 9-17
Features 9-17
NQ Merchandised Accessories 9-18
QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers 9-20
9
NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards 9-22
QMB Panelboards
11/10/2017
Operating Mechanisms, Accessories Disconnect Switches and Circuit Breakers
Class 9422 / Refer to Catalog 9420CT9701
schneider-electric.us
9-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
NQ Panelboards
This page contains UL Tested and Certified series combination ratings for panelboards.
These ratings apply to either an integral main located in the same enclosure or a remote
main located in a separate enclosure.
PANELBOARDS
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
25,000 LD, HD, JD
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
HG, JG
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
65,000 QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
9
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
LG QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 40–60 A —
LJ
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 40–60 A —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
HJ, JJ
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
120/240 1P/3W[7] QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
LJ
QO (B) EPD — 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
100,000 QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH — 150 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
DJ 400 A QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) AS 15–30 A 15–30 A —
QO (B) VH — 150 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QJ
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
125,000 HL, JL
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
[1] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[2] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[3] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[4] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[5] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[6] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
[7] Two-pole CAFI circuit breakers are only 120/240 Vac and may only be used on 120/240 VAC single phase 3 wire systems.
9-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NQ and NF Panelboards
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [10][11][12][13]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [8][9] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
LA/LH (L) 34200MC
LA/LH (L) 34225MC
18,000 QO (B) 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
LA/LH (L) 34250MC
9
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — 15–125 A 15–150 A
DJ-W 150 A MC[8]
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
30,000
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
DJ-W 250 A MC[8]
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
30,000 DJ-W 600 A MC[8]
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LG QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
208Y/120 3P/4W QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
65,000 QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LJ QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) GFI — — 15–30 A
LL QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
100,000 DJ 400 A QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QJ QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
100,000 QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
LJ
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
QO (B) EPD — 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
[8] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[9] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[10] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[11] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[12] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[13] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
[8] To achieve selective coordination, the rating of the DJ main circuit breaker must be at least two times greater than the ampere rating of any branch circuit breaker.
9-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
22,000 QO (B) VH
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
PANELBOARDS
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QD QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
ED, FD QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
25,000 QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
9
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) AS 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
KD
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
HD, JD QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
240/120 3P/4W
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
25,000 LD QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
Q2L-H — 100–225 A 100–225 A
LA, MA
QDL — 70–225 A 70–225 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–70 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LC 400 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
42,000
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
LC 600 A QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
MG QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–30 A 15–30 A
QO (B) 15–30 A 15–30 A —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
LC 400 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
65,000
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
QO (B) GFI — — 15–30 A
LC 600 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NQ and NF Panelboards
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
DJ 400 A QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–150 A —
9
[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
PANELBOARDS
QO (B) PL 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–30 A
125,000 HL, JL QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
200,000 FI, KI, HR, JR
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) VH QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
9
22,000
QO (B) PL — 15–30 A —
Q2-H QO (B) — — 15–30 A
QO (B) — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QD QO (B) PL — 15–60 A 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
25,000
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
ED, FD
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
KD QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
HD, JD
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
25,000 LD QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
LA, MA QDL — 70–225 A 70–225 A
LC 400 A QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
240 3P/3W or 42,000
LC 600 A QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
240 1P/2W
(two pole only) MG QO (B) VH — — 150 A
LC 400 A QO (B) VH — — 15–100 A
LC 600 A QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
DJ 400 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
DJ, DG, DL 150–600 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
EG, FG, KG
QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
QG QO (B) — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
65,000 QG, HG, JG QO (B) PL — — 15–30 A
HG, JG QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
FC_ or KC_22___ QO (B) — — 15–100 A
FC_ or KC_34___ QO (B) AS — 15–30 A 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
LG
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
LJ
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NQ and NF Panelboards
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Maximum System Allowable Ampere Ranges [11][12][13][14]
Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main
Voltage AC [9][10] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
65,000 LL
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
FC_ or KC_24___
QO (B) GFI — 15–30 A —
FC_ or KC_34___
DJ 400 A QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
9
QO (B) — — 15–100 A
QO (B) H — 15–100 A —
125,000 HL, JL QO (B) VH — — 35–150 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–30 A
200,000 FI, KI, HR, JR QO (B) — — 15–100 A
42,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–150 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
400 A Max.Class J Fuses
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
65,000
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–150 A —
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
400 A Max.Class T6 Fuses
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
120/240 1P/3W[9]
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
100,000 200 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A 15–20 A —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
200,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A —
200 A Max. Class T6, J Fuses QO (B) GFI — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
208Y/120 3P/4W 200,000 QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
42,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) VH 15–30 A 15–125 A —
50,000 400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A —
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
400 A Max. Class JFuses
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
65,000
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QO (B) VH 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–150 A
400 A Max. Class T6 Fuses
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
240/120 3P/4W QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
100,000 200 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) AFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) CAFI 15–20 A — —
QO (B) DF 15–20 A — —
QOT 15–30 A 15–30 A —
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
200 A Max.Class J or T6Fuses
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) 15–70 A 15–125 A 15–100 A
200,000
QO (B) GFI 15–30 A 15–60 A —
400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) EPD 15–30 A 15–60 A 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
[9] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[10] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[11] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[12] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[13] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[14] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
[9] Two-pole CAFI circuit breakers are only 120/240 Vac and may only be used on 120/240 VAC single phase 3 wire systems.
9-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 1640 and 1670
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.1 NQ Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum System Maximum Short Square D™ Brand Integral or Remote Square D™ Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation and
Voltage AC [10] Circuit Current Main Circuit Breakers and Remote Main Allowable Ampere Ranges [12][13][14][15]
[11] Rating Fuses Type 1 Pole 2 Pole 3 Pole
50,000 400 A Max.Class J or T6Fuses QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
400 A Max.Class JFuses QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
65,000 QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
QO (B) VH — — 15–150 A
400 A Max.Class T6Fuses
240 3P/3W or QOB VH1?, 2W only — 150 A —
240 1P/2W QO (B) — — 15–100 A
(two pole only) 100,000 200 A Max. Class T3 Fuses
QO (B) VH — — 15–30 A
QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
200 A Max.Class J or T6Fuses
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
PANELBOARDS
200,000 QO (B) — — 15–100 A
400 A Max. Class T3 Fuses QO (B) EPD — — 15–50 A
QO (B) EPE — — 15–50 A
[10] For shown circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage, the indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[11] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[12] Suffixes HID, SWD, and SWN may also be applied to the applicable branch circuit breakers shown above. Suffix SWN may not be applied in combination with LC main breakers.
[13] Where QO (B) circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) H, QO (B) VH, and QH (B) circuit breakers may also be used.
[14] Where QO (B) GFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) EPD and/or QO (B) EPE circuit breakers may also be used. QO-EPE only comes in 3-pole construction.
[15] Where QO (B) AFI circuit breakers are shown above, QO (B) CAFI circuit breakers may also be used.
9-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NF and I-Line™ Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.3: I-Line Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical)
Maximum Short Circuit Current Square D Brand Integral or Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker
Maximum System Voltage AC [17] Remote 2- or 3-Pole Main Circuit
Rating Catalog Designation Poles
Breaker [18]
42,000 MG FY
QG, LH FA, FD
65,000
QG, BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 (60 A Max.)
FJ, QJ FD
QJ, LC FA
120 100,000 1
LJ FH
QJ, BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 (60 A Max.)
125,000 HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
LR FH, FY
200,000
HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
65,000 QG, BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
QJ FA, FD
208Y/120 2, 3
100,000 QJ, BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
QJ, PH, PJ, RJ QD, QG
35,000 MG FA 1
KA FD 1, 2, 3
42,000
LA, MA HD, JD, QD
2, 3
MG FA
50,000
MG FA (25 A Max.) 1
HG, JG FA, HD
JG JD, QD
QG FA, FD, QD 2, 3
240 QG, BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
LH, MH, PA, PG, RG HD, JD, QD
FG, FH, MH, MX, PJ FD
65,000
FC, KC, KH, LC, LH FD, FG 1, 2, 3
LH FA
LH LA
MG HD, JD, KA
2, 3
DG FH, HD, JD, KA, LA, MA
LG HD, JD, KA, LA, MA
[16] Short circuit tests are conducted at 100–105% of the maximum rated voltage of the panelboard.
[17] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[18] LD, LG, LJ, and LL are only available in 3-pole configurations.
9-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF and I-Line™ Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.3 I-Line Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Circuit Current Square D Brand Integral or Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker
Maximum System Voltage AC [19] Rating Remote 2- or 3-Pole Main Circuit
Breaker [20] Catalog Designation Poles
LG LD 3
85,000 RL FH, KH 2, 3
FC, KC, LC, LX FD, FG, FJ 1
PH, PJ, RJ QD, QG 2, 3
QJ FD 2
FJ FD
HD, HG, JD, JG, FH, KA, LA, MA, 2, 3
LJ
MG
LJ LD, LG 3
FC, KC FA, FH, FD, FG, FJ
LC, LX FH, FD, FG, FJ
QJ, BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
PANELBOARDS
2, 3
KC, LC, LX KA
100,000
KC, LC KH
LC LA, LH, MG
LC FA 1, 2, 3
HJ, JJ FA, FH, HD, HG
JJ JD, JG
LC, LX, MJ, PJ, RJ HD, HG, JD, JG
MJ LA, LH
FH, HD, HG, JD, JG, KA, LA, MA,
DJ
MG
RL RG
HL, JL HD, HG, HJ, FA, FH 2, 3
JL JD, JG, JJ
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ
PC, PH, PL, RL HD, HG, JD, JG
9
125,000
PC, PL, RL HJ, JJ
FI, KI, LI, LXI HD, HG, HJ
KI, LI, LXI JD, JG, JJ
FI, KI, LI, LXI FD, FG, FJ 1
FI, KI FA, FH, FC, FD, FG, FJ
LI, LXI FH, FD, FG, FJ
LI FC
200,000 HR, JR, LR BD6, BG6, BJ
KI, LI, LXI KA, QD, QG, QJ 2, 3
LI KC
JR QD
HJ, HL, JJ, JL, FH, LA, LH, QD, QG,
LR QJ
18,000 LD FY
25,000 FH, KA FD
FG, KH, LH FD
DG, LG FH, FY
35,000
FC, KC FH
BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 (60 A Max.)
FJ FD
FC, KC FA, FY, FD, FG
LC, LX (400 A Max.) FH
LC, LX (600 A Max.) FY, FD, FG
277 65,000 DJ FH, FY 1
LL FY
LJ FH, FY
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 (60 A Max.)
FI, KI FH
DL, LL FH, FJ
100,000
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
FI, KI FA, FY, FD, FG, FJ
LI, LXI, (400 A Max.) FH
200,000
LI, LXI, (600 A Max.) FY, FD, FG, FJ
HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
MG FA
22,000
MX, PA, PC, PX FH
KH, LA, MA, PJ FH
LA, MA, PA, PC, PX KA
30,000 LA, MA, PA HD, JD
MG FA (25 A Max.), FH, KA
MX, PA HD, JD
2, 3
MH HD, JD
HG, JG FA, HD
480
JG JD
LH, MG, PG, RG HD, JD
35,000 BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
LH HG, JG
DG FH, HD, JD, KA, LA, MA
LG LD 3
LG HD, JD, FH, KA, LA, MA 2, 3
MJ FH (25 A Max.)
42,000 2, 3
RL RG
[19] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[20] LD, LG, LJ, and LL are only available in 3-pole configurations.
9-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Series Ratings NF and I-Line™ Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.3 I-Line Series Connected Circuit Breaker Ratings (RMS Symmetrical) (cont'd.)
Maximum Short Circuit Current Square D Brand Integral or Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker
Maximum System Voltage AC [19] Rating Remote 2- or 3-Pole Main Circuit
Breaker [20] Catalog Designation Poles
50,000 MJ KA, KH
FC, KC FA, FH
HJ, JJ FA, FH, HD, HG
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
JJ JD, JG
9
JL JD, JG, JJ
LI, LXI (600 A Max.) KA 2, 3
PC, PH, PL, RL HJ, JJ
100,000 RL RG
FH, HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, KA, LA,
DL
MA
LL LD, LG, LJ 3
LL HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, FH, KA, LA,
MA
JR FA
FI, KI FA, FH, FC, HD, HG, HJ
HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ
KI JD, JG, JJ, KA
LI FC, KA, KC, LA, HJ, HL, JJ, JL
200,000
LXI KA, HJ, HL, JJ, JL
HR FA, HD, HG, HJ, HL
JR HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
LR HJ, HL, JJ, JL, FH, LA, LH
25,000 FH, KA FD 2, 3
FG, KH, LH FD
35,000
BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6
FJ FD
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6
65,000
480Y/277 FC, KC FD, FG
LC, LX (600 A Max.) FD, FG
100,000 HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ
FI, KI FD, FG, FJ
200,000 HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ
LI, LXI (600 A MAX.) FD, FG, FJ
HG, JG FA, HD
JG JD
2, 3
MG, PG, RG HD, JD
18,000
MG FA
LG LD 3
LG HD, JD
HJ, JJ FA, HD, HG
2, 3
JJ JD
25,000 PJ, RJ MG
LJ LD, LG 3
LJ JD, JG, HD, HG, MA
600 35,000 LC FH, HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, LA
HL, JL FA, HD, HG, HJ 2, 3
JL JD, JG, JJ
50,000 PK HJ, JJ, MJ
LL LD, LG, LJ 3
LL HD, HG, HJ, JD, JG, JJ, MA
FI, KI HD, HG, HJ
KI JD, JG, JJ
HR FA, HD, HG, HJ, HL 2, 3
100,000
JR FA, HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
KI, LI FH
LI LA
18,000 BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 (60 A Max.)
347 25,000 BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 (60 A Max.) 1
100,000 HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ (60 A Max.)
BG6, HG, JG, LG, MG, PG BD6 3
18,000
MG FA (25 A Max.) 1
BJ, HJ, JJ, LJ, MJ, PJ BD6, BG6 3
25,000
600Y/347 MJ FA (25 A Max.) 1
HL, JL, LL BD6, BG6, BJ 3
50,000
HL, JL FJ 1
100,000 HR, JR BD6, BG6, BJ 3
[19] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
[20] LD, LG, LJ, and LL are only available in 3-pole configurations.
9-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Panelboards Series Ratings
Class 2110
schneider-electric.us
I-Line Panelboards
Table 9.4: Fuse/I-Line Circuit Breaker Series Connected Ratings
Maximum System Maximum Short Circuit Remote Main Fuse Square D Brand Branch Circuit Breaker Catalog Designation (2- or 3-Pole)
Voltage AC [19] Current Rating Max A Class Unless Otherwise Stated
1200 A L, T (300 V)
120/240 1Ø 208Y/120 100,000 800 A T (600 V) QD, QG
600 A J, RK5
1200 A L, T (300 V)
65,000 800 A T (600 V) QD
600 A J, RK5
1200 A L, T (300 V)
800 A T (600 V) QD, QG (2-Pole)
J, RK5
PANELBOARDS
J, T (600 V) FA, FH, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
600 A
RK5 FH, KA, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG, HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
100,000 J HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
T (600 V) FH, KA, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
800 A T (300 V) PG
240 L FH, KA, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
L FH, KH, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, PG
1200 A
T (600 V) HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
J, T (600 V) FA (3-pole only) FH, FC, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
FH, FC, HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NC, NX,
600 A RK5 PG,PJ, PL
J HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
200,000 T (600 V) FH, FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
800 A T (300 V) PG, PJ, PL
9
L FH, FC, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
L FC, KH, KC, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
1200 A
T (600 V) HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
400 A J, T(600 V) HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
600 A J, RK5 HJ, HL, JJ, JL
J, T (600 V) FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
600 A
100,000 RK5 FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
800 A L, T(600V) FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
L FC, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, PG, PJ
1200 A
T (600 V) HJ, HL, JJ, JL
200 A RK5 HJ, HL
FA, FH, FC, HJ, HL, JJ, JL, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG,
480 J PJ, PL
400 A
T (600 V) FA, FH, FC, HJ, HL, JJ, JL, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX
J FC, KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
200,000 600 A T(600 V) KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX
RK5 KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NC, NX, PG, PJ
T(300 V) PG, PJ, PL
800 A T(600 V) KA, KH, KC, LA, LH, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
L KC, LA, LH, LC, MA, MH, MX, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
1200 A L KC, LC, MA, MH, MX, MG, MJ, NA, NC, NX, PG, PJ, PL
30 A CC HG, JG (Molded Case Switches)
600 100,000 200 A J HD, HG, HJ, HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
400 A J, T (600 V) HJ, HL, JJ, JL
• The fuse used in this UL test is an envelope (umbrella) fuse. This fuse is designed as
a “worst case’’ fuse. Thus, no matter what manufacturer’s fuse is used, the Square
D™ brand circuit breaker is protected.
• The line side fused switch may be in a separate enclosure or in the same enclosure as
the loadside circuit breaker. A line side fused switch may be a submain, integral main,
or remote main. A load side circuit breaker may be a branch, submain, or an integral
main used on the load side of a remote main. This series combination short circuit
current rating shall not exceed that of the line side fused switch. The charts apply to
Square D™ brand load side circuit breakers only. However, the line side fuse ratings
are independent of the fuse manufacturer.
• Not applicable to Corner Grounded Systems.
• Limiters used in Square D™ brand DSL and DSL II fused power circuit breakers are
not class L fuses and do not have series ratings.
[19] For indicated circuit breakers rated less than this maximum voltage. The indicated short circuit current rating also applies, but at the voltage rating of the circuit breaker.
9-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ and NF Panelboard Merchandised NQ and NF Panelboards
Selection Procedure
Class 1640 and 1670 schneider-electric.us
tables Table 9.6, Table 9.8, or Table 9.41), based upon the equivalent number of
poles and ampere rating.
NOTE: Interiors include solid neutral and are field convertible to top-feed.
• If a main circuit breaker interior was selected, select a main circuit breaker (or
fuse) from pages page 7-2, page 7-6, page 7-7, page 7-10, or page 7-11, or Table
9.49.
4. Select ground bars from tables Table 9.9 or Table 9.48 and any non-standard neutral
PANELBOARDS
bars (i.e., 200% neutral for non-linear loads) from tables Table 9.10 or Table 9.43.
5. Select any required sub-feed circuit breakers, sub-feed lugs (SFL), or feed-through
lugs (FTL) kits:
• Sub-feed lugs (SFL) or feed-through lugs (FTL) kits: tables Table 9.11 or Table
9.44 in the NQ or NF Accessories sections.
• Any subfeed circuit breakers: Table 7.1 or tables Table 9.16–Table 9.20 or tables
Table 9.49–Table 9.61.
6. Determine the total mounting inches required by adding requirements from interior,
main circuit breaker, neutrals and ground bars, SFL, FTL, or sub-feed circuit breaker.
7. Select enclosure from the tables Table 9.5–Table 9.14, Table 9.22, Table 9.24, Table
9.26, Table 9.42, Table 9.45, and Table 9.46.
Type 1—select box and front (cover) catalog number corresponding to interior
catalog number.
Type 3R, 5, 12—select enclosure. Cover for Type 3R, 5, 12 is included with the
enclosure.
8. Select the branch circuit breakers to be installed in the panel.
For NQ panelboards use QO circuit breakers from tables Table 7.1, page 7-13–page
7-14, or QOB circuit breakers from Table 9.16–Table 9.20.
For NF panelboards, use E-frame circuit breakers from Table 9.49.
9. Select options and accessories from tables Table 9.7–Table 9.15 or Table 9.43–Table
9.48.
NOTE: Additional NF and NQ options may be found in the Supplemental and
Obsolescence Digest, Section 4.
NQ Merchandised Selection Example
208Y/120 Vac, 3Ø4W, 10 kA SCCR, 225 A, MLO, Type-1, surface-mount, bolt-on,
branch circuit breakers, main sub-feed lugs
Branches Table No. Catalog Number Spaces
(20) 20/1 Table 9.17 (20) QOB120 20
two 40/2 Table 9.17 two QOB240 4
two 30/3 Table 9.17 two QOB330 6
Total 30 spaces
9-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Main Lug Interiors—240 Vac, 48 Vdc NQ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us
NQ Merchandised Panelboards
Table 9.5: Main Lug Interiors—Accepts plug-on and bolt-on circuit breakers
Type 1 Enclosure Type 3R, 5, 12 Enclosure [1]
Interior Only
Pole Mains (Order Branch Circuit Box
20 in. W x 5.75 in. Mono-Flat™ Front [3] Hinged Front Enclosure
Spaces Rating Breakers Separately) 20 in. W x 6.5 in. D Height
D [2] (In.)
Catalog No. [4] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
20-inch-wide Cabinet —Single Phase 3-Wire
NQ18L1
18 MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
NQ18L1C
100
NQ30L1
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ30L1C
NQ30L2
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
PANELBOARDS
NQ30L2C
NQ42L2
42 MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ42L2C
225
NQ72L2
72[5] MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ72L2C
NQ84L2
84[5] MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ84L2C
NQ30L4
30
NQ30L4C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ42L4
42
400 NQ42L4C
NQ54L4
54 MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ54L4C
84[5] NQ84L4C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
30 NQ30L6C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH62WP[6] 50/62
42 NQ42L6C
9
600 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR
54 NQ54L6C MH56 MH56WP 56
84[5] NQ84L6C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH80WP[6] 68/80
20-inch-wide Cabinet —Three Phase 4-Wire
NQ418L1
18 MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
NQ418L1C
100
NQ430L1
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ430L1C
NQ430L2
30 MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ430L2C
NQ442L2
42
NQ442L2C
MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ454L2
54 225
NQ454L2C
NQ472L2
72[5] MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ472L2C
NQ484L2
84[5] MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ484L2C
NQ430L4
30
NQ430L4C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ442L4
42
NQ442L4C
400 NQ454L4
54 MH56 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ454L4C
NQ472L4
72[5] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ472L4C
84[5] NQ484L4C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
30 NQ430L6C
MH50 NC50V ( ) NC50V( )HR MH62WP[6] 50/62
42 NQ442L6C
600 NC56V( ) NC56V( )HR
54 NQ454L6C MH56 MH56WP 56
84[5] NQ484L6C MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH80WP[6] 68/80
NQ30L1C
NQ30L2
30 225 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ30L2C
NQ42L2
42 225 HD, HG, HJ, HL[15] or JD, MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ42L2C NQMB2HJ JG, JJ, JL
NQ72L2 NQMB2Q QB,QD,QG,QJ
72[16] 225 MH56 NC56 ( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ72L2C
NQ84L2
84[16] 225 MH62 NC62 ( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ84L2C
NQ30L4
30 400 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ30L4C
NQ42L4
42 400 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ42L4C
NQ54L4
54 400 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
NQ54L4C
84[16] 400 NQ84L4C NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH80 NC80V ( ) NC80V( )HR MH80WP 80
20-inch-wide Cabinet [12]—Three Phase 4-Wire
NQ418L1 —
15[13] Select MH26 NC26 ( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP 26
100 NQ418L1C —
QOB 3-pole or
back-fed NQ430L1 — QOB-VH[14]
27[13] MH32 NC32 ( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP 32
NQ430L1C —
NQ418L1
18 HD, HG, HJ, HL, or QB, MH38 NC38 ( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP 38
NQ418L1C NQMB2HJ
100 NQMB2Q QD, QG, QJ
NQ430L1 100A maximum
30 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ430L1C
NQ430L2
30 MH44 NC44 ( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP 44
NQ430L2C
NQ442L2
42
NQ442L2C
HD, HG, HJ, HL or JD, JG, MH50 NC50 ( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP 50
NQ454L2 NQMB2HJ
54 225 JJ, JL
NQ454L2C NQMB2Q QB,QD,QG,QJ
NQ472L2
72 MH56 NC56 ( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP 56
NQ472L2C
NQ484L2
84 MH62 NC62 ( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ484L2C
NQ430L4
30
NQ430L4C
NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH62 NC62V ( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP 62
NQ442L4
42
NQ442L4C
400 NQ454L4
54 NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH68 NC68V ( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP 68
NQ454L4C
NQ472L4
72[16] NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH74 NC74V ( ) NC74V( )HR MH74WP 74
NQ472L4C
84[16] NQ484L4C NQMB4LA LA/LH[17] MH80 NC80V ( ) NC80V( )HR MH80WP 80
• 240 Vac, 48 Vdc maximum • Interiors accept bolt-on and plug-on branch circuit
breakers
• 225 A maximum main circuit breaker or main lugs
• Three-phase, four-wire, and single-phase, three-wire
• 60 A maximum branch circuit breakers interiors available
• Visi-Trip™ indication on branch circuit breakers • Panelboards available with Mono-Flat™ front
• 10,000–65,000 A Short Circuit Current Rating
(SCCR)
• Suitable for use as service entrance equipment
• Branch circuit filler plates provide fast and easy
• Interiors supplied with tin plated copper bus as installation
standard •
PANELBOARDS
Both fully and series-rated systems are available
Table 9.7: Main Lug Interiors—Accepts Plug-On and Bolt-On Branch Breakers
Interior Only Type 1 Enclosure
(Order Branch
Max. Number Main Circuit Breakers Box 14"W x Mono Flat
Ratings Hinged Front
of Breakers Seperately) 5.75" Db Front
14–inch wide NQ
Panelboard Main Lug Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. [18] Cat. No.
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Single Phase 3-Wire
18 NQ18L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 A
30 NQ30L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ30L2C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
225 A
42 NQ42L2C14 NQB538 NQC38 N/A
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Three Phase 4-Wire
18 NQ418L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 A
9
30 NQ430L1C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ430L2C14 NQB532 NQC32 N/A
225 A
42 NQ442L2C14 NQB538 NQC38 N/A
Table 9.8: Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—Accepts Plug-On and Bolt-On Branch
Breakers
Interior Only Type 1 Enclosure
(Order Branch
Max. Circuit Main Circuit Breaker Adapter
Number Main Kit (Less Circuit Breaker) Box 14"W Mono Flat Hinged
Breakers x 5.75" Db Front Front
of Ratings Seperately)
Main Circuit Breaker Breakers
Panelboard Cat. No.
Cat. No. Cat. No Cat. No [19] Cat. No. [18] Cat. No.
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Single Phase 3-Wire
16 [20] NQ18L1C14 — Select QOB NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 2-pole or
28 [20] NQ30L1C14 — QOB-VH[21] NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ30L2C14 HD, HG, HJ, NQB544 NQC44 N/A
NQMB2HJ14 HL, OR JD,
225 or JG, JJ, JL,
42 NQ42L2C14 NQMB2Q14 QB , QD, QG, NQB550 NQC50 N/A
QJ
14-inch-wide Cabinet—Three Phase 4-Wire
15 [20] NQ418L1C14 — Select QOB NQB532 NQC32 N/A
100 3-pole or
Main Lug Panelboard 27 [20] NQ430L1C14 — QOB-VH[21] NQB532 NQC32 N/A
30 NQ430L2C14 HD, HG, HJ, NQB544 NQC44 N/A
NQMB2HJ14 HL, OR JD,
225 or JG, JJ, JL,
42 NQ442L2C14 NQMB2Q14 QB , QD, QG, NQB550 NQC50 N/A
QJ
[18] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[19] All 14” W boxes come with blank endwalls.
[20] Pole spaces shown are available for branch circuits, with spaces deducted for the back-fed main breaker.
[21] Select a Q or H frame circuit breaker (and associated main circuit breaker kit) from the list for 225 interiors, for panels to be "Suitable for use as UL service equipment."
9-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Panelboards NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us
NQ Merchandised Accessories
Table 9.10: NQ Merchandised Neutrals
Mains 200% Neutral Kit Copper 100% Neutral Kit
Ampacity Catalog No. Box Add Schedule Catalog No. Box Add Schedule
100 NQNL1 NQN1CU
no adder PE-1A no adder PE-1A
225 NQNL2 or NQNL2ACCY[22] NQN2CU
400 NQNL4[23] no adder PE-1A NQN6CU
no adder PE-1A
9
Table 9.11: NQ Merchandised Sub-feed Lugs, Feed-through Lugs and Sub-feed Breakers
Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Kits (breaker not incl.)
Mains Sub-feed Lugs (N/A in MCB Interiors) Feed-through Lugs
Ampacity Single SFB Two SFB
Catalog No. Schedule Catalog No. Schedule Catalog No. Schedule Catalog No. Schedule
NQSFL1 100 A not available; use
100 A PE-1A 225 A interior — — — — —
PANELBOARDS
NQFTL2L[24] NQSFB2Q or
225 A NQSFL2 PE-1A PE-1A PE-1A — —
NQFTL2H[25] NQSFB2HJ
NQFTL4L[24] NQSFB4Q or
400 A NQSFL4 PE-1A PE-1A Use the 2 SFB kit — NQSFB4HJ PE-1A
NQFTL4H[25]
600 A Use FTL Factory Assembled Only
NOTE: See Table 9.12 and Table 9.13.
Table 9.12: Box Selection Table: Merchandised NQ Main Lug Panelboards with Accessories
Sub-feed Lugs Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breakers
Feature
Circuits 225 A
100 A 225 A 400 A 600 A 100 A 225 A 400 A 600 A 100 A (one) 400 A (two) 600 A (two)
18 MH26 — — Use FTL — — — — — —
30 MH32 MH38 MH50 Use FTL MH38 MH50 Factory — MH50 MH74 Factory
42 — MH44 MH50 Use FTL Use 225A MH38 MH56 Asssembled — MH56 MH74 Asssembled
72 — MH50 MH62 Use FTL Interior MH50 MH68 Only — MH62 MH86 Only
84 — MH56 MH68 Use FTL MH56 MH68 — MH68 [26]
Table 9.13: Box Selection Table: Merchandised NQ Vertically Mounted Main Breaker Panelboards w/ Accessories
Feature Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breakers
Circuits 100 A 225 A 400 A 600 A 100 A 225 A (one) 400 A (two) 600 A (two)
18 — — — — — —
30 — MH62 Factory — MH62 MH86 Factory
MH50
42 — MH68 Asssembled — MH68 MH86 Asssembled
72 — MH62 MH80 Only — MH74 [26] Only
84 — MH68 MH80 — MH80 [26]
NOTE: See Table 9.157 NQ SurgeLogic SurgeLoc Plug-on SPDs, page 9-64
[22] For 225A panel with SFL, FTL, or SFB, use NQNL2ACCY (enclosure size increases by 6 inches). Otherwise, use NQNL2.
[23] Not to be used with SFL, FTL, or SFB. These combinations are factory assembled only.
[24] The final character L indicates the kit is used for Low circuit count interiors 30 and 42.
[25] The final character H indicates the kit is used for High circuit count interiors 54, 72, and 84.
[26] Requires box longer than available box offer.
9-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Accessories NQ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us
PANELBOARDS
1–102 sequential (left side numbered 1,2,3 ... 102) NQ102S
103–204 sequential (left side numbered 103,104,105 ... 204) NQ204S
6 in. Extension NQ6RDE
12 in. Extension NQ12RDE
Rail and Deadfront Extensions
18 in. Extension NQ18RDE
24 in. Extension NQ24RDE
Touch-up paint USAS #49 Gray (Aerosol can) PK49SP
Handle Attachments—Branch Circuit Breakers
Handle lock-off HLO1
Handle tie - (QO and QOB only) QO1HT
Handle padlock attachment—1-pole QO1PA
2- and 3-pole QO1PL
Handle tie and lock-off for three 1-pole (QO, QOB) QO3HT
Handle tie for two 10–30 A single pole QO(B) circuit breaker QOHT2
Handle tie for three 10–30 A single pole QO(B) circuit breaker QOHT3
9
Handle Padlock Attachment for Padlocking in OFF position
For padlocking 1P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment QO1PAF
For padlocking 2P and 3P QO circuit breaker in OFF position only, fixed attachment QO2PAF
For padlocking 1P QO-GFI, QO-AFI, QO-CAFI, and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment QOGFI1PAF
For padlocking 2P QO-GFI and QO-EPD circuit breakers in OFF position only, fixed attachment QOGFI2PAF
Neutral or Ground Lugs
#10 to #2 Al or #14 to #4 Cu QO70AN
#4 to #1/0 Al or Cu Q1100AN
#1 to #4/0 Al or Cu Q1150AN
Endwalls for MH Enclosures
Blank (one per package) 8011010501
With Knockouts (one per package) 8011010401
9-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers With Visi-Trip™ Indicator for NQ
Panelboards
Class 690, 730, 910, 950 schneider-electric.us
QOB-VHGFI [5]
120 Vac—22 k AIR
15 A QOB115VHGFI
20 A QOB120VHGFI
25 A QOB125VHGFI
30 A QOB130VHGFI
QOB-EPD—QOB Equipment protection circuit breakers
with UL Listed 30 mA (EPD) or 100 mA (EPE) equipment protection.
120 Vac—10 k AIR 120/240 Vac— 240 Vac—10 k AIR
10 k AIR
15 A QOB115EPD QOB215EPD QOB315EPD[6] QOB315EPE[6]
20 A QOB120EPD QOB220EPD QOB320EPD[6] QOB320EPE
25 A QOB125EPD QOB225EPD — —
30 A QOB130EPD QOB230EPD QOB330EPD[6] QOB330EPE[6]
40 A — QOB240EPD QOB340EPD[6] QOB340EPE[6]
50 A — QOB250EPD QOB350EPD[6] QOB350EPE[6]
60 A — QOB260EPD — —
QOB-VHEPD
120 Vac—22 k AIR
15 A QOB115VHEPD
20 A QOB120VHEPD
25 A QOB125VHEPD
30 A QOB130VHEPD
QOB-HM—High magnetic trip circuit breakers
15 A QOB115HM[7]
20 A QOB120HM[7]
QOB-K—Key operated QOB circuit breakers [8]
120 Vac—10 k AIR
10 A QOB110K
15 A QOB115K
20 A QOB120K
25 A QOB125K
30 A QOB130K
[1] For QO plug-on circuit breakers, see the tables starting on Digest page 7-11.
[2] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[3] Do not connect to more than 250 feet of load conductor for the total one-way run to prevent nuisance tripping.
[4] Suitable only for feeding 240 Vac and 208 Vac two-wire loads. Does not contain load neutral connection.
[5] Recommended for applications where high initial inrush may occur and for individual dimmer applications.
[6] See note in Instruction Bulletin when using in an enclosure with a QO403 or QON prefix.
[7] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[8] Available in single pole construction and can be mounted in any single pole space which will accept a standard QOB. These circuit breakers can be turned ON or OFF or RESET with a
special key (Catalog No. QOK10) included with the circuit breaker. These circuit breakers are UL Listed and available as shown in the table.
[9] UL Listed 5,000 AIR on 3Ø corner grounded delta systems.
[10] DC Rating is not available on indicated products.
[11] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating, and refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
9-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
With Visi-Trip™ Indicator for NQ QOB Bolt-On Circuit Breakers
Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 690, 730, 910, 950
Table 9.17 Standard Interrupting QOB 10,000 AIR Circuit Breakers (cont'd.)
Two-pole—Common Two-pole— Three-pole—
Ampere One-pole Trip Common Trip [13] Common Trip
Rating [12]
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
110 A — QOB2110[14] [15] — —
125 A — QOB2125[14] [15] — —
Molded Case Switch 60 A max—240 Vac QOB200 — QOB300
Molded Case Switch 100 A max—240 Vac QOB2000 — QOB3000
PANELBOARDS
15 A QOB115VH [17][14] QOB215VH[14] QOB315VH[14]
20 A QOB120VH [17][14] QOB220VH[14] QOB320VH[14]
25 A QOB125VH[14] QOB225VH[14] QOB325VH[14]
30 A QOB130VH[14] QOB230VH[14] QOB330VH[14]
40 A QOB140VH QOB240VH[14] QOB340VH[14]
50 A QOB150VH QOB250VH[14] QOB350VH[14]
60 A QOB160VH QOB260VH[14] QOB360VH[14]
70 A QOB170VH QOB270VH[14] QOB370VH[14]
80 A — QOB280VH[14] QOB380VH[14]
90 A — QOB290VH[14] QOB390VH[14]
100 A — QOB2100VH[14] QOB3100VH[14]
110 A — QOB2110VH[14] QOB3110VH [18]
125 A — QOB2125VH[14] QOB3125VH [18]
150 A — QOB2150VH [18] QOB3150VH [18]
9
QHB
120 Vac—65 k AIR 120 Vac/240 Vac—65 k AIR 240 Vac—65 k AIR
15 A QHB115 [17] QHB215[14] QHB315[14]
20 A QHB120 [17] QHB220[14] QHB320[14]
25 A QHB125[14] QHB225[14] QHB325[14]
30 A QHB130[14] QHB230[14] QHB330[14]
QOB-HID—HID circuit breakers [19]
120 Vac—10 k AIR 120/240 Vac—10 k AIR 240 Vac—10 k AIR
15 A QOB115HID [17] QOB215HID QOB315HID
20 A QOB120HID [17] QOB220HID QOB320HID
25 A QOB125HID QOB225HID QOB325HID
30 A QOB130HID QOB230HID QOB330HID
40 A QOB140HID QOB240HID —
50 A QOB150HID QOB250HID —
QOB-SWN—Switch Neutral—Common Trip—NEC 514.11
1-pole—2-Wire 2-pole—3-Wire
2 Spaces —120 Vac 3 Spaces—120/240 Vac
10 A — QOB210SWN QOB310SWN
15 A — QOB215SWN QOB315SWN
20 A — QOB220SWN QOB320SWN
25 A — QOB225SWN QOB325SWN
30 A — QOB230SWN QOB330SWN
40 A — QOB240SWN QOB340SWN
50 A — QOB250SWN QOB350SWN
[12] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[13] UL Listed 5,000 AIR on 3Ø corner grounded delta systems.
[14] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating, and refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[15] DC Rating is not available on indicated products.
[16] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–0 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[17] UL Listed as SWD (switching duty) rated suitable for switching 120 Vac fluorescent lighting loads.
[18] QOB2150VH uses 4 pole spaces. QOB3110VH, QOB3125VH, and QOB3150VH each use 6 pole spaces. 40A maximum circuit breaker mounted opposite. Use with 75 °C wire only.
[19] UL Listed for use on circuit feeding fluorescent and High Intensity Discharge (HID) lighting systems such as mercury vapor, metal halide, or high pressure sodium. These circuit breakers are
physically interchangeable with QOB circuit breakers.
9-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards 240 Vac, 48 Vdc
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.21: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker (PowerPact Q-frame - see Tables PowerPact
PANELBOARDS
Interrupting Ratings, page 7-30 and Common Catalog Numbering System, page 7-
30)
No. of Poles Ampacity
2 110–225 A
3 110–225 A
Space Only 110–225 A
PowerPact H, J, & L frame circuit breakers are also available - see Tables PowerPact Interrupting Ratings, page 7-
30 and Common Catalog Numbering System, page 7-30
Sub-feed Lugs
NOTE: Available on main lug interiors only, 1Ø or 3Ø.
Table 9.23: Sub-feed Wire Range Per Phase Table 9.24: Sub-feed Lug Cabinet Data
Mains Rating Incoming Outgoing Max. No. of Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
100 one #6-2/0 Al or Cu one #6-2/0 Al or Cu Branch Spaces 100 A 225 A 400 A
225 one 1/0-350 kcmil Al or Cu one 1/0-350 kcmil Al or Cu 18 MH26 — —
400 one 1/0-750 kcmil Cu only one 1/0-750 kcmil Cu only 30 MH32 MH38 MH50
42 — MH44 MH50
54 — MH44 MH50
72 — MH50 MH62
84 — MH56 MH68
Feed-through Lugs
Table 9.25: Feed-through Lugs Table 9.26: Feed-through Lug Cabinet Data
Mains Rating Feed-Through Wire Range Per Phase Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
100 A one #6-2/0 Al or Cu Max. No. 225 A 250 A 400 A 600 A
225 A one #6–350 kcmil Al or Cu of Branch Main
Main Main Main Main Main Circuit
400 A one 1/0–750 kcmil or two 1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu Spaces Circuit Circuit
Lugs Lugs Lugs Break-
600 A two 1/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu Breaker Breaker er [1]
30 38 50 50 62 62 68
42 38 50 56 68 62 80
72 50 62 68 80 74 —
84 56 68 68 80 80 —
[20] UL Listed as HACR type for use with air conditioning, heating, and refrigeration equipment having motor group combinations and marked for use with HACR type circuit breakers.
[21] QO arc-fault circuit breakers provide branch feeder protection (for example, QO115AFI) or combination protection (for example, QO115CAFI) as required by the NEC and local code
adoption, and comply with UL 1699.
[22] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–0 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[23] 10–30 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 60 °C or 75 °C conductors. 35–60 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 °C conductors.
[1] 8.75 in. deep box, ship fully assembled only.
9-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Common Features NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1640CT0801
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.31: 200% Rated Neutrals Table 9.32: NQ Main Neutral Conductors—Required Size and
Panelboards with 200% rated neutrals are not available with 250 A J- and K-frame main
circuit breakers or integral lighting contactors Quanitity
100 A[2] one #6-2/0 kcmil Al or Cu per lug Panelboard Actual Lug Wire
Ampacity Neutral Conductors Required Range
225 A[2] one #6-350 kcmil Al or Cu per lug
one #1/0-750 kcmil Al or Cu per lug or 100/125 (2) 1/0 Cu or Al (2) #4-300kcmil
400 A[2] two 1/0-300 kcmil per lug 225 (2) 4/0 Cu or (2) 300 kcmil Al (2) #4-300 kcmil
(4) 3/0 Cu or
(4) 250 kcmil Al (2) 1/0-300 kcmil or
400 A (2) 600 kcmil Cu (1) 750 kcmil
(2) 750 kcmil Al
NOTE: Neutral conductors must be of size and quantity per
table above.
Table 9.33: Metal Directory Frames Table 9.34: Hinged Door-in-Door Trims
PANELBOARDS
Metal Directory Frame Hinged Door-in-Door Trim
Replaces standard plastic stick-on directory pouch Hinged Door-in-Door Trim has piano hinge down one side.
Inner door has a lock, outer door is retained with screws
Hinged Door-in-Door with Outer Door Lock in place of screws
Table 9.35: Weatherproof or Dusttight Cabinets—Type 3R, 5, 12 Table 9.36: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs
Weatherproof or Dusttight Cabinets for Main Lug Interiors
NOTE: 600 A L-Frame main circuit breaker NQ panelboards are not Main Lug Interiors
available with a weatherproof enclosure (Use I-Line) Aluminum Compression Lugs
Copper Mechanical Lugs
Copper Compression Lugs
400 and 600 A NQ panelboards with sub-feed circuit breakers are not available with a weatherproof
enclosure (Use I-Line).
400 A NQ panelboards are available with a subfeed breaker up to 150 A. See Table 9.22 Sub-feed
9
Circuit Breaker Cabinet Data, page 9-22.
NOTE: Optional lugs are not available for Q frame main or QOB
Table 9.37: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs circuit breakers
for Main Circuit Breaker Interiors
Main Circuit Breaker Interiors: Table 9.38: Surgelogic™ SurgeLoc Plug-On SPD [3]
Aluminum Compression Lugs
Surge Current Rating kA
Copper Mechanical Lugs
80 kA
Copper Compression Lugs 100 kA
120 kA
160 kA
200 kA
240 kA
Factory-installed IP2X barriers for NQ Panelboards reduce the risk of accidental contact
with energized components if a cover is removed.
Features
• Plastic barriers cover Mains (lugs or circuit breaker), copper bus, and branch circuit
breakers
– IP2X per IEC 60529 on all ungrounded parts
9
circuit breakers
• Series rated up to 200 kAIC with integral main circuit breaker—fully rated
up to 65 kAIC
• Sub feed[4] lugs up to 225 A
• cULus Listed to UL 67 and CSA C22.2, No. 29
New Enhanced IP2X design meets IEC 60529 with or without a branch circuit
breaker installed.
• Same plastic barriers over mains, bus ends, and branch circuit breaker terminations
as standard NQ Fingersafe design
• Unique
barriers
jaw kit allows QOB branch circuit breakers to plug onto NQ interior with IP2X
PANELBOARDS
QO / QOB 70 L L H
80–100 — H H
QO-H / QOB-H 15–30 — L —
40–100 — H —
15–30 L L L
QO-HID / QOB-HID
40–50 L L —
QO-HM / QOB-HM 15–20 L — —
15–30 — L L
QO- VH / QOB-VH 15–70 L — —
40–100 — H H
QOH[6] 40–100 — H —
QHB[6] 15–30 L L —
IP2X QO(B) Lug L (Low Amp) - QOFSLALB
overs: H (High Amp) - QOFSHALB
Replacement Parts
9
Replacement Parts
Catalog Number Quantity Per Package Description
QOFSBF12 12 NQ IP2X Bus Finger Filler[7]
QOFSLALB12 12 NQ IP2X QO(B) Lug Cover Low Amp
NQ IP2X QO(B) Lug Cover High
QOFSHALB12 12 Amp
HJQLLC HJQ Main Breaker IP2X Line Lug
1
Cover
LA/LH Main Breaker IP2X Line Lug
LALLC 1
Cover
NQHJLSC HJ Main Breaker IP2X Load Side
1 Cover
NQQLSC Q Main Breaker IP2x Load Side
1 Cover
NQLALHLSC LA/LH Main Breaker IP2X Load Side
1
Cover
NQMLLSC 1 Main Lugs IP2X Cover
NQNCC 1 NQ IP2X Neutral Cover
QO1PJ15 1 QOB Jaw Kit[8]
[5] QOB circuit breakers and jaw kits required for Enhanced IP2X design.
[6] Available only in standard IP2X design
[7] Used only with Standard IP2X design.
[8] Used only with Enhanced IP2X design.
9-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF Merchandised Panelboards 20-inch Wide Enclosures 480Y/277 Vac
Max.
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701 schneider-electric.us
Table 9.41: NF Main Circuit Breaker Interiors—Use I-Line Panelboards on 480 V 3Ø3W Delta Applications
NEMA 1 Enclosure NEMA 3R, 5, 12 Enclosure [2]
Max. No. of Main Circuit
Mains Breaker Main Circuit Interior Only [1] Box Mono-Flat™
One-pole EDB 20 in. W x Hinged Front Enclosure
Circuit Rating Adapter Kit Breaker Front [4] 20 in. W x 6.5 in. D Height
Frame 5.75in. D [3] (In.)
Breakers
Kit Catalog No. [5] Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
(Single Phase 3-Wire: Factory Assembled Only) Three Phase 4-Wire
NF418L1 MH26 NC26( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP
15 125 Back-fed 26
EDB, EGB or NF418L1C MH26 NC26( ) NC26( )HR MH26WP
Main
Breaker[7] EJB NF430L1 MH32 NC32( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP
27 125 32
NF430L1C MH32 NC32( ) NC32( )HR MH32WP
NF418L1 MH38 NC38( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP
18 125 38
N150MH HD/HG/ NF418L1C MH38 NC38( ) NC38( )HR MH38WP
[8] HJ/HL NF430L1 MH44 NC44( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP
30 125 44
NF430L1C MH44 NC44( ) NC44( )HR MH44WP
NF430L2 MH50 NC50( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP
30 250 50
NF430L2C MH50 NC50( ) NC50( )HR MH50WP
NF442L2 MH56 NC56( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP
42 250 56
N250MJ JD/JG/ NF442L2C MH56 NC56( ) NC56( )HR MH56WP
[8] JJ/JL NF454L2 MH62 NC62( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP
54 250 56
NF454L2C MH62 NC62( ) NC62( )HR MH62WP
NF466L2 MH74 NC74( ) NC74( )HR MH74WP
66 [9] 250 74
NF466L2C MH74 NC74( ) NC74( )HR MH74WP
NF430L4 MH62 NC62V( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP
30 400 N400M[8] 62
NF430L4C MH62 NC62V( ) NC62V( )HR MH62WP
NF442L4 MH68 NC68V( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP
42 400 N400M[8] LA/LH 68
NF442L4C MH68 NC68V( ) NC68V( )HR MH68WP
NF466L4 MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR MH86WP
66 [9] 400 N400M[8] 86
NF466L4C MH86 NC86V( ) NC86V( )HR MH86WP
Accessories
Table 9.43: NF Merchandised Neutrals
Mains 200% Neutral Kit Copper 100% Neutral Kit
Ampacity Catalog No. Catalog No.
125 NFNL1 NFN1CU
250 NFNL2 NFN2CU
400 NFNL4[10] NFN6CU
600 Factory Assembled Only NFN6CU[10]
PANELBOARDS
Catalog No. Catalog No. Circuit Breaker Circuit Breakers
Catalog No. Catalog No.
125 NF125SFL NF125FTL 250 NF250SFBH/NF250SFBJ —
250 NF250SFL NF250FTL — NF600SFBH
400
400 NF400SFL [14] NF400FTL — NF600SFBJ
600
[15] [15] 600 FACTORY ASSEMBLED ONLY
800
800 FACTORY ASSEMBLED ONLY
NOTE: NF250SFBH and NF600SFBH are for use with HDL, HGL, HJL, and HLL circuit breakers. NF600SFBJ are for use with JDL, JGL,
JJL, and JLL circuit breakers.
Table 9.45: Special Features Box Selection Table—Standard Mechanical Lugs Only
Main Lugs Only
Feature Sub-feed Lugs Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breaker
9
No. of
18 30 42 66 84 18 30 42 66 84 30 42 66
Circuits
Ampacity Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat No. Cat No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
100/125 MH26 MH32 — — — MH32 MH38 — — — — — —
250 — MH38 MH44 MH62 — — MH50 MH56 MH74 — MH56 MH62 MH80
400 — MH50 MH56 MH74 MH86 — MH56 MH62 MH80 MH92 MH68 MH74 —
600
— [15] [15] [15] [15] — [15] [15] [15] [15] [15] [15] [15]
800
Table 9.46: Special Features Box Selection Table—Standard Mechanical Lugs Only (continued)
Vertical Main Circuit Breaker [16] Back-fed Main Circuit Breaker
Feature Feed-through Lugs Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Feed-through Lugs
No. of Circuits 18 30 42 66 30 42 18 30
Ampacity Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
100/125 MH44 MH50 — — — — MH32 MH38
250 — MH62 MH68 MH86 MH68 MH74 MH38 MH44
400[16] — MH68 MH74 MH92 MH80 MH86 — —
600 Available factory assembled only. — —
Table 9.47: Optional Main Lug Kits for Main Lug Panelboards
AL Compression Lug Kit CU Mechanical Lug Kit CU Compression Lug Kit [14]
Ampacity
Catalog No. Lug Wire Range Catalog No. Lug Wire Range Catalog No. Lug Wire Range
125 NFALV1 [17] one #4–300 kcmil NFCUM1 #6–2/0 AWG NFCUV1 [18] one #6–1/0
250 NFALV2 one 250–350 kcmil NFCUM2 #6–250 kcmil NFCUV2 [18] one 2/0–300 kcmil
one 1/0–750 kcmil,
400 NFALV4 two 2/0–500 kcmil NFCUM4 two 1/0–350 kcmil NFCUV4 one 400–750 kcmil
600 NFALV6 two 2/0–500 kcmil NFCUM6 two 1/0–750 kcmil NFCUV6 two 250–500 kcmil
800 Contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.
[10] Not to be used with SFL, FTL, or SFB. These combinations are factory assembled only.
[11] Available factory assembled only on non-linear panelboards.
[12] Select box from the Box Selection Table.
[13] Order appropriate circuit breaker.
[14] Use copper wire only.
[15] Available factory assembled only.
[16] 400 A dimension for LA/LH main circuit breakers only.
[17] Use of this kit requires an additional 6 in. added to box height.
[18] Use of this kit to terminate larger than standard wire size requires an additional 6 in. added to box height.
9-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers For NF Merchandised Panelboards
Class 515
schneider-electric.us
EDB, EGB, EJB Table 9.51: Factory Installed Electrical Accessory Packages for ED, EG, EJ
3–pole
PANELBOARDS
15–125 A Circuit Breakers
Accessory Package Suffix
[5][6] AABA
Shunt Trip Package[5][6] SA
Auxiliary Switch/Alarm
Switch/Shunt Trip Package[5][6] AABASA
Alarm Switch (N.O.) Package for EPDs only BA
9
EXB Fixed Padlock Attachment, Lock ON/OFF
EDB, EPD
1–pole ED, EG, EJ 1, 2, or 3 EDPA
with Alarm Switch EXB Fixed padlock attachment, Lock OFF only
ED, EG, EJ 1, 2, or 3 EDPAF
EXB Removable padlock attachment, Lock OFF only
ED, EG, EJ 1, 2, or 3 HPAFD
EXB Handle Ties
Ties 2 – 1P ECB2HT
ED, EG, EJ
Ties 3 – 1P ECB3HT
Table 9.55: Mechanical Lug Kit Information (Al lugs for use with Al or Cu wire)[6]
Circuit Breaker Application Number of Wires Per
Lug Catalog Lugs
Ampere Ampere Number Per Kit
Standard Rating Optional Rating and Wire Range
Table 9.56: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Table 9.57: Sub-feed Circuit Breaker Cabinet Data
Max. No. of Box Height (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
(150–400 A) Branch Spaces 250 A 400 A LA/LH 600 A 800 A
(Does not include
No. of sub-feed circuit Main Main Main Main Main Main
Poles Lugs Lugs Main Lugs Lugs [2]
breaker spaces) Breaker Breaker Breaker [1]
2
30 56 68 68 80 74 80[3] 68
3
42 62 74 74 86 80 86[3] 74
54 68 80 80 92 86 92[3] 80
66 80 N/A
84 N/A
Common Features
Table 9.58: Sub-feed (Double) Lugs (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)
Mains Rating Sub-feed Wire Range
Wire Bending Space per NEC Table 373-6
125 A two #6–2/0 Al or Cu
250 A two 1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu
400 A two 1/0–600 kcmil Cu
600 A (4) 4/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
9
Table 9.59: Sub-feed Lug Cabinet Data (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)
Max. No. of Main Lugs Box Height in Inches (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
Branch Spaces 125 A 250 A 400 A 600 A 800 A [4]
PANELBOARDS
18 26 — — — —
30 32 38 50 74 74
42 — 44 56 80 80
54 — 50 62 86 86
Table 9.61: Feed-through Lug Cabinet Data (Standard Aluminum Mechanical Lugs)
Max. Box Height in Inches (20 in. W x 5.75 in. D)
No. 125 A 100/125 A 250 A 400 A LA/LH 600 A 800 A
of
Bran- Main
Breaker Main Main Main Main Main Main
ch Main Main Main Breaker Lugs
Spa- (back-fed Lugs Breaker Lugs Breaker Lugs Breaker Lugs
only) [5] [6]
ces
18 38 32 44 — — — — — — —
30 44 38 50 50 62 56 68 62 74 56
42 50 — — 56 68 62 74 68 80 62
54 — — — 62 74 68 80 74 86 68
[4] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep and 26 in. wide box.
[5] 600 A main circuit breaker panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
[6] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
9-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Common Features NF Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 1670 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701
schneider-electric.us
PANELBOARDS
Hinged Door-in-Door Trim
Hinged Door-in-Door Trim has piano hinge down one side.
Inner door has a lock, outer door is retained with screws
Hinged Door-in-Door with Outer Door Lock in place of screws
Table 9.71: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs for Main Lug Interiors
Main Lug Interiors
Aluminum Compression Lugs
Copper Mechanical Lugs
9
Copper Compression Lugs
Table 9.72: Optional Factory Assembled Lugs for Main Circuit Breaker Interiors
Main Circuit Breaker Interiors
Aluminum Compression Lugs
Copper Mechanical Lugs
Copper Compression Lugs
[7] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75 in. deep, 26 in. wide box.
[8] Panelboard box height with SPD unit—Contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor.
9-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NF Factory Assembled Panelboards Separated Distribution and Split Bus NF
and NQ Panelboards
Class 1670 schneider-electric.us
Special lug pad adaptors allow field removal of cables, for easy field
installation of solid core or split CTs for electrical energy measurement,
by load type.
Square D NF and NQ Separated Distribution and Split Bus Panelboards come Factory
Assembled with copper bus, with or without an integral Main Circuit Breaker. A wide
variety of configurations may be submitted for quotation via Square D QuoteFAST, and
may be quoted or ordered by Authorized Distributors using SE Advantage or E-Way
Quote Management.
Features:
• Multiple branch section configurations (pole spaces per section):
– Split Bus: 18-30; 30-18; 30-30; 30-18-18
– Separated Distribution: 30-18-18; 18-18-18
9-32
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Single-Row (Column-width)—240 Vac NQ/NF Merchandised Single Row (Column
Bolt-on Width) Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 1640 / Refer to Catalog 1670CT0701, 1640CT0801
PANELBOARDS
panelboards.
Branches: Bolt-on QOB, 60 A maximum. QOB 10-60 A 1-, 2- and 3-pole. See QOB Bolt-
On Circuit Breakers, page 9-20 and NQ Factory Assembled Panelboards, page 9-22 for
branch circuit breaker terminal data. QOB-VH and QHB branch circuit breakers are also
available as factory assembled.
Cabinet: Front—Screw cover. Box—galvanized steel with removable endwalls.
Gutters:
• 100 A—4 in. min. mains end, 3 in. min. opposite mains
• 225 A—10 in. min. mains end, 5 in. min. opposite mains
Table 9.75: NQ Single-Row (Column-width)—240 Vac Bolt-on [1]
Box and Interior with Solid Neutral
Max. (8.625 in. W. x 5 in. D.) Front
Mains
9
No. of (Surface Mount)
Rating (Order branch circuit breakers separately)
Poles
Catalog Number Box Height (In.) Catalog Number
1 Phase 3-Wire Main Lugs Only
30 225 NQ830L2C 45 LX45TS
Main Circuit Breaker—2-pole
20 100 NQ820B1C 40 LX40TS
3 Phase 4-Wire Main Lugs Only
30 100 NQ8430L1C 40 LX40TS
42 225 NQ8442L2C 58 LX58TS
Main Circuit Breaker—3-pole
30 100 NQ8430B1C 45 LX45TS
42 225 NQ8442B2C 62 LX62TS
Thermal-magnetic (480Y/277 Vac), page 9-28 for branch circuit breaker catalog numbers
and terminal data.
Cabinet: Front—Screw cover. Box—galvanized steel with removable endwalls.
Gutters:
• 100 A—4 in. min. mains end, 3 in. min.opposite mains
• 225 A—10 in. min. mains end, 5 in. min. opposite mains
Table 9.77: NF Single-Row (Column-width)—480Y/277 Vac Bolt-on
20 in.
Box and Interior with S/N Front
Max. No. Mains (8.625 in. W. x 5.625 in. D.) (Surface Mount)
of Poles Rating Catalog Catalog
Box Height (In.)
15 in.
Number Number
Cable
Trough
Main Lugs Only—3 Phase 4-Wire
Length 30 125 NF8430L1C 59 NC59TS
42 225 NF8442L2C 71 NC71TS
Main Circuit Breaker—3-pole
Solid NF8430M1C
Pull Box Neutral 30 100 65 NC65TS
(Cover Removed) Bar NF8430M1HDC
42 225 NF8442M2JDC 85 NC85TS
Cable
Trough Table 9.78: Cable Troughs and Pull Boxes
Panel Cable Troughs (L=Length) [3] Pull Boxes with Solid Neutral
Height L 8.625 in. x 5.625 in. S/N Catalog
Column (In.) Catalog Number [4] Terminals Number
Width 36 NTX836
Lighting 48 NTX848
Panelboard 42 MPX81542
56 NTX856
8 5⁄8 in. 66 NTX866
PANELBOARDS
controller that provides system intelligence for 168 remotely operated branch circuits.
Master panelboards contain the control electronics, power supply, and control bus strips
for up to 42 branch circuit breakers. Sub-panels extend the capability of the system by
allowing remotely operated branch circuit breakers to be operated from the master
controller via a simple, 4-wire, sub-net connection.
Powerlink panels systems have the capability of being networked together and operated
from a central workstation or via a remote modem connection. Powerlink software allows
users to remotely configure the system, change time schedules, monitor circuit breaker
or input status, and override zones and breakers.
BACnet Capability
The Building Automation and Control network (BACnet) communication protocol is
incorporated into the Powerlink™ controller design. The addition of the BACnet protocol
allows Powerlink panels to be easily integrated into a Building Automation System (BAS)
Powerlink available in employing this open communication standard without the need for communication
9
column width design
bridges or gateways.
Controller Models
The following Powerlink controller models support ‘native’ BACnet communications:
• NF2000G3 — Ethernet communications, shared remote inputs, network time
synchronization
• NF3000G3 — Email upon alarm, onboard web pages for status/control/configuration
• NF3500G4 — Embedded web server, 256 communication inputs available
9-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerlink™ Lighting Control Systems Lighting Control Products
Class 1210
schneider-electric.us
ECB-G3 remotely operated circuit breakers and EDB, EGB and EJB standard branch
circuit breakers.
• Refer to panelboard section for additional panelboard accessories.
• For complete price, order by description.
• Apply appropriate discount schedule.
240 V Factory Assembled System Example:
PANELBOARDS
500 level system with 225 A MLO panelboard rated for 208Y/120 V, 3Ø4W, 10kAIR,
Type 1, surface mount with ground bar and (12) 20 A 1-pole bolt-on remote operated
circuit breakers.
Table 9.79:
Item Page No.
System Type: 500 controller with 12 ckt bus page 9-37
Panel type: 250 A MLO page 9-26
Branch circuit breakers: (12) 20 A 1-pole page 9-36
Ground bar page 9-30
Table 9.80:
System Level
Feature
500 1000 2000 3000 3500
Inputs
2 - wire 8 16 16 16 16
2 - wire with status feedback[1] 8 8 8 8 8
3 - wire 8 8 8 8 8
Time Scheduler
Independent schedules — 16 16 16 64
ON-OFF periods/schedule — 24 24 24 999
Special events/holiday periods — 32 32 32 64
Up to eight panels can Automatic daylight savings — X X X X
be controlled from a Sunrise/sunset tracking — X X X X
single controller. Network Variables
Communications inputs accessible 64 64 64 64 256
Remote sources (per controller) — — 32 32 128
Maximum subscriptions — — 256 256 256
Zones
Maximum number 64 64 64 64 256
Maximum number of sources per zone 1 1 4 4 4
Maximum number of remotely operated circuit
breakers (per subnet) 168 168 168 168 168
Networking
RS-232 port/RS-485 port X X X X X
Ethernet (100BaseT port) — — X X X
Protocols
Modbus™ ASCII/RTU X X X X X
Modbus TCP — — X X X
BACnet/IP, BACnet MS/TP — — X X X
DMX512 — X X X X
Powerlink™ Accessories
Table 9.83: Control Bus
Max. No. of
Required Catalog No.
Control Panel Orientation
Circuits Interior Size
12 30 Left NF12SBLG3
12 30 Right NF12SBRG3
18 42 Left NF18SBLG3
18 42 Right NF18SBRG3
21 54 Left NF21SBLG3
21 54 Right NF21SBRG3
PANELBOARDS
240 V Panel Bus NF240PSG3
277 V Panel Bus NF277PSG3
120 V External NF120PSG3L
240 V External NF240PSG3L
277 V External NF277PSG3L
9
Voltage Catalog No.
120 V RSC16G3120
240 V RSC16G3240
277 V RSC16G3277
Powerlink Software
[6] Requires 2000 and 3000 controller and either Analog or Ethernet modem connection to each master panel.
[7] LC and JJ may not be combined.
[8] 600 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75" deep box.
[9] Dimensions also for 400 A LC/LI main circuit breaker panels.
[10] 600 A main lug panelboards require an 8" deep, 26” wide box.
[11] 800 A main lug panelboards require an 8.75” deep, 26” wide box.
9-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Lighting Control System, Relay Panels, and Powerlink™ Energy Management (EM)
Switches
schneider-electric.us Class 1210
PANELBOARDS
• Integral individual and optional mains metering to provide utmost flexibility in assurng a sustainable metering and
verification program
• Monitors current, voltage, energy consumption, demand, and power factor for complete energy profiling
• Accumulated metering information transmitted via Modbus communications interface
• Data updates occurring within seconds to provide timely preventative maintenance information
• Optional EGX web interface for storing and reporting data via standard web browser (suggested for applications
without Energy Management System [EMS] software)
• Alarm indication when parameters approach user-configured thresholds
• 16 hard-wired inputs available for connection to devices with physical dry-contacts
• 64 communication inputs available for network connection
• 16 independent time schedules, each can be configured into 24 distinct periods
• 7-day repeating clock with changeable automatic daylight savings time
• Automatic sunrise/sunset tracking with offsets
9
• 32 special event periods
• 32 remote sources for sharing input status, time schedules, or zone status between controllers
• Full custom logic capabilities, including full Boolean functions and synchronization services
[1] Recommended for application where EMS software monitoring is not provided.
9-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards I-Line Combo Panelboard
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
[1] B denotes a blank space on the right hand side of a duplex panel for future expansion
9-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line Combo Panelboard I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.97: RTI Cabled Lighting Section Kit for I-Line Combo Panelboard
Lighting Lighting
MLO Panelboard Section
Part Number Description Ampacity Section
Type Circuits
NFICRT418L1C NF Lighting Section Kit 125 NF 18 dual
NFICRT442L2C NF Lighting Section Kit 250 NF 42
NFICRT442L4C NF Lighting Section Kit 400 NF 42
NFICRT442L6C NF Lighting Section Kit 600 NF 42
NQICRT418L1C NQ Lighting Section Kit 100 NQ 18 dual
NQICRT442L2C NQ Lighting Section Kit 225 NQ 42
NQICRT442L4C NQ Lighting Section Kit 400 NQ 42
NQICRT442L6C NQ Lighting Section Kit 600 NQ 42
Contactor with 18 Circuit
NQICRT418C1C NQ Lighting Section Kit 100 NQ 18
Contactor with 18 Circuit
PANELBOARDS
NFICRT418C1C NF Lighting Section Kit 125 NF 18
I-Line Panelboard
9
QG, QJ QG, QJ HL, JD, JG, JJ, JL
FA, FH FA, FH
FY FY FY, FA, FH
HD, HG, HJ, HL, HR
HD, HG HD, HG
HJ, HL, HR HJ, HL, HR Q B,Q D ,Q G ,Q J
JD, JG JD, JG
JJ, JL, JR JJ, JL, JR
JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR
BD, BG BD, BG
BJ BJ
1⁄2 Total LD, LG, LJ, LL, LA, LH, LR
Breaker
Mounting
Space BD, BG, BJ
Each
Side
MG, MJ, PG, JP, PL
PGC, JPC, PL C
Box Size:
32 in. Wide, 8.25 in. Deep Box Size:
26 in. Wide, 9.5 in. Deep
[2] For main circuit breaker panel, order plug-on I-Line type PG, PJ, PL, MG, or MJ circuit breakers from 9–47 through 9–48 and backfeed as the main breaker (order solid neutral from 9–37).
[3] PG, PJ, PL circuit breakers are available with both thermal-magnetic equivalent and Micrologic trip. The Micrologic circuit breakers are available 80% and 100% rated. “C” suffix denotes a
100% rating.
[4] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[5] For Type 1 applications, order interior, front, and box. For Type 3R/5/12 applications, order interior and box only. The front is included with the box.
[6] For Type 1 applications order interior, trim and box. For type 3R/5/12, order interior and box only.
[7] Remove drain screws for Type 3R rating.
[8] Suitable for use as service equipment if equipped with an integral main circuit breaker or when not more than six main disconnecting means are provided and the panelboard is not used as
a lighting and appliance branch circuit panelboard.
[9] Bottom feed standard.
[10] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
9-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards I-Line Combo Panelboard
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Use HCP —
800 A HCM18738MP
45 400 A HCM23734M
HCM73T( ) HCM73T( )D HC3273B HC3273WP 73
54 225 A HCM27732MN
600 A HCM36916MP
72 HCM91T( ) HCM91T( )D HC3291DB9[15] Use HCP —
800 A HCM36918MP
81 400 A HCM41914M HCM91T( ) HCM91T( )D HC3291B HC3291WP 91
HCP-SU [16] Universal Single Row Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker [17]
3-pole—Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker. [18]
54 800 HCP54868SU HC2686T( )4P HC2686T( )HR[19] HC2686DB HC2886WP 86
PANELBOARDS
Table 9.99: Circuit Breaker / Sub-feed Lug Kit Mounting Space Requirement
Type of Maximum No. of Inch Type of Maximum No. of Inch
Circuit Breaker Ampacity Poles Mounting Circuit Breaker Ampacity Poles Mounting
Require- Require-
ments ments
FY 30 1 1.5
FA, FH 100 1 1.5 QB, QD, QG, QJ 225 2 3
FA, FH 2 3 QB, QD, QG, QJ 225 3 4.5
FA, FH, SL-100 3 4.5 JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR, 250 2, 3 4.5
KI, SL250
FI 2, 3 4.5 LA, LH, SL400 400 6
BD, BG, BJ 125 1 1.5 LD, LG, LJ, LL, LR 600 6
BD, BG, BJ 2 3 LC, LI, LXI 600 7.5
BD, BG, BJ 3 4.5 MG, MJ, MA, MH, 800 9
HD, HG 150 2 3 SL800, PGC, PJC,
PLC
HD, HG 3 4.5 PG, PJ, PL, 1200
S33931
HJ, HL, HR 2, 3 4.5 RG, RJ, RL, RGC, 15
RJC, RLC,
S33930
[11] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[12] For Type 1 applications, order interior, front, and box. For Type 3R/5/12 applications, order interior and box only. The front is included with the box.
[13] For Type 1 applications order interior, trim and box. For type 3R/5/12, order interior and box only.
[14] Remove drain screws for Type 3R rating.
[15] DB9 box is 9.5 inches deep.
[16] For main lugs panel, order sub-feed lug kit and back-feed as main lugs.
[17] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
[18] Suitable for use as service equipment if equipped with an integral main circuit breaker or when not more than six main disconnecting means are provided and the panelboard is not used as
a lighting and appliance branch circuit panelboard.
[19] Hinged trim with door.
[20] FA and JDA circuit breakers with field installable ground fault kits may be mounted in type HCP, HCP-SU, and HCR-U panelboards as shown, and require L-frame mounting space.
[21] PG, PJ, and PL circuit breakers are available with both thermal-magnetic equivalent and Micrologic trip. The Micrologic circuit breakers are available 80% and 100% rated. “C” suffix denotes
a 100% rating.
[22] FA and JDA circuit breakers with field installable ground fault kits may be mounted in type HCP, HCP-SU, and HCR-U panelboards as shown, and require L-frame mounting space.
[23] When RL main circuit breakers with equipment ground fault are applied on a 3Ø4W system, order solid neutral catalog number HCR12SNCT. The HCR12SNCT includes a neutral current
transformer.
9-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line Combo Panelboard I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.100: (1200 A Interiors Include solid neutral, all others without solid neutral) [24]
Total Max. Front [25]
Circuit No. of Interior Assembly
Mains (Less Branch Circuit Breakers) 4 Piece Trim Box [26] Box
Breaker LC, MJ, Without Door [27] Trim With Door
Mtg. Amp. Height
Rating PL, RL (In.)
Space Circuit Catalog Catalog Catalog Catalog
(In.) Breakers Number Number Number Number
HCP Main Lugs Only—3-pole
Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker. [28]
400 HCP14504
600 HCP14506
27 1PL HCW50T( ) HCW50T( )D HC4250DB 50
800 HCP14508
1200 HCP145012N
400 HCP23594
600 HCP23596
45 2PL HCW59T( ) HCW59T( )D HC4259DB 59
800 HCP23598
1200 HCP235912N
PANELBOARDS
400 HCP32684
600 HCP32686
63 3PL HCW68T( ) HCW68T( )D HC4268DB 68
800 HCP32688
1200 HCP326812N
400 HCP50864
600 HCP50866
99 5PL HCW86T( ) HCW86T( )D HC4286DB 86
800 HCP50868
1200 HCP508612N
HCP Main Circuit Breaker[29]—Includes 3-pole
Vertically mounted main circuit breaker—Suitable for use as service equipment.
600 HCP18686M
36 2LC HCW68T( ) HCW68T( )D HC4268DB 68
800 HCP18688M
600 HCP36866M
72 4LC HCW86T( ) HCW86T( )D HC4286DB 86
800 HCP36868M
HCR-U Universal Main Lugs or Main Circuit Breaker [30] —3-pole
Suitable for use as service equipment when provided with a main circuit breaker.
9
For Main Lugs panel, order sub-feed lug kit catalog number S33930 and back feed as main lugs.
For Main Circuit Breaker panel, order plug-on I-Line type PG, PJ, PL, RGC, RJC, or RLC [31]circuit breakers from page 9-53 through page 9-56,
and back feed as the main circuit breaker. (Order solid neutral separately)
108 [32] 1200 6PL or 3RLC HCR548612U HCR86T( )[33] HCR86T( )D HC4486DB 86
Table 9.101: Main Circuit Breaker Interiors —Standard Frame Types [29]
Panelboard Factory Supplied
Main Circuit Breaker Ampacity Type Main Circuit Breaker
225 HCM JDA36225
400 HCM LAP36400MB
600 MGP36600
or HCM, HCP or
800 MGP36800
[24] Order solid neutral from Table 9.103 I-Line Merchandised Panelboard Accessories, page 9-44.
[25] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[26] For 42 in. wide weatherproof enclosures, see Table 9.107 Type 3R/5/12 Enclosures, page 9-45
[27] Add-on door kit available. Example: For HCW50TS trim kit, order HCW50D door kit.
[28] Suitable for use as service equipment if equipped with an integral main circuit breaker or when not more than six main disconnecting means are provided and the panelboard is not used as
a lighting and appliance branch circuit panelboard.
[29] Circuit breaker interrupt ratings, see the tables starting on page 7-30.
[30] Add “F” for flush mount, “S” for surface mount.
[31] When RL main circuit breakers with equipment ground fault are applied on a 3Ø4W system, order solid neutral catalog number HCR12SNCT.
The HCR12SNCT includes a neutral current transformer.
[32] 15 in. of mounting space is taken up by the back fed main lug kit or RG, RJ, RL main circuit breaker, leaving 93 in. of branch circuit breaker mounting space.
[33] Add-on door kit available. Example: For HCR86TS trim kit, order HCW86D door kit.
9-43
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards Accessories
Class 690, 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Accessories
9
HNM1BL
PANELBOARDS
Blank Filler Kit—1.5 in.[34] (One kit contains quantity of 3 blank fillers.)
Blank Filler Kit—4.5 in.[34] (One kit contains quantity of 5 blank fillers.) HNM4BL
Solid Neutral Assemblies
HC2SN
225 A
HC4SN [35], HCW4SN [36]
400 A
HC6SN [35], HCW6SN [36]
600 A
HC8SN [35], HCW8SN [36]
HCPSU8SN[37]
800 A
HCPSU8SNCW[37]
HCW12SN[36]
1200 A
1200 A, including neutral Current Transformer (CT) for 3Ø4W systems HCR12SNCTW[38]
Equipment Ground Bar Kits—HCJ, HCM, HCP, HCP-SU (single row), HCR-U PK32DGTA
Blank Extensions (For replacement purposes)
1.5 in. for mounting on wide side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the wide side of the panel (HCP, HCP-SU and HCRU). HLW1BL
(Kit contains quantity of 3.)
Do not use with Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on wide side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and HLW4BL
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the wide side of the panel (HCP, HCP-SU and HCRU).
Do not use with Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34] (Kit contains quantity of 5.)
1.5 in. for mounting on narrow side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and
HLN1BL
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the narrow side of the panel. Do not use with (Kit contains quantity of 3.)
Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on narrow side of I-Line panelboard used with HNM1BL and HLN4BL
HNM4BL as a filler plate on the narrow side of the panel. Do not use with
(Kit contains quantity of 5.)
Micrologic trip unit as this filler will cover the trip unit. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on wide side of I-Line panelboard. For use with PowerPact H HLW4EBL
and J circuit breakers mounted on the wide side of the panel so that electronic trip (Kit contains quantity of 5.)
unit can be accessed. [34]
4.5 in. for mounting on narrow side of I-Line panelboard. For use with PowerPact H
HLN4EBL
and J circuit breakers mounted on the narrow side of the panel so that electronic (Kit contains quantity of 5.)
trip unit can be accessed. [34]
Blank Extensions
[34] Blank extension and blank filler pricing is per kit. See note on kit number for number included in each kit.
[35] Used on Type HCJ, HCN, HCM.
[36] Used on 400 A, 600 A, 800 A, and 1200 A HCP (main lugs), and 600 A and 800 A (main circuit breaker).
[37] Used on Type HCP-SU (single row).
[38] Used on Type HCR-U.
9-44
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards
Class 690, 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
PANELBOARDS
HCW8SNCU (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (28)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750
HCWM12SN (9)-#14 - 1/0, (7)-#6 - 350, (34)-#14 - #4, (4)-3/0-750
HCPSU8SN (7) #6-350, (34) #4- #14, (9) #14-1/0
HCPSU8SNCW (3) 3/0-750, (7) #6-350, (34) #14-#4, (9) #14-1/0
9
Dimensions (In.)
Catalog Number Interior Type
H W D
HC4250WP HCP 50 42 12.95
HC4259WP HCP 59 42 12.95
HC4268WP HCP 68 42 12.95
HC4286WP HCP 86 42 12.95
HC4486WP HCR-U 86 44 14.50
[39] For use with MLO panel, order VCEL lugs seperately.
[40] Not for use with P- or R-frame circuit breakers or sub-feed kits S33930 or S33931.
9-45
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Merchandised Panelboards Accessories
Class 690, 2110 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
PowerPact™ B-frame
Accessories are located in Section 7 PowerPact Accessories, page 7-54.
PANELBOARDS
600Y/347 Vac 14 kA 18 kA 25 kA 65 kA
Table 9.112: PowerPact B-frame, 125A max, Thermal Magnetic UL Circuit Breaker
(PowerPact B-frame 1–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 1.5" of I-Line mounting
space, 2–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 3" of I-Line mounting space and 3–
pole B-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space.)
D - SCCR
480Y/277 Vac 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Amps 277 Vac 480/277 Vac 480/277 Vac Hold Trip
15 BDA14015 BDA24015Y BDA34015Y 400 A 600 A
20 BDA14020 BDA24020Y BDA34020Y 400 A 600 A
25 BDA14025 BDA24025Y BDA34025Y 400 A 600 A
30 BDA14030 BDA24030Y BDA34030Y 400 A 600 A
35 BDA14035 BDA24035Y BDA34035Y 400 A 600 A
9
40 BDA14040 BDA24040Y BDA34040Y 400 A 600 A
45 BDA14045 BDA24045Y BDA34045Y 400 A 600 A
50 BDA14050 BDA24050Y BDA34050Y 480 A 720 A
60 BDA14060 BDA24060Y BDA34060Y 640 A 960 A
70 BDA14070 BDA24070Y BDA34070Y 640 A 960 A
80 BDA14080 BDA24080Y BDA34080Y 800 A 1200 A
90 BDA14090 BDA24090Y BDA34090Y 1000 A 1500 A
100 BDA14100 BDA24100Y BDA34100Y 1000 A 1500 A
110 BDA14110 BDA24110Y BDA34110Y 1000 A 1500 A
125 BDA14125 BDA24125Y BDA34125Y 1000 A 1500 A
G - SCCR
480Y/277 Vac 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Amps 277 Vac 480/277 Vac 480/277 Vac Hold Trip
15 BGA14015 BGA24015Y BGA34015Y 400 A 600 A
20 BGA14020 BGA24020Y BGA34020Y 400 A 600 A
25 BGA14025 BGA24025Y BGA34025Y 400 A 600 A
30 BGA14030 BGA24030Y BGA34030Y 400 A 600 A
35 BGA14035 BGA24035Y BGA34035Y 400 A 600 A
40 BGA14040 BGA24040Y BGA34040Y 400 A 600 A
45 BGA14045 BGA24045Y BGA34045Y 400 A 600 A
50 BGA14050 BGA24050Y BGA34050Y 480 A 720 A
60 BGA14060 BGA24060Y BGA34060Y 640 A 960 A
70 BGA14070 BGA24070Y BGA34070Y 640 A 960 A
80 BGA14080 BGA24080Y BGA34080Y 800 A 1200 A
90 BGA14090 BGA24090Y BGA34090Y 1000 A 1500 A
100 BGA14100 BGA24100Y BGA34100Y 1000 A 1500 A
110 BGA14110 BGA24110Y BGA34110Y 1000 A 1500 A
125 BGA14125 BGA24125Y BGA34125Y 1000 A 1500 A
J - SCCR
600Y/347 Vac 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole Fixed AC Magnetic Trip
Amps 347 Vac 600Y/347 Vac 600Y/347 Vac Hold Trip
15 BJA16015 BJA26015 BJA36015 400 A 600 A
20 BJA16020 BJA26020 BJA36020 400 A 600 A
25 BJA16025 BJA26025 BJA36025 400 A 600 A
30 BJA16030 BJA26030 BJA36030 400 A 600 A
35 BJA16035 BJA26035 BJA36035 400 A 600 A
40 BJA16040 BJA26040 BJA36040 400 A 600 A
45 BJA16045 BJA26045 BJA36045 400 A 600 A
50 BJA16050 BJA26050 BJA36050 480 A 720 A
60 BJA16060 BJA26060 BJA36060 640 A 960 A
70 BJA16070 BJA26070 BJA36070 640 A 960 A
80 BJA16080 BJA26080 BJA36080 800 A 1200 A
90 BJA16090 BJA26090 BJA36090 1000 A 1500 A
100 BJA16100 BJA26100 BJA36100 1000 A 1500 A
110 BJA16110 BJA26110 BJA36110 1000 A 1500 A
125 BJA16125 BJA26125 BJA36125 1000 A 1500 A
F-frame
For phase option information see Table 9.114.
Table 9.113: QO™ Distribution Panel—240 Vac Max. Only Mounts in Type HCM,
HCP, HCP-SU, or HCR-U I-Line panelboards, 30 A max. branch circuit breaker.
Maximum No. 1-pole Phase Mounting Height 2-pole 3-pole
QO Circuit Breakers Connection In. mm Catalog Number Catalog Number
6 AB 4.5 114 HQO206AB —
6 BC 4.5 114 HQO206BC —
9-47
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers B- and F-frame for I-Line F-frame
Panelboards and Switchboards
Class 650, 651 schneider-electric.us
Table 9.113 QO™ Distribution Panel—240 Vac Max. Only Mounts in Type HCM,
HCP, HCP-SU, or HCR-U I-Line panelboards, 30 A max. branch circuit breaker.
(cont'd.)
Maximum No. 1-pole Phase Mounting Height 2-pole 3-pole
QO Circuit Breakers Connection In. mm Catalog Number Catalog Number
6 AC 4.5 114 HQO206AC —
6 ABC 4.5 114 — HQO306
9
PANELBOARDS
Table 9.114: Example: BD, 20 A 1-Pole, 277 Vac and 90 A 2- and 3- Pole Table 9.115: Example: FA, 30 A, 480 Vac. Use phase option
BD 240 Vac. Use phase option number for BD, BG, BJ, HD, HG, HJ, HL, letters for FA, FH, LA, and LH.
HR, JD, JG, JJ, JL, JR, MG, and MJ. Phase 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole
Option Letter
Phase
Phase 1-pole 2-pole 3-pole A FA14035A — —
Option Connection
Number B FA14035B — —
1 A FJA140201 — — C FA14035C — —
3 B FJA140203 — — AB — FA24030AB —
5 C FJA140205 — — AC — FA24030AC —
1 AB — QBA220701 — BC — FA24030BC —
2 AC — QBA220702 — ABC — — FA34030
3 BA — QBA220703 — CBA — — FA34030CBA
4 BC — QBA220704 —
5 CA — QBA220705 —
6 CB — QBA220706 —
Standard [1] ABC — — QBA32070
6 CBA — — QBA320706
Table 9.116: Interrupt Ratings (kA) Table 9.117: F-frame—100 A, Thermal-magnetic (240 Vac)
FA (240 V) FA (480 V) FJ 40 A AC Magnetic FA22040( )
18 (1P), 25 (2, 3P) Trip Settings Standard
240 V 10 65
Ampere Interrupting Terminal Wire Range
277 V — 18 65
Rating Hold Trip Catalog
480 V — 18 —
Number
600 V — — —
2-pole, 240 Vac [2]
F-frame accessories starting on Supplemental Digest Section 3.
15 A FA22015( )
20 A FA22020( ) AL50FA
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A FA22025( ) #12–#4 AWG Al
30 A FA22030( )
AL100FA
35 A 400 850 FA22035( ) #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
45 A FA22045( )
50 A FA22050( )
60 A FA22060( )
70 A 800 1450 FA22070( )
80 A FA22080( )
90 A FA22090( )
900 1700
100 A FA22100( )
3-pole, 240 Vac
15 A FA32015
20 A FA32020 AL50FA
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or
25 A FA32025 #12–#4 AWG Al
30 A FA32030
35 A FA32035
40 A FA32040 AL100FA
400 850 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
45 A FA32045 or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
50 A FA32050
60 A FA32060 AL100FA
70 A 800 1450 FA32070 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
80 A FA32080 or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
90 A FA32090 AL100FA
900 1700 #14–#1/0 AWG Cu
100 A FA32100 or #12–#1/0 AWG Al
[1] The absence of a phase option number after a 3-pole catalog number will result in an ABC phase connection.
[2] 1- and 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection letters as a suffix.
9-48
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
F-frame Circuit Breakers B- and F-frame for I-Line
Panelboards and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 650, 651
Table 9.118: F-frame—100 A, Thermal-magnetic (480 Vac)
AC Magnetic
Trip Settings Standard Interrupting Extra High Interrupting Terminal Wire Range
Ampere
Rating Catalog
Hold Trip Catalog Number FY/FA Lugs FJ/FC Lugs
Number
1-pole, 277 Vac, 125 Vdc [3]
15 A FY14015( )[4] FJA14015( )
20 A FY14020( )[4] FJA14020( ) AL50FA AL30FD
275 600 #14-#4 AWG Cu, or #12–#6 AWG Al, or
25 A FY14025( )[4] FJA14025( ) #12-#4 AWG Al #14–#6 AWG Cu
30 A FY14030( )[4] FJA14030( )
35 A FA14035( ) FJA14035( )
40 A FA14040( ) FJA14040( )
400 850
45 A FA14045( ) FJA14045( )
50 A FA14050( ) FJA14050( ) AL100FD
AL100FA #12–#2/0 AWG Al
60 A FA14060( ) FJA14060( ) #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or
PANELBOARDS
#12–#1/0 AWG Al or
70 A 800 1450 FA14070( ) FJA14070( ) #14–#2/0 AWG Cu
80 A FA14080( ) —
90 A FA14090( ) —
900 1700
100 A FA14100( ) —
2-pole, 480 Vac, 250 Vdc [3][4][5]
15 A FA24015( ) —
20 A FA24020( ) — AL50FA CU30FA4
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or one #14–#10 AWG
25 A FA24025( ) — #12–#4 AWG Al Cu only
30 A FA24030( ) —
35 A FA24035( ) —
40 A FA24040( ) —
400 850
45 A FA24045( ) —
50 A FA24050( ) — AL100FA4
AL100FA
one #14–#3 AWG Cu
9
60 A FA24060( ) — #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or
#12–#1/0 AWG Al or
70 A 800 1450 FA24070( ) — one #12–#1 AWG Al
80 A FA24080( ) —
90 A FA24090( ) —
900 1700
100 A FA24100( ) —
3-pole, 480 Vac, 250 Vdc [3]
15 A FA34015 —
20 A FA34020 — AL50FA CU30FA4
275 600 #14–#4 AWG Cu or one #14–#10 AWG
25 A FA34025 — #12–#4 AWG Al Cu only
30 A FA34030 —
35 A FA34035 —
40 A FA34040 —
400 850
45 A FA34045 —
50 A FA34050 — AL100FA4
AL100FA
60 A FA34060 — #14–#1/0 AWG Cu or one #14–#3 AWG Cu
or
70 A 800 1450 FA34070 — #12–#1/0 AWG Al
one #12–#1 AWG Al
80 A FA34080 —
90 A FA34090 —
900 1700
100 A FA34100 —
[3] 1- and 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection letters as a suffix.
[4] Rated 277 Vac 15 and 20 A FY circuit breakers are rated for switching duty (SWD). 15, 20, 25, and 30 A FA I-Line circuit breakers are also available (no SWD rating).
[5] Rated 277 Vac, 125 Vdc, except FY circuit breakers, which have no dc rating.
15–30 A circuit breakers suitable for use with 60 oC or 75 oC conductors. 35–100 A circuit breakers are suitable for use with 75 oC conductors.
9-49
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers F-frame, PowerPact Q-frame for I-Line™
Panelboards and Switchboards
Class 650, 734, 820 schneider-electric.us
[1] 1- and 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required connection letters as a suffix, see F-frame, page 9-47.
[2] 2-pole QB, QD, QG, and QJ circuit breakers are completed by adding the required phasing numbers as indicated in the parentheses, see F-frame, page 9-47
[3] 3-pole QB, QD, QG, and QJ circuit breakers for ABC phasing are complete without additional phasing number. For CBA phasing, complete the catalog number by inserting the number “6” in
the parentheses.
9-50
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards Circuit Breakers
and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 612
Table 9.120 PowerPact™ Q-frame— 225 A, Thermal-magnetic (240 Vac)(PowerPact Q-frame 2–pole branch circuit breakers utilize 3" of
I-Line mounting space and 3–pole Q-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space.) (cont'd.)
AC Magnetic "B" Interrupting "D" Interrupting "G" Interrupting "J" Interrupting
Ampere Trip Settings
Rating
Hold Trip Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
80 A QBA32080( ) QDA32080( ) QGA32080( ) QJA32080( )
90 A QBA32090( ) QDA32090( ) QGA32090( ) QJA32090( )
100 A QBA32100( ) QDA32100( ) QGA32100( ) QJA32100( )
110 A QBA32110( ) QDA32110( ) QGA32110( ) QJA32110( )
125 A QBA32125( ) QDA32125( ) QGA32125( ) QJA32125( )
150 A 1200 2400 QBA32150( ) QDA32150( ) QGA32150( ) QJA32150( )
175 A QBA32175( ) QDA32175( ) QGA32175( ) QJA32175( )
200 A QBA32200( ) QDA32200( ) QGA32200( ) QJA32200( )
225 A QBA32225( ) QDA32225( ) QGA32225( ) QJA32225( )
PANELBOARDS
See [4] below.
9
H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards and Switchboards
Table 9.122: H-frame 150 A Thermal-Magnetic UL Current-Limiting[6] Circuit
Breakers (600 Vac, 250 Vdc) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit[7] Suitable for Reverse
Connection[7]
(PowerPact HD and HG 2–pole circuit breakers utilize 3" of I-Line mounting space,
HJ and HL 2–pole circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space, all 3–pole
H and J-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line mounting space.)
Current Fixed AC Magnetic
Trip Terminal
Rating @ Cat. No.[8] Wire Range
40o C Hold Trip
H-frame, 150A 2P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc[9]
15 A 350 A 750 A H( )A26015( )
20 A 350 A 750 A H( )A26020( )
25 A 350 A 750 A H( )A26025( )
30 A 350 A 750 A H( )A26030( )
35 A 400 A 850 A H( )A26035( )
40 A 400 A 850 A H( )A26040( )
45 A 400 A 850 A H( )A26045( )
50 A 400 A 850 A H( )A26050( ) AL150HD
14–3/0 AWG
60 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26060( ) Al or Cu
70 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26070( )
80 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26080( )
90 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A26090( )
100 A 800 A 1700 A H( )A26100( )
110 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A26110( )
125 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A26125( )
150 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A26150( )
H-frame 150A 3P, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz, 250 Vdc
15 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36015
20 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36020
25 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36025
30 A 350 A 750 A H( )A36030
35 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36035
40 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36040
45 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36045
50 A 400 A 850 A H( )A36050 AL150HD
14–3/0 AWG
60 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36060 Al or Cu
70 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36070
80 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36080
90 A 800 A 1450 A H( )A36090
100 A 800 A 1700 A H( )A36100
110 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A36110
125 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A36125
150 A 900 A 1700 A H( )A36150
[4] Replacement lugs are not available on QB, QD, QG, or QJ circuit breakers. Lugs for QB, QD, QG, or QJ circuit breakers accept one #4 AWG–300 kcmil.
No accessories are available for PowerPact Q Frame breakers.
[5] 3-pole QJ circuit breakers are rated at 208Y/120 Vac only.
[6] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[7] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
[8] To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (D, G, J, L).
[9] 2 pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection number as a suffix see Table 9.128, page 9-53.
9-51
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers H- and J-frame for I-Line™ Panelboards
and Switchboards
Class 612 schneider-electric.us
Table 9.124: H-frame 150 A and J-frame 250 A Electronic Trip UL Current-Limiting
[10]Circuit Breakers
(600 Vac) With Factory Sealed Trip Unit[11] Suitable for Reverse Connection [14]
(PowerPact Electronic Trip H- and J-frame circuit breakers utilize 4.5" of I-Line
mounting space.)
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor
Rating Cat. No.[12] Terminal
Type Function Trip Unit
600 Vac, 50/60 Hz, 3P
60 A H( )A36060U31X
100 A H( )A36100U31X AL150HD[16]
LI 3.2[15]
150 A H( )A36150U31X
Micrologic 250 A J( )A36250U31X AL250JD[17]
Standard 60 A H( )A36060U33X
100 A H( )A36100U33X AL150HD[16]
LSI 3.2S[15]
150 A H( )A36150U33X
250 A J( )A36250U33X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U43X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U43X AL150HD[16]
LSI 5.2A
Ammeter 150 A H( )A36150U43X
250 A J( )A36250U43X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U53X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U53X AL150HD[16]
Energy LSI 5.2E
150 A H( )A36150U53X
250 A J( )A36250U53X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U44X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U44X AL150HD[16]
Ammeter LSIG 6.2A
150 A H( )A36150U44X
250 A J( )A36250U44X AL250JD[17]
60 A H( )A36060U54X
Micrologic 100 A H( )A36100U54X AL150HD[16]
Energy LSIG 6.2E
150 A H( )A36150U54X
250 A J( )A36250U54X AL250JD[17]
[10] Circuit breakers with J, L, and R interrupting ratings are UL certified as current limiting.
[11] See Supplemental Digest Section 3 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
[12] To complete catalog number, replace the blank with the appropriate rating (D, G, J, L).
[13] 2 pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding the required phase connection number as a suffix see Table 9.128, page 9-53.
[14] For applications requiring communications, see page 7-65.
[15] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[16] AL150HD wire range is 14–3/0 AWG Al or Cu.
[17] AL250JD wire range is 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al or Cu. For smaller wire range (4–4/0 AWG Al or Cu), replace the lug’s wire binding screws with the larger binding screws provided.
9-52
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
K-, PowerPact H-, J-, L-frame for I-Line™ Circuit Breakers
Panelboards & Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 825, 0612
PANELBOARDS
L-frame Mission Critical Circuit Breaker
Table 9.127: L-frame 600 A Electronic Trip Mission Critical Circuit Breakers (480/277 Vac) With Factory Sealed Trip Units Suitable for
Reverse Connection[20]
Electronic Trip Trip Continuous D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Trip Unit Terminal
Unit Type Function Current Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
250 LDA34250WU31X LGA34250WU31X LJA34250WU31X LLA34250WU31X AL400L61K3[21]
Standard LI 3.3 W 400 LDA34400WU31X LGA34400WU31X LJA34400WU31X LLA34400WU31X
AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU31X LGA34600WU31X LJA34600WU31X LLA34600WU31X
250 LDA34250WU33X LGA34250WU33X LJA34250WU33X LLA34250WU33X AL400L61K3[21]
Standard LSI 3.3S-W 400 LDA34400WU33X LGA34400WU33X LJA34400WU33X LLA34400WU33X
AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU33X LGA34600WU33X LJA34600WU33X LLA34600WU33X
400 LDA34400WU43X LGA34400WU43X LJA34400WU43X LLA34400WU43X
High Perf. Ammeter LSI 5.3A-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU43X LGA34600WU43X LJA34600WU43X LLA34600WU43X
400 LDA34400WU53X LGA34400WU53X LJA34400WU53X LLA34400WU53X
High Perf. Energy LSI 5.3E-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU53X LGA34600WU53X LJA34600WU53X LLA34600WU53X
9
400 LDA34400WU44X LGA34400WU44X LJA34400WU44X LLA34400WU44X
High Perf. Ammeter LSIG 6.3A-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU44X LGA34600WU44X LJA34600WU44X LLA34600WU44X
400 LDA34400WU54X LGA34400WU54X LJA34400WU54X LLA34400WU54X
High Perf. Energy LSIG 6.3E-W AL600LF52K3[22]
600 LDA34600WU54X LGA34600WU54X LJA34600WU54X LLA34600WU54X
Table 9.128: PowerPact™ H-, J-, and L-frame Automatic Molded Case Switches, 600 Vac
G Withstand L Withstand R Withstand
Circuit Ampere
Poles Trip Terminal Wire Range
Breaker Rating Cat. No. Cat. No. Trip Point Cat. No. Trip Point
Point
150 A HGA26000S15( ) 2250 A HLA26000S15 2250 A — — — —
2[23] 175 A JGA26000S17( ) 3125 A JLA26000S17 3125 A — — — —
H-frame 250 A JGA26000S25( ) 3125 A JLA26000S25 3125 A — — — —
J-frame 150 A HGA36000S15 2250 A HLA36000S15 2250 A HRA36000S15 2250 A AL150HD 14 AWG–3/0 AWG Al/Cu
3 175 A JGA36000S17 3125 A JLA36000S17 3125 A JRA36000S17 3125 A AL175JD 4–4/0 AWG Al/Cu
250 A JGA36000S25 3125 A JLA36000S25 3125 A JRA36000S25 3125 A AL250JD 3/0 AWG–350 kcmil Al/Cu
400 A LGA36000S40X 4800 A LLA36000S40X 4800 A LRA36000S40X 4800 A AL150HD AL600LS52K3
L-frame 3 (2) 2/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al/Cu
600 A LGA36000S60X 6600A LLA36000S60X 6600 A LRA36000S60X 6600 A AL250JD
Table 9.130: Interrupt Ratings (kA) Table 9.131: Phase Options—Example HDA26150( )
D G J L Phase Option Phase 2-pole 3-pole
240 V 25 65 100 125 Number Connection
480 V 18 35 65 100 1 AB HDA261501 —
2 AC HDA261502 —
3 BA HDA261503 —
4 BC HDA261504 —
5 CA HDA261505 —
6 CB HDA261506 —
Standard ABC — JDA34250WU31X
6 CBA — JDA34250WU31X6
LA Circuit Breakers
Table 9.132: L-frame—400 A, Thermal-magnetic (600 Vac)
AC Magnetic Standard Interrupting Terminal
Ampere Trip Settings
Rating Wire
Low High Catalog Number Range
2-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc [24]
125 A 625 1250 LA26125( )
150 A 750 1500 LA26150( )
175 A 875 1750 LA26175( )
200 A 1000 2000 LA26200( ) AL400LA
225 A 1125 2250 LA26225( ) one #1 AWG–600 kcmil or
two #1 AWG–250 kcmil
250 A 1250 2500 LA26250( ) AL or Cu
300 A 1500 3000 LA26300( )
350 A 1750 3500 LA26350( )
400 A 2000 4000 LA26400( )
3-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
125 A 625 1250 LA36125
150 A 750 1500 LA36150
FI36100 175 A 875 1750 LA36175
2- and 3-pole 200 A 1000 2000 LA36200 AL400LA
225 A 1125 2250 LA36225 one #1 AWG–600 kcmil or
4.5 in (114 mm) two #1 AWG–250 kcmil
250 A 1250 2500 LA36250 AL or Cu
Mounting Height 300 A 1500 3000 LA36300
350 A 1750 3500 LA36350
400 A 2000 4000 LA36400
L-frame acccessories starting on Supplemental Digest Section 3.
L-frame dimensions Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions, page 7-77.
L-frame optional lugs Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.
[24] 2-pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding required phase connection letters as suffix to catalog number. See page 9-47.
9-54
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
L- and PowerPact M-frame for I-Line™ Circuit Breakers
Panelboards and Switchboards
schneider-electric.us Class 612, 661
PANELBOARDS
250 A L( )A36250U33X AL400L61K3[28]
Micrologic 3.3S[27]
LSI 400 A L( )A36400U33X
Standard
600 A L( )A36600U33X
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U43X
LSI 5.3A L( )A36600U43X
Ammeter 600 A
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U53X
Energy LSI 5.3E L( )A36600U53X AL600LF52K3[29]
600 A
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U44X
LSIG 6.3A L( )A36600U44X
Ammeter 600 A
Micrologic 400 A L( )A36400U54X
Energy LSIG 6.3E L( )A36600U54X
600 A
9
600 V [31] 18 25 50
Table 9.136: PowerPact M-frame: with ET1.0 Factory – sealed trip unit (not field adjustable)—800 A [32]
(PowerPact M-frame circuit breakers utilize 9" of the available I-Line bussing.)
Adjustable Instantaneous
Ampere G Interrupting J Interrupting Terminal
Trip Range [33]
Rating Wire Range
Low High Catalog Number [34] Catalog Number [34]
300 A 600 3000 MGA26300( ) MJA26300( )
350 A 700 3500 MGA26350( ) MJA26350( )
400 A 800 4000 MGA26400( ) MJA26400( )
450 A 900 4500 MGA26450( ) MJA26450( ) 3–3/0
2-pole, 600 Vac, through 500 kcmil
50/60 Hz 500 A 1000 5000 MGA26500( ) MJA26500( ) Al or Cu
600 A 1200 6000 MGA26600( ) MJA26600( )
700 A 1400 7000 MGA26700( ) MJA26700( )
800 A 1600 8000 MGA26800( ) MJA26800( )
300 A 600 3000 MGA36300 MJA36300
350 A 700 3500 MGA36350 MJA36350
400 A 800 4000 MGA36400 MJA36400
450 A 900 4500 MGA36450 MJA36450 3–3/0
3-pole, 600 Vac,
50/60 Hz through 500 kcmil
500 A 1000 5000 MGA36500 MJA36500 Al or Cu
600 A 1200 6000 MGA36600 MJA36600
700 A 1400 7000 MGA36700 MJA36700
800 A 1600 8000 MGA36800 MJA36800
L-frame accessories, see Supplemental Digest Section 3. M-frame accessories, page 7-54.
L-frame dimensions, page 7-77. M-frame dimensions, page 7-77.
L-frame optional lugs, page 7-59. M-frame optional lugs, page 7-59.
[25] See Supplemental Digest page 3-4 for circuit breakers with field-interchangeable trip units.
[26] For 100% rated circuit breakers (250 A and 400 A only), add a “C” in the 9th character place (for example, LRA36400CU31X).
[27] 3P circuit breakers with this trip unit can be used for 2P applications.
[28] AL400L61K3 terminal wire ranges are (1) 2 AWG–600 kcmil Cu or (1) 2 AWG–500 kcmil Al.
[29] AL600LFS52K3 terminal wire range is (2) 3/0 –500 kcmil.
[30] L interrupting rating is not available in M-frame.
[31] 600 V interrupt ratings not available for D-frame.
[32] The ET 1.0 trip unit cannot be field replaced, nor does it allow adjustment of the long-time trip point setting. It is considered an electronic equivalent of a thermal-magnet circuit breaker.
[33] UL magnetic trip setting tolerances are ±10% from the nominal values shown.
[34] Fill in parentheses with the following phase connection options: (2) for AC and (5) for CA.
[35] The withstand rating is the fault current, at rated voltage, that the molded case switch will withstand without damage when protected by a circuit breaker with an equal ampere rating.
[36] Fill in parentheses with the following phase connection options: (2) for AC or (5) for CA.
9-55
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Circuit Breakers PowerPact P- and R-frame for I-Line™
Panelboards and Switchboards
Class 612 / Refer to Catalog 0612CT0101 schneider-electric.us
Switchboards
Table 9.139: PowerPact P-frame 1200 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic Trip Unit
(PowerPact P-frame circuit breakers utilize 9" of the available I-Line bussing.)
Electronic Trip Unit Sensor Terminal
Rating Cat. No.[37][38][39][40] Wire Range
Type Function Code
600 A P( )A36060 (3) 3/0 AWG–500 kcmil Al or Cu
Basic Electronic
Trip Unit Fixed long-time, 800 A P( )A36080 AL800M23K
Adjustable ET1.0I
PANELBOARDS
[37] To complete the catalog number, replace the blank ( ) with the appropriate interrupt rating (G, J, K, or L).
[38] For 100% rated circuit breakers add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the catalog number for a 100% standard-type trip unit with LI trip functions at 250 A would be
PGA36025CU31A.
[39] The L interrupt rating is supplied in 480 V only. Change the 5th character (voltage rating) from a 6 (600 V) to a 4 (480 V); for example, PLA34025U31A.
[40] See Table 9.138 PowerPact P- and R-frame Interrupt Ratings, page 9-55 for interrupt ratings.
9-56
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
600 Vac, 250 Vdc I-Line™ Factory Assembled Panelboards
Class 2110 / Refer To Catalog 2110CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Table 9.140: PowerPact R-frame 1200 A (600 Vac, 50/60 Hz) 3P Circuit Breaker with Electronic Trip Unit
Electronic Trip Unit Terminal
Sensor Wire
Rating Cat. No. [41][42][43][44]
Type Function Code Range
Basic Electronic Trip Unit Fixed Long-Time, Adjustable R( )A36120
(Not Interchangeable) Instantaneous ET1.01 1200 A
1000 A R( )A36100CU31A
Micrologic LI 3.0
1200 A R( )A36120CU31A
Interchangeable Standard
Trip Unit 1000 A R( )A36100CU33A
LSI 5.0
1200 A R( )A36120CU33A
1000 A R( )A36100CU41A
LI 3.0A
1200 A R( )A36120CU41A
Micrologic 1000 A R( )A36100CU43A
Interchangeable Ammeter LSI 5.0A
Trip Unit 1200 A R( )A36120CU43A AL1200R53K
R( )A36100CU44A (4) 3/0-600 kcmil
1000 A
PANELBOARDS
LSI 6.0A Al or Cu
1200 A R( )A36120CU44A
1000 A R( )A36100CU63AE1
Micrologic LSI 5.0P
1200 A R( )A36120CU63AE1
Interchangeable Power
Trip Unit 1000 A R( )A36100CU64AE1
LSIG 6.0P
1200 A R( )A36120CU64AE1
1000 A R( )A36100CU73AE1
Micrologic LSI 5.0H
1200 A R( )A36120CU73AE1
Interchangeable Harmonic
Trip Unit 1000 A R( )A36100CU74AE1
LSIG 6.0H
1200 A R( )A36120CU74AE1
P- and R-frame accessories, Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.
P- and R-frame dimensions, Molded Case Circuit Breaker Dimensions, page 7-77.
P- and R-frame trip unit options, Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units, page 7-65.
9
P- and R-frame optional lugs, Mechanical Lugs, page 7-59.
P- and R-frame alternate rating plugs, Micrologic™ Electronic Trip Units, page 7-65.
I-Line™ Factory Assembled Panelboards
Table 9.141: I-Line 200% Rated Neutral—Standard Terminal Configuration
Branch Space Neutral Terminals Quantity and Size Type 1 Enclosure
Panel
Type Ampacity Type H W D
In. mm Main Branch
In. mm In. mm In. mm
600 A MLO 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil 91 2311 32 813 8.25 210
600 A (MG, MJ) M/B 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil (35) 350 kcmil, 91 2311 32 813 9.50 241
HCM (9)#14-1/0, (17)#14-#4
800 A MLO 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil 91 2311 32 813 8.25 210
800 A (MG, MJ) M/B 72 1829 (8) 750 kcmil 91 2311 32 813 9.50 241
(8) 600 kcmil, (15) 350 kcmil
HCR-U[1] 1200A M/B, MLO 108 2743 (8) 750 kcmil (9) #14-1/0, (17)#14-#4 86 2184 44 1118 9.50 241
(35) 350 kcmil,
600A M/B, MLO 63 1600 (8) 750 kcmil (9)#14-1/0, (17)#14-#4 68 1727 42 1067 9.50 241
HCP
(35) 350 kcmil,
800A M/B, MLO 99 2515 (8) 750 kcmil 86 2184 42 1067 9.50 241
(9)#14-1/0, (17)#14-#4
HCP-SU (8) 750 kcmil, (21) 350 kcmil,
800A M/B, MLO 54 1371 (8) 750 kcmil 86 2184 26 660 9.5 241
[2] (9) #14-1/0, (17) #14-#4
[41] To complete the catalog number, replace the blank ( ) with the appropriate interrupt rating (G, J, K, or L).
[42] For 100% rated circuit breakers add a “C” in the 9th character place. For example, the catalog number for a 100% standard-type trip unit with LI trip functions at 250 A would be
PGA36025CU31A.
[43] The L interrupt rating is supplied in 480 V only. Change the 5th character (voltage rating) from a 6 (600 V) to a 4 (480 V); for example, PLA34025U31A.
[44] See Table 9.138 PowerPact P- and R-frame Interrupt Ratings, page 9-55 for interrupt ratings.
[1] 6 in. enclosure extension is required for HCRU I-Line panelboard.
[2] 9 in. enclosure extension is required for HCP-SU I-Line panelboard.
9-57
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QMB Fusible Branch Switches 600 Vac, 250 Vdc
Class 4620 / Refer to Catalog 4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us
30 A-30 A QMB221TW 2 — — — — — — — — 5
HRK30 QMB300EK (1 or 2) 1.5 3 3 7.5
30 A-Blank QMB221HW [3] — — — — — — — — 5
4.5
60 A-60 A QMB222TW — — — — — — — — 10
QMB36R QMB300EK (1 or 2) 3 7.5 10 15
60 A-Blank QMB222HW [3] — — — — — — — — 10
100 A-100 A QMB223TW — — — — — — — —
6 1 QMB100R QMB610EK (1 or 2) 7.5 15 15 30 20
100 A-Blank QMB223HW [3] — — — — — — — —
200 A 9 QMB224W HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 25 15 60 — — — — — — — — 40
15 QMB225W QMB4060R — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
PANELBOARDS
400 A
9 QMB225WT3 [4] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
600 A Use 3-pole devices for 2-pole application. — — — — — — — — — — — — —
3-pole, 240 Vac
30 A-30 A QMB321TW 2 — — — — — — — — — — —
HRK30 3 7.5
30 A-Blank QMB321HW [3] — — — — — — — — — — —
4.5 QMB300EK (1 or 2)
60 A-60 A QMB322TW — — — — — — — — — — —
QMB36R 7.5 15
60 A-Blank QMB322HW [3] — — — — — — — — — — —
100 A-100 A QMB323TW 1 — — — — — — — — — — —
6 QMB100R QMB610EK (1 or 2) 15 30
100 A-Blank QMB323HW [3] — — — — — — — — — — —
200 A 9 QMB324W HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 25 — 60 — — — — — — — — —
15 QMB325W QMB4060R — — — 125 — — — — — — — — —
400 A QMB325WT3 50
9 [4] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
QMB326W 1 QMB4060R — — — 150 — — — — — — — — —
600 A QMB326WT3
15 [4] — — — — 75 — — — — — — — — — — —
800 A QMB327WT3 [4] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
2-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc[5]
30 A-30 A QMB261TW — — — —
QMB36R QMB300EK (1 or 2) 1.5 3 3 5 7.5 15 3 10 5
30 A-Blank QMB261HW [3] — — — —
4.5 1
60 A-60 A QMB262TW — — — —
QMB60R 3 10 5 15 20 30 10 25 10
60 A-Blank QMB262HW [3] — — — —
QMB610EK (1 or 2)
100 A-100 A QMB263TW 2 — — 30 60 15 — 40 —
6 HRK1020 7.5 15 10 25 20
100 A-Blank QMB263HW [3] — — — — — — — —
1
200 A 9 QMB264W HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) 15 — — — 25 50 50 125 30 — 50 — 40
400 A Use 3-pole devices
for 2-pole application. — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
600 A
3-pole, 600 Vac, 250 Vdc[5]
QMB361TW 1 QMB36R — 3 — 7.5 — 5 — 15 — 7.5 — 20 —
30 A-30 A
4.5 QMJ361T — — QMB300EK (1 or 2) — — — — — — — — — — — 20 5
30 A-Blank QMB361HW [3] QMB36R — 3 — 7.5 — 5 — 15 — 7.5 — 20 —
1
QMB362TW QMB60R — 7.5 — 15 — 15 — 30 — 15 — 50 —
60 A-60 A
QMJ362T — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 10
60 A-Blank 6 QMB362HW [3] QMB60R — 7.5 — 15 — 15 — 30 — 15 — 50 —
1 QMB60R and
60 A-30 A QMB362T21W QMB36R — — — — — — — — — — — — —
7.5 QMB363TW 2 HRK1020 QMB610EK (1 or 2) — 15 — 30 — 25 — 60 — 30 — 75 —
100 A-100 A
6 QMJ363T — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 20
7.5 QMB363HW [3] 1 HRK1020 — 15 — 30 — 25 — 60 — 30 — 75 —
100 A-Blank
6 QMJ363H [3] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 20
100 A-30 A QMB363T31W QMB36R
7.5 1 — — — — — — — — — — — — —
100 A-60 A QMB363T32W QMB60R
200 A 9 QMB364W 1 HRK1020 QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 25 — 60 — 50 — 125 — 60 — 150 —
200 A-200 A QMJ364T — — 25 — 60 — 50 — 125 — 60 — 150 40
7.5 — QMB610EK (1 or 2)
200 A-Blank QMJ364H [3] — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
400 A[6] 15 QMB365W 1 QMB4060R — — — — — — 100 — 250 — 125 — 350 50
400 A QMJ365 — QMB200EK (1 or 2) — 50 — 125 — 100 — 250 — 125 — 350 50
9 —
400 A[6] QMB365WT6 [7] — — — — — — — — — — — — — — —
600 A [6] QMB366W 1 QMB4060R — — — — — — 150 — 400 — 250 — 500 —
600 A 15 QMJ366 — — — 75 — 150 — — — — — — — — —
—
800 A QMB367W — — — — — — — 150 — 400 — 250 — 500 —
NOTE: See the Supplemental Digest for merchandised motor starter units, QMB RTI panelboards, and replacement switches for Series 1–4
and D2 QMB panelboards.
NOTE: For series E1 and E2, QMJ switches may be used in 400 A–1200 A interiors in a NEMA 1 without door only. QMJ switches cannot be
used in series E1 and E2, 225 A panelboards. QMJ switches cannot be used in NEMA 1 with door or any NEMA 3R/12 enclosure.
PANELBOARDS
Enclsoure Modifications
Hinged Trim
Weatherproof - NEMA 3R
Lugs
Mechanical Lugs - Standard
Copper Mechanical Lugs
Copper Compression Lugs
Aluminum Compression Lugs
VCEL Lugs
UL Listed Short Circuit Ratings for QMB Starters
Fusible switch-600V Max.
Starter Size (with Class R or J Fuses) RMS Sym. Thermal-Magnetic Bircuit Breaker 600V Max.
Amps Rms Sym. Amps
0 100,000 5,000
100,000 5,000
9
1
2 100,000 5,000
3 100,000 5,000
9-59
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QMB Fusible Branch Switches Common Features
Class 4620 / Refer to Catalog 4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us
[8] NF panels require 18 in. of additional box height regardless of contactor ampacity or manufacturer.
[9] When greater than 125 A lugs are required on the split section of the bus, contact your local Schneider Electric representative or distributor for the box height.
[10] For I-Line panelboards, dimension includes height of “SL” sub-feed lug kit from Digest, plus 3 in. from available branch mounting space.
9-60
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Modifications For Factory Assembled Modifications for Factory Assembled
Panelboards Panelboards
schneider-electric.us Class 1640, 1670, 2110, 4620, 6650 / Refer to 2110CT9701, 1640CT0701, 1640CT0801, 4620CT9601
PANELBOARDS
• Customer equipment space (NQ and NF) [1]
• Increased box depth [1]
• Increased gutters–top, bottom, and sides [1]
• Non-standard paint [1]
• Welded base channel [1]
• Type 1 gasketed [1]
• Type 2 drip hood [1]
• Type 3R/4/4X/5/12 stainless steel enclosure [1]
• Type 4X fiberglass enclosure [1]
• Stainless steel trim front [1]
• Padlockable hasp [1]
• Special locks (Corbin, Yale, Best) [1]
9
• Equal height boxes [1]
• Common trim to cover two equal height boxes [1]
• Panelboard skirt—hides conduits feeding a panelboard [1]
• Panelboard wireway—for terminating conduit in wireway endwall [1]
• Keyed mechanical interlocking of two or more circuit breakers (I-Line and QMB) [1]
• Motor operators (I-Line only)
• Panelboard interiors and special fronts to fit existing boxes
• A standard panelboard box has one blank endwall and one with knockouts. Blank
endwalls or knockouts in both endwalls are also available [1]
Table 9.149: NF Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.150: NF Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Circuit
Panel Type Ampere Rating Lug Wire Range Breaker
125 A one #6–2/0 Al or Cu Circuit Breaker
Panel Type Ampere Rating Type Lug Wire Range [1]
250 A one #6–350 kcmil Al or Cu
NF 400 A one #1/0–750 kcmil or two #1/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu 125 A ED, EG, EJ one #14–#2/0 Al or Cu
600 A two #1/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu 150 A HD, HG, HJ, HL one #14–#3/0 Al or Cu
800 A three #4/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu JD, JG, JJ, JL one #3/0–350 kcmil Al or Cu [1]
250 A
NF DJ one #2–600 Cu or #2–500 Al
LA, LH one #1–600 kcmil or two #1–250
400 A kcmil Al or Cu
600 A LD, LG, LJ, LL, two #4/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
LR
[1] The lug range shown is for the highest amperage of the circuit breaker frame shown in the table.
9-62
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Terminal Data I-Line™ and QMB
Class 2110, 4620 / Refer to Catalog 2110CT9701,4620CT9601
schneider-electric.us
Terminal Data
Table 9.151: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.152: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Circuit Breaker
Wire Range Am-
Panel Ampere Panel pere Circuit Breaker Wire Range
Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per
Type Rating Type Rat- Type
Table 312-6 [1] NEC Table 312-6 [1]
100 A — — ing
225 A one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu 100 A FA, FH, FI one #14-1/0 Al or Cu one #14-1/0 Al or Cu
one #2–600 kcmil Al or Cu 150 A HD, HG, HJ, HL one #14-3/0 Al or Cu one #14-3/0 Al or Cu
400 A two #2–600 kcmil Al or Cu two #2–500 kcmil Al or Cu
I-Line one #4-300 kcmil Al or
225 A KI one #4-300 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A two #2–600 kcmil Al or Cu two #2–500 kcmil Al or Cu Cu
800 A (4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu JD, JG, JJ, JL one #1/0-#4/0 Al or Cu one #1/0-300 kcmil Al or
(4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu (4) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu Cu
1200 A 250 A
LX, LXI, LE two #1-350 kcmil Al or
Cu two #1-350 kcmil Al or Cu
PANELBOARDS
I-Line one #1-600 or two #1-
400 A LA, LH one #1-600 kcmil Al or Cu
250 kcmil Al or Cu
LC, LI, LX, LXI, two 4/0-500kcmil Al or
600 A two 4/0-500kcmil Al or Cu
LE Cu
MG, MJ, PG, three 3/0-500 kcmil Al three 3/0-500 kcmil Al or
800 A PJ, PL or Cu Cu
PG, PJ, PL, four 3/0-500 kcmil Al or four 3/0-500 kcmil Al or
1200 RGC, RJC,
A RLC Cu Cu
Table 9.153: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Lugs Table 9.154: Standard Mechanical Lugs—Main Switch
Mains Wire Range Mains Wire Range
Panel Panel
Ampere Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC Type Ampere Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC
Type Rating Table 312-6 [1]
Rating Table 312-6 [1]
225 A one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu 200 A #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu
one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu 400 A 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu and, QMB
9
400 A and, 600 A 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
one 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu one 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
800 A 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
600 A two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu
QMB (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu or
800 A (4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
two 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
(4) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu or
1200 A (4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
(4) 3/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
1600 A VCEL compression lugs Standard.
Table 9.155: Standard Mechanical Lugs—QMB Branch Switch Units Table 9.156: Standard Mechanical Lugs—QMJ Branch Switch
Panel
Switch Wire Range Units [2]
Ampere Lug Wire Range [1] Wire Bending Space per NEC
Type Switch Wire Range
Rating Table 312-6 [1] Panel Ampere Lug Wire Range [1]
Type Wire Bending Space per NEC
30 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu Rating Table 312-6 [1]
60 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu 30 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu
100 A one #14–1/0 Al or Cu one #14–1/0 Al or Cu 60 A one #14–#2 Al or Cu one #14–#2 Al or Cu
QMB 200 A one #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu one #4–300 kcmil Al or Cu 100 A one #14–1/0 Al or Cu one #14–1/0 Al or Cu
400 A two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or
600 A two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu two 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu QMJ 200 A Cu one #6–300 kcmil Al or Cu
800 A (3) 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu (3) 3/0–500 kcmil Al or Cu one 1/0–750 kcmil Al or
400 A one 1/0–750 kcmil Al or Cu
Cu
two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or
600 A two 3/0–600 kcmil Al or Cu
Cu
NQ Merchandised Accessories
Table 9.157: NQ SurgeLogic SurgeLoc Plug-on SPD [1][2]
Voltage Part Number Poles Occupied
80 kA SSP01BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP01BIA10PBQ1
120 kA SSP01BIA12PBQ1
120 / 240 V 12
160 kA SSP01BIA16PBQ1
9
200 kA SSP01BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP01BIA24PBQ1
80 kA SSP02BIA08PBQ1
100 kA SSP02BIA10PBQ1
120 kA SSP02BIA12PBQ1
208 Y / 120 V 12
160 kA SSP02BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP02BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP02BIA24PBQ1
80 kA SSP03BIA08PBQ1
PANELBOARDS
100 kA SSP03BIA10PBQ1
120 kA SSP03BIA12PBQ1
240 / 120 HLD 12
160 kA SSP03BIA16PBQ1
200 kA SSP03BIA20PBQ1
240 kA SSP03BIA24PBQ1
[1] When selecting a panelboard with SurgeLoc SPD, an additional 12 circuit positions (6 adjacent mounting spaces per side) are occupied. For example, if the desired number of circuits is 30,
refer to page 9-15 and page 9-16 to select the NQ442L2/NQ442L2C interior and corresponding Box and Trim.
[2] SPD is only available up to 72 desired circuit counts.
9-64
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 10
Power Solutions Integrated Equipment
Power Solutions Integrated Equipment 10-2
10 EQUIPMENT
IP C
IP C2
11/10/2017
Power Solutions Integrated Equipment NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 2200 / Refer to Documents 2230DB0601, and 2735CT0001
schneider-electric.us
For more complex applications, the Integrated Power Center (IPC) allows for the
integration of a variety of components, including electrical distribution equipment, HVAC
controls, lighting controls, power quality and power conditioning products, SPDs, building
management systems and power metering/monitoring solutions. As with all Power
Solutions Integrated Equipment products, the IPC is designed to meet applicable codes
EQUIPMENT
10-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Accessories Modular Panelboard System and Integrated
Power Center
schneider-electric.us Class 2210, 2220 / Refer to Document 2735CT0001
Integrated Power Center 2 Transformer Combo
Ideally suited for projects having both 480Y/277V and 208Y/120V requirements.
Available as a stand-alone solution or can be incorporated into an MPS, IPC or IPC2
lineup. The standard 42" wide x 24" deep footprint will decrease space requirements by
40% or more. A typical IPC2 Transformer Combo includes two panels in the upper cells
and a transformer in the bottom cell. Other upper cell options include contactors,
individually mounted circuit breakers, ATS's, equipment spaces and power metering/
monitoring solutions. The IPC2 Transformer Combo is available as seismically qualified.
Enclosure options include NEMA 1, NEMA 1 with driphood and NEMA 3R. IPC2
Transformer Combo sections are:
• 91.5 in. (2324 mm) high, and
• vary in width and depth depending on the transformer kVA
Additional savings are realized on installation, material costs and material handling, as
shown in the table below.
Table 10.1: IPC2 Transformer Combo—Estimated Savings [1]
Stick-Built Transformer Combo Savings Realized
Estimated Installation
26–32 3–6 23–26
Hours
Associated pipe, wire and Associated pipe, wire and
Materials fittings — fittings
EQUIPMENT
• 2006 Product of the Year Gold Medal Award given by the Consulting/Specifying
Engineer magazine
10
monitoring, and system display meters
Equipment spaces including factory-installed lighting contactors are available in three
configurations:
1. Unwired: Mounted in cell only
2. Line side wired: Line side of each pole is wired to a branch circuit breaker
3. Fully wired: Line side of each pole is wired to a branch circuit breaker, load side of
each pole is wired to a terminal block
Built on a panelboard platform, Modular Panelboard System sections are NEMA 1-rated
and meet the requirements of UL 67. Individual MPS configurations include panel
sections in full-height, stacked or side-by-side arrangements. Individual sections
measure:
• 86 in. (2184 mm) high
Modular Panelboard System • 10–44 in. (254–1118 mm) wide
• 9.5 in. (241 mm) deep
Typical applications for MPS equipment include:
• Restaurants / Food service
• Office buildings / Public buildings
• Warehouses
• Schools / Universities
MPS Interior
• Application:
– 400 A and 600 A available
– 240 V and 480 V versions available
– Three-phase + neutral + ground
10-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NQ Merchandised Accessories Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™)
Class 2230 / Refer to Document 2230DB0601
schneider-electric.us
EQUIPMENT
metering components and providing an integrated solution in one enclosure/lineup
including:
• Panelboards
• PowerLogic™ EM4800 Multi-Circuit Energy Meters and associated CTs
• Surge Suppression
• Factory-installed wiring between components
Submetering IPC width and height dimensions vary depending on the application.
All sections are 10.5 in. (266.7 mm) deep.
Typical applications for Submetering IPC equipment include:
10
• Office towers • Other multi-user environments
• Condominiums • Configurations with 2-PowerLogic EM4800 meters plus Ethernet switch
• Apartment buildings when required based on the number of metered points
• Shopping centers
• Schools/Universities • Casinos
• Office buildings • Hotels
• Data centers • Any project with panels and transformers
• Industrial facilities
10-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Integrated Power Center 2 (IPC2™) NQ Merchandised Accessories
Class 2230 / Refer to Document 2230DB0601
schneider-electric.us
IPC2 Shipping
IPC2 lineups are shipped fully assembled and ready-to-install. Customers may specify
single- or multiple-section shipping splits (some limitations apply). In addition, lineups
may be ordered with or without factory-installed power cables.
Integrated Power Center 2 Transformer Combo
For projects having both 480Y/277 V and 208Y/120 V requirements, the Integrated
Power Center 2 (IPC2) Transformer Combo is the perfect solution. One of the most
popular members of the IPC2 product family, the IPC2 Transformer Combo has been
recognized by the industry multiple times for its innovative design.
As a stand-alone solution, the IPC2 Transformer Combo is appropriate when
panelboards and transformers are installed in close proximity to each other. It provides
the flexibility to enter and/or exit the section from either the top or the bottom. Catalog
numbers have been created for some of the more typical configurations.
All IPC2 sections can be close-coupled to QED switchboard, MPS, and IPC products.
Enclosure options for IPC2 include NEMA 1, NEMA 1 with driphood, and NEMA 3R-
rated, and all meet the requirements of UL 891. These sections are also seismically
qualified to meet IBC and ASCE7 requirements.
10-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 11
Switchboards and Switchgear
Power-Style™ Switchboards 11-2
11
Active, Arc-Resistant Arc Terminator™ Arc Extinguishing System 11-34
Passive, Arc-Resistant Masterclad™ Medium Voltage Switchgear 11-34
Unit S ubs ta tion
Unit Substations 11-35
11/10/2017
Power-Style™ Switchboards QED-2 (UL Listed)
Classes 2741, 2742 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us
Features
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
Additional Information:
See Table 9.99 Circuit Breaker / Sub-feed Lug Kit Mounting Space
Requirement, page 9-42 for circuit breaker mounting height
requirements.
Where Utility compartments are required, contact your local Schneider
Electric representative.
11-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
QED-6 (UL Listed) Power-Style™ Switchboards
Class 2746 / Refer to Catalog 2746CT0101
schneider-electric.us
11
breakers are required; front access to control wires is desired; ease of installation,
maintenance, and upgrade of circuit breaker compartmentalization is required; system
integrity and segregation of circuit breaker compartments from bus and cable
compartments is required; equipment isolation is required.
Benefits/Values of Circuit Breaker Performance
Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers are designed to provide maximum protection and
reliable operation with a long service life. They exceed all UL 489 endurance testing
requirements and are certified to a minimum of 10,000 operations through the 3000 A
frame.
11-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Style™ Switchboards QED-6 (UL Listed)
Class 2746 / Refer to Catalog 2746CT0101
schneider-electric.us
System Coordination
Short-time ratings are high, giving users excellent system coordination and selectivity
with downstream breakers.
High Short-Circuit Current Ratings (SCCR)
Up to 200 k AIR at 240 V, 150 k AIR at 480 V, and 100 k AIR at 600 V, which allows
customers to design systems with high fault current and paralleling schemes.
Arc Flash Limiting (LF) Feeder Breakers
High speed operation of Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers (150 k AIR at 480 V)
helps reduce arc flash incident energy (cal/cm2) on downstream equipment.
Ease of Installation and Maintenance
Thru-the-door construction, an easy to operate drawout mechanism, and front access to
all control wiring make this equipment easy to install, maintain, and upgrade. Load
connections in the cable compartment are easily accessible in the rear of the
switchboard. Remote racking of the Masterpact NW circuit breaker is also available with
the optional remote racking tool, which, if required, is field installable.
Ability to Upgrade
UL Listed, field-installable accessories include: motor operators, shunt trips, under
voltage devices, trip units, and communication modules for trip units. Manually operated
circuit breakers are field convertible to electrical operation.
Open Communication System
The Micrologic trip units in Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers use the Ethernet
TCP/IP or Modbus™ serial protocol. These are widely accepted protocols which allow
QED-6 to be integrated into new or many existing communication systems.
Adaptable
Drawout and bolt-in circuit breakers, front access control wiring, and expandable lineups
are quickly adaptable to changing load and control requirements.
11
Expandable
Masterpact NW and NT circuit breakers have many control termination points, giving the
equipment extensive flexibility and expandability for sophisticated control schemes.
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
11-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
CMM (UL Listed) Power-Style™ Switchboards
Classes 2755, 2756 / Refer to Catalogs 2755CT9501, 2756CT9601
schneider-electric.us
11-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Speed-D™ Switchboards Speed-D SB/SF (UL Listed)
Class 2710 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us
• Single service disconnect, either circuit breaker or fusible rated 400, 600, or 800 A with
either type of distribution interiors, NQ up to 240 Vac, I-Line™ through 480 Vac
• Six service disconnects, group-mounted fusible, QMB/QMJ,
30–400 A; utility compartment—400, 600, and 800 A
• Meter doors can be 15 inches high with one meter socket and test block, or 30 inches
high with two meter sockets and test block
• Meter sockets can be 6-, 8-, 13-, or 15-jaw meter sockets with test block, based on
application
• Accessories include:
– Underground pull sections with and without lug landing
– Loadside wireway
– Bus links for donut-type current transformers
– Double padlock hasp attachments
EUSERC UCT EUSERC UCT – Plug-on distribution panel
Single Main Circuit Breaker with Fusible Multiple Mains
I-Line Distribution Panel – Subfeed circuit breakers
• Full height add-on I-Line distribution section
• Stand-alone I-Line distribution section
Application
11
Metering
C/T compartment with two 15-inch blank meter doors. (Order doors with meter socket
from Table 11.6 Meter Door Selection, page 11-8.) Incoming cable lugs are for top feed
with one twin conductor 2 AWG–600 kcmil lug per phase and neutral, suitable for
aluminum or copper cables. Optional single conductor lug is available. Refer to Table
11.7 Accessories, page 11-8.
Mains
Main circuit breaker types are either LH or MJ. Main fusible device is supplied with Class
T fuses. Multiple main devices use plug-on fusible switches.
Branches
NQ distribution bus is rated 400 A and provides mounting space for QO™/QOB Type
(150 A maximum) circuit breakers. Panel provides space for mounting 42 single pole
circuit breakers. One or two individually mounted 225 A maximum circuit breakers can
be added with bus connectors. (Order subfeed circuit breakers from Table 11.8 Subfeed
Circuit Breakers (Series E4) , page 11-8.)
I-Line™ distribution bus is rated 400, 600, or 800 A and will accept 27 inches of I-Line
circuit breakers on the left side with a maximum frame size of “J” . The right side will
accept either a QO plug-on distribution panel (240 V only) or LA or LH I-Line circuit
breaker.
Enclosure
Totally enclosed front accessible with ANSI 49 gray baked enamel finish. Dimensions are
90 in. (H) x 36 in. (W) x 14 in. (D) for indoor and 90 in. (H) x 36 in. (W) x 24.5 in. (D) for
outdoor enclosures.
11-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Speed-D SB/SF (UL Listed) Speed-D™ Switchboards
Class 2710 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us
11
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 I-Line 100 65 SF346IS SF346IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 600 None 200 200 SF346WS SF346WR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 I-Line 100 65 SF348IS SF348IR
480Y/277
208Y/120
3Ø4W [1] 240/120 800 None 200 200 SF348WS SF348WR
480Y/277
[1] Can be used on 3Ø3W Delta voltage systems (for example, 240 V Delta or 480 V Delta).
[2] QMB/QMJ fusible switches, maximum 400 A, SCCR based on Class J, R, or T fuses. QMB plug-in circuit breaker rating is equal to the lowest rating of the circuit breaker.
[3] Multiple mains—provisions for mounting 30 inches of fusible devices. No more than six main devices permitted per NEC.
11-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Speed-D™ Switchboards Merchandised, Service Selection
Class 2710 / Refer to Catalog 2700CT1101
schneider-electric.us
System Pole
Phase Spaces
Plug-On Distribution Panel—mounts on right side of I-Line interior. Cannot be used with LA/LH branch circuit breaker. 1Ø AC SS212AC
Panel rated 225 A for 240 V applications. For QO™ type plug-on circuit breakers only.
3Ø ABC 12 SS312
3Ø AB SS212AB [7]
Ordering Information
1. Service section: Order service section from Table 11.2 Single Main Circuit Breaker
with Distribution (Series E4), page 11-7 , Table 11.3 Single Main Fusible Disconnect
with Distribution (Series E4), page 11-7 , or Table 11.4 Multiple Mains—Fusible
(Series E4) , page 11-7, as determined by mains rating, voltage, and system.
2. Meter doors: Order meter door from Table 11.6 Meter Door Selection, page 11-8 as
determined by the height and utility metering requirements.
3. Accessories and subfeeds: Order as required from Table 11.7 Accessories, page
11-8 and/or Table 11.8 Subfeed Circuit Breakers (Series E4) , page 11-8.
4. Circuit breakers and switches: Order devices from pages listed below as
determined by voltage, trip rating, AIR, and mounting space.
Multiple Mains and Branch Devices
• QO, QOB, QO-VH, QOB-VH: page 7-11 and page 9-20
• I-Line: page 9-50 to page 9-56
• QMB Switches: page 9-58
[4] 6-jaw meter socket can also be used on 4- and 5-jaw applications.
[5] Door with provisions for mounting meter socket.
[6] All EUSERC Utilities (except Arizona Public Service and Salt River Project) require a lug landing kit SA8LL.
[7] To be used on 120/240 V, 3Ø4W delta applications.
[8] Two pole circuit breaker catalog numbers are completed by adding required phase connection letters as suffix (for example, SASFBH100LAC).
[9] Cannot use subfeed circuit breaker kit with multiple mains service section switchboards.
11-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Metal-Enclosed Drawout Low Voltage Switchgear
Class 6037 / Refer to Catalog 6037CT9901
schneider-electric.us
11
800 NW08H3 4000 NW40H3
NW40L1
NW08L1
NW08L1F
NW16N1
NW16H1 NW50H2
NW16H2
1600 NW16H3 5000 NW50H3
NW50L1
NW16L1
NW16L1F
NW20H1
NW20H2 NW60H2
2000 NW20H3 6000 NW60H3
NW20L1 NW60L1
NW20L1F
NW32H1
NW32H2
3200
NW32H3
NW32L1
Masterpact NT
800 NT08N1
11-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low Voltage Switchgear Metal-Enclosed Drawout
Class 6037 / Refer to Catalog 6037CT9901
schneider-electric.us
11-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MiniBreak™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6042 / Refer to Brochure 6042BR9401
11
25E 5GS025
30E 5GS030
40E 5GS040
50E 5GS050
D 12”
65E 5GS065
80E 5GS080
100E 5GS100
125E 5GS125
150E 5GS150
D 12”
175E 5GS175
200E 5GS200
[1] Contact your Schneider Electric representative for current stock quantities.
[2] Includes one set of three fuses, packed in a single box.
[3] Arresters are line side connected.
11-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed MiniBreak™
Switchgear
Class 6042 / Refer to Brochure 6042BR9401 schneider-electric.us
Ordering Example
Order one (1), 5 kV, 200 A switch with 65E current-limiting fuses. Provide one auxiliary
switch with 1-N.O. and 1-N.C. contact and with provision for installing a “lock open” key
interlock on the switch operating mechanism.
Order: Catalog No.
Switch with enclosure HVMB305200
Auxiliary switch HVMX1
Key interlock adapter HVMK1
Fuses (set of three, from Table 11.12 Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-
Disconnect Type, page 11-11. [4] [5] 5GS065
25.15 25.20
2.20 639 640
56
66.00
1677
47.52
1207
29.00
737
25.20
640
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
25.15
639
2.20 20.75
56 527
23.78
604
18.38
467
47.52
1207
2.70
69
15.35
390
[4] For fuses produced by other manufacturers, contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric distributor.
[5] Current-limiting fuses will increase the integrated short-circuit ratings beyond the non-fusible units. Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric
distributor.
11-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cb™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6065 / Refer to Brochure 6065BR1401
4.6
6.1
13.3
7.4 ±.06
Low volta ge
compa rtme nt
Low volta ge
compa rtme nt
Me dium volta ge
dis conne ctor compa rtme nt
11
Circuit bre a ke r s ta tus
vie wing window
40.4
REF
11-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cb™
Switchgear
Class 6065 / Refer to Brochure 6065BR1401 schneider-electric.us
To To To
Ground Ground Ground
Bus Bus Bus
Options
• Internal ground switch: Has full fault making capability
• Connections to HVL/cc load interrupter switchgear and Motorpact motor controllers
• Service entrance available
• Voltage transformers
• Control power transformer
11
11-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Premset™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT1601
11
11-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 or Product Data 6040PD9601 schneider-electric.us
Front
Optional
low voltage
compartment
Main bus
compartment
Switch with 90.00
enclosure 2286
Mechanism
compartment
Fuse cable
37.25
compartment 946
Fuse/cable
access
panel 37.25
946
W 14.75
375
Right Side
View Plan Front
View View
Table 11.16: HVL/cc Load Interrupter Switches— Full Range 600/1200 A Ratings
Switch (kV)—maximum design 5.5 17.5 17.5 25.8 38
BIL (kV) 60 95 110 125 150
Frequency (Hz) 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60
Withstand (kV) 19 36 36 50 80
Continuous current (A) 600/1200 600/1200 600/1200 600 600
Interrupting current (A) 600/1200 600/1200 600/1200 600 600
Fault close
(kA asymmetrical) 40 40 40 32 32
Momentary current
(kA asymmetrical) 40 40 40 32 32
Short time current
(kA symmetrical) 25 25 25 25 25
Electrical endurance 100/600 A 100/600 A 100/600 A
(number of operations at 80% P.F.) 100 100
26/1200 A 26/1200 A 26/1200 A
Mechanical endurance
(number of operations) 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
11-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cc™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 or Product Data 6040PD9601
Switch Standard Features
• Switch Positions: Closed, open, and internally grounded (optional) (connects switch
contacts to ground)
• Enclosure: Epoxy
• Medium: Sulphur hexalfluoride
• Maintenance: Maintenance free sealed for life
• Pressure:
– 5.8 PSI (≤ 17.5 kV)
– 22 PSI (25.8–38 kV)
• View ports to show switch blade position
To To To
Ground Ground Ground
Bus Bus Bus
Options
• Internal ground switch: Has full fault making capability
• Fuselogic™ system
• Infrared viewing windows
• Class I, Division 2
• Fast auto transfers
•
11
Fuse/cable access panel interlocked with switch
Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear • Front access only
• Animated mechanism mimic bus
• Padlocking provision—open or closed (OTM); open-only (SEM)
• Top or bottom cable entry
• UL/CUL Listed, IEEE C37.20.3
• Live line indicators on all incoming switch bays and outgoing feeder circuits
• Cable lugs included for one cable per phase
• Tin plated copper bus for lineups
Table 11.17: Surge Arresters
System L-L Voltage kV Arrester MCOV-kV
Effectively Impedance Grounded
Nominal Maximum Grounded and Ungrounded
Neutral Circuits Circuits
2.4 2.54 — 2.55
4.16 4.4 2.55 5.1
4.8 5.08 — 5.1
6.9 7.26 — 7.65
12.0 12.7 7.65 12.70
12.47 13.2 7.65 12.70
13.2 13.97 8.4 —
13.8 14.52 8.4 —
11-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 schneider-electric.us
M
M
90.00 450E
2286 M 90.00
2286 450E
11
M
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
37.25
14.75 946 37.25
375 14.75 946
375
5 kV Indoor N1 5 kV Indoor N1
Top Cable In/Bottom Cable Top Cable In/Bottom Cable Out
Out Switch in Position A Switch in Position B
11-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cc™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801
600 A Single Switch Fused
• Provisions only for Square D™ brand current-limiting DIN/E fuses—order separately
• Manual over-toggle mechanism, no grounding switch
• Includes (1) set screw lug for (2) #2–350 kcmil Cu or Al conductor per phase
• Application A = Top entry (incoming—cable or main bus), bottom exit (load—cable or
main bus)
• Application B = Bottom entry (incoming—cable or main bus), top exit (load—cable or
main bus)
Table 11.19: Fused Switch Selection
Catalog kV Fuse Range Application Width
No. Rating in mm
HVLCCA14305D 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20305D 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508
HVLCCA14315D 15 10–200E A 14.75 375
HVLCCA20315D 15 10–200E A 20.00 508
HVLCCB14305D 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20305D 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508
HVLCCB14315D 15 10–200E B 14.75 375
HVLCCB20315D 15 10–200E B 20.00 508
11
HVLCCMBA20A20 A 20.00 508 A 20.00 508
HVLCCMBB14B14 B 14.75 375 B 14.75 375
HVLCCMBB14B20 B 14.75 375 B 20.00 508
HVLCCMBB20B14 B 20.00 508 B 14.75 375
HVLCCMBB20B20 B 20.00 508 B 20.00 508
Ratings
HVL/cc Switch with manually operated type OTM mechanism in cubicle enclosure (does
not include internal ground switch). Ratings are based on an X/R ratio of 1.6.
Factory Modifications
Table 11.24: Factory Modifications
Catalog No. Description
HVLCC-X3 Auxiliary switch 2 N.O.–2 N.C. contact
600 A “Single” HVL/cc Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
600 A, Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-
tin-plated, Dry™, Power-Cast™, and Uni-Cast™ Transformers
copper bus (FLC = 300 A MAXIMUM)
RH—Transformer on right, LH—Transformer on Left
Application A = Top Entry (Incoming Cables)
Application B = Bottom Entry (Incoming Cables)
M
90.00 200E
2286
M
Table 11.26: 600 A “Single” HVL/cc Switch Selection
Catalog kV Ap- Width
Fuse Range plica- RH / LH
No. Rating in mm
tion
14.75 14.75 37.25 HVLCCA14405DGR 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 RH
946
375 375
HVLCCA20405DGR 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCA14405DGL 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCA20405DGL 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCA14415DGR 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCA20415DGR 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 RH
Listed Metal-Enclosed HVLCCA14415DGL 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 LH
Interrupter Switchgear
HVLCCA20415DGL 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14405DGR 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20405DGR 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14405DGL 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20405DGL 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14415DGR 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20415DGR 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14415DGL 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20415DGL 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 LH
NOTE: Switches with transformer connections are painted ANSI 49. Standalone
switches are painted ANSI 61. Transformer connections in HVL/cc switches are
based on standard Square D™ brand transformer connections. If these switches are
used to connect to other manufacturers' transformers, then connections must match
standard Square D™ brand transformer connections. (Cable connections are
furnished with the transformer.)
11-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL/cc™ Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801
General Purpose E-Rated Current-Limiting Fuses: Type DIN/E for HVL/cc
Switches
• Integrated rating for 600 A HVL/cc switches with Square D™ brand DIN/E fuses listed
below is 65 kA rms symmetrical amperes.
• Current-limiting fuses increase the integrated short-circuit current rating because of
their energy-limiting capabilities.
• To increase the short-circuit current rating of the entire lineup of switchgear, current-
limiting fuses must be used in the entrance sections.
Table 11.27: Fuse Selection
Section
Catalog kV Fuse Set of Fuses Fuse Width Required
No. Rating Rating [7] Size
in mm
55DE010 5.5 10E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE015 5.5 15E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE020 5.5 20E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE025 5.5 25E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE030 5.5 30E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE040 5.5 40E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE050 5.5 50E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE065 5.5 65E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE080 5.5 80E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE100 5.5 100E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE125 5.5 125E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE150 5.5 150E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE175 5.5 175E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE200 5.5 200E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE250 5.5 250E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE300 5.5 300E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE350 5.5 350E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE400 5.5 400E 1 Actual 14.75 375
55DE450 5.5 450E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE010 15.5 10E 1 Actual 14.75 375
175DE015 15.5 15E 1 Actual 14.75 375
600 A “Duplex” HVL/cc Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry,
Power-Cast, and Uni-Cast Transformers
• FLC = 300 A maximum
• RH—Transformer on right
• LH—Transformer on left includes mechanical interlock to prevent paralleling of
11
sources
• Application A = top entry (incoming cables)
• Application B = bottom entry (incoming cables)
Table 11.28: 600 A “Duplex” HVL/cc Switch Selection
Width
Catalog kV Appli-
Rating Fuse Range RH / LH
No. cati- in mm
on
HVLCCA14505DGR 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCA20505DGR 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCA14505DGL 4.76 10–450E A 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCA20505DGL 4.76 10–450E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCA14515DGR 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCA20515DGR 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCA14515DGL 15 10–200E A 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCA20515DGL 15 10–200E A 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14505DGR 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20505DGR 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14505DGL 4.76 10–450E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20505DGL 4.76 10–450E B 20.00 508 LH
HVLCCB14515DGR 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 RH
HVLCCB20515DGR 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 RH
HVLCCB14515DGL 15 10–200E B 14.75 375 LH
HVLCCB20515DGL 15 10–200E B 20.00 508 LH
[7] Each set of fuses contains three fuses, so, for example, two sets of fuses yield a total of six fuses.
11-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL/cc™
Switchgear
Class 6045 / Refer to Catalog 6045CT9801 schneider-electric.us
Ordering Information
1. Select switch catalog number based on fused or unfused and cable entry locations
(top or bottom) from Table 11.18 Unfused Switch Selection, page 11-18, or Table
11.19 Fused Switch Selection, page 11-19.
2. Select incoming line auxiliary bay from Table 11.20 Bays for Bottom Entry/Exit
Cables, page 11-19, or Table 11.21 Bays for Top Entry/Exit Cables, page 11-19, if
required.
3. Select main bus from Table 11.22 Bus Kits, page 11-19, if required.
4. Select catalog numbers for factory modifications from Table 11.24 Factory
Modifications, page 11-20, if required.
5. If fused, select DIN/E fuses from Table 11.27 Fuse Selection, page 11-21.
Ordering Example
Order indoor 600 A, 5 kV, HVL/cc switch with bottom incoming and bottom outgoing
cables (1) #2 AWG per phase, (1) set 200E fuses, and (1) set 6 kV surge arresters.
Order: Catalog. No.
Switch w/fuse provisions and bottom exit load cables HVLCCA14305D
600 incoming line auxiliary bay (Application A—bottom entry) HVLCCA14A
Main Bus (Application A—14 in. to Application A–14 in.) HVLCCMBA14A14
6 kV LAs HVLCCDSA6
Set 200E fuses 55DE200
11
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
11-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401
Standard Features
Listed Metal-Enclosed
Interrupter Switchgear • 11 gauge steel enclosure
• Direct drive mechanism
• Permanently attached operating handle
• Visible isolation viewing window
H
• Mechanical interlocked fuse access door
• Provision for padlock and key interlock
• Highly flexible design
• ANSI 61 paint
Options
D W
• Outdoor construction
11
Side view Front view
• Square D™ brand DIN-style current-limiting fuses
Recommended power • Boric acid fuses
cable conduit area • Silver or tin plated copper bus
2.00 38.00 2.00 • 600, 1200, or 2000 A main bus
51 965 51
• Heat shrink insulated bus
34 x 6
864 x 152
• Motor operator
4.00
102
34 x 6
864 x 152 • Shunt trip
D
Conduit
Control
Conduit Area
D1 • Fuselogic™ tripping system
2x4
51 x 102 • Roof bushings
6.36
• Key interlocks
35.74
162
• Surge arresters
1.13
29 908 • Utility metering bays
.875 Mounting Hole
(4 Places for .75 Anchor Bolts) • Duplex switch
• Transformer connections
• Infrared windows for thermal scanning of connections
Fuselogic™
Fuselogic is a protection system that provides the ultimate in medium voltage fuse
protection. This patented system utilizes the Square D™ brand current-limiting fuses
with mechanical sensors that function without any auxiliary power requirements. Several
combinations of Fuselogic functions can be combined to provide simple blown fuse
indication contacts with mechanical lockout to anti-single phasing protection. Anti-single
phasing requires the optional stored energy mechanism (SEM). Fuselogic is available on
both HVL/cc™ and HVL switches.
11-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL
Switchgear
Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401 schneider-electric.us
Table 11.31: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses
Catalog No. kV Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type
HVL305DEG 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1
11
Table 11.32: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for S&C Boric Acid
Non-Disconnect Type Fuses [8]
Catalog No. kV Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type
HVL305BG 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1
HVL305BW 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R
HVL315BG 15 10E–400E NEMA 1
HVL315BW 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R
HVL317BG 17 10E–400E NEMA 1
HVL317BW 17 10E–400E NEMA 3R
[8] Boric acid fuses may increase lead times. Contact the factory for availability.
11-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401
Provisions for Future Expansion
All “single” Digest switches have provisions for future expansion on either side. Order
kits HVMB for top crossover copper 600 A bus and HVLC for line connections to the top
bus. (See Table 11.40 Factory Modifications, page 11-26.)
HVL Switches for Power-Dry II ™, Power-Cast II ™,
and Uni-Cast II ™ Transformer Connections
HVL switches can be configured for close coupling cable connections to listed dry type
transformers for primary main switches of unit substations. These are listed in the tables
below with current-limiting or boric acid fuses. Both single and duplex switch mains are
included in this selection. Transformers are listed on page 14-21 and may not be suitable
for close coupling. For transformer availability and specific configurations, contact your
local Schneider Electric sales office. All connections in this digest are based on standard
Square D™ brand transformer connections. If these switches are used to connect to
other manufacturers’ transformers, then connections must coordinate with
standard Square D™ brand transformer connections. (Cable connections are furnished
with the transformer.)
Table 11.36: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry
II, Power-Cast II, and Uni-Cast II Transformers
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV Fuse Range Enclosure Type
Rating RH / LH
No.
HVL405DEGR 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 RH
HVL405DEGL 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 LH
HVL405DEWRH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R RH
HVL405DEWLH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R LH
HVL415DEGR1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 RH
HVL415DEGR2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 RH
HVL415DEGL1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 LH
HVL415DEGL2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 LH
Table 11.37: 600 A “Duplex” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for Square D™ brand
Current-Limiting, Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry
II, Power-Cast II, and Uni-Cast II Transformers
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV
Rating Fuse Range Enclosure Type RH / LH
No.
HVL505DEGR 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 RH
HVL505DEGL 4.76 10–450E NEMA 1 LH
HVL505DEWRH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R RH
HVL505DEWLH 4.76 10–450E NEMA 3R LH
HVL515DEGR1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 RH
HVL515DEGR2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 RH
HVL515DEGL1 15 10–100E NEMA 1 LH
HVL515DEGL2 15 125–200E NEMA 1 LH
11
HVL515DEWR1H 15 10–100E NEMA 3R RH
HVL515DEWR2H 15 125–200E NEMA 3R RH
HVL515DEWL1H 15 10–100E NEMA 3R LH
HVL515DEWL2H 15 125-200E NEMA 3R LH
Table 11.38: 600 A “Single” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for S&C Boric Acid
Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry II, Power-Cast II,
and Uni-Cast II Transformers [9]
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV
Fuse Range Enclosure Type RH / LH
No. Rating
HVL405BGR 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL405BGL 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL405BWRH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL405BWLH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
HVL415BGR 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL415BGL 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL415BWRH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL415BWLH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
[9] Includes fuse holder only. See Table 11.42 Boric Acid Fuses , page 11-28for fuse refills. Boric acid fuses may increase lead times. Contact the factory for availability.
11-25
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL
Switchgear
Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401 schneider-electric.us
Table 11.39: 600 A “Duplex” Switch with PROVISIONS ONLY for S&C Boric Acid
Non-Disconnect Type Fuses for Cable Connection to Power-Dry II, Power-Cast II,
and Uni-Cast II Transformers [10]
(FLC = 300 A max.) RH—Transformer on Right, LH—Transformer on Left
Catalog kV
Fuse Range Enclosure Type RH / LH
No. Rating
HVL505BGR 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL505BGL 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL505BWRH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL505BWLH 4.76 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
HVL515BGR 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 RH
HVL515BGL 15 10E–400E NEMA 1 LH
HVL515BWRH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R RH
HVL515BWLH 15 10E–400E NEMA 3R LH
NOTE: Switches with transformer connections are painted ANSI 49. Standalone
switches are painted ANSI 61.
Fuse Selection
The rule of thumb method for selecting fuses for transformer protection is 1.33 times the
self-cooled full load current of the transformer or the next higher fuse rating. Selection of
the fuse is the customer’s responsibility and should be based on transformer and system
characteristics.
• Maximum Fuse Size:
Maximum fuse size should be determined by comparing the fuse total clearing curve
to the transformer damage curve. Contact Schneider Electric for transformer overload
and short-circuit withstand capability.
• Minimum Fuse Size:
Minimum fuse size shall carry the transformer magnetizing inrush current of 12 times
full load amperes for 0.1 second.
Table 11.40: Factory Modifications
11
Catalog Description
No.
HVMB Main Bus Kit, 600 A copper
Line side connector kit (main bus) 600 A
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
Standard Features
• Switches for transformer primaries are cable connected only.
• Key interlocks must be ordered and coordinated by customer.
• Standard color is ANSI 61 for standalone units; ANSI 49 for switches connecting to
transformers.
• If switches are purchased to coordinate with Square D™ brand transformers,
composite drawings and shipment coordination will not be available.
• Switches are not designed for any special dimensions for retrofit purposes. For
dimensions other than shown, contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or
your local Schneider Electric distributor.
Ordering Information
1. Select switch catalog number based on fused or unfused and enclosure type.
2. Select catalog numbers for factory modifications from the table above.
3. If fused, select fuse from Table 11.41 DIN/E Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-
Disconnecting Type (Extended Travel Blown Fuse Indicator), page 11-27 or Table
11.42 Boric Acid Fuses, page 11-28.
4. Price switch and fuses separately. Switches are furnished with provisions only for
current-limiting fuse or boric acid fuse.
[10] Includes fuse holder only. See Table 11.42 Boric Acid Fuses , page 11-28for fuse refills. Boric acid fuses may increase lead times. Contact the factory for availability.
[11] Load side connected
11-26
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
HVL Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed
Switchgear
schneider-electric.us Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401
Square D™ Brand DIN/E Fuse Selection Tables—HVL
Table 11.41: DIN/E Current-Limiting Fuses, Non-Disconnecting Type [12][13][14]
(Extended Travel Blown Fuse Indicator)
Fuse Mounting Clip [15]
Continuous Catalog
Current Centers Diameter No. [16][17]
(in) (mm)
5 kV Fuse
10E 17.4 51 55DE010
15E 17.4 51 55DE015
20E 17.4 51 55DE020
25E 17.4 51 55DE025
30E 17.4 51 55DE030
40E 17.4 51 55DE040
50E 17.4 51 55DE050
65E 17.4 51 55DE065
80E 17.4 51 55DE080
100E 17.4 51 55DE100
125E 17.4 76 55DE125
150E 17.4 76 55DE150
175E 17.4 76 55DE175
200E 17.4 76 55DE200
250E 17.4 76 55DE250
300E 17.4 76 55DE300
350E 17.4 76 55DE350
400E 17.4 76 55DE400
450E 17.4 76 55DE450
15 kV Fuse
10E 17.4 51 175DE010
15E 17.4 51 175DE015
20E 17.4 51 175DE020
25E 17.4 51 175DE025
30E 17.4 51 175DE030
40E 17.4 76 175DE040
50E 17.4 76 175DE050
11
[12] Square D™ brand DIN/E fuses are shown in this table. For fuses produced by other manufacturers, contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric
distributor.
[13] Current-limiting fuses will increase the integrated short-circuit ratings beyond the non-fusible units. Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office or your local Schneider Electric
distributor.
[14] Caution—These fuses will not work for the MiniBreak. See Table 11.12 Current-Limiting Fuses, page 11-11 for the appropriate MiniBreak fuses.
[15] All fuses are single barrel arrangement with ferrule diameters per the chart.
[16] Contact your Schneider Electric representative for current stock quantities.
[17] Includes one set of three fuses, packed in a single box.
11-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Enclosed HVL
Switchgear
Class 6040 / Refer to Catalog 6040CT9201 or Brochure 6040BR9401 schneider-electric.us
11
11-29
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear CBGS-0
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 6047BR1401
schneider-electric.us
Nominal voltage
(kV) 15 27 38 15 27 38 15 27 38 15 27 38 15 27 38
Busbar system
rated current (A) 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000
Outgoing rated
current (A) 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 1200/2000 —
Short-time
withstand current 25–31.5 25–31.5 25–31.5 25–31.5 Limited by the
(kA) fuse
11-30
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
DVCAS Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 6000BR1202
schneider-electric.us
O
I D
VIP
11
– disconnector operating mechanism
– operating mechanism of the circuit breaker
– protection relay VIP, Sepam, or Micom
– zero sequence current transformer CSH 30
YO 1 Mitop VIP
• MV cable compartment
– bushings for cable connection
CS H 30
– Three CRc current sensors per phase
• Stainless steel, gas-tight tank
– busbar system
– three position disconnector
– circuit breaker
Module D
11-31
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Gas-Insulated Switchgear DVCAS
Class 6047 / Refer to Brochure 6000BR1202
schneider-electric.us
D+O
DO
Transformer protection + Outgoing line
(I + D + O)
I DO Incoming line + Transformer protection +
Outgoing line
(I + I + D + O)
I I DO Two Incoming lines + Transformer
protection + Outgoing line
Recommended Configurations
11
• Automatic shutters driven by breaker racking mechanism
• Closed door breaker position indication
• Closed door breaker racking mechanism
• Insulated main bus—aluminum or copper
• Standard glass polyester insulators or optional epoxy and porcelain insulators
• Mechanical interlocks
• Disconnect type CPT and VT trucks
• Grounded breaker truck in and between test/disconnected and connected positions
Masterclad 27 kV, Outdoor • Low voltage instrument/control compartment isolated from primary voltage areas
Non Walk-in, Metalclad Switchgear • Compliance to ANSI/IEEE standards C37.20.2 and C37.55 (designed and tested to
comply with or exceed ANSI and IEEE standards)
• ISO 9001 Certification (Designed and manufactured in a facility that is Quality
Systems Certified by Underwriters Laboratories, Inc.® to ISO 9001)
• Indoor NEMA 1 enclosure
• Outdoor NEMA 3R enclosure
– Walk-in enclosure
– Non walk-in enclosure
11-33
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Metal-Clad Switchgear Arc Resistant Switchgear
Class 6055 / Refer to Handouts 6055HO0101 and 6055HO0901
schneider-electric.us
Active, Arc-Resistant
Arc Terminator™ Arc Extinguishing System
Active system detects and controls the effects of internal arcing faults. It complies with
ANSI C37.20.7 requirements for arc-resistant switchgear for Type 1, Type 2B, and
Type 2C enclosures, even with the switchgear doors open.
In the event of a confirmed arcing fault inside a Masterclad switchgear or Motorpact
equipment lineup containing an Arc Terminator (AT) system, the AT system provides a
low impedance parallel path to effectively transfer the fault current from the arc to the 3-
phase main bus assembly of the switchgear.
The AT system consists of the following components:
• Aswitchgear.
high-speed closing, or shorting, switch is designed to close on the main bus of the
This creates a three-phase short circuit fault confined to the main bus.
Upstream protective device must clear fault within allowed time per applicable
standard.
Arc Terminator ™
• The controller box is the central processing device that responds to the signals given
Arc Extinguishing System
by the current sensors and the optical sensors. The current sensor module and the
control logic process incoming current and optical signals and send a signal to the
output triggering circuit. The output triggering circuit releases stored energy to initiate
closing of the mechanical switch and provides optical isolation to prevent false
triggering
• Optical sensors are located in each medium voltage compartment within switchgear
structures. A dedicated, properly sized set of current transformers is located at the
incoming power source(s).
Benefits
• Prevents pressure buildup
• Reduces release of toxic materials
11
Passive, Arc-Resistant
Masterclad™ Medium Voltage Switchgear
This switchgear and all its components meet the IEEE C37.20.7 arc-resistant test
guideline for Type 2B enclosures as well as all other applicable ANSI, UL, and CSA
standards for metalclad switchgear.
Switchgear Construction:
• Arc exhaust options: vented, arc shield, arc planum and duct
• High-speed operation—3–cycles
• Removable (draw-out) circuit breaker
• Fully compartmentalized construction
• Grounded metal barriers enclose all live parts
• Automatic shutters driven by breaker racking mechanism
Two-high, Masterclad 5–15 kV
• Closed door breaker position indication
Metalclad, Arc-Resistant Switchgear • Closed door breaker racking mechanism
• Insulated copper main bus
• Standard glass polyester supports
• Mechanical interlocks
• Disconnect type CPT and VT trucks
• Grounded breaker truck in and between test/disconnected and connected positions
• Low voltage instrument/control compartment isolated from primary voltage areas
• Compliance to ANSI standards C37.06, C37.09, C37.013, C37.54 and C37.55
(designed and tested to comply with or exceed ANSI and IEEE standards)
Ratings
• Up to 63 kA arc containment for 0.5 seconds
• Voltage ratings from 2.4 kV to 15 kV up to 4,000 A
• Type 2B construction, one- and two-high structures
11-34
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone Load Center; Model III Unit Substations
Classes 6010, 6020 / Refer to Catalog 6020CT9401 or Data Bulletin 6010DB1001
schneider-electric.us
11
The secondary circuit breaker distribution section may be equipped with an individually
mounted secondary main breaker or an I-Line distribution panelboard. Branch circuit
breakers from PowerPact™ B to PowerPact RLC 1200 A may be installed. PowerPact M-
, P-, and R-frame molded case circuit breakers are available with electronic trip units.
Additional options include PowerLogic™ and ION™ series metering, surge arresters, and
I-Line™ plug-on units with a Surgelogic™ Surge Protective Device (SPD).
Model III Package Unit Substation
with HVL/cc Load Interrupter Switch (on left)
11-35
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Unit Substations Power-Zone™ Model III
Class 6010 / Refer to Catalog 6020CT9401
schneider-electric.us
Transformer Section
Special barrel wound dry-type transformers employing resin encapsulated VPI (Vacuum
Pressure Impregnation) techniques are used to achieve the low-loss, compact design
necessary for the space-saving package substation concept. Class H, 220 °C insulation
is used throughout. Temperature rise is 150 °C as standard, although 80°C or 115 °C low
temperature premium transformers are available through 750 kVA. Aluminum windings
are standard with copper as an option. Four full capacity 2-1/2 percent taps are provided-
two above nominal voltage and two below.
Fan cooling is optional. When selected, it increases the capacity rating of the transformer
an additional 33 percent. The Model 98 digital controller is employed. This system
provides precision control through the use of three high accuracy thermocouple type
sensors—one in each phase of the windings.
The controller has a membrane front panel for displaying the temperature of all three
phases with individual readings. The hottest phase is automatically displayed. The
Model 98 digital controller features simple three-button operation with fan, alarm and trip
function settings and is Powerlogic™ compatible.
HVL/cc™ switch, I-Line panelboard
top feed
Nameplate
Removable
cover 5.45
(138)
85.0
(2159)
11
80.00
(2032)
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
11-36
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone™ Model III Unit Substations
Class 6010 / Refer to Catalog 6020CT9401
schneider-electric.us
Distribution Section
I-Line™ Mounted Molded Case Circuit Breakers
Molded case circuit breakers are group mounted in an I-Line panelboard section offering
the inherent ease of installation for which the plug-on I-Line circuit breaker has become
known. All circuit breakers are quick-make, quick-break, thermal magnetic, permanent
trip type and are factory-calibrated and sealed for accurate overcurrent response and
maximum short-circuit strength. PowerPact™ P and R circuit breakers are available with
solid-state Micrologic™ trip units. Current limiting high interrupting capacity FI, KI, and LI
circuit breakers are also available. Circuit breakers may be safely back-fed for use as
main circuit breakers. All circuit breakers are UL listed and carry integrated equipment
rating when used exclusively with other Square D™ brand circuit breakers in intended
assemblies.
I-Line panel is available in 1200 A. Maximum mounting space is 108 inches.
Tin-plated copper bus is standard.
Dimensions shown
in Inches (mm). See
table below for A, B,
A C, D, E dimensions. 8.6
1.0 (218) 8.0
(25) D Typ. E (203) 4.0
(102)
5.0 13.9
17.5 Me dium volta ge (353)
(445) (127)
conduit a re a
(top e ntry)
40.0
22.0 (1016)
29.3
(559) (744)
7.5
7.0 (191)
(178)
4.0
(102)
1.2 3.3 4.0
(30) 9.3 9.3
Low volta ge conduit 1.6 C (84) (102)
(41) 1.5 0.50 (13) dia . (236) (236)
provis ion; 2 pla ce s ; B 0.63 (16) dia .
Low volta ge (38) bolt-down bolt-down Low volta ge
1.125 (29) dia . 1.5
Contact your nearest Schneider Electric sales office for ordering assistance.
1200 A Max. Main Lugs or
SN
1200 A Max. Main Breaker
11
11-37
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
MV Controllers Motorpact™
Class 8198 / Refer to Documents 8198CT0201, 8198HO0201
schneider-electric.us
11-38
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Vacuum Substation Circuit Breakers Substation Circuit Breakers
Class 6065 / Refer to Document 1910BR0902
schneider-electric.us
11-39
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Medium Voltage Overhead Distribution Recloser; Sectionalizer
Class 6000 / Refer to Document 6000BR1301
schneider-electric.us
Applications
• Feeder automatic circuit recloser
• Substation automatic circuit recloser
• Loop automation
• Automatic change-over
11
• Smart grid
Load Break Switch/Sectionalizer
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
Overview
The RL-series Load Break Switch/Sectionalizer is a switch used in conjunction with an
upstream recloser or circuit breaker. It counts the interruptions created by a recloser
during a fault sequence. On a preset count, the sectionalizer trips during the dead time of
the up stream recloser and isolates the faulty network section.
RL-series
Applications
• Manual load-break switch
• Motorized load-break switch
• Fully automated sectionalizer
• Normally-open tie point
Table 11.55: Ratings
Load Break Switch/
Automatic Circuit Recloser Sectionalizer
Attribute
N-series U-series W-series RL-series
Phases 3 1 3
Nominal Voltage (kV) 15, 27, 38 15, 27 15, 24 15, 27, 38
Continuous amperes (A) 800 630 400 630
Short-time rating (kA) 12.5/16 12.5 6 12.5/16
Insulation Gas Epoxy Epoxy Gas
Interruption Vacuum Gas
Operations (elec/mech) 10000/10000 600/5000
11-40
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Controller Medium Voltage Overhead Distribution
Class 6000 / Refer to Document 6000BR1301
schneider-electric.us
ADVC Controller
Overview
The ADVC controller offers advanced protection, measurement, diagnostic, and
communication features in a reliable package. Designed around the user, the controller
offers flexibility and choice. Users have a choice of two cubicle sizes (ULTRA and
COMPACT) and two operator interfaces (flexVUE and setVUE).
All the protection, monitoring, communication, diagnostic, and automation features are
included as standard in all models:
• ULTRA—large 316SS controller cubicle with two accessory mounting areas
• COMPACT—smaller 304SS controller cubicle with one accessory mounting area
• flexVUE—interface with 20 configurable status lamps and 12 quick action keys
• setVUE—large 4 x 40 LCD with familiar menu-driven operation
Applications
The ADVC controller interfaces with the following:
• N-series recloser
• U-series recloser
• W-series recloser
• RL-series load break switch/sectionalizer
11
11-41
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
schneider-electric.us
11
SWITCHBOARDS AND SWITCHGEAR
11-42
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 12
Busway
Powerbus™ Busway 12-2
Feeder Style
Power-Zone™ Busway 12-18
BUSWAY
exact fit of all components. Contact your local Schneider Electric sales office for exact
details.
• Emergency Service; we are on call 24 hours a day, 7 days a week, 365 days a year.
For emergencies, call 1-888-SquareD (1-888-778-2733).
• Quick Ship program provides product availability for time sensitive orders. The
program is available through the product selectors and offers a limited selection of I-
Line busway footage and fittings. Contact your local Schneider Electric sales office for
exact details.
12
Power-Zone Busway
11/10/2017
Powerbus™ Busway Powerbus™ Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Powerbus Busway
Construction
Powerbus busway construction consists of a light-weight electrical grade all-aluminum
housing with up to five (5) silver-plated copper conductor bars for maximum electrical
efficiency. The total product offer includes straight sections, fittings, accessories, and
plug-in units for a total installation. This busway is available in 400 A, 225 A and 100 A
ratings. A 50% integral ground is standard.
Straight Sections
Straight sections of busway are available in 10 ft. and 4 ft. lengths in a painted black
finish. The Enhanced busway offer includes 10 plug-in openings on each side of a 10 ft.
section and 3 plug-in openings on each side of a 4 ft. section.
Metering and Communications Options
Single phase systems and DC systems are also available. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative.
Powerbus busway tap boxes and plug-in units are available with optional metering and
communication capabilities, which include an integrated display and the ability to
remotely monitor the busway.
[1] Busway catalog numbers shown include a black painted finish. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for a natural aluminum finish option.
[2] For 100 A busway only, add an (L), for top cable access, or a (U), for bottom cable access, before the last letter in the catalog no., which is (B).
[3] Replace the ( ) in the Tap Box w/Meter catalog number with the meter suffix number in Table 12.3 Meter Suffix Number, page 12-3. The meter will be configured based on the system
voltage.
12-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerbus Plug-In Units Powerbus™ Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
BUSWAY
Table 12.7: Factory Assembled Units with FA Circuit Breakers—600 V max[9]
Circuit 3A Configuration 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Breaker [10]
Rating Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
15 PBPFA3A100A015 PBPFA4A100A015 PBPFA5A100A015 PBPFA5B100A015
20 PBPFA3A100A020 PBPFA4A100A020 PBPFA5A100A020 PBPFA5B100A020
30 PBPFA3A100A030 PBPFA4A100A030 PBPFA5A100A030 PBPFA5B100A030
40 PBPFA3A100A040 PBPFA4A100A040 PBPFA5A100A040 PBPFA5B100A040
50 PBPFA3A100A050 PBPFA4A100A050 PBPFA5A100A050 PBPFA5B100A050
60 PBPFA3A100A060 PBPFA4A100A060 PBPFA5A100A060 PBPFA5B100A060
70 PBPFA3A100A070 PBPFA4A100A070 PBPFA5A100A070 PBPFA5B100A070
80 PBPFA3A100A080 PBPFA4A100A080 PBPFA5A100A080 PBPFA5B100A080
90 PBPFA3A100A090 PBPFA4A100A090 PBPFA5A100A090 PBPFA5B100A090
12
100 PBPFA3A100A100 PBPFA4A100A100 PBPFA5A100A100 PBPFA5B100A100
[4] Busway catalog numbers shown include a black painted finish. Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for a natural aluminum finish option.
[4] Replace the ( ) in the Tap Box w/Meter catalog number with the meter suffix number in Table 12.3 Meter Suffix Number, page 12-3. The meter will be configured based on the system
voltage.
[5] For the NetShelter TM IT Rack-Mounting Bracket, refer to 5600CT9101.
[6] For single-pole operation on QO and ED circuit breakers.
[7] Certain NEMA receptacles can be field installed in this unit. Consult your local Schneider Electric representative.
[8] Plug-in tap box to be installed on 100 A and 225 A busways only.
[9] See Digest Section 7, Table 7.147 QB, QD, QG, QJ, Q4, FA, LA, Circuit Breakers, page 7-76 for FA circuit breaker information.
[10] The 4B configuration catalog numbers are also available.
12-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerbus™ Busway Powerbus Plug-In Units
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Table 12.8: 120 V Factory Assembled Units: 1-pole QO/QOB circuit breakers with
NEMA 5-15R or 5-20R receptacles[11][12]
Circuit Breaker 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Rating Type Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
Type 1 (3 circuit breakers w. 3 duplex receptacles)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M115 PBPQOR5A100M115 PBPQOR5B100M115
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M115B PBPQOR5A100M115B PBPQOR5B100M115B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M120 PBPQOR5A100M120 PBPQOR5B100M120
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M120B PBPQOR5A100M120B PBPQOR5B100M120B
Type 2 (3 circuit breakers w. 2 duplex/1 locking recpt.)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M215 PBPQOR5A100M215 PBPQOR5B100M215
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M215B PBPQOR5A100M215B PBPQOR5B100M215B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M220 PBPQOR5A100M220 PBPQOR5B100M220
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M220B PBPQOR5A100M220B PBPQOR5B100M220B
Type 3 (3 circuit breakers w. 1 duplex/2 locking recpt.)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M315 PBPQOR5A100M315 PBPQOR5B100M315
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M315B PBPQOR5A100M315B PBPQOR5B100M315B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M320 PBPQOR5A100M320 PBPQOR5B100M320
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M320B PBPQOR5A100M320B PBPQOR5B100M320B
Type 4 (3 circuit breakers w. 3 locking receptacles)
15 QO PBPQOR4A100M415 PBPQOR5A100M415 PBPQOR5B100M415
15 QOB PBPQOR4A100M415B PBPQOR5A100M415B PBPQOR5B100M415B
20 QO PBPQOR4A100M420 PBPQOR5A100M420 PBPQOR5B100M420
20 QOB PBPQOR4A100M420B PBPQOR5A100M420B PBPQOR5B100M420B
Table 12.9: Factory Assembled Units: One (1) QOU circuit breaker and one (1) drop cord with connector[13][14]
Circuit Breaker NEMA Drop Cord 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
Rating Poles Connector Length (ft) Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number
15 A 1 L5-15 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL515 PBPQOU5A100COOL515 PBPQOU5B100COOL515
20 A 1 L5-20 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL520 PBPQOU5A100COOL520 PBPQOU5B100COOL520
30 A 1 L5-30 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL530 PBPQOU5A100COOL530 PBPQOU5B100COOL530
15 A 2 L6-15 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL615 PBPQOU5A100COOL615 PBPQOU5B100COOL615
20 A 2 L6-20 3 PBPQOU4A100COOL620 PBPQOU5A100COOL620 PBPQOU5B100COOL620
12
[11] Many more factory assembled units are available using combinations of 1P/2P/3P circuit breakers with other NEMA receptacles. Maximum of 3 breaker spacess available. Consult your
local Schneider Electric representative.
[12] See Digest Section 7, QO and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers, page for QOU circuit breaker information.
[13] Factory assembled units are available using combinations of 1P/2P/3P circuit breakers with other NEMA and IEC type receptacles. Maximum of three drop cords with six breaker spaces
available. Consult your local Schneider Electric representative.
[14] See Digest Section 7, QO and QOU Miniature Circuit Breakers, page for QOU circuit breaker information. Catalog numbers shown have the breaker in the top slot in the front cover and
the drop cord in the left position in the base of the unit. Other combinations are available.
12-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Powerbus Plug-In Units Powerbus™ Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Table 12.10: Factory Assembled Units with NEMA Connectors and Metering[15][16]
Circuit Breaker NEMA Drop Cord Catalog Number[17][18]
Rating Poles Connector Length (ft) 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
15 A 1 L5-15 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL515M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL515M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL515M( )
20 A 1 L5-20 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL520M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL520M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL520M( )
30 A 1 L5-30 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL530M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL530M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL530M( )
15 A 2 L6-15 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL615M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL615M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL615M( )
20 A 2 L6-20 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL620M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL620M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL620M( )
30 A 2 L6-30 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL630M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL630M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL630M( )
20 A 3 L21-20 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL2120M( )
30 A 3 L21-30 3 PBPEDU4A100COOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOL2130M( )
15 A 1 L5-15 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL515M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL515M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL515M( )
20 A 1 L5-20 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL520M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL520M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL520M( )
30 A 1 L5-30 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL530M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL530M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL530M( )
15 A 2 L6-15 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL615M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL615M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL615M( )
20 A 2 L6-20 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL620M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL620M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL620M( )
30 A 2 L6-30 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL630M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL630M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL630M( )
20 A 3 L21-20 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL2120M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL2120M( )
30 A 3 L21-30 6 PBPEDU4A100FOOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5A100FOOL2130M( ) PBPEDU5B100FOOL2130M( )
Table 12.11: Factory Assembled Units with IEC Connectors and Metering[15][16]
Circuit Breaker Drop Cord Catalog Number[18][20]
Rating Poles IEC 60309 Connector[19] Length (ft) 4A Configuration 5A Configuration 5B Configuration
20 2 2-Pole, 3-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS3420M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS3420M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS3420M( )
30 2 2-Pole, 3-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS3430M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS3430M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS3430M( )
60 2 2-Pole, 3-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS3460M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS3460M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS3460M( )
20 3 3-Pole, 4-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS4420M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS4420M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS4420M( )
30 3 3-Pole, 4-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS4430M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS4430M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS4430M( )
60 3 3-Pole, 4-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS4460M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS4460M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS4460M( )
20 3 4-Pole, 5-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS5420M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS5420M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS5420M( )
30 3 4-Pole, 5-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS5430M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS5430M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS5430M( )
60 3 4-Pole, 5-Wire Grounding 3 PBPEDU4A100COOS5460M( ) PBPEDU5A100COOS5460M( ) PBPEDU5B100COOS5460M( )
BUSWAY
Table 12.14: NEMA Receptacles and Connectors[23]
NEMA Non-Locking NEMA Locking
Wiring Voltage
15 A 20 A 30 A 15 A 20 A 30 A
2-pole, 3-wire grounding 120 5–15 5–20 5–30 L5–15 L5–20 L5–30
2-pole, 3-wire grounding 240 6–15 6–20 6–30 L6–15 L6–20 L6–20
3-pole, 4-wire grounding 120/240 14–15 14–20 14–30 — L14–20 L14–30
3-pole, 4-wire grounding 3Ø 240 15–15 15–20 15–30 — L15–20 L15–30
4-pole, 5-wire grounding 3ØY
120/208 — — — — L21–20 L21–30
12
Short-Circuit Current Rating
Product KA, RMS Symmetrical
UL 3–Cycle Test
100 A 14 kA
225 A 22 kA
400 A 35 kA
[15] See Digest Section 9, For NF Merchandised Panelboards, page 9-28 for ED circuit breaker information. Catalog numbers shown have the breaker in the top slot in the front cover and the
drop cord in the left position in the base of the unit. Other combinations are available. The Power Meter display will be located below the breaker space. For remote monitoring capabilities, a
gateway is required. The gateway is located in the tap box with metering or in a separate gateway plug-in unit listed below. The units with metering can be daisy-chained together back to the
gateway. A maximum of 30 units should be daisy-chained together to one gateway.
[16] Factory assembled units are available using combinations of 1P/2P/3P circuit breakers with other NEMA and IEC type receptacles. Maximum of three drop cords with three breaker spaces
available. Consult your local Schneider Electric representative.
[17] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
[18] For metering, replace ( ) in catalog number with the appropriate number in Table 12.12 Meter Suffix Number, page 12-5. Connectors must be rated for appropriate voltages.
[19] Other IEC Connectors are available.
[20] For the offer without metering, do not use the suffix “M” or any numbers following.
[21] Replace ( ) in above tables with the appropriate meter suffix number. Connectors must be rated for appropriate voltages.
[22] For remote monitoring capabilities, a gateway is required. The gateway is located in the tap box with metering or in a separate gateway plug-in unit listed above. Units with metering can be
daisy-chained together back to the gateway. A maximum of 30 units should be daisy-chained together to one gateway.
[23] Additional NEMA, IEC, and California Standard type receptacles and connectors are available.
[24] See 5600CT9101 for fuse and circuit breaker series connected ratings.
12-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ Busway Standard Components
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
[1] Add “I” for inside elbow; add “O” for outside elbow.
[2] For seismic applications, seismic hangers must be used with horizontal mount flatwise or edgewise busway. Vertical mount busway may use standard fixed or spring hangers.
12-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
800 A–5000 A Busway I-Line™ II Busway
Class 5615 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Number Ampere
of Poles Rating
End Tap Box Edgewise Elbow Flatwise Elbow End Tap Box Edgewise Elbow Flatters Elbow
Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No. Catalog No.
800 AF2308GETBMB AF2308GLEM11 AF2308GLFM11 CF2308GETBMB CF2308GLEM11 CF2308GLFM11
1000 AF2310GETBMB AF2310GLEM11 AF2310GLFM12 CF2310GETBMB CF2310GLEM11 CF2310GLFM11
1200 AF2312GETBMB AF2312GLEM11 AF2312GLFM12 CF2312GETBMB CF2312GLEM11 CF2312GLFM12
BUSWAY
1350 AF2313GETBMB AF2313GLEM11 AF2313GLFM13 CF2313GETBMB CF2313GLEM11 CF2313GLFM12
3Ø3W 1600 AF2316GETBMB AF2316GLEM11 AF2316GLFM13 CF2316GETBMB CF2316GLEM11 CF2316GLFM12
with Integral 2000 AF2320GETBMB AF2320GLEM11 AF2320GLFM15 CF2320GETBMB CF2320GLEM11 CF2320GLFM13
Ground Bus 2500 AF2325GETBMB AF2325GLEM11 AF2325GLFM17 CF2325GETBMB CF2325GLEM11 CF2325GLFM15
3000 AF2330GETBMB AF2330GLEM11 AF2330GLFM18 CF2330GETBMB CF2330GLEM11 CF2330GLFM16
3200 — — — CF2332GETBMB CF2332GLEM11 CF2332GLFM17
4000 AF2340GETBMB AF2340GLEM11 AF2340GLFM22 CF2340GETBMB CF2340GLEM11 CF2340GLFM21
5000 — — — CF2350GETBMB CF2350GLEM11 CF2350GLFM21
800 AF2508GETBMB AF2508GLEM11 AF2508GLFM11 CF2508GETBMB CF2508GLEM11 CF2508GLFM11
1000 AF2510GETBMB AF2510GLEM11 AF2510GLFM12 CF2510GETBMB CF2510GLEM11 CF2510GLFM11
1200 AF2512GETBMB AF2512GLEM11 AF2512GLFM12 CF2512GETBMB CF2512GLEM11 CF2512GLFM12
1350 AF2513GETBMB AF2513GLEM11 AF2513GLFM13 CF2513GETBMB CF2513GLEM11 CF2513GLFM12
3Ø4W 1600 AF2516GETBMB AF2516GLEM11 AF2516GLFM13 CF2516GETBMB CF2516GLEM11 CF2516GLFM12
12
with Integral 2000 AF2520GETBMB AF2520GLEM11 AF2520GLFM15 CF2520GETBMB CF2520GLEM11 CF2520GLFM13
Ground Bus 2500 AF2525GETBMB AF2525GLEM11 AF2525GLFM17 CF2525GETBMB CF2525GLEM11 CF2525GLFM15
3000 AF2530GETBMB AF2530GLEM11 AF2530GLFM18 CF2530GETBMB CF2530GLEM11 CF2530GLFM16
3200 — — — CF2532GETBMB CF2532GLEM11 CF2532GLFM17
4000 AF2540GETBMB AF2540GLEM11 AF2540GLFM22 CF2540GETBMB CF2540GLEM11 CF2540GLFM21
5000 — — — CF2550GETBMB CF2550GLEM11 CF2550GLFM21
[1] To complete the catalog number, replace the blank with an “H” for the plug-in unit to be mounted on horizontally—oriented busway and “V” for the plug-in unit to be mounted on vertically-
oriented busway.
[2] Cannot be used for 800 A copper busway.
[3] Feeder style available in lengths from 16 to 120 inches.
[4] Plug-in style also available in 4, 6, and 8 foot lengths.
[5] For seismic applications, seismic hangers must be used with horizontal mount flatwise or edgewise busway. Vertical mount busway may use standard fixed or spring hangers.
12-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway 800 A–5000 A Busway
Class 5615 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
[6] For seismic applications, seismic hangers must be used with horizontal mount flatwise or edgewise busway. Vertical mount busway may use standard fixed or spring hangers.
12-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
800 A to 5000 A “Factory Assembled" I-Line™ II Busway
Busway Systems (or Components)
schneider-electric.us Class 5615 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
BUSWAY
Unfused reducers are used to reduce from a higher amperage busway to a lower
amperage.
NOTE: The National Electric Code does not allow the use of unfused reducers in
vertical riser installations. Refer to the NEC for restrictions in industrial installations.
Fused or Circuit Breaker Cubicle
These are used as in-line overcurrent protection devices. They can be used in
conjunction with an unfused reducer to offer a device which reduces a run of busway in
ampacity and offers overcurrent protection.
I-Line to I-Line II Adapter
12
This adapter is used to join I-Line II busway (800 A–5000 A) to existing installations of
original I-Line busway. If connecting to an existing “slot end” of original I-Line, use a “bolt
end” adapter (-12B), and vice versa.
Expansion Fittings
The expansion fitting is built into a 3 ft. – 4 in. straight length for 800 A–5000 A and a 5
feet – 0 inch straight length for 225 A–600 A. Limit of expansion or contraction is ±1-1/2
inches. Not available in outdoor construction.
Bussed Transformer Connection
A bussed transformer connection is used when the busway physically attaches (other
than cable) to a three phase transformer. For power company vault termination
information, consult the factory.
Transformer Taps
Transformer taps are used to make cable connection to transformers. Lugs other than
standard Square D brand lugs are available. Note that taps need NOT be located directly
above transformers for cable connections.
Finger Protection to IP2X
This feature provides improved protection from accidental contact with live parts during
insertion and removal of plug-in units. This feature meets the IP2X rating as defined by
IEC529 standard.
12-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway Additions, Accessories, and Electrical Data
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Table 12.22: Short Circuit Ratings: UL 3 Cycle Test (KA, RMS Symmetrical)[7]
Aluminum Copper
Ampere APH CPH
Rating AOF2 AOFH AP COF2 COFH CP
AP2/AR2 APH2/ CF2 CFH2 CP2/CR2 CPH2/
AF2 AFH2 CRH2
ARH2
225 — — 22 — — — 22 —
400 — — 22 42 — — 22 42
600 — — 22 42 — — 22 42
800 50 85 50 75 50 85 50 75
1000 50 100 50 100 50 85 50 75
1200 50 100 50 100 50 100 50 100
1350 50 100 50 100 50 100 50 100
1600 50 100 50 100 50 100 50 100
2000 100 150 125 150 50 100 65 100
2500 100 150 125 150 100 150 125 150
3000 100 150 125 150 100 150 125 150
3200 — — — — 100 150 125 150
4000 150 200 200 — 150 200 200 —
5000 — — — — 150 200 200 —
[7] 6–cycle and 30–cycle, and fuse/circuit breaker series connected ratings are available. Please reference 5600CT9101.
[8] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
[9] For use on vertical riser applications only.
[10] For vertical riser applications, order auxiliary mounting kit—Catalog Number PBQ4060RMK.
[11] This device uses bolt-on connection. It may be used only on plug-in busway with same number of poles. To complete the catalog number, replace the blank with an “H” for the plug-in unit to
be mounted on horizontally—oriented busway and “V” for the plug-in unit to be mounted on vertically-oriented busway. Not for use on 800 A copper busway.
[12] Kit must be field installed.
[13] Contains parts to convert two units.
12-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Plug-In Units I-Line™ II Busway
Class 5615, 5630 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
BUSWAY
12
Table 12.34: H- and J-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø4W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip Trip Unit
Ampere Function [16] [17] Catalog Number[18][19][20] Catalog Number[18][19] Catalog Number[18][19][20] Catalog Number[18][19][20]
[20]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
60 PHD36060GNU31X PHG36060GNU31X PHJ36060GNU31X PHL36060GNU31X
100 PHD36100GNU31X PHG36100GNU31X PHJ36100GNU31X PHL36100GNU31X
LI 3.2
150 PHD36150GNU31X PHG36150GNU31X PHJ36150GNU31X PHL36150GNU31X
250 PJD36250GNU31X PJG36250GNU31X PJJ36250GNU31X PJL36250GNU31X
60 PHD36060GNU33X PHG36060GNU33X PHJ36060GNU33X PHL36060GNU33X
100 PHD36100GNU33X PHG36100GNU33X PHJ36100GNU33X PHL36100GNU33X
LSI 3.2 S
150 PHD36150GNU33X PHG36150GNU33X PHJ36150GNU33X PHL36150GNU33X
250 PJD36250GNU33X PJG36250GNU33X PJJ36250GNU33X PJL36250GNU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
60 PHD36060GNU43X PHG36060GNU43X PHJ36060GNU43X PHL36060GNU43X
100 PHD36100GNU43X PHG36100GNU43X PHJ36100GNU43X PHL36100GNU43X
LSI 5.2 A
150 PHD36150GNU43X PHG36150GNU43X PHJ36150GNU43X PHL36150GNU43X
250 PJD36250GNU43X PJG36250GNU43X PJJ36250GNU43X PJL36250GNU43X
60 PHD36060GNU44X PHG36060GNU44X PHJ36060GNU44X PHL36060GNU44X
100 PHD36100GNU44X PHG36100GNU44X PHJ36100GNU44X PHL36100GNU44X
LSIG 6.2 A
150 PHD36150GNU44X PHG36150GNU44X PHJ36150GNU44X PHL36150GNU44X
BUSWAY
250 PJD36250GNU44X PJG36250GNU44X PJJ36250GNU44X PJL36250GNU44X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
60 PHD36060GNU53X PHG36060GNU53X PHJ36060GNU53X PHL36060GNU53X
100 PHD36100GNU53X PHG36100GNU53X PHJ36100GNU53X PHL36100GNU53X
LSI 5.2 E
150 PHD36150GNU53X PHG36150GNU53X PHJ36150GNU53X PHL36150GNU53X
250 PJD36250GNU53X PJG36250GNU53X PJJ36250GNU53X PJL36250GNU53X
60 PHD36060GNU54X PHG36060GNU54X PHJ36060GNU54X PHL36060GNU54X
100 PHD36100GNU54X PHG36100GNU54X PHJ36100GNU54X PHL36100GNU54X
LSIG 6.2 E
150 PHD36150GNU54X PHG36150GNU54X PHJ36150GNU54X PHL36150GNU54X
250 PJD36250GNU54X PJG36250GNU54X PJJ36250GNU54X PJL36250GNU54X
12
[16] If alternate trip functions are required, contact your local Schneider Electric field office for pricing.
[17] For Trip Unit information, refer to Micrologic Trip Units, page 7-65.
[18] For communication capabilities, add the communication suffix as shown in Communication Suffix, page . The communication package will be configured based on the system voltage
specified by the communication suffix.
[19] For availability on 100% rated, see 5600CT9101.
[20] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway PowerPactTM H-, J-, and L-Frame Plug-in
Units with Electronic Trip
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101 schneider-electric.us
Table 12.35: L-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø3W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting R Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip
Trip Unit[22] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24]
Ampere Function[21]
[25][26] [25][26] [24][25][26] [25][26] [25][26]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
250 PBLD36250GU31X PBLG36250GU31X PBLJ36250GU31X PBLL36250GU31X PBLR36250GU31X
400 LI 3.3 PBLD36400GU31X PBLG36400GU31X PBLJ36400GU31X PBLL36400GU31X PBLR36400GU31X
600 PBLD36600GU31X PBLG36600GU31X PBLJ36600GU31X PBLL36600GU31X PBLR36600GU31X
250 PBLD36250GU33X PBLG36250GU33X PBLJ36250GU33X PBLL36250GU33X PBLR36250GU33X
400 PBLD36400GU33X PBLG36400GU33X PBLJ36400GU33X PBLL36400GU33X PBLR36400GU33X
LSI 3.3 S
600 PBLD36600GU33X PBLG36600GU33X PBLJ36600GU33X PBLL36600GU33X PBLR36600GU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GU43X PBLG36400GU43X PBLJ36400GU43X PBLL36400GU43X PBLR36400GU43X
LSI 5.3 A
600 PBLD36600GU43X PBLG36600GU43X PBLJ36600GU43X PBLL36600GU43X PBLR36600GU43X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø3W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GU53X PBLG36400GU53X PBLJ36400GU53X PBLL36400GU53X PBLR36400GU53X
LSI 5.3 E
600 PBLD36600GU53X PBLG36600GU53X PBLJ36600GU53X PBLL36600GU53X PBLR36600GU53X
Table 12.36: L-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip—Standard (80%) Rated—3Ø4W
D Interrupting G Interrupting J Interrupting L Interrupting R Interrupting
Trip Rating Trip Trip Unit[22]
Ampere Function[21] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24] Catalog Number[23][24]
[25][26] [25][26] [25][26] [25][26] [25][26]
Micrologic Standard Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
250 PBLD36250GNU31X PBLG36250GNU31X PBLJ36250GNU31X PBLL36250GNU31X PBLR36250GNU31X
400 PBLD36400GNU31X PBLG36400GNU31X PBLJ36400GNU31X PBLL36400GNU31X PBLR36400GNU31X
LI 3.3
600 PBLD36600GNU31X PBLG36600GNU31X PBLJ36600GNU31X PBLL36600GNU31X PBLR36600GNU31X
250 PBLD36250GNU33X PBLG36250GNU33X PBLJ36250GNU33X PBLL36250GNU33X PBLR36250GNU33X
400 PBLD36400GNU33X PBLG36400GNU33X PBLJ36400GNU33X PBLL36400GNU33X PBLR36400GNU33X
LSI 3.3 S
600 PBLD36600GNU33X PBLG36600GNU33X PBLJ36600GNU33X PBLL36600GNU33X PBLR36600GNU33X
Micrologic Ammeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GNU43X PBLG36400GNU43X PBLJ36400GNU43X PBLL36400GNU43X PBLR36400GNU43X
LSI 5.3 A
600 PBLD36600GNU43X PBLG36600GNU43X PBLJ36600GNU43X PBLL36600GNU43X PBLR36600GNU43X
400 PBLD36400GNU44X PBLG36400GNU44X PBLJ36400GNU44X PBLL36400GNU44X PBLR36400GNU44X
LSIG 6.3 A
600 PBLD36600GNU44X PBLG36600GNU44X PBLJ36600GNU44X PBLL36600GNU44X PBLR36600GNU44X
Micrologic Energymeter Trip Unit
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
400 PBLD36400GNU53X PBLG36400GNU53X PBLJ36400GNU53X PBLL36400GNU53X PBLR36400GNU53X
LSI 5.3 E
600 PBLD36600GNU53X PBLG36600GNU53X PBLJ36600GNU53X PBLL36600GNU53X PBLR36600GNU53X
400 PBLD36400GNU54X PBLG36400GNU54X PBLJ36400GNU54X PBLL36400GNU54X PBLR36400GNU54X
LSIG 6.3 E
600 PBLD36600GNU54X PBLG36600GNU54X PBLJ36600GNU54X PBLL36600GNU54X PBLR36600GNU54X
12
BUSWAY
[21] If alternate trip functions are required, contact your local Schneider Electric field office for pricing.
[22] For Trip Unit information, refer to Micrologic Trip Units, page 7-65.
[23] For communication capabilities, add the communication suffix as shown in Communication Suffix, page . The communication package will be configured based on the system voltage
specified by the communication suffix.
[24] For availability on 100% rated, see 5600CT9101.
[25] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
[26] For vertical riser applications, order auxiliary mounting kit—Catalog Number PBQ4060RMK.
12-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPactTM M-Frame Plug-in Units with I-Line™ II Busway
Basic Electronic Trip
schneider-electric.us Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
H- , J-, and L-Frame Plug-In Units with Electronic Trip and
Communication
Hardware communication packages are now available on Powerpact H-, J-, and
L-Frame Plug-in Units with Electronic Trip. These hardware communication packages
will provide you the capability to access and monitor circuit breaker data from these plug-
in units. The packages are available in Modbus and Ethernet.
Add the appropriate communication system voltage suffix to the end of the associated
H-, J-, or L-Frame breaker with electronic trip, for example: PHD36060GNU31XIFE4.
Table 12.39: M-Frame Circuit Breaker Plug-in Units with Basic Electronic Trip Unit
(ET 1.0)—3Ø4W[28][29]
G Interrupting J Interrupting
Trip Rating Ampere
Catalog Number[30] Catalog Number[30]
3Ø4W + G, 600 Vac 50/60 Hz
300 PTMG36300GN( ) PTMJ36300GN( )
350 PTMG36350GN( ) PTMJ36350GN( )
400 PTMG36400GN( ) PTMJ36400GN( )
450 PTMG36450GN( ) PTMJ36450GN( )
500 PTMG36500GN( ) PTMJ36500GN( )
600 PTMG36600GN( ) PTMJ36600GN( )
700 PTMG36700GN( ) PTMJ36700GN( )
800 PTMG36800GN( ) PTMJ36800GN( )
BUSWAY
12
[27] Communication packages are housed in a separate enclosure mounted adjacent to the plug-in units.
[28] The ET 1.0 trip unit cannot be field replaced or have the long-time trip point setting adjusted.
[29] All these devices use bolt-on connection. It may be used only on busway with same number of poles. Not for use on 800 A copper busway. To complete the catalog number, replace the
blank with an “H” for horizontal applications and “V” for vertical applications.
[30] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
I-Line™ II Busway PowerPactTM P-Frame Plug-in Units
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
[31] The 250 A is available as a special device. Contact your local Schneider Electric field office for ordering information.
[32] If alternate trip functions are required, contact your local Schneider Electric field office for pricing.
[33] For Trip Unit information, refer to Micrologic Trip Units, page 7-65.
[34] Listed catalog numbers are for 80% rated circuit breakers. For 100% rated circuit breakers, replace the blank with an “HC” for horizontal applications and “VC” for vertical applications. For
example, the catalog number for a 100% standard trip unit with standard LI trip functions at 800 A 3Ø3W for a horizontal application would be PTPG36080GHCU31A.
[35] The standard rating plug supplied with a trip unit will be the "A" rating plug. To specify an alternative rating plug, replace the "A" at the end of the catalog number with the applicable suffix
letter. See Table 7.132 Rating Plugs, page 7-69 for rating plug catalog suffix letters.
[36] All these devices use bolt-on connection. It may be used only on busway with same number of poles. Not for use on 800 A copper busway. To complete the catalog number, replace the
blank with an “H” for horizontal applications and “V” for vertical applications.
[37] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
PowerPactTM R-Frame Plug-in Units I-Line™ II Busway
Class 5600 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
BUSWAY
800 PTRG36080GN( )U41A PTRJ36080GN( )U41A PTRL36080GN( )U41A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U41A PTRJ36100GN( )U41A PTRL36100GN( )U41A
LI 3.0 A
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U41A PTRJ36120GN( )U41A PTRL36120GN( )U41A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U41A PTRJ36160GN( )U41A PTRL36160GN( )U41A
800 PTRG36080GN( )U43A PTRJ36080GN( )U43A PTRL36080GN( )U43A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U43A PTRJ36100GN( )U43A PTRL36100GN( )U43A
LSI 5.0 A
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U43A PTRJ36120GN( )U43A PTRL36120GN( )U43A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U43A PTRJ36160GN( )U43A PTRL36160GN( )U43A
800 PTRG36080GN( )U44A PTRJ36080GN( )U44A PTRL36080GN( )U44A
1000 PTRG36100GN( )U44A PTRJ36100GN( )U44A PTRL36100GN( )U44A
LSIG 6.0 A
1200 PTRG36120GN( )U44A PTRJ36120GN( )U44A PTRL36120GN( )U44A
1600 PTRG36160GN( )U44A PTRJ36160GN( )U44A PTRL36160GN( )U44A
12
[38] The 600 A is available as a special device. Contact your local Schneider Electric field office for ordering information.
[39] Listed catalog numbers are for 80% rated circuit breakers. For 100% rated circuit breakers, replace the blank with an “HC” for horizontal applications and “VC” for vertical applications. For
example, the catalog number for a 100% standard trip unit with standard LI trip functions at 800 A 3Ø3W for a horizontal application would be PTPG36080GHCU31A.
[40] The standard rating plug supplied with a trip unit will be the "A" rating plug. To specify an alternative rating plug, replace the "A" at the end of the catalog number with the applicable suffix
letter. See Table 7.132 Rating Plugs, page 7-69 for rating plug catalog suffix letters.
[41] All these devices use bolt-on connection. It may be used only on busway with same number of poles. Not for use on 800 A copper busway. To complete the catalog number, replace the
blank with an “H” for horizontal applications and “V” for vertical applications.
[42] For IP54 splash resistant construction, add an "M54" suffix.
12-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone™ Busway Non-Segregated Bus
Class 6090 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Non-Segregated Bus
• Non-segregated phase bus
• 600 V through 38 kV (1200 A–6000 A)
• Aluminum, steel or stainless steel housing
• Aluminum or copper bus bars
• Insulated with fluidized bed epoxy (5 kV–38 kV)
• Complete line of fittings provides for any configuration
• Indoor trapeze and outdoor column supports
• For use in utilities, industrial and commercial facilities
Power-Zone bus is custom designed, manufactured and tested per ANSI C37.23
standards to meet customer specifications. The 600 V product is also UL Listed. It is a
completely coordinated package of equipment with all the auxiliary material and supports
for connecting transformers, switchgear, MCCs, and motors, in all types of utility,
industrial, and commercial facilities.
Bus Options
Some available options are special momentary rating, special housing material and/or
finish, special conductor supports, heaters and thermostats, and ground bus.
Weatherproof Bus
12
All weatherproof runs must be equipped with strip heaters to eliminate condensation and,
if applicable, a thermostat. A heater should be used for every seven (7) foot of bus and
no more than 20 heaters can be controlled by one thermostat. Also, each bus run should
have its own thermostat. The heaters are rated 240 V, 500 watts and operate at 120 V,
125 watts.
Flanged Ends
A flanged end is used to terminate the bus into switchgear, motor control centers,
BUSWAY
Transformer/Generator Connection
This type of termination should be used whenever the bus is connecting to a transformer,
generator, motor, switch or any connection where the bus bars are connecting to
porcelain mounted equipment terminals. It will include the same components as a
flanged end plus one set of flexible braid type connectors and a terminal box (if required).
12-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Segregated Bus Power-Zone™ Busway
Class 6090 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Ground Bus
The bus housing is designed and constructed to provide an electrically continuous
ground path. The side rails of the bus housings are capable of carrying the full rated
phase current continuously and, under short circuit conditions, are capable of carrying up
to 60 kA RMS asymmetrical fault current for 3 seconds. Consequently, a separate
ground bus is not necessary unless specified.
Expansion Fittings
An expansion fitting is used to counteract the strain placed on the bus due to the
expansion and contraction of the building or the bus itself. One should be used whenever
the bus run crosses a building expansion joint and whenever a straight run of bus
exceeds 60 feet.
BUSWAY
Table 12.45: Hangers/Supports
Support Description Maximum Height Options
Indoor Trapeze Hanger —
Outdoor, Single
Column Support 12 feet
Outdoor, Double
Column Support 22 feet
12
12-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power-Zone™ Busway Non-Segregated Bus
Class 6090 / Refer to Catalog 5600CT9101
schneider-electric.us
Standard Construction
Standard construction is as follows:
• Conductor (plating): Copper (silver) or Aluminum (tin)
• Conductor Insulation (5 kV through 38 kV only): epoxy
• Conductor
kV)
Supports: Glass reinforced polyester blocks (5 kV and 15 kV); porcelain (38
12-20
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 13
Wire Management
Wireway 13-2
Wa ll Duct
WIRE MANAGEMENT
13
11/10/2017
Wireway Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5100 / Refer to Catalog 5100CT0101
schneider-electric.us
Painted Hinge-Cover
Type LDB—ANSI 61 Gray
Polyester Powder Finish
Sizes
2-1/2”, 4”, and 6” sizes are manufactured from 16 gauge steel. Straight lengths are
available with or without knockouts. Knockouts are of various sizes in sides and bottom
of wireway. 8”, 10”, and 12” sizes are made of 14 gauge steel and are furnished without
knockouts.
Table 13.1: General Purpose (Connectors not supplied; order separately)[1][2]
2-1/2" x 2-1/2" 4" x 4" 6" x 6" 8" x 8" 10" x 10" 12" x 12"[3]
Component Catalog Number Catalog Number Catalog Number Cat. No. Cat. No. Cat. No.
With Without With Without With Without Without Without Without
Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts Knockouts
1' Length LDB21KO LDB21 LDB41KO LDB41 LDB61KO LDB61 LDB81 LDB101 LDB121
2' Length LDB22KO LDB22 LDB42KO LDB42 LDB62KO LDB62 LDB82 LDB102 LDB122
3' Length LDB23KO LDB23 LDB43KO LDB43 LDB63KO LDB63 LDB83 LDB103 LDB123
4' Length LDB24KO LDB24 LDB44KO LDB44 LDB64KO LDB64 LDB84 LDB104 LDB124
5' Length LDB25KO LDB25 LDB45KO LDB45 LDB65KO LDB65 LDB85 LDB105 LDB125
6' Length — — LDB46KO LDB46 LDB66KO LDB66 LDB86 LDB106 —
10' Length LDB210KO LDB210 LDB410KO LDB410 LDB610KO LDB610 LDB810 LDB1010 LDB1210
90o L — LDB290L — LDB490L — LDB690L LDB890L LDB1090L LDB1290L
90o Sweep L — LDB290LS — LDB490LS — LDB690LS LDB890LS LDB1090LS LDB1290LS
45o L — LDB245L — LDB445L — LDB645L LDB845L LDB1045L LDB1245L
Tee — LDB2T — LDB4T — LDB6T LDB8T LDB10T LDB12T
Junction Box — LDB2J — LDB4J — LDB6J LDB8J LDB10J LDB12J
Telescope Ftg. — LDB2TF — LDB4TF — LDB6TF LDB8TF LDB10TF LDB12TF
Connector[2] — LDB2C — LDB4C — LDB6C LDB8C LDB10C LDB12C
Drop/Brkt Hgr. — LDB2H — LDB4H — LDB6H LDB8H LDB10H LDB12H
Support Hanger — LDB2SH — LDB4SH — LDB6SH LDB8SH LDB10SH LDB12SH
Closing Plate LDB2CPKO LDB2CP LDB4CPKO LDB4CP LDB6CPKO LDB6CP LDB8CP[4] LDB10CP[4] LDB12CP[4]
Panel Adapter — LDB2A — LDB4A — LDB6A LDB8A LDB10A LDB12A
Open Adapter — LDB2OA — LDB4OA — LDB6OA LDB8OA LDB10OA LDB12OA
— — — LDB42R — LDB64R LDB86R LDB108R LDB1210R
Reducer
— — — — — — — — LDB128R
Adapter
to “LD”[5] — LDB2GASK — LDB4GAS — LDB6GAS LDB8GASK LDB10GASK —
Barrier Kit—5 ft.
long w/hardware — — — LJB45B — LJB65B LJB85B — —
5 pc. Barrier
Pack—5 ft. long — — — LJB45BKM — LJB65BKM — — —
13
Oiltight—NEMA Type 12
Type LJB Oiltight lay-in wireway is fully gasketed and used to protect runs of electrical
wiring from oil, water, coolants, dirt, or dust as well as physical damage. This wireway is
manufactured to exceed oiltight and NFPA standards for industrial control equipment.
Lengths and fittings are made of 14 gauge steel with 10 gauge end flanges. Straight
lengths and fittings have hinged covers with oil resistant gasket all around and are held
closed with pull-down latches. All lengths and fittings are without knockouts. Type LJB
lay-in Wireway is finished with ANSI-61 gray polyester powder finish over a corrosion
resistant phosphate preparation. All Type LJB oiltight wireway is UL listed as steel
enclosed wireway and auxiliary gutter. Conforms to NEMA Type 12.
WIRE MANAGEMENT
5 pc. Barrier Bracket—3 compartment — LJB4BB3C LJB6BB3C — —
13
Lay-In
Wall Duct
18 x 3 1 ⁄2 " 18 x 3 1 ⁄2 "
Trench Duct
WIRE MANAGEMENT
Sweep Edgewise Elbow Cabinet Connector 10"W — — RWT10SWEECC 14.0
18"W — — RWT18SWEECC 20.0
13
[1] All devices available in aluminum. Add “A” suffix to the catalog number.
13-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Wall Duct Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5250 / Refer to Catalog 5250CT9201
schneider-electric.us
[2] All devices available in aluminum. Add “A” suffix to the catalog number.
[3] Tunnels form a 3" wide compartment.
13-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Segregated Bus Trench Duct
Class 5200 / Refer to Catalog 5230CT9601
schneider-electric.us
2 3/8 - 3 3/8"
Standard or
Depth Width Less 1.8"
3 - 4"
W + 3"
WIRE MANAGEMENT
6" REC06
9" REC09
End Closures[4] 12" REC12
18" REC18
24" REC24
30" REC30
6" RVE06
9" RVE09
12" RVE12
Vertical Elbows
18" RVE18
24" RVE24
30" RVE30
6" RRC06
Riser and Cabinet 9" RRC09
Connector 12" RRC12
(Removable Front) 18" RRC18
24" RRC24
30" RRC30
13
Z-Divider 5'-0"[4]
Adjustable Barrier and RZD60
Support Strip
[1] Straight length cover plates are shipped separately and must be ORDERED SEPARATELY.
[2] Covers and/or vertical elbows for connecting trench duct to lay-in wall duct—ORDER SEPARATELY.
[3] All devices through 18" width are available in aluminum. Height is factory-set to customer specifications from 2-1/2 to 4 inches. (Non-Adjustable)
[4] For 3" to 4" trench duct, add a “3” to end of catalog number.
13-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Trench Duct Non-Segregated Bus
Class 5200 / Refer to Catalog 5230CT9601
schneider-electric.us
12" U-Compartment
Right Hand Reducer
18" to 12" RRV182100012RR 5'-0" Long x 3 -1/2" Wide with RUC60
Cover Included Adjustable Height Sides
15"
Reducing Tee Cover Lifter
18" to 12" RTV182100017 (Suction Cup Device) G1735S
Cover Included
[5] All devices through 18" width are available in aluminum. Height is factory-set to customer specifications from 2-1/2 to 4 inches. (Non-Adjustable)
[6] Includes cover; shipped attached. All coverplate corner notches are 1–1/2” deep.
13-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 14
Transformers
EZ Selector–Selection Assistance 14-2
Overview 14-3
General Purpose Dry Type 600 Volts and Below Overview 14-3
New! Energy Efficient Three Phase 14-4
Energy Efficient Single Phase and Single Phase Watchdog 14-7
Accessories 14-8
Enclosures and Accessories 14-8
Mini Power-Zone Unit Substation 14-10
Sealed, Mini Power-Zone™ Unit Substation 14-10
Resin Encapsulated Three and Single Phase Transformers 14-11
Resin Encapsulated Export Model and Buck Boost Transformers 14-12
Non-Ventilated and Transformer House 14-13
PZC Transformer Enclosures 14-13
Industrial Control 14-14
TRANSFORMERS
11/10/2017
EZ Selector–Selection Assistance LV Transformers EZ Selector–Selection
Assistance
schneider-electric.us
14-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Overview Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us
Distribution transformer means a transformer that (1) has an input voltage of 34.5 kV or
less; (2) has an ouput voltage of 600 V or less; (3) is rated for operation at a frequency of
60 Hz; and (4) has a capacity of 10 to 2500 kVA for liquid-immersed units and 15 to 2500
kVA for dry-type units.
Low voltage dry-type distribution transformer means a distribution transformer that: has
an input voltage of 600 V or less, is air-cooled, and not used oil as a coolant.
The following product offering must comply with the table above:
• Three- and single-phase
• Step up and step down transformers
• General purpose ventilated transformers (isolation transformers)
• Watchdog general purpose ventilated transformers (low temperature rise)
• Transformers designed for harmonic applications (K-rated, harmonic mitigating, data
center transformers, etc.)
• General purpose open core and coil transformers
The following low voltage transformers do not need to comply with the table above:
• Auto-transformers
• Drive isolation transformers
• Non-ventilated transformers
• Resin encapsulated transformers
• Buck boost transformers
• Control transformers (machine tool)
• Medical isolation panel transformers compliance with UL 1047 (tables 30.1 and 30.2)
(SPECIAL IZ — LOW LEAKAGE)
New Three-Phase Offering from Square D — DOE 2016 EX
• Exceed the efficiency levels from 10 CFR 431.196
• Terminals sized to handle wire ranges to match Square D circuit breakers, switches,
panelboards, etc. Located to meet NEC bending radius and layout to simplifiy
connections
• IZ Levels to allow for designing with the minimum AIC Panels available
• In-rush current limited to expand the Square D circuit breaker options at both 125 and
250% sizing
• Sound level at 3 dB for all designs, but up to 6–10 dB below on certain units—QUIET
TRANSFORMERS
QUALITY
• 1/2 in. clearance from the rear and side, UL 1561alcove testing all enclosures to
not exceed 90°C on adjacent walls
• Four product families of the DOE 2016 EX: General purpose, aluminum and copper
windings, 150°C rise; Watchdog, low temperature rise, aluminum and coover
windings, 115 or 80°C rise; Two solutions for harominic loads: K-13 Wye secondary,
harmonic mitigating transformers and K-9 ZigZag secondary, harmonic mitigating
transformers.
Association (NEMA) Standard TP–1–2002, Guide for Determining Energy Efficiency for Distribution Transformers.)
14-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution New! Energy Efficient Three Phase
Transformers
Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT1501 schneider-electric.us
[2] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[3] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
New! Energy Efficient Three Phase Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT1501
Table 14.3: EX Three Phase 60 Hz, 240 Vac Delta Secondary; UL Listed
120 Volt Center Tap - Limited to 7.5% Loading, Design for Ground Reference and Light Maintenance Loading.
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[5]
@ 35% 75°C Rise Level dB [4]
480 Vac Delta Primary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T6HCT 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.9% 42 dB 235 17K
30 EX30T6HCT 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.2% 42 dB 405 18K
45 EX45T6HCT 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 42 dB 480 18K
75 EX75T6HCT 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.8% 47 dB 640 20K
112.5 EX112T6HCT 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.5% 47 dB 910 21K
150 EX150T6HCT 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.1% 47 dB 1140 22K
225 EX225T6HCT 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.5% 52 dB 1820 25J
300 EX300T6HCT 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 5.2% 52 dB 1960 25J
500 EX500T63HCT 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.9% 57 dB 3090 30J
750 EX750T63HCT 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 150 220 4.9% 61 dB 4120 31J
Watchdog transformers, by design, reduct energy consumption at loads greater than
50% loading, giving fewer BTUs/hour at those loading levels. The life expectancy is
greater than that of 150°C rise General Purpose units.
• Aluminum or copper windings
• Two temperature rise options: 115°C rise on 220°C insulation systems (15%
continuous emergency overload capacity); 80°C rise on 220°C insulation systems
(30% continuous emergency overload capacity)
Table 14.4: EX Three Phase 60 Hz, 480Y/277 Vac Secondary; UL Listed
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Efficiency Full Capacity Taps Degree C Temp. Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[5]
@ 35% 75°C Rise Level [4]
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T3HF 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.5% 39 dB 245 17K
30 EX30T3HF 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.5% 39 dB 400 18K
45 EX45T3HF 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 5.1% 39 dB 490 18K
75 EX75T3HF 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.3% 44 dB 920 20K
112.5 EX112T3HF 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.4% 47 dB 1170 21K
150 EX150T3HF 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.8% 49 dB 825 22K
225 EX225T3HF 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.5% 49 dB 1825 24J
300 EX300T3HF 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 30.0% 49 dB 1975 25J
500 EX500T68HF 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 4.9% 56 dB 3100 30J
750 EX750T68HF 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 5.0% 58 dB 4125 31J
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings
15 EX15T3HFCU 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.1% 39 dB 250 17K
30 EX30T3HFCU 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.5% 39 dB 410 18K
45 EX45T3HFCU 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.3% 39 dB 495 18K
75 EX75T3HFCU 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.6% 44 dB 755 20K
112.5 EX112T3HFCU 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.1% 47 dB 1025 21K
150 EX150T3HFCU 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.9% 49 dB 1270 22K
225 EX225T3HFCU 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 6.8% 49 dB 1545 24J
300 EX300T3HFCU 99.02% 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 5.0% 49 dB 1975 25J
500 EX500T68HFCU 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 4.8% 56 dB 3705 30J
750 EX750T68HFCU 99.23% 4–2.5%2+2– 115 220 5.3% 58 dB 4400 31J
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings
15 EX15T3HB 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.7% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HB 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.8% 39 dB 490 18K
45 EX45T3HB 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.9% 44 dB 920 20K
75 EX75T3HB 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 5.2% 47 dB 1170 21K
112.5 EX112T3HB 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.3% 49 dB 1825 22K
150 EX150T3HB 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.2% 49 dB 1825 24J
225 EX225T3HB 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.6% 49 dB 1975 25J
300 EX300T68HB 99.02% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 4.4% 56 dB 3100 30J
500 EX500T68HB 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 4.9% 58 dB 4125 31J
480 V Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings
15 EX15T3HBCU 97.89% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.4% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HBCU 98.23% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.7% 39 dB 495 18K
45 EX45T3HBCU 98.40% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.4% 44 dB 755 20K
75 EX75T3HBCU 98.60% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.6% 47 dB 1025 21K
112.5 EX112T3HBCU 98.74% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 4.2% 49 dB 1270 22K
150 EX150T3HBCU 98.83% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 3.8% 49 dB 1545 24J
225 EX225T3HBCU 98.94% 6–2.5%2+4– 80 220 6.9% 49 dB 1975 25J
300 EX300T68HBCU 99.02% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 5.0% 56 dB 3705 30J
500 EX500T68HBCU 99.14% 4–2.5%2+2– 80 220 4.8% 58 dB 4400 31J
TRANSFORMERS
[4] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
14
[5] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution New! Energy Efficient Three Phase
Transformers
Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT1501 schneider-electric.us
DOE 2016 Low Voltage Distribution Transformers designed for applications with
harmonic loads.
Square D offers offers Delta - Wye 30°Phase Shift transformers which reconfigure the
harmonic models and mitigate the harmful effects of triplens. UL Listed with the following
K-ratings to handle excess heat created by harmonic wave forms, K13. Available with
aluminum or copper windings and 150°C or 115°C Rise with 220C insulation system.
Table 14.5: EX Three Phase 60 Hz, 30° Phase Shift, 480 Delta to 208Y/120; UL Listed, K-13
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Phase Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation Class %IZ Sound Weight (lbs) Enclosure[7]
Efficiency @ 35% Shift Temp. Rise Level [6]
75°C
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings, 150°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 1.90% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.60% 39 dB 490 18K
45 EX45T3HNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.10% 44 dB 920 20K
75 EX75T3HNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.80% 47 dB 1170 21K
112.5 EX112T3HNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.30% 49 dB 1825 22K
150 EX150T3HNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 49 dB 1825 24J
225 EX225T3HNLP 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.30% 49 dB 1975 25J
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings, 150°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HCUNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 1.90% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HCUNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 39 dB 495 18K
45 EX45T3HCUNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 44 dB 755 20K
75 EX75T3HCUNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 2.80% 47 dB 1025 21K
112.5 EX112T3HCUNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.00% 49 dB 1270 22K
150 EX150T3HCUNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 4.60% 49 dB 1545 24J
225 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 150 220 3.80% 49 dB 1975 25J
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Aluminum Windings, 115°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HFNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 1.80% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HFNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.50% 39 dB 490 18K
45 EX45T3HFNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.00% 44 dB 920 20K
75 EX75T3HFNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.80% 47 dB 1170 21K
112.5 EX112T3HFNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.30% 49 dB 1825 22K
150 EX150T3HFNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.00% 49 dB 1825 24J
225 EX225T3HFNLP 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.30% 49 dB 1975 25J
480 Delta Primary, 208Y/120 Secondary, Copper Windings, 115°C Rise, 220C Insulation, K13 Listed
15 EX15T3HFCUNLP 97.89% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 1.70% 39 dB 400 18K
30 EX30T3HFCUNLP 98.23% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.80% 39 dB 495 18K
45 EX45T3HFCUNLP 98.40% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.00% 44 dB 755 20K
75 EX75T3HFCUNLP 98.60% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.70% 47 dB 1025 21K
112.5 EX112T3HFCUNLP 98.74% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 2.90% 49 dB 1270 22K
150 EX150T3HFCUNLP 98.83% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 4.60% 49 dB 1545 24J
225 EX225T3HFCUNLP 98.94% 30° 6–2.5%2+4– 115 220 3.70% 49 dB 1975 25J
14
TRANSFORMERS
[6] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[7] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Energy Efficient Single Phase and Single Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Phase Watchdog Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT0601
TRANSFORMERS
[10] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
14-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Accessories
Transformers
schneider-electric.us
Style D and H—Type 2 Rated Style K—Type 2 Rated Style J—Type 2 Rated
Converts to Type 3R with Weathershield Converts to Type 3R with Weathershield Converts to Type 3R with Weathershield
[11] These dimensions are not for construction. Contact your local Schneider Electric.
[12] Wall mounting brackets are used with units weighing no more than 700 lbs.
[13] Ceiling mounting brackets are used with units weighing no more than 1200 lbs.
14-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us
Schneider Electric Low Voltage Transformers have been qualified to the site-specific
requirements of the following listed model building code and/or standard. (International
Building Code, California Buildling Code, Uniformed Building Code). Qualification based
on tri-axial shake table test results conduced in accordance with the AC156 test
protocol3 (Acceptance Criteria for Seismic Qualification Testing of Nonstructural
Components).
• Enclosure 1A to 11A, 12C to 16C, 12B to 15B (Resin Encapsulated Transformers)
• Enclosure 17D to 31D, 17H to 18H, 17K to 22K, 25J to 31J (Ventilated Transformers)
• Enclosure 17K to 20K with wall mounting bracket (Ventilated Transformres)
• Enclosure 17E to 31E (Non-ventilated Transformers)
• Enclosure MPZ A, AA, B, BB, C, CC (MPZB)
Product is Listed for installation in Hospitals State of California–OSHPD Special Seismic
Certification Preapproval OSP-0023-10.
Accessory Lables–required for Building Inspection–OSHPD
OSP Label Catalog Number Products Enclosure Style
7400CAOSHPDABC Resin encapsulated, buck boost Style A, B, C
transformers
7400CAOSHPDDH Ventilated Type EE, drive isolation, Style D, H
auto-transformers
7400CAOSHPDF Low voltage 750 and 1000 kVA Type Style F
EE
7400CAOSHPDJ Ventilated Type EX Style J
7400CAOSHPDK Ventilated Type EX Style K
7400CAOSHPDKO Ventilated Type EX, wall-mounted Style K with WMB
using Square D brackets
7400CAOSHPDMPZB Mini Power Zone Bolt-on A, AA, B, BB, C, CC
TRANSFORMERS
14
14-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution Mini Power-Zone Unit Substation
Transformers
Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT0901 schneider-electric.us
14-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Resin Encapsulated Three and Single Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Phase Transformers Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7400 / Refer to Catalog 7400CT9601
[15] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[16] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.8 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-8
[17] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.17 Enclosure Dimensions, page 14-12
14
Table 14.16: Single-Phase—110/220 Vac Secondary; 50/60 Hz; cULus Listed (240 x 480 Vac Primary to 120/240 Vac Secondary - 60 Hz
only)
kVA 220 x 440 Primary Weight (lbs)[19] Enclosure[20] Full Capacity Taps Degree C Insulation
Catalog No. Temperature Class
Rise
1 1S67F 21.2 7A 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
2 2S67F 39.1 9A 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
3 3S67F 55.2 10A 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
5 5S67F 135 13B 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
7.5 7S67F 165 13B 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
10 10S67F 165 13B 190/200/208/220 x 380/400/416/440 115 180
Fingersafe™ terminal block cover kits for encapsulated transformers can be used to
meet touch-safe requirements.
Enclosure Kit Catlog Number Description
7A (1 kVA) 7400ENT9 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
9A (2 kVA) 7400ENT11 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
10A (3 kVA) 7400ENT11 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
13B (5–10 kVA) 7400ENT13 Terminal Block H1, H2, H3, H4, H5, H6, H7, H8, H9, H10 and X1, X2, X3, X4
[19] Not for construction, Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for certified prints.
[20] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.17 Enclosure Dimensions, page 14-12
14-12
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Non-Ventilated and Transformer House Low-Voltage Dry-Type Distribution
Transformers
schneider-electric.us
PZC transformer enclosures are shipped separately from transformers so they can be
pre-installed on the job site.
Four standard enclosures of each type material are available for installation of
transformer enclosure types D and H.
Drawings are in the Classic Technical Library. Search by catalog number, which is the
same as the drawing number.
Table 14.21: Stainless Steel Option Table 14.22: Painted Galvanized Option
Catalog No. L W H Weight Enclosure Catalog No. L W H Weight Enclosure
7400SS3R-001 3'-8" 3'-4" 4'-9" 450 lbs 17D, 17H, 18D, 18H, 19D, 20D, 21D, 7400PG3R-001 3'-8" 3'-4" 4'-9" 450 lbs 17D, 17H, 18D, 18H, 19D,
22D 20D, 21D, 22D
7400SS3R-002 4'-6" 3'-9" 6'-0" 500 lbs 24D, 25D, 26D, 36D, 37D 7400PG3R-002 4'-6" 3'-9" 6'-0" 500 lbs 24D, 25D, 26D, 36D, 37D
TRANSFORMERS
7400SS3R-003 5'-8" 4'-1" 7'-0" 550 lbs 28D, 29D, 30D, 38D 7400PG3R-003 5'-8" 4'-1" 7'-0" 550 lbs 28D, 29D, 30D, 38D
7400SS3R-004 6'-4" 4'-9" 7'-10" 600 lbs 31D, 45D 7400PG3R-004 6'-4" 4'-9" 7'-10" 600 lbs 31D, 45D
[23] For enclosure styles, see Table 14.20 Enclosure Dimensions and Accessories, page 14-13
14-13
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Industrial Control Type T and Type TF
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us
Selection Guide
1. Determine the inrush and sealed VA of each coil in the control circuit and the VA of
all other components.
2. Total the sealed VA of all operating coils and the VA of all other loads. (This
determines the minimum VA size required for the circuit.)
3. Total the inrush VA of all coils that are starting at the same time and all loads and
coils that are running.
4. Locate a value in the VA column ofTable 14.23 Regulation Chart for Type T, page
14-14, shown below, that is equal to or greater than the value calculated in step 2.
5. In the VA row selected in step 4, find the inrush value under the appropriate voltage
regulation column ofTable 14.23 Regulation Chart for Type T, page 14-14, shown
below. If this value is greater than the calculated value from step 3, this is the
correct transformer VA rating.
If the inrush value on the selected VA row is not greater than the calculated value
from step 3, use the next higher transformer VA rating, that is, the rating on the next
row.
If your supply voltage is stable and fluctuates less than 5%, Schneider Electric
recommends you use the 90% secondary voltage column. If your supply voltage is not
stable and fluctuates more than 10% we recommend you use the 95% secondary
voltage column. We recommend that you never use the 85% secondary voltage column
since magnetic devices lose life expectancy if they are continuously started at 85% of
rated voltage.
14-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Type T and Type TF Industrial Control
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us
Table 14.24: 240 x 480 V Primary, 120 V Secondary; 230 x 460 V Primary, 115 V Secondary; 220 x 440 V Primary, 110 V Secondary
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D1 9070TF25D1 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D1 9070TF50D1 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D1 9070TF75D1 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D1 9070TF100D1 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D1 9070TF150D1 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D1 9070TF200D1 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D1 9070TF250D1 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D1 9070TF300D1 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D1 9070TF350D1 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D1 9070TF500D1 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D1 9070TF750D1 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D1 9070TF1000D1 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D1 9070TF1500D1 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D1 9070TF2000D1 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D1 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D1 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2
[1] TF units are design for line to line voltages on the primary, 277 Vac is a line to neutral voltage.
14-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Industrial Control Type T and Type TF
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us
Table 14.28: 240 x 480 V Primary, 120/240 V Secondary; 230 x 460 V Primary, 115/230 V Secondary; 220 x 440 V Primary, 110/220 V
Secondary
VA Type T Type TF[2] Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
25 25 9070T25D31 9070TF25D31 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
50 50 9070T50D31 9070TF50D31 2.5 2.58 66 4.00 102 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D31 9070TF75D31 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D31 9070TF100D31 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D31 9070TF150D31 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D31 9070TF200D31 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D31 9070TF250D31 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D31 9070TF300D31 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D31 9070TF350D31 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D31 9070TF500D31 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D31 9070TF750D31 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D31 9070TF1000D31 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D31 9070TF1500D31 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D31 9070TF2000D31 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D31 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D31 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2
[2] TF designed for line to line primary and line to neutral secondary. If secondary connected in series, fuse block should be disconnected.
14-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Type T and Type TF Industrial Control
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us
Table 14.33: 240/480/600 V Primary, 120 V Secondary; 230/460/575 V Primary, 115 V Secondary; 220/440/550 V Primary to 110 V
Secondary
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D32 9070TF50D32 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D32 9070TF75D32 3.8 2.89 73 4.18 106 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D32 9070TF100D32 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D32 9070TF150D32 5.5 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D32 9070TF200D32 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
250 160 9070T250D32 9070TF250D32 8.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D32 9070TF300D32 10.5 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D32 9070TF350D32 11.9 3.84 98 5.13 130 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D32 9070TF500D32 11.0 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
750 500 9070T750D32 9070TF750D32 20.6 4.51 115 5.80 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D32 9070TF1000D32 34.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D32 9070TF1500D32 47.0 6.17 157 7.46 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D32 9070TF2000D32 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D32 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2
Table 14.34: 240/416/480/600 Vac Primary, 99/120/130 Vac Secondary; 230/400/460/575 Vac Primary, 95/115/125 Vac Secondary;
220/380/440/550 Vac Primary, 90/110/120 Vac Secondary; 208/360/416/520 Vac Primary, 85/104/115 Vac Secondary
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D50 9070TF50D50 4.0 2.89 73 4.19 106 3.38 86 4.43 113 FSC23
75 75 9070T75D50 9070TF75D50 7.2 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 4.70 119 FSC23
100 100 9070T100D50 9070TF100D50 7.1 3.20 81 4.50 114 3.75 95 4.70 119 FSC23
150 150 9070T150D50 9070TF150D50 8.5 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC23
200 200 9070T200D50 9070TF200D50 10.5 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC23
250 160 9070T250D50 9070TF250D50 10.5 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC23
300 200 9070T300D50 9070TF300D50 11.9 3.84 98 5.14 131 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC23
350 250 9070T350D50 9070TF350D50 11.0 4.51 115 5.81 148 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC23
500 300 9070T500D50 9070TF500D50 11.0 4.51 115 5.81 148 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC23
750 500 9070T750D50 9070TF750D50 20.6 4.51 115 5.81 148 5.25 133 6.3. 160 FSC23
1000 630 9070T1000D50 9070TF1000D50 34.0 6.17 157 7.47 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC23
1500 1000 9070T1500D50 9070TF1500D50 47.0 6.17 157 7.47 190 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC23
2000 1500 9070T2000D50 9070TF2000D50 60.0 7.63 194 8.93 227 9.00 229 6.38 162 FSC23
Table 14.35: 240 x 480 Vac Primary, 120/24 Vac Secondary (24 Vac limited to 20% of nameplate VA)
VA Type T Type TF Weight Height Width Depth Acceso-
Type T Type TF ry
Finger-
UL/CSA/NOM CE Catalog No. in. mm in. mm in. mm in. mm safe
Covers
50 50 9070T50D15 — 2.5 2.58 66 — — 3.00 76 3.09 79 FSC1
75 75 9070T75D15 — 3.8 2.89 73 — — 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
100 100 9070T100D15 — 3.8 2.89 73 — — 3.38 86 3.34 85 FSC1
150 150 9070T150D15 — 5.5 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
200 200 9070T200D15 — 5.5 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 3.59 91 FSC1
250 160 9070T250D15 — 7.1 3.20 81 — — 3.75 95 5.30 135 FSC2
300 200 9070T300D15 — 8.5 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 4.74 120 FSC2
350 250 9070T350D15 — 10.5 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 5.11 130 FSC2
500 300 9070T500D15 — 11.9 3.84 98 — — 4.50 114 5.49 139 FSC2
TRANSFORMERS
750 500 9070T750D15 — 11.0 4.51 115 — — 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC2
1000 630 9070T1000D15 — 20.6 4.51 115 — — 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC2
1500 1000 9070T1500D15 — 34.0 6.17 157 — — 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC2
2000 1500 9070T2000D15 — 47.0 6.17 157 — — 7.06 179 7.17 182 FSC2
3000 2000 9070T3000D15 — 60.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 7.24 184 FSC2
5000 3000 9070T5000D15 — 89.0 8.75 222 — — 9.00 229 9.15 232 FSC2
14-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Industrial Control Type T and Type TF
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT9901
schneider-electric.us
500 300 9070T500D19 11.0 4.51 147 5.25 133 5.61 143 FSC23
750 500 9070T750D19 20.6 4.51 147 5.25 133 6.30 160 FSC23
1000 630 9070T1000D19 34.0 6.17 190 7.06 179 5.92 150 FSC23
14-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Transformer Disconnects Industrial Control
Class 9070 / Refer to Catalog 9070CT0301
schneider-electric.us
TRANSFORMERS
14
14-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Instrument, 600 Volt Class Voltage and Current Transformers
Class 4210 / Refer to Catalog 4210CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Voltage Transformers
Schneider Electric offers three models of voltage transformers, each suited for a
particular application:
• Model 450R
– Applications requiring accurate voltage measurement within the 0.3% accuracy
class
– Switchboards with 1% instrumentation
• Model 460R
– Applications with less critical accuracy and low burden requirements
– Transducers and other panelboard monitoring
• Model 470R
– Extremely accurate voltage measurement
– Low burden applications, such as PLC modules and similar, high-impedance
electronic devices
Current Transformers
Current transformers are low cost, compact units that offer good electrical performance
in a general purpose transformer.
• They are very easy to mount on the conductors.
• All current transformers feature permanent polarity marks molded into the case.
The following types of current transformers are available:
• General purpose
• Toroidal (single ratio)
• Rectangle window (single ratio)
• Split core
• Bushing (single ratio) (multi-ratio)
For part numbers, see Section 6 of the Supplemental Digest or see the Schneider
Electric Product Configurator.
Contact your local Schneider Electric representative for other available features.
312R — X 600–4000
4.50 114
202R — X X 100–1000
5.25 133 203R — X — 100–3000
5.75 146 120R — X — 200–3000
6.25 159 210R — X X 200–3000
151R — X 600–4000
6.88 175
152R — X X 50–4000
8.13 206 140R — X X 50–6000
2.12 x 4.25 54 x 108 260R X — — 100–4000
TRANSFORMERS
Table 14.45: New! Standard Efficiency Levels for Liquid Immersed Distribution
Transformers
Power Cast II™
Single Phase Three Phase
kVA Efficiency % kVA Efficiency %
10 98.7 — —
15 98.82 — —
25 98.95 45 98.92
37.5 99.05 75 99.03
50 99.11 112.5 99.11
75 99.19 150 99.16
100 99.25 225 99.23
167 99.33 300 99.27
250 99.39 500 99.35
333 99.43 750 99.4
500 99.49 1000 99.43
667 99.52 1500 99.48
833 99.55 2000 99.51
Liquid Filled Pad Mounted — — 2500 99.53
All Efficiency values are at 50% of nameplate-rated load, determined according to the
DOE Test Procedure 10 CFR 431, Subpart K, Appendix A.
Table 14.46: New! Standard Levels for Medium Voltage Dry Type Distribution
Transformers
kVA Single Phase kVA Three Phase
20-45kV 46-95 kV >/ 96 kV 20-45kV 46-95 kV >/ 96 kV
BIL BIL BIL BIL BIL BIL
Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency Efficiency
% % % % % %
15 98.1 97.86 — 45 98.1 97.86 —
25 98.33 98.12 — 75 98.33 98.13 —
37.5 98.49 98.3 — 112.5 98.52 98.36 —
50 98.6 98.42 — 150 98.65 98.51 —
75 98.73 98.57 98.53 225 98.82 98.69 98.57
Liquid Filled Substation
100 98.82 98.67 98.63 300 98.93 98.81 98.69
167 98.96 98.83 98.8 500 99.09 98.99 98.89
250 99.07 98.95 98.91 750 99.21 99.12 99.02
333 99.14 99.03 98.99 1000 99.28 99.2 99.11
500 99.22 99.12 99.09 1500 99.37 99.3 99.21
667 99.27 99.18 99.15 2000 99.43 99.36 99.28
833 99.31 99.23 99.2 2500 99.47 99.41 99.33
NOTE: BIL means Basic Impulse Level.
NOTE: All Efficiency values are at 50% of nameplate-rated load, determined
according to the DOE Test Procedure 10 CFR 431, Subpart K, Appendix A.
TRANSFORMERS
14
14-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage
Distribution Transformers
Class 7432 schneider-electric.us
Table 14.47: New! EX Three Phase Medium Voltage Transformers Table 14.48: New! Three Phase Voltage Codes
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Weight (lbs) Enclosure kV Class Code Primary Secondary
Efficiency @ 50% 13 2400 Delta 208Y/120
load
14 2400 Delta 480Y/277
2.4 kV and 5 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150oC Rise 2.4
15 2400 Delta 240 Delta
112.5 EX112T( )H 98.52 1200 50D 30 kV BIL
16 2400 Delta 480 Delta
150 EX150T( )H 98.65 1400 51D 17 2400 Delta 600 Delta
225 EX225T( )H 98.82 1900 51D 18 4160 Delta 208Y/120
300 EX300T( )H 98.93 2100 52D 19 4160 Delta 480Y/277
500 EX500T( )H 99.09 3000 52D 20 4160 Delta 240 Delta
21 4160 Delta 480 Delta
750 EX750T( )H 99.21 5000 55F
22 4160 Delta 600 Delta
1000 EX1000T( )H 99.28 6000 56F 23 4160Y/2400 240 Delta
1500 EX1500T( )H 99.37 8100 56F 5 25 4160Y/2400 480 Delta
30 kV BIL
2000 EX2000T( )H 99.43 11000 57F 26 4160/2400 600 Delta
2500 EX2500T( )H 99.47 13100 58F 27 4800 Delta 208Y/120
15 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150oC Rise 28 4800 Delta 480Y/277
29 4800 Delta 240 Delta
112.5 EX112T( )H 98.36 2000 52D
30 4800 Delta 480 Delta
150 EX150T( )H 98.51 2200 52D 31 4800 Delta 600 Delta
225 EX225T( )H 98.69 2800 53D 32 7200 Delta 208Y/120
300 EX300T( )H 98.81 3300 53D 33 7200 Delta 480Y/277
500 EX500T( )H 98.99 5000 54F 34 7200 Delta 240 Delta
750 EX750T( )H 99.12 6000 55F 35 7200 Delta 480 Delta
36 7200 Delta 600 Delta
1000 EX1000T( )H 99.2 7400 56F
37 12000 Delta 208Y/120
1500 EX1500T( )H 99.3 9000 56F 38 12000 Delta 480Y/277
2000 EX2000T( )H 99.36 11000 57F 39 12000 Delta 240 Delta
2500 EX2500T( )H 99.41 13000 58F 40 12000 Delta 480 Delta
3000 EX3000T( )H — 18000 58F 41 12000 Delta 600 Delta
42 12470 Delta 208Y/120
43 12470 Delta 480Y/277
44 12470 Delta 240 Delta
45 12470 Delta 480 Delta
46 12470 Delta 600 Delta
15
47 12470Y/7200 240 Delta
60 kV BIL
48 12470Y/7200 480 Delta
49 12470Y/7200 600 Delta
50 13200 Delta 208Y/120
51 13200 Delta 480Y/277
52 13200 Delta 240 Delta
53 13200 Delta 480 Delta
54 13200 Delta 600 Delta
55 13200Y/7620 240 Delta
56 13200Y/7620 480 Delta
57 13200Y/7620 600 Delta
58 13800 Delta 208Y/120
59 13800 Delta 480Y/277
60 13800 Delta 240 Delta
61 13800 Delta 480 Delta
62 13800 Delta 600 Delta
All secondary voltages are at 10 KV BIL (BIL means Basic Impulse Level).
2. Insert the voltage code number in place of the ( ) in the catalog number.
Example 1: 1,000 kVA Energy Efficient, 3Ø, 60 Hz, 150oC temp. rise, 60 kV BIL, NEMA sound level, ventilated
indoor enclosure, 13.2 kV delta 480Y/277, with 2-2.5% full capacity taps. 2AN and 2BN = EX1000T51H .
Example 2: 750 KVA Energy Efficient 3Ø, 60 Hz, 80oC temp. rise, 60 kV BIL, NEMA sound level, ventilated indoor
enclosure, 4160 V Delta, 480Y/277, 2-2.5% full capacity taps. 2AN and 2BN = Part number EX750T19HB.
Example 3: 500 kVA Energy Efficient, 3Ø, 60 Hz, 115oC temp. rise, Copper Windings, 60 kV BIL, NEMA sound level,
ventilated indoor enclosure, 12470 Vac delta, 208Y/120, with 2-2.5% full capacity taps. 2AN and 2BN =
EX500T42BCU.
TRANSFORMERS
14-22
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV
Distribution Transformers
schneider-electric.us Class 7432
1,201–15,000 Vac Single-Phase Indoor Transformers
Table 14.49: New! EX Single Phase Medium Voltage Transformers
kVA Catalog No. Minimum Weight Enclosure
Efficiency @ (lbs)
50% load
2.4 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150 oC Rise
167 EX167S( )H 98.96 1500 51D
250 EX250S( )H 99.07 2200 52D
333 EX333S( )H 99.14 2500 52D
5 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150 oC Rise
167 EX167S( )H 99.07 1500 52D
250 EX250S( )H 99.14 2400 52D
333 EX333S( )H 99.22 3000 53D
15 kV Voltage Class 60 Hz 150 oC Rise
167 EX167S( )H 98.95 2400 52D
250 EX250S( )H 99.03 3400 53D
333 EX333S( )H 99.12 4000 53D
Lugs: Furnished by customer.
Example: 167 kVA Energy Efficient 1Ø 2400/4160Y-120/240 Vac, 1Ø 60 Hz unit is EX167S13H. The unit would be
supplied with 2–2.5% above and 2–2.5% full capacity below normal taps on the primary.
Enclosures
Table 14.51: New! Enclosure Dimensions
Enclosure Number/ Style Height Width Depth Mounting NEMA 3R
in. mm in. mm in. mm
50 D 40.5 1029 36.5 927 21.75 552 Floor n/a consult
factory
51 D 51.5 1308 40.5 1029 26.5 673 Floor n/a consult
factory
52 D 66 1676 50.5 1283 32 813 Floor n/a consult
factory
53 D 80 2032 64 1626 44 1118 Floor n/a consult
factory
54 F 90 2286 72 1829 50 1270 Floor n/a consult
factory
55 F 90 2286 80 2032 50 1270 Floor n/a consult
factory
Style D, NEMA 1 Rated 56 F 90 2286 90 2286 50 1270 Floor n/a consult
factory
57 F 100 2540 100 2540 60 1524 Floor n/a consult
factory
58 F 108 2743 108 2743 60 1524 Floor n/a consult
factory
TRANSFORMERS
These dimensions are not for construction. Contact your local Schneider Electric sales
office for certified prints.
Special outdoor construction required for NEMA 3R applications. Contact your local
Schneider Electric sales office for details.
14-23
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Energy Efficient, Dry Type 2.4, 5, and 15 kV New! Energy Efficient Medium Voltage
Distribution Transformers
Class 7432 schneider-electric.us
14
TRANSFORMERS
14-24
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 15
MEDICAL PRODUCTS
Medical Products
Line Isolation Monitor (LIM) 15-2
IG2000P 15-3
IG2000CBM 15-3
Isolated Power Panels 15-4
Accessories 15-5
15
Receptacle Modules for Controlled Panels 15-5
Hospital Ground Cords and Jacks 15-5
Ordering Information 15-6
11/10/2017
Line Isolation Monitor (LIM) Iso-Gard™ Series 6
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4805CT1301
15
schneider-electric.us
15-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
IG2000 Series Remote Alarm Indicators
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
schneider-electric.us
NEC® Requirement
MEDICAL PRODUCTS
The National Electrical Code® (NEC®) requires audible and visual alarm indication
where isolation power is used (NEC 517-160). Schneider Electric offers the IG2000P and
IG2000CBM remote alarm indicators for this purpose.
IG2000P
The Iso-Gard™ IG2000P remote indicator from Schneider Electric provides remote
indication of the visible and audible alarms from a line isolation monitor (LIM).
• Green LED—stays illuminated while the system is in normal condition
• Red hazard LED—illuminates when the Total Hazard Current (THC) exceeds the
preset alarm level
• Audible hazard alarm—sounds when the THC exceeds the preset alarm level
Mute button with yellow LED—silences the audible alarm on the remote indicator
(local muting), or silences all audible alarms in the system (system muting)
15
• Test button—remotely performs a functional test of the LIM
The IG2000P remote indicator is available mounted in a one- or two-gang stainless steel
faceplate for flush mounting into a panel or wall box with a two-inch minimum depth. The
basic electrical connection is made using three wires.
IG2000CBM
The Iso-Gard™ IG2000CBM remote indicator from Schneider Electric provides remote
indication of the visible and audible alarms and digital mA reading from an Iso-Gard
Series 6 (IG6) line isolation monitor (LIM).
• Green LED—stays illuminated while the system is in normal condition
• Red hazard LED—illuminates when the Total Hazard Current (THC) exceeds the
preset alarm level
• Audible hazard alarm—sounds when the THC exceeds the preset alarm level
Mute button with yellow LED—silences the audible alarm on the remote indicator
(local muting), or silences all audible alarms in the system (system muting)
• Test button—remotely performs a functional test of the LIM
The IG2000CBM remote indicator is available mounted in a two-gang stainless steel
faceplate for flush mounting into a wall box with a two-inch minimum depth. The basic
electrical connection is made using four wires.
15-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Isolated Power Panels Panel Layout Types
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
15
schneider-electric.us
Overview
Incoming powe r
(customer conne ction)
Isolated power panels provide a small local electrical network that can be monitored from
a line isolation monitor (LIM), allowing for predictive ground fault protection instead of
MEDICAL PRODUCTS
reactive.
A typical isolated power system contains:
• Main disconnect
Electrostatic shi e ld
connected to pa ne l
– QO circuit breaker (120 V, 208 V, 240 V)
Main
circuit
ground bus – H-Frame circuit breaker (277 V, 480 V)
breaker
Panel
• Standard isolation panels
ground • Duplex panels
bus
• Dual voltage panels
• Controlled panels
Standard Isolation Panels
Standard panels offer the most compact solution for a single isolated power system
feeding one operating room.
120 V Distribution
• Available in four options: 3, 5, 7.5, or 10 kVA
• Up to 16 branch circuits
208 V (240 V) Distribution
• Available in four options: 3, 5, 7.5, or 10 kVA
• One or two branch circuits
Duplex Panels
Duplex panels offer two isolated power systems in a single panel. The systems are
separated from each other by a barrier. Duplex panels provide the ability to mix and
match the two systems for kVA and distribution voltage to help the designer maximize
wall space while meeting the power requirements of the operating room(s).
Dual Voltage Panels
Dual voltage panels supply both 120 V and 208 V (240 V) isolated power to an operating
room.
• Back box requires a 14–inch-deep wall
• Each panel supplies up to sixteen 120 V circuits, plus two 208 V branch circuits
The standard offering includes the following:
• One 30 A, 208 V circuit for equipment such as a laser receptacle
• One 50 A, 208 V circuit for equipment such as an X-ray receptacle
Controlled Panels
Controlled panels are designed to provide 208 V (240 V) of isolated power to multiple
areas from one central location. Historically, they were used to retrofit operating rooms
with 208 V. A programmable logic controller (PLC) lets the panel be designed to feed
multiple load location, but only provide power to specific power modules. This helps
prevent overloading of the system. Since the PLC limits the number of circuits, only the
longest-possible conductor length is taken into account during start-up testing.
15-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Power/Ground Modules, Ground Cords Accessories
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
schneider-electric.us
Schneider Electric offers 208 V or 240 V modules designed to complete the control circuit
MEDICAL PRODUCTS
of a controlled power panel.
Receptacle Modules for Controlled Panels
X-ray/laser power receptacle modules provide a convenient source of power for portable
X-ray and laser equipment. The receptacle provided in each module is matched to the
NEMA plug configuration of the equipment with which it will be used, and is mounted
behind the door on the stainless steel face plate. The door features a concealed hinge
and a touch latch.
15
Power/Ground Modules
When both ground jacks and power receptacles are required, these UL Listed modules
offer convenience and save labor in field wiring. The units include four power
receptacles, four twist-to-lock ground jacks, and a ground bus with a generous number of
lugs for external ground connections.
The main ground connection in the module accommodates up to a #1/0 cable. The units
are completely factory wired; only field power connections and ground connections are
necessary. They are furnished with Type 304, brushed stainless steel face plates.
Ground Cord with Lug End Ground Cord with Clip End
15-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Ordering Information Standard Panels
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
15
schneider-electric.us
LIM Circuit
Included Main Breakers
kVA Primary Secondary Catalog No. (field- (factory- Spaces Catalog No. Flush Surface Flush Surface
Disconnect
installed) installed)
Plug-on Circuit Breakers
208 V SXM03BA SIP03BA
Iso-Gard QOU220 Eight
3 240 V 120 V SXM03CA Eight 2-pole SIP03CA ST4526 ST4324 SB432406 SB432406S
Series 6 QO220
277 V SXM03DA HDL26015 SIP03DA
208 V SXM05BA SIP05BA
QOU230
240 V SXM05CA Iso-Gard Eight SIP05CA
5 120 V Eight 2-pole ST4526 ST4324 SB432406 SB432406S
277 V SXM05DA Series 6 HDL26025 QO220 SIP05DA
480 V SXM05EA HDL26015 SIP05EA
208 V SXM07BA QOU245 SIP07BA
240 V SXM07CA Iso-Gard QOU240 Eight SIP07CA
7.5 120 V Eight 2-pole ST4526 ST4324 SB432408 SB432408S
277 V SXM07DA Series 6 HDL26035 QO220 SIP07DA
480 V SXM07EA HDL26020 SIP07EA
208 V SXM10BA SIP10BA
QOU260
240 V SXM10CA Iso-Gard Eight SIP10CA
10 120 V Eight 2-pole ST4526 ST4324 SB432408 SB432408S
277 V SXM10DA Series 6 HDL26045 QO220 SIP10DA
480 V SXM10EA HDL26030 SIP10EA
15-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Table of Contents
Section 16
NEMA and Definite Purpose Contactors and
Starters
Selection Information 16-2
16
Reversing Vacuum Contactors, Full Voltage 16-64
Accessories 16-124
11/10/2017
Selection Information NEMA and Definite Purpose Contactors
and Starters
Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201 schneider-electric.us
Selection Information
16
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 T02, T36 8502 & 8702 8536 & 8736 8538 & 8738
NEMA Style, Full Voltage Non-Reversing and Full Voltage Reversing
Manual Starters and Switches, Combination Magnetic
Type of Product Non-Reversing, Reversing and TeSys™ N AC Magnetic Contactors AC Magnetic Starters Starters with
Two Speed Contactors and Starters
Disconnect Switch
M-0 8538: 0– 6
NEMA Sizes M-1 00–7 00–7 00–7 8738: 0–5
M-1P
UL File E42243 NLRV Contactors: UL File E164862 UL File E78351 NLDX UL File E78351 NLDX UL File E152395 NKJH7
NLDX
UR File E42243 NLRV2 CSA LR43364 Class 3211-24 CSA 60905 Class 3211-04 CSA 60905 Class 3211-04 CSA LR584 Class 3211 04
Approvals Starters: UL File E152395 NKJH
CSA File LR 25490 CSA LR60905 Class 3211-24 CE IEC 947-4-1 CE IEC 947-4-1
Sizes 00–5 Only Sizes 00–5 Only
16-2
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
NEMA and Definite Purpose Contactors Selection Information
and Starters
schneider-electric.us Class 4800 / Refer to Catalog 4800CT1201
Selection Information
16
Breaker switches or PowerPact™ and Starter or PowerPact™ circuit
configurations to 3 poles. circuit breakers Configurations also breakers. disconnecting means.
available.
Load
Voltage 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max. 600 Vac Max.
Melting Alloy N/A N/A Melting Alloy (8911) Melting Alloy Melting Alloy
Overload Relay Bimetallic
(Size 0–1) Bimetallic Bimetallic
Solid State Solid State Solid State
UL File E152395 NKJH7 UL File E78427 NRNT UL File E16151 NRNT UL E3190 NLDX2 UL/cUL 152395 NKJH UL File E152395
Approvals CSA LR584 CSA LR60905 cUL File E16151 NRNT CSA LR25490 NKJH7
Class 3211 04 Class 3231 01 Class 3211 04
16-3
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Manual Starters, Type F—Fractional
Horsepower
Class 2510, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701 schneider-electric.us
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG1P FGJ1P FF1P FS1P FSJ1P — — FO1P 1
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
Toggle
Standard FG2 FGJ2 FF2 FS2 — — — FO2 1
2
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG2P FGJ2P FF2P FS2P FSJ2P — — FO2P 1
Standard FG3 FGJ3 FF3 FS3 — — — FO3 1
1
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG3P FGJ3P FF3P FS3P FSJ3P — — FO3P 1
Key
Standard FG4 FGJ4 FF4 FS4 — — — FO4 1
2 With Red Pilot Light [2] FG4P FGJ4P FF4P FS4P FSJ4P — — FO4P 1
Starter with Handle Guard/Lock-Off—Class 2510
Standard FG5 FGJ5 FW1 FR1 [3] [4] 1
1
With Red Pilot Light [2] FG5P FGJ5P Order basic starter plus FW1P — [3] [4] 1
Toggle
Standard FG6 FGJ6 separate handle guard kit. FW2 FR2 [3] [4] 1
2 With Red Pilot Light [2] FG6P FGJ6P FW2P — [3] [4] 1
[1] Furnished with one 3/4" pipe tap in the bottom (reversible for top feed). For a 3/4" pipe tap in the top and bottom, add the suffix H to the Type.
[2] For a green pilot light, add the letter G to the catalog number (i.e. 2510FG2PG).
[3] For a replacement starter, order the Open type above.
[4] When replacing a starter equipped with a pilot light in NEMA 4 enclosure, retain the pilot light mounting bracket from the original device.
16-4
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Switches, 30 A—Type K Manual Starters and Switches
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
schneider-electric.us
16
Table 16.7: Reversing—Class 2511
NEMA 1 With Flush Plate for
General Purpose Replacement
Operator Suitable for Features Cavity Mounting Switch
No. of Poles Enclosure (Without Pull Box)
Style Motor Types (Including Mechanical Interlock) Surface Mounting Class 2510
Type Type Type
Table 16.9: Class 2511 and 2512 Horsepower Ratings Type K Table 16.10: Class 2510 Horsepower Ratings
Maximum DC Hp Maximum DC Hp
No. of Motor Type Maximum Hp Maximum Hp (breaking 2 poles)
Device (breaking 2 poles) Class No. of Motor
Poles AC 2510 Poles Type AC
115 V 230 V 460–575 V 90 V 115 V 230 V 115 230 460 575 90 V 115 V 230 V
Class 2 1Ø 2 2 3 V V V V
2511 3 3Ø 2 7-1/2 10 KO1 Single Ø
KO3 2 2 2 3 3
2 1Ø 2 2 3
KO2
3 Ø, KO4 3 Three Ø 2 7-1/2 10 10 1 2 1-1/2
1 2 1-1/2
Class 3 Constant or 2 7-1/2 10
Variable Torque KO5 2 Single Ø 2 3 7-1/2 10
2512
3 Ø, KO6 3 Three Ø 2 7-1/2 15 20
3 Constant Hp 2 7-1/2 10 Continuous current rating 30 A at 600 Vac maximum 30 A at 24 Vdc maximum
Continuous current rating 30 A at 600 Vac maximum 30 A at 24 Vdc maximum
Table 16.11: How to Order
To Order Specify: Catalog Number
• Class Number Class Type
• Type Number 2510 KO2
[5] Furnished with one 3/4" pipe tap in the bottom (reversible for top feed). For a 3/4" pipe tap in the top and bottom, add the suffix H to the Type.
[6] For a green pilot light, add the letter G to the catalog number (i.e. 2510FG2PG)
[7] When replacing a starter equipped with a pilot light in NEMA 4 enclosure, retain the pilot light mounting bracket from the original device.
16-5
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Type F and K—Approximate Dimensions
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
schneider-electric.us
Open Type
Mtg. Holes for #6-32 Screws (2)
Pilot Light Mtg. Holes For #6-32 Screws (2)
Pilot Light
1.69
OFF
43 1.69
.84
OFF
43
21 .84
21
16
2.38
60 2.38
3.28
83 3.28 60
4.13
105 4.13 83
105
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
2.22
2.34
56
60
1.59 1.70
40
43
16-6
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Approximate Dimensions—Type F and K Manual Starters and Switches
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
schneider-electric.us
6.36
161
Table 16.15: NEMA 1 General Purpose Surface Mount Enclosure for Duplex
Pilot
Light Devices
3.00 Type of Type
OFF OFF 76 Device Operator Class
16
4.25 Toggle 2510 FGO2, 02P
108 One Starter
Key 2510 FGO4P
Toggle 2510 FG22, 22P
Two Starters
2.75 .38 1.88 1.88
0.56 2.56 Key 2510 FG44P
70 10 48 48 65
4.50 14 Toggle
2.88
114
2.63 One Starter and 2510 FG71, 71P, 72, 72P
73 67
3.81 One Selector Switch[8] Key 2510 FG74P
97
Reversing Switch[9] Toggle 2511 KG11, 11A, 11B, 22, 22A, 22B, 22C
Two-Speed Starter Toggle 2512 FG11, 11P, 22, 22P
1.06 Two-Speed Switch Toggle 2512 KG11, 11A, 11B, 22, 22B, 22C
27
0.5–0.75 Conduit Knockout, Both Ends Table 16.16: General Purpose Flush Mounting Plate for Duplex Devices
Type of Dimensions[10]
Device Class Type
Operator A B C D
FF22, 22P 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.44
Toggle 2510
Two FS22P 4.56 3.5 4.5 1.44
Starters FF44P 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.44
Key 2510
FS44P 4.56 3.5 4.5 1.44
One FF71, 71P, 72, 72P 5.25 0.75 5.25 2
Toggle 2510
2.56 OFF OFF C Starter FS71P, 72P 4.56 3.5 4.5 2
and One
65 Selector Key
FF74P 5.25 3.75 5.25 2
2510
Switch[11] FS74P 4.56 3.5 4.5 2
KF11, 11A, 11B
Reversing Toggle KF22, 22A
2511 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.75
Switch KF22B, 22C
A Pilot Two-Speed Toggle 2512 FF11, 11P, 22, 22P 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.44
Light Starter
Two-Speed Toggle KF11, 11A, 11B,
Switch 2512 KF22, 22B, 22C 5.25 3.75 5.25 1.75
.75
D
19
.91
23 B
[8] Selector switch is on the left and increases the overall depth to 3.5 in.
[9] Only one pilot light (located on right) is used on Class 2511 switches.
[10] Dimensions include factory wired power connections.
[11] Selector Switch is on left, extends 1-5/8" from mounting surface.
16-7
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Manual Starters, Type M and T—Integral
Horsepower
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701 schneider-electric.us
Integral Horsepower
Types M and T integral horsepower manual starters provide
convenient On-Off operation of small single phase, polyphase or DC
motors. Typical applications include small machine tools, pumps, fans
and conveyors.
• Push button (M) or toggle (T) operators
• Reliable overload protection
16
Table 16.17: Integral Horsepower Manual Starters (see Thermal Unit Selection, page 16-130)
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
[12] NEMA 7 & 9 enclosures are cast iron. NEMA 7 & 9 cast aluminum enclosures are also available; to order, replace the R in the catalog number with a T. For additional information, contact the
Customer Care Center.
[13] Approved for group motor installations per NEC 430-53(c).
16-8
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters, Type M and T—Integral Manual Starters and Switches
Horsepower
schneider-electric.us Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
Reversing and Two Speed
Class 2511 reversing and Class 2512 two-speed manual starters consist of two
mechanically interlocked Class 2510 Types M or T manual starters.
Table 16.20: Two Speed, Class 2512 (Wye-Connected Separate Winding Motors Only)
Ratings NEMA 1 Open Type
Surface Mounting
Number
Description NEMA Constant
Class of Size Square Square
Poles Motor Constant Torque or Toggle Toggle
Voltage P.B. P.B.
Hp Variable Operator Operator Operator Operator
Torque
200-230 2 3
M-0 MBG1 TBG1 MBO1 TBO1
380-575 3 5
2512 Standard 3-Pole
200-230 5 7-1/2
M-1 MCG1 TCG1 MCO1 TCO1
380-575 7-1/2 10
Thermal Units
Starters will not operate without properly installed thermal units and device reset.
16
Thermal unit must be installed so that markings face the front of starter.
Application Data
Size–Available in NEMA Sizes M-0, M-1, and M-1P.
Poles–Two poles single phase; three poles polyphase; 2 poles DC.
Voltage–600 Vac max.; 250 Vdc max.
Overload Relays–Melting alloy thermal overload relays have provisions for one Type B
thermal unit for single phase starters and three Type B thermal units for three phase
starters. All thermal units must be installed and the device reset before the starter
contacts will operate. After overload relays have tripped, allow one or two minutes for
the alloy to solidify before resetting.
Operator–Available with a push button or toggle operator in open and NEMA 1 versions.
NEMA 4/4X (stainless) and 12 versions utilize a direct acting push button only.
NEMA 4/4X (polyester) and 7/9 versions utilize an external toggle to actuate a push
button device inside.
Maintenance of Equipment
For proper performance, all equipment should be periodically inspected and maintained.
Replacement contacts and interlocks are available in kit form to facilitate servicing and
stocking. In addition, the service bulletin contains an exploded view of the device with
components clearly marked for easy identification by description and part number.
Mechanism Lock Off – Both open devices and starters in NEMA 1 surface and flush
mounting, and NEMA 4, 4X, 7 & 9, and 12 enclosures can be locked in the Off or Stop
position.
The NEMA 1 surface mounting, 4, 4X, 7 & 9, and 12 enclosures can also be locked
closed to prevent unauthorized entry.
16-9
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Manual Starters and Switches Manual Starters, Type M and T—Integral
Horsepower
Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701 schneider-electric.us
Approximate Dimensions
3.50 .28
1.75 89 7 4.03
44 102
1.25
32
START
5.13
16
STOP
130
RESET
5.72
1.13 145
29
.44 Travel to
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
.28 Dia.
(3) .5 -.75 K.O. .22
Top and Bottom 6
Mtg. Holes
START START
1.69
.75 43 1.28
7.25 19
3.38 33
184 86
8.94 .84
227 21
Class 2510 Type M & T Size M-1P Class 2510 Types M & T Sizes M-0 and M-1 Class 2510 Type M Sizes M-0, M-1 and M-1P
NEMA 1 General Purpose Enclosure NEMA 1 General Purpose Enclosure NEMA 4/4X Watertight Stainless Steel Enclosure
Approximate Shipping Weight: 5 lb Approximate Shipping Weight: 5 lb NEMA 12 Dusttight Industrial Use Enclosure
Approximate Shipping Weight: 9 lb
Class 2510 Type M Size M-0 (AC–DC) Class 2510 Type M Sizes M-1 and M-1P (AC) Class 2510 Type M Sizes M-0, M-1 and M-1P
and Size M-1 (DC) NEMA 4/4X NEMA 4/4X Watertight Corrosion-Resistant NEMA 7 & 9 Hazardous Location
Watertight Corrosion-Resistant Glass Polyester Enclosure Cast Iron Enclosure
Glass Polyester Enclosure Approximate Shipping Weight—6 lb Approximate Shipping Weight—18 lb
Approximate Shipping Weight—6 lb
16-10
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories, Modifications, and Manual Starters and Switches
Replacement Parts
schneider-electric.us Class 2510, 2511, 2512 / Refer to Catalog 2510CT9701
Table 16.24: Accessories—Class 2510 Table 16.25: Pilot Light Kits—Class 2510 Types F and K
Red Pilot Light Green Pilot Light
Types F and K Application Voltage
Class & Type Class & Type
Description Class & Type 110–120 Vac 9999PL11 9999PL11G
Handle Guard Kit with Padlock Provision [18] 2510FL1 Type KF, KG, KW [19] 208–277 Vac 9999PL12 9999PL12G
Emergency Off Actuator 2510PB1 440–600 Vac 9999PL13 9999PL13G
Additional Key for Key Operated Devices 2510FK1 Type FF, FG, FW [19] 115–240 Vac/dc 9999PL10 9999PL10G
16
1-3/4" x 2-13/16" Nameplate Standard commercial switch (Blank) FN1 — FN2 —
with Embossed Mounting Holes box cover or flush plate, including
for #6 Oval Head Screws Square D stainless steel plates (Special marking –specify the marking desired) FN5 — FN6 —
(Blank) FN10 FN20 FN30 FN40
High FN11 FN21 FN31 FN41
1-29/32" x 3-27/32" Square D NEMA 1 Low FN12 FN22 FN32 FN42
Flat Nameplate surface mounted enclosure
with Mounting Holes Forward FN13 — — —
or gray flush plate
for #6 Pan Head Screws Reverse FN14 FN24 — —
(Special marking—specify the marking desired) FN15 FN25 FN35 FN45
Contact Kits
See page 16-122 for Class 9998 Replacement Contact Kits.
[14] May only be field-added to NEMA 1 enclosures. For green pilot light, order 9999SPG1 additionally.
[15] Form P11 pilot lights require a voltage code. Refer to Table 16.22. Catalog number example: 2510MBG1V02P11.
[16] For proper operation, only one auxiliary contact kit per device may be added.
[17] Used to control a single phase motor utilizing a three phase starter.
[18] Standard on Type K devices.
[19] The lens cannot be replaced. The pilot light kits for NEMA 4 enclosed units are for replacement only.
16-11
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ U Motor Starters TeSys™ U Starter Components
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
TeSys U Selection
The NEMA style TeSys U motor starter is an integrated product—simple to choose and
For detailed information about TeSys U, to install—consisting of a control unit snapped into a power base. TeSys U can be
visit www.schneider-electric.com/us. configured to fit specific applications as well. The NEMA style TeSys U starter uses the
same optional accessories—reverser, current limiter, predictive maintenance options,
and communication options—as the IEC TeSys U.
Selecting a NEMA TeSys U Motor Starter in Three Steps
Step 1
Power Base
Step 2
Control Unit
Step 3 = NEMA TeSys™ U Motor Starter
Function Modules
Auxiliary Contacts
Enclosure Type
N: No enclosure
16
Table 16.37: TeSys N Non-Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [2]
200 1.5
230 1.5
00 9 T02AN13●●
460 2
575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 T02BN13●●
460 5
575 5
TeSys N non-reversing contactor, Size 1 200 7.5
230 7.5
1 27 T02CN13●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15
2 45 T02DN13●●
460 25
575 25
200 25
230 30
3 90 T02EN13●●[3]
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T02FN13●●[3]
460 100
575 100
200 75
TeSys N non-reversing contactor, Size 3 230 100
5 270 T02GN13●●[3]
460 200
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 T02HN13●●[3]
460 400
575 400
200 —
230 300
7 810 T02JN13●●[3]
460 600
575 600
Table 16.38: TeSys N Non-Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Single Phase, 600 Vac
Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog Number
115 1/3
00 9 T02AN13●●
230 1
115 1
0 18 T02BN13●●
230 2
115 2
1 27 T02CN13●●
230 3
115 3
2 45 T02DN13●●
230 7.5
[2] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to voltage codes shown in Table 16.39.
[3] Order lugs separately. See Table 16.61. The mounting hardware (screws, washers, and nuts) comes with the contactors, not the lugs. Starters Sizes 3–7 come with lugs.
16-14
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Reversing Contactors TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
Table 16.40: TeSys N Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
16
200 25
230 30
3 90 T02EN23●●[5]
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T02FN23●●[5]
460 100
575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 T02GN23●●[5]
460 200
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 T02HN23●●[5]
460 400
575 400
200 —
230 300
7 810 T02JN23●●[5]
460 600
575 600
Table 16.41: TeSys N Reversing Contactors, 3-Pole Single Phase, 600 Vac Max.
(replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Open
NEMA Size Current Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [4]
115 1/3
00 9 T02AN23●●
230 1
115 1
0 18 T02BN23●●
230 2
115 2
1 27 T02CN23●●
230 3
115 3
2 45 T02DN23●●
230 7.5
[4] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to the voltage codes shown in Table 16.42.
[5] Order lugs separately. See Table 16.61. The mounting hardware (screws, washers, and nuts) comes with the contactors, not the lugs. Starters Sizes 3–7 come with lugs.
16-15
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Non-Reversing Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
Table 16.43: 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max. (replace ●● with the coil voltage code)
Continuous Current Open
NEMA Size Motor Voltage Max HP
Rating (A) Catalog No. [6]
200 1.5
230 1.5
00 9 T36AN13●●
460 2
575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 T36BN13●●
TeSys N Size 1 Contactor + 460 5
TeSys N non-reversing starter, TeSys LRD Bimetallic Overload 575 5
Size 1 Relay 200 7.5
230 7.5
1 [7] 27 T36CN13●●
460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15
2 45 T36DN13●●
460 25
575 25
200 25
230 30
3 90 T36EN13●●
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T36FN13●●
460 100
575 100
TeSys N Size 1 Contactor + 200 75
TeSys N non-reversing starter, TeSys LR9D Electronic Overload 230 100
Size 3 Relay 5 270 T36GN13●●
460 200
For more information on TeSys D relays, see 575 200
Section 18. 200 150
230 200
6 540 T36HN13●●
460 400
575 400
Dimensions: page 16-22 200 —
TeSys N Accessories: pages page 16-18 230 300
7 810 T36JN13●●
460 600
575 600
Table 16.44: TeSys N Coil Voltage Codes Table 16.45: TeSys LR9D Electronic Overload Relays
Voltage Code by NEMA Size Current Setting Range (A) For Direct Mounting to Class 5/10/20/30
Voltage TeSys N Contactors Selectable
Size 00 Size 0 Size 1 Size 2 Size 3 Size 4 Size 5 Size 6 Size 7
24 Vac [8] B7 B7 B7 B7 B6 B6 — — — 0.1–0.5 LR9D01
24 Vdc [9] 0.4–2.0 LR9D02
BD BD BD BD BD BD — — — Size 00–1
1.6–8.0 LR9D08
120 Vac [8] G7 G7 G7 G7 G6 G6 G7 F7 F7 6.4–32 LR9D32
208 Vac LE7 LE7 LE7 LE7 L6 L6 L7 L7 L7
240 Vac U7 U7 U7 U7 U6 U6 U7 U7 U7
480 Vac T7 T7 T7 T7 Q5 Q5 S7 N7 N7
[6] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to the coil voltage codes shown in Table 16.44.
[7] Special size combinations of the contactor and Motor Logic overload relay are available. Add 0 to the catalog number before the coil voltage for a Size 0 overload relay (6–18 A); 9 for a Size
00C (3–9 A); and 8 for a Size 00B (1.5–4.5 A)—for example, T36CN130G7.
[8] The 24 and 120 Vac coils are available with optional separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN13B7S).
[9] The 24 Vdc coil requires separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN13BDS).
16-16
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Reversing Starters TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
Table 16.47: TeSys N Reversing Starters, 3-Pole Polyphase, 600 Vac Max.
16
575 25
200 25
230 30
3 90 T36EN23●●
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 T36FN23●●
460 100
TeSys N reversing starter, Size 4 575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 T36GN23●●
460 200
575 200
LR43364
Class 3211 04
[10] Replace the bullets (●●) in the catalog number with the coil voltage code. Refer to the coil voltage codes shown in Table 16.48.
[11] Special size combinations of the contactor and Motor Logic overload relay are available. Add 0 to the catalog number before the coil voltage for Size 0 overload relays (6–18 A); 9 for Size
00C (3–9 A); and 8 for Size 00B (1.5–4.5 A)—for example, T36CN230G7.
[12] The 24 and 120 Vac coils are available with optional separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN13B7S).
[13] The 24 Vdc coil requires separate control; add Form S to the catalog number (for example, T36AN23BDS).
16-17
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Accessories
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
Table 16.53: Coil Voltage Codes for LA6DK Mechanical Latch Blocks
Volts 24 120 208 240 480
AC or DC [23] B F L M R
[14] For spring terminal versions of these blocks, add a 3 to the end of the catalog number (for example, LADN223). For slip-on versions, add 9 to the end of the catalog number (for example,
LADN229).
[15] Including 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. make-before-break overlapping contacts.
[16] 1 block may be added to the left side of Size 00–1, AC coils only; only 1 block may be added to either side of the Size 2 contactor, AC coil only. Cannot be installed on Size 00–2 contactors
with DC coils.
[17] Device comes with 4 ground terminal points.
[18] For spring terminal versions of these blocks, add a 3 to the end of the catalog number (for example, LADT23). There is no charge for this modification.
[19] Scale range is expanded between 0.1 and 0.6 seconds on the dial for more accurate settings at the lower end of the range.
[20] Switching time between the opening of the N.C. contact and the closing of the N.O. contact: 40 ms ± 15 ms .
[21] Complete the catalog number by adding the coil voltage code (for example, LAD6K10F).
[22] Does not include internal coil clearing contact.
[23] DC available at 24 V only.
16-18
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Accessories TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
16
without tools[25]
120–240 V LAD4VU
24 V LAD4V3E
Snap-on mounting, and connection without
Size 2 120 V LAD4V3G
tools to the contactor coil terminals
120-240 V LAD4V3U
LAD4T3B
[24] Installing the suppressor into the cavity makes the electrical connection. The overall width of the contactor remains the same.
[25] Installing the suppressor into the cavity makes the electrical connection. The overall width of the contactor remains the same.
[26] Installing the suppressor into the cavity makes the electrical connection. The overall width of the contactor remains the same.
[27] For Size 00–2 with DC coils, 3-pole contactors are fitted with built-in bidirectional diode suppression as standard.
16-19
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters Accessories
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
0.1–2 s LA4DT0U
On-delay Size 00–2 1.5–30 s LA4DT2U
25–500 s LA4DT4U
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
The Interface Modules in Table 16.60 allow the contactor coils to be energized from low
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
voltage and low current level signals. They come in mechanical relay and solid-state
versions. The relay plus manual operation versions include a lever for manually turning
the contactor on and off. When a module receives a low-level signal, it allows the
separate-sourced control voltage to flow to the contactor coil. It saves space and wiring
time compared to conventional interposing relays.
LAD9ET1S LADN22S
16
230/240 LXD1U7 380 LXD3Q7
277 LXD1W7 400 LXD3V7
380/400 LXD1Q7 415 LXD3N7
400 LXD1V7 440 LXD3R7
415 LXD1N7 480 LXD3T7
440 LXD1R7 500 LXD3S7
480 LXD1T7 575 LXD3SC7
575 LXD1SC7 600 LXD3X7
600 LXD1X7 Specification 50/60 Hz
Specifications 50/60 Hz Average consumption:
Average consumption - Inrush (inductance 0.3) 140 VA (inductance: 0.9)
- Inrush (inductance 0.75) 70 VA - Sealed (inductance 0.3) 7.5 VA (inductance: 0.9)
- Sealed (inductance 0.3) 7 VA Operating range at θ < 55 °C / 131 °F 80–115% of nominal voltage
Operating range@ 60 °C 50 Hz: 80–110% of nominal
60 Hz: 85–110% of nominal
[31] Provided per pole: 2 fixed contacts, 1 movable contact, 2 deflectors, 1 backplate, and the mounting screws and washers.
[32] Complete the catalog number by adding the suffix (for example, LX1FF020).
[33] The 600 V coils for Sizes 6 and 7 do not include an auxiliary contact for holding circuits. If required, select the appropriate contacts from page 16-18.
[34] Complete the catalog number by adding the suffix (for example, LX4FF024).
16-21
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
TeSys™ N Contactors and Starters TeSys™ N Dimensions
Refer to Catalog MKTED210011EN
schneider-electric.us
6.54 166
Without cover or add-on blocks 4.65 118
4.80
4.61
c
117
122
=
b: Contactor base 3.35 85 3.35 85
c: With cover, without add-on blocks 3.62 92 3.98 101
e1 0.35 9 0.35 9
e2 0.20 5 0.20 5
60/70
G: Mounting holes 3.15 80 3.15 80
=
=
e2
16
122
128
X X
A A J
G G
F F
16
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
B B
H H
R
K
D D
E E
A N
G G A
F A/2 P
E F
X X
RESET
RESET
T
D
O D R
E
16
N
G A G A
F F G
P
16
X
X X
NEMA AND DEFINITE PURPOSE
CONTACTORS AND STARTERS
B H
H
B
RES ET
RES ET
K T
K D R
E D
J E
Catalog Numbering
Class 8536 Type S C G 3 V02 Form S
16
Design
page for each product for more options.
Type S NEMA Contactors and Starters
16-27
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Type S Full Voltage Contactors and Starters Contactors, Type S
Class 8502 / Refer to Catalog 8502CT9701
schneider-electric.us
General Information
Class 8502 Type S magnetic contactors are used to switch heating loads, capacitors,
transformers, and electric motors where overload protection is provided separately.
Class 8502 contactors are available in NEMA Sizes 00–7. Type S contactors are
designed for operation up to 600 Vac, 50–60 Hz.
NOTE: In Table 16.81, replace ●●● with the voltage code shown in Table 16.82.
Table 16.81: 3-Pole Polyphase—600 Vac Maximum—50–60 Hz
NEMA 4 & 4X
NEMA 1 Watertight, Dusttight
Continuous Open Type General Brushed Stainless
NEMA Motor Max. Purpose
Current Steel Enclosure
Size Ratings Voltage Hp Enclosure (Size 0-5) [1]
Type Type Type
200 1.5
230 1.5
Type SCO2 00 9 SAO12●●● SAG12●●● Use Size 0
460 2
Size 1, 3-Pole Contactor 575 2
200 3
230 3
0 18 SBO2●●● SBG2●●● SBW12●●●
460 5
575 5
200 7.5
230 7.5 SCO2●●● SCG2●●● SCW12●●●
1 27 460 10
575 10
200 10
230 15 SDO2●●● SDG2●●● SDW12●●●
2 45 460 25
575 25
200 25
3 90 230 30 SEO2●●● SEG2●●● SEW12●●●
460 50
575 50
200 40
230 50
4 135 460 100 SFO2●●● SFG2●●● SFW12●●●
575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 460 200 SGO2●●● SGG2●●● SGW12●●●
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 SHO2●●● SHG2●●● SHW2●●●
460 400
575 400
200 —
230 300
7 810 SJO2●●● SJG2●●● SJW2●●●
460 600
575 600
[1] Size 6 and 7 are NEMA 4 only, painted sheet steel enclosures.
[2] 24 V coils are not available on Sizes 4–7. On Sizes 00–3, where 24 V coils are available, Form S (separate control) must be specified (for example, order as 8502SBO2V01S).
[3] 120 V polyphase contactors are wired for separate control. Form S must be specified (i.e., order as 8502SCO2V02S).
16-28
© 2017 Schneider Electric
All Rights Reserved
11/10/2017
Contactors, Type S Type S Full Voltage Contactors and Starters
Class 8502 / Refer to Catalog 8502CT9701
schneider-electric.us
16
575 50
200 40
230 50 SFW22●●● — SFT42●●● SFR2●●● SFA2●●●
4 135 460 100
575 100
200 75
230 100
5 270 460 200 — — SGT42●●● SGR2●●● SGA2●●●
575 200
200 150
230 200
6 540 460 400 — — — — SHA2●●●
575 400
200 –
230 300
7 810 — — — — SJA2●●●
460 600
575 600
Auxiliary Units
Auxiliary contacts and power poles can be added in the factory or the field on all Type S
starters and contactors. Table 16.84 shows the maximum number of auxiliary units, in
addition to the holding circuit contact, that can be added to a given size starter or
contactor. In addition, it is possible to add a second internal contact on NEMA Size 0, 1,
and 2 contactors and starters.
Table 16.84: Auxiliary Units—Class 8502 and 8536
Type Maximum Number of External Auxiliary Units
NEMA Size No. of Poles—Basic Contactor (in addition to holding circuit contact)
00 SA 2–3 4 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) if second internal auxiliary contact is not used.
4 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) [7]
1–3
0–2 SB–SD 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) plus 1 power pole adder (1 or 2 poles, N.O. or N.C.)
4–5 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.)
3–4 SE–SF 2–5 3 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.)
5 SG 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) plus 1 NEMA Size 0–1 or Size 2 power pole adder
2–3 (1 or 2 poles, N.O. or N.C.)
3 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.)
6–7 SH–SJ 2–3 2 single-circuit auxiliary contacts (N.O. or N.C.) plus 1 NEMA Size 0–1 or Size 2 power pole adder
(1 or 2 poles, N.O. or N.C.)
Dimensions page 16-38
Factory Modifications (Forms) page 16-115
Separate Enclosures (Class 9991) page 16-108
Replacement Parts (Class 9998) page 16-90
Type S Accessories (Class 9999) page 16-123
For How to Order Information, see page 16-27.
[4] NEMA 12 enclosures can be field modified for outdoor non-corrosive and non–service entrance rated applications.
[5] Limited to one pilot light, and a selector switch or Start-Stop push button.
[6] NEMA 7 and 9 bolted cast aluminum are not UL listed